You can not select more than 25 topics Topics must start with a letter or number, can include dashes ('-') and can be up to 35 characters long.

24835 lines
661KB

  1. @chapter Filtering Introduction
  2. @c man begin FILTERING INTRODUCTION
  3. Filtering in FFmpeg is enabled through the libavfilter library.
  4. In libavfilter, a filter can have multiple inputs and multiple
  5. outputs.
  6. To illustrate the sorts of things that are possible, we consider the
  7. following filtergraph.
  8. @verbatim
  9. [main]
  10. input --> split ---------------------> overlay --> output
  11. | ^
  12. |[tmp] [flip]|
  13. +-----> crop --> vflip -------+
  14. @end verbatim
  15. This filtergraph splits the input stream in two streams, then sends one
  16. stream through the crop filter and the vflip filter, before merging it
  17. back with the other stream by overlaying it on top. You can use the
  18. following command to achieve this:
  19. @example
  20. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf "split [main][tmp]; [tmp] crop=iw:ih/2:0:0, vflip [flip]; [main][flip] overlay=0:H/2" OUTPUT
  21. @end example
  22. The result will be that the top half of the video is mirrored
  23. onto the bottom half of the output video.
  24. Filters in the same linear chain are separated by commas, and distinct
  25. linear chains of filters are separated by semicolons. In our example,
  26. @var{crop,vflip} are in one linear chain, @var{split} and
  27. @var{overlay} are separately in another. The points where the linear
  28. chains join are labelled by names enclosed in square brackets. In the
  29. example, the split filter generates two outputs that are associated to
  30. the labels @var{[main]} and @var{[tmp]}.
  31. The stream sent to the second output of @var{split}, labelled as
  32. @var{[tmp]}, is processed through the @var{crop} filter, which crops
  33. away the lower half part of the video, and then vertically flipped. The
  34. @var{overlay} filter takes in input the first unchanged output of the
  35. split filter (which was labelled as @var{[main]}), and overlay on its
  36. lower half the output generated by the @var{crop,vflip} filterchain.
  37. Some filters take in input a list of parameters: they are specified
  38. after the filter name and an equal sign, and are separated from each other
  39. by a colon.
  40. There exist so-called @var{source filters} that do not have an
  41. audio/video input, and @var{sink filters} that will not have audio/video
  42. output.
  43. @c man end FILTERING INTRODUCTION
  44. @chapter graph2dot
  45. @c man begin GRAPH2DOT
  46. The @file{graph2dot} program included in the FFmpeg @file{tools}
  47. directory can be used to parse a filtergraph description and issue a
  48. corresponding textual representation in the dot language.
  49. Invoke the command:
  50. @example
  51. graph2dot -h
  52. @end example
  53. to see how to use @file{graph2dot}.
  54. You can then pass the dot description to the @file{dot} program (from
  55. the graphviz suite of programs) and obtain a graphical representation
  56. of the filtergraph.
  57. For example the sequence of commands:
  58. @example
  59. echo @var{GRAPH_DESCRIPTION} | \
  60. tools/graph2dot -o graph.tmp && \
  61. dot -Tpng graph.tmp -o graph.png && \
  62. display graph.png
  63. @end example
  64. can be used to create and display an image representing the graph
  65. described by the @var{GRAPH_DESCRIPTION} string. Note that this string must be
  66. a complete self-contained graph, with its inputs and outputs explicitly defined.
  67. For example if your command line is of the form:
  68. @example
  69. ffmpeg -i infile -vf scale=640:360 outfile
  70. @end example
  71. your @var{GRAPH_DESCRIPTION} string will need to be of the form:
  72. @example
  73. nullsrc,scale=640:360,nullsink
  74. @end example
  75. you may also need to set the @var{nullsrc} parameters and add a @var{format}
  76. filter in order to simulate a specific input file.
  77. @c man end GRAPH2DOT
  78. @chapter Filtergraph description
  79. @c man begin FILTERGRAPH DESCRIPTION
  80. A filtergraph is a directed graph of connected filters. It can contain
  81. cycles, and there can be multiple links between a pair of
  82. filters. Each link has one input pad on one side connecting it to one
  83. filter from which it takes its input, and one output pad on the other
  84. side connecting it to one filter accepting its output.
  85. Each filter in a filtergraph is an instance of a filter class
  86. registered in the application, which defines the features and the
  87. number of input and output pads of the filter.
  88. A filter with no input pads is called a "source", and a filter with no
  89. output pads is called a "sink".
  90. @anchor{Filtergraph syntax}
  91. @section Filtergraph syntax
  92. A filtergraph has a textual representation, which is recognized by the
  93. @option{-filter}/@option{-vf}/@option{-af} and
  94. @option{-filter_complex} options in @command{ffmpeg} and
  95. @option{-vf}/@option{-af} in @command{ffplay}, and by the
  96. @code{avfilter_graph_parse_ptr()} function defined in
  97. @file{libavfilter/avfilter.h}.
  98. A filterchain consists of a sequence of connected filters, each one
  99. connected to the previous one in the sequence. A filterchain is
  100. represented by a list of ","-separated filter descriptions.
  101. A filtergraph consists of a sequence of filterchains. A sequence of
  102. filterchains is represented by a list of ";"-separated filterchain
  103. descriptions.
  104. A filter is represented by a string of the form:
  105. [@var{in_link_1}]...[@var{in_link_N}]@var{filter_name}@@@var{id}=@var{arguments}[@var{out_link_1}]...[@var{out_link_M}]
  106. @var{filter_name} is the name of the filter class of which the
  107. described filter is an instance of, and has to be the name of one of
  108. the filter classes registered in the program optionally followed by "@@@var{id}".
  109. The name of the filter class is optionally followed by a string
  110. "=@var{arguments}".
  111. @var{arguments} is a string which contains the parameters used to
  112. initialize the filter instance. It may have one of two forms:
  113. @itemize
  114. @item
  115. A ':'-separated list of @var{key=value} pairs.
  116. @item
  117. A ':'-separated list of @var{value}. In this case, the keys are assumed to be
  118. the option names in the order they are declared. E.g. the @code{fade} filter
  119. declares three options in this order -- @option{type}, @option{start_frame} and
  120. @option{nb_frames}. Then the parameter list @var{in:0:30} means that the value
  121. @var{in} is assigned to the option @option{type}, @var{0} to
  122. @option{start_frame} and @var{30} to @option{nb_frames}.
  123. @item
  124. A ':'-separated list of mixed direct @var{value} and long @var{key=value}
  125. pairs. The direct @var{value} must precede the @var{key=value} pairs, and
  126. follow the same constraints order of the previous point. The following
  127. @var{key=value} pairs can be set in any preferred order.
  128. @end itemize
  129. If the option value itself is a list of items (e.g. the @code{format} filter
  130. takes a list of pixel formats), the items in the list are usually separated by
  131. @samp{|}.
  132. The list of arguments can be quoted using the character @samp{'} as initial
  133. and ending mark, and the character @samp{\} for escaping the characters
  134. within the quoted text; otherwise the argument string is considered
  135. terminated when the next special character (belonging to the set
  136. @samp{[]=;,}) is encountered.
  137. The name and arguments of the filter are optionally preceded and
  138. followed by a list of link labels.
  139. A link label allows one to name a link and associate it to a filter output
  140. or input pad. The preceding labels @var{in_link_1}
  141. ... @var{in_link_N}, are associated to the filter input pads,
  142. the following labels @var{out_link_1} ... @var{out_link_M}, are
  143. associated to the output pads.
  144. When two link labels with the same name are found in the
  145. filtergraph, a link between the corresponding input and output pad is
  146. created.
  147. If an output pad is not labelled, it is linked by default to the first
  148. unlabelled input pad of the next filter in the filterchain.
  149. For example in the filterchain
  150. @example
  151. nullsrc, split[L1], [L2]overlay, nullsink
  152. @end example
  153. the split filter instance has two output pads, and the overlay filter
  154. instance two input pads. The first output pad of split is labelled
  155. "L1", the first input pad of overlay is labelled "L2", and the second
  156. output pad of split is linked to the second input pad of overlay,
  157. which are both unlabelled.
  158. In a filter description, if the input label of the first filter is not
  159. specified, "in" is assumed; if the output label of the last filter is not
  160. specified, "out" is assumed.
  161. In a complete filterchain all the unlabelled filter input and output
  162. pads must be connected. A filtergraph is considered valid if all the
  163. filter input and output pads of all the filterchains are connected.
  164. Libavfilter will automatically insert @ref{scale} filters where format
  165. conversion is required. It is possible to specify swscale flags
  166. for those automatically inserted scalers by prepending
  167. @code{sws_flags=@var{flags};}
  168. to the filtergraph description.
  169. Here is a BNF description of the filtergraph syntax:
  170. @example
  171. @var{NAME} ::= sequence of alphanumeric characters and '_'
  172. @var{FILTER_NAME} ::= @var{NAME}["@@"@var{NAME}]
  173. @var{LINKLABEL} ::= "[" @var{NAME} "]"
  174. @var{LINKLABELS} ::= @var{LINKLABEL} [@var{LINKLABELS}]
  175. @var{FILTER_ARGUMENTS} ::= sequence of chars (possibly quoted)
  176. @var{FILTER} ::= [@var{LINKLABELS}] @var{FILTER_NAME} ["=" @var{FILTER_ARGUMENTS}] [@var{LINKLABELS}]
  177. @var{FILTERCHAIN} ::= @var{FILTER} [,@var{FILTERCHAIN}]
  178. @var{FILTERGRAPH} ::= [sws_flags=@var{flags};] @var{FILTERCHAIN} [;@var{FILTERGRAPH}]
  179. @end example
  180. @anchor{filtergraph escaping}
  181. @section Notes on filtergraph escaping
  182. Filtergraph description composition entails several levels of
  183. escaping. See @ref{quoting_and_escaping,,the "Quoting and escaping"
  184. section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils} for more
  185. information about the employed escaping procedure.
  186. A first level escaping affects the content of each filter option
  187. value, which may contain the special character @code{:} used to
  188. separate values, or one of the escaping characters @code{\'}.
  189. A second level escaping affects the whole filter description, which
  190. may contain the escaping characters @code{\'} or the special
  191. characters @code{[],;} used by the filtergraph description.
  192. Finally, when you specify a filtergraph on a shell commandline, you
  193. need to perform a third level escaping for the shell special
  194. characters contained within it.
  195. For example, consider the following string to be embedded in
  196. the @ref{drawtext} filter description @option{text} value:
  197. @example
  198. this is a 'string': may contain one, or more, special characters
  199. @end example
  200. This string contains the @code{'} special escaping character, and the
  201. @code{:} special character, so it needs to be escaped in this way:
  202. @example
  203. text=this is a \'string\'\: may contain one, or more, special characters
  204. @end example
  205. A second level of escaping is required when embedding the filter
  206. description in a filtergraph description, in order to escape all the
  207. filtergraph special characters. Thus the example above becomes:
  208. @example
  209. drawtext=text=this is a \\\'string\\\'\\: may contain one\, or more\, special characters
  210. @end example
  211. (note that in addition to the @code{\'} escaping special characters,
  212. also @code{,} needs to be escaped).
  213. Finally an additional level of escaping is needed when writing the
  214. filtergraph description in a shell command, which depends on the
  215. escaping rules of the adopted shell. For example, assuming that
  216. @code{\} is special and needs to be escaped with another @code{\}, the
  217. previous string will finally result in:
  218. @example
  219. -vf "drawtext=text=this is a \\\\\\'string\\\\\\'\\\\: may contain one\\, or more\\, special characters"
  220. @end example
  221. @chapter Timeline editing
  222. Some filters support a generic @option{enable} option. For the filters
  223. supporting timeline editing, this option can be set to an expression which is
  224. evaluated before sending a frame to the filter. If the evaluation is non-zero,
  225. the filter will be enabled, otherwise the frame will be sent unchanged to the
  226. next filter in the filtergraph.
  227. The expression accepts the following values:
  228. @table @samp
  229. @item t
  230. timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown
  231. @item n
  232. sequential number of the input frame, starting from 0
  233. @item pos
  234. the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown
  235. @item w
  236. @item h
  237. width and height of the input frame if video
  238. @end table
  239. Additionally, these filters support an @option{enable} command that can be used
  240. to re-define the expression.
  241. Like any other filtering option, the @option{enable} option follows the same
  242. rules.
  243. For example, to enable a blur filter (@ref{smartblur}) from 10 seconds to 3
  244. minutes, and a @ref{curves} filter starting at 3 seconds:
  245. @example
  246. smartblur = enable='between(t,10,3*60)',
  247. curves = enable='gte(t,3)' : preset=cross_process
  248. @end example
  249. See @code{ffmpeg -filters} to view which filters have timeline support.
  250. @c man end FILTERGRAPH DESCRIPTION
  251. @anchor{commands}
  252. @chapter Changing options at runtime with a command
  253. Some options can be changed during the operation of the filter using
  254. a command. These options are marked 'T' on the output of
  255. @command{ffmpeg} @option{-h filter=<name of filter>}.
  256. The name of the command is the name of the option and the argument is
  257. the new value.
  258. @anchor{framesync}
  259. @chapter Options for filters with several inputs (framesync)
  260. @c man begin OPTIONS FOR FILTERS WITH SEVERAL INPUTS
  261. Some filters with several inputs support a common set of options.
  262. These options can only be set by name, not with the short notation.
  263. @table @option
  264. @item eof_action
  265. The action to take when EOF is encountered on the secondary input; it accepts
  266. one of the following values:
  267. @table @option
  268. @item repeat
  269. Repeat the last frame (the default).
  270. @item endall
  271. End both streams.
  272. @item pass
  273. Pass the main input through.
  274. @end table
  275. @item shortest
  276. If set to 1, force the output to terminate when the shortest input
  277. terminates. Default value is 0.
  278. @item repeatlast
  279. If set to 1, force the filter to extend the last frame of secondary streams
  280. until the end of the primary stream. A value of 0 disables this behavior.
  281. Default value is 1.
  282. @end table
  283. @c man end OPTIONS FOR FILTERS WITH SEVERAL INPUTS
  284. @chapter Audio Filters
  285. @c man begin AUDIO FILTERS
  286. When you configure your FFmpeg build, you can disable any of the
  287. existing filters using @code{--disable-filters}.
  288. The configure output will show the audio filters included in your
  289. build.
  290. Below is a description of the currently available audio filters.
  291. @section acompressor
  292. A compressor is mainly used to reduce the dynamic range of a signal.
  293. Especially modern music is mostly compressed at a high ratio to
  294. improve the overall loudness. It's done to get the highest attention
  295. of a listener, "fatten" the sound and bring more "power" to the track.
  296. If a signal is compressed too much it may sound dull or "dead"
  297. afterwards or it may start to "pump" (which could be a powerful effect
  298. but can also destroy a track completely).
  299. The right compression is the key to reach a professional sound and is
  300. the high art of mixing and mastering. Because of its complex settings
  301. it may take a long time to get the right feeling for this kind of effect.
  302. Compression is done by detecting the volume above a chosen level
  303. @code{threshold} and dividing it by the factor set with @code{ratio}.
  304. So if you set the threshold to -12dB and your signal reaches -6dB a ratio
  305. of 2:1 will result in a signal at -9dB. Because an exact manipulation of
  306. the signal would cause distortion of the waveform the reduction can be
  307. levelled over the time. This is done by setting "Attack" and "Release".
  308. @code{attack} determines how long the signal has to rise above the threshold
  309. before any reduction will occur and @code{release} sets the time the signal
  310. has to fall below the threshold to reduce the reduction again. Shorter signals
  311. than the chosen attack time will be left untouched.
  312. The overall reduction of the signal can be made up afterwards with the
  313. @code{makeup} setting. So compressing the peaks of a signal about 6dB and
  314. raising the makeup to this level results in a signal twice as loud than the
  315. source. To gain a softer entry in the compression the @code{knee} flattens the
  316. hard edge at the threshold in the range of the chosen decibels.
  317. The filter accepts the following options:
  318. @table @option
  319. @item level_in
  320. Set input gain. Default is 1. Range is between 0.015625 and 64.
  321. @item mode
  322. Set mode of compressor operation. Can be @code{upward} or @code{downward}.
  323. Default is @code{downward}.
  324. @item threshold
  325. If a signal of stream rises above this level it will affect the gain
  326. reduction.
  327. By default it is 0.125. Range is between 0.00097563 and 1.
  328. @item ratio
  329. Set a ratio by which the signal is reduced. 1:2 means that if the level
  330. rose 4dB above the threshold, it will be only 2dB above after the reduction.
  331. Default is 2. Range is between 1 and 20.
  332. @item attack
  333. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain
  334. reduction starts. Default is 20. Range is between 0.01 and 2000.
  335. @item release
  336. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before
  337. reduction is decreased again. Default is 250. Range is between 0.01 and 9000.
  338. @item makeup
  339. Set the amount by how much signal will be amplified after processing.
  340. Default is 1. Range is from 1 to 64.
  341. @item knee
  342. Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.
  343. Default is 2.82843. Range is between 1 and 8.
  344. @item link
  345. Choose if the @code{average} level between all channels of input stream
  346. or the louder(@code{maximum}) channel of input stream affects the
  347. reduction. Default is @code{average}.
  348. @item detection
  349. Should the exact signal be taken in case of @code{peak} or an RMS one in case
  350. of @code{rms}. Default is @code{rms} which is mostly smoother.
  351. @item mix
  352. How much to use compressed signal in output. Default is 1.
  353. Range is between 0 and 1.
  354. @end table
  355. @subsection Commands
  356. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  357. @section acontrast
  358. Simple audio dynamic range compression/expansion filter.
  359. The filter accepts the following options:
  360. @table @option
  361. @item contrast
  362. Set contrast. Default is 33. Allowed range is between 0 and 100.
  363. @end table
  364. @section acopy
  365. Copy the input audio source unchanged to the output. This is mainly useful for
  366. testing purposes.
  367. @section acrossfade
  368. Apply cross fade from one input audio stream to another input audio stream.
  369. The cross fade is applied for specified duration near the end of first stream.
  370. The filter accepts the following options:
  371. @table @option
  372. @item nb_samples, ns
  373. Specify the number of samples for which the cross fade effect has to last.
  374. At the end of the cross fade effect the first input audio will be completely
  375. silent. Default is 44100.
  376. @item duration, d
  377. Specify the duration of the cross fade effect. See
  378. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  379. for the accepted syntax.
  380. By default the duration is determined by @var{nb_samples}.
  381. If set this option is used instead of @var{nb_samples}.
  382. @item overlap, o
  383. Should first stream end overlap with second stream start. Default is enabled.
  384. @item curve1
  385. Set curve for cross fade transition for first stream.
  386. @item curve2
  387. Set curve for cross fade transition for second stream.
  388. For description of available curve types see @ref{afade} filter description.
  389. @end table
  390. @subsection Examples
  391. @itemize
  392. @item
  393. Cross fade from one input to another:
  394. @example
  395. ffmpeg -i first.flac -i second.flac -filter_complex acrossfade=d=10:c1=exp:c2=exp output.flac
  396. @end example
  397. @item
  398. Cross fade from one input to another but without overlapping:
  399. @example
  400. ffmpeg -i first.flac -i second.flac -filter_complex acrossfade=d=10:o=0:c1=exp:c2=exp output.flac
  401. @end example
  402. @end itemize
  403. @section acrossover
  404. Split audio stream into several bands.
  405. This filter splits audio stream into two or more frequency ranges.
  406. Summing all streams back will give flat output.
  407. The filter accepts the following options:
  408. @table @option
  409. @item split
  410. Set split frequencies. Those must be positive and increasing.
  411. @item order
  412. Set filter order, can be @var{2nd}, @var{4th} or @var{8th}.
  413. Default is @var{4th}.
  414. @end table
  415. @section acrusher
  416. Reduce audio bit resolution.
  417. This filter is bit crusher with enhanced functionality. A bit crusher
  418. is used to audibly reduce number of bits an audio signal is sampled
  419. with. This doesn't change the bit depth at all, it just produces the
  420. effect. Material reduced in bit depth sounds more harsh and "digital".
  421. This filter is able to even round to continuous values instead of discrete
  422. bit depths.
  423. Additionally it has a D/C offset which results in different crushing of
  424. the lower and the upper half of the signal.
  425. An Anti-Aliasing setting is able to produce "softer" crushing sounds.
  426. Another feature of this filter is the logarithmic mode.
  427. This setting switches from linear distances between bits to logarithmic ones.
  428. The result is a much more "natural" sounding crusher which doesn't gate low
  429. signals for example. The human ear has a logarithmic perception,
  430. so this kind of crushing is much more pleasant.
  431. Logarithmic crushing is also able to get anti-aliased.
  432. The filter accepts the following options:
  433. @table @option
  434. @item level_in
  435. Set level in.
  436. @item level_out
  437. Set level out.
  438. @item bits
  439. Set bit reduction.
  440. @item mix
  441. Set mixing amount.
  442. @item mode
  443. Can be linear: @code{lin} or logarithmic: @code{log}.
  444. @item dc
  445. Set DC.
  446. @item aa
  447. Set anti-aliasing.
  448. @item samples
  449. Set sample reduction.
  450. @item lfo
  451. Enable LFO. By default disabled.
  452. @item lforange
  453. Set LFO range.
  454. @item lforate
  455. Set LFO rate.
  456. @end table
  457. @section acue
  458. Delay audio filtering until a given wallclock timestamp. See the @ref{cue}
  459. filter.
  460. @section adeclick
  461. Remove impulsive noise from input audio.
  462. Samples detected as impulsive noise are replaced by interpolated samples using
  463. autoregressive modelling.
  464. @table @option
  465. @item w
  466. Set window size, in milliseconds. Allowed range is from @code{10} to
  467. @code{100}. Default value is @code{55} milliseconds.
  468. This sets size of window which will be processed at once.
  469. @item o
  470. Set window overlap, in percentage of window size. Allowed range is from
  471. @code{50} to @code{95}. Default value is @code{75} percent.
  472. Setting this to a very high value increases impulsive noise removal but makes
  473. whole process much slower.
  474. @item a
  475. Set autoregression order, in percentage of window size. Allowed range is from
  476. @code{0} to @code{25}. Default value is @code{2} percent. This option also
  477. controls quality of interpolated samples using neighbour good samples.
  478. @item t
  479. Set threshold value. Allowed range is from @code{1} to @code{100}.
  480. Default value is @code{2}.
  481. This controls the strength of impulsive noise which is going to be removed.
  482. The lower value, the more samples will be detected as impulsive noise.
  483. @item b
  484. Set burst fusion, in percentage of window size. Allowed range is @code{0} to
  485. @code{10}. Default value is @code{2}.
  486. If any two samples detected as noise are spaced less than this value then any
  487. sample between those two samples will be also detected as noise.
  488. @item m
  489. Set overlap method.
  490. It accepts the following values:
  491. @table @option
  492. @item a
  493. Select overlap-add method. Even not interpolated samples are slightly
  494. changed with this method.
  495. @item s
  496. Select overlap-save method. Not interpolated samples remain unchanged.
  497. @end table
  498. Default value is @code{a}.
  499. @end table
  500. @section adeclip
  501. Remove clipped samples from input audio.
  502. Samples detected as clipped are replaced by interpolated samples using
  503. autoregressive modelling.
  504. @table @option
  505. @item w
  506. Set window size, in milliseconds. Allowed range is from @code{10} to @code{100}.
  507. Default value is @code{55} milliseconds.
  508. This sets size of window which will be processed at once.
  509. @item o
  510. Set window overlap, in percentage of window size. Allowed range is from @code{50}
  511. to @code{95}. Default value is @code{75} percent.
  512. @item a
  513. Set autoregression order, in percentage of window size. Allowed range is from
  514. @code{0} to @code{25}. Default value is @code{8} percent. This option also controls
  515. quality of interpolated samples using neighbour good samples.
  516. @item t
  517. Set threshold value. Allowed range is from @code{1} to @code{100}.
  518. Default value is @code{10}. Higher values make clip detection less aggressive.
  519. @item n
  520. Set size of histogram used to detect clips. Allowed range is from @code{100} to @code{9999}.
  521. Default value is @code{1000}. Higher values make clip detection less aggressive.
  522. @item m
  523. Set overlap method.
  524. It accepts the following values:
  525. @table @option
  526. @item a
  527. Select overlap-add method. Even not interpolated samples are slightly changed
  528. with this method.
  529. @item s
  530. Select overlap-save method. Not interpolated samples remain unchanged.
  531. @end table
  532. Default value is @code{a}.
  533. @end table
  534. @section adelay
  535. Delay one or more audio channels.
  536. Samples in delayed channel are filled with silence.
  537. The filter accepts the following option:
  538. @table @option
  539. @item delays
  540. Set list of delays in milliseconds for each channel separated by '|'.
  541. Unused delays will be silently ignored. If number of given delays is
  542. smaller than number of channels all remaining channels will not be delayed.
  543. If you want to delay exact number of samples, append 'S' to number.
  544. If you want instead to delay in seconds, append 's' to number.
  545. @item all
  546. Use last set delay for all remaining channels. By default is disabled.
  547. This option if enabled changes how option @code{delays} is interpreted.
  548. @end table
  549. @subsection Examples
  550. @itemize
  551. @item
  552. Delay first channel by 1.5 seconds, the third channel by 0.5 seconds and leave
  553. the second channel (and any other channels that may be present) unchanged.
  554. @example
  555. adelay=1500|0|500
  556. @end example
  557. @item
  558. Delay second channel by 500 samples, the third channel by 700 samples and leave
  559. the first channel (and any other channels that may be present) unchanged.
  560. @example
  561. adelay=0|500S|700S
  562. @end example
  563. @item
  564. Delay all channels by same number of samples:
  565. @example
  566. adelay=delays=64S:all=1
  567. @end example
  568. @end itemize
  569. @section aderivative, aintegral
  570. Compute derivative/integral of audio stream.
  571. Applying both filters one after another produces original audio.
  572. @section aecho
  573. Apply echoing to the input audio.
  574. Echoes are reflected sound and can occur naturally amongst mountains
  575. (and sometimes large buildings) when talking or shouting; digital echo
  576. effects emulate this behaviour and are often used to help fill out the
  577. sound of a single instrument or vocal. The time difference between the
  578. original signal and the reflection is the @code{delay}, and the
  579. loudness of the reflected signal is the @code{decay}.
  580. Multiple echoes can have different delays and decays.
  581. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  582. @table @option
  583. @item in_gain
  584. Set input gain of reflected signal. Default is @code{0.6}.
  585. @item out_gain
  586. Set output gain of reflected signal. Default is @code{0.3}.
  587. @item delays
  588. Set list of time intervals in milliseconds between original signal and reflections
  589. separated by '|'. Allowed range for each @code{delay} is @code{(0 - 90000.0]}.
  590. Default is @code{1000}.
  591. @item decays
  592. Set list of loudness of reflected signals separated by '|'.
  593. Allowed range for each @code{decay} is @code{(0 - 1.0]}.
  594. Default is @code{0.5}.
  595. @end table
  596. @subsection Examples
  597. @itemize
  598. @item
  599. Make it sound as if there are twice as many instruments as are actually playing:
  600. @example
  601. aecho=0.8:0.88:60:0.4
  602. @end example
  603. @item
  604. If delay is very short, then it sounds like a (metallic) robot playing music:
  605. @example
  606. aecho=0.8:0.88:6:0.4
  607. @end example
  608. @item
  609. A longer delay will sound like an open air concert in the mountains:
  610. @example
  611. aecho=0.8:0.9:1000:0.3
  612. @end example
  613. @item
  614. Same as above but with one more mountain:
  615. @example
  616. aecho=0.8:0.9:1000|1800:0.3|0.25
  617. @end example
  618. @end itemize
  619. @section aemphasis
  620. Audio emphasis filter creates or restores material directly taken from LPs or
  621. emphased CDs with different filter curves. E.g. to store music on vinyl the
  622. signal has to be altered by a filter first to even out the disadvantages of
  623. this recording medium.
  624. Once the material is played back the inverse filter has to be applied to
  625. restore the distortion of the frequency response.
  626. The filter accepts the following options:
  627. @table @option
  628. @item level_in
  629. Set input gain.
  630. @item level_out
  631. Set output gain.
  632. @item mode
  633. Set filter mode. For restoring material use @code{reproduction} mode, otherwise
  634. use @code{production} mode. Default is @code{reproduction} mode.
  635. @item type
  636. Set filter type. Selects medium. Can be one of the following:
  637. @table @option
  638. @item col
  639. select Columbia.
  640. @item emi
  641. select EMI.
  642. @item bsi
  643. select BSI (78RPM).
  644. @item riaa
  645. select RIAA.
  646. @item cd
  647. select Compact Disc (CD).
  648. @item 50fm
  649. select 50µs (FM).
  650. @item 75fm
  651. select 75µs (FM).
  652. @item 50kf
  653. select 50µs (FM-KF).
  654. @item 75kf
  655. select 75µs (FM-KF).
  656. @end table
  657. @end table
  658. @section aeval
  659. Modify an audio signal according to the specified expressions.
  660. This filter accepts one or more expressions (one for each channel),
  661. which are evaluated and used to modify a corresponding audio signal.
  662. It accepts the following parameters:
  663. @table @option
  664. @item exprs
  665. Set the '|'-separated expressions list for each separate channel. If
  666. the number of input channels is greater than the number of
  667. expressions, the last specified expression is used for the remaining
  668. output channels.
  669. @item channel_layout, c
  670. Set output channel layout. If not specified, the channel layout is
  671. specified by the number of expressions. If set to @samp{same}, it will
  672. use by default the same input channel layout.
  673. @end table
  674. Each expression in @var{exprs} can contain the following constants and functions:
  675. @table @option
  676. @item ch
  677. channel number of the current expression
  678. @item n
  679. number of the evaluated sample, starting from 0
  680. @item s
  681. sample rate
  682. @item t
  683. time of the evaluated sample expressed in seconds
  684. @item nb_in_channels
  685. @item nb_out_channels
  686. input and output number of channels
  687. @item val(CH)
  688. the value of input channel with number @var{CH}
  689. @end table
  690. Note: this filter is slow. For faster processing you should use a
  691. dedicated filter.
  692. @subsection Examples
  693. @itemize
  694. @item
  695. Half volume:
  696. @example
  697. aeval=val(ch)/2:c=same
  698. @end example
  699. @item
  700. Invert phase of the second channel:
  701. @example
  702. aeval=val(0)|-val(1)
  703. @end example
  704. @end itemize
  705. @anchor{afade}
  706. @section afade
  707. Apply fade-in/out effect to input audio.
  708. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  709. @table @option
  710. @item type, t
  711. Specify the effect type, can be either @code{in} for fade-in, or
  712. @code{out} for a fade-out effect. Default is @code{in}.
  713. @item start_sample, ss
  714. Specify the number of the start sample for starting to apply the fade
  715. effect. Default is 0.
  716. @item nb_samples, ns
  717. Specify the number of samples for which the fade effect has to last. At
  718. the end of the fade-in effect the output audio will have the same
  719. volume as the input audio, at the end of the fade-out transition
  720. the output audio will be silence. Default is 44100.
  721. @item start_time, st
  722. Specify the start time of the fade effect. Default is 0.
  723. The value must be specified as a time duration; see
  724. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  725. for the accepted syntax.
  726. If set this option is used instead of @var{start_sample}.
  727. @item duration, d
  728. Specify the duration of the fade effect. See
  729. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  730. for the accepted syntax.
  731. At the end of the fade-in effect the output audio will have the same
  732. volume as the input audio, at the end of the fade-out transition
  733. the output audio will be silence.
  734. By default the duration is determined by @var{nb_samples}.
  735. If set this option is used instead of @var{nb_samples}.
  736. @item curve
  737. Set curve for fade transition.
  738. It accepts the following values:
  739. @table @option
  740. @item tri
  741. select triangular, linear slope (default)
  742. @item qsin
  743. select quarter of sine wave
  744. @item hsin
  745. select half of sine wave
  746. @item esin
  747. select exponential sine wave
  748. @item log
  749. select logarithmic
  750. @item ipar
  751. select inverted parabola
  752. @item qua
  753. select quadratic
  754. @item cub
  755. select cubic
  756. @item squ
  757. select square root
  758. @item cbr
  759. select cubic root
  760. @item par
  761. select parabola
  762. @item exp
  763. select exponential
  764. @item iqsin
  765. select inverted quarter of sine wave
  766. @item ihsin
  767. select inverted half of sine wave
  768. @item dese
  769. select double-exponential seat
  770. @item desi
  771. select double-exponential sigmoid
  772. @item losi
  773. select logistic sigmoid
  774. @item nofade
  775. no fade applied
  776. @end table
  777. @end table
  778. @subsection Examples
  779. @itemize
  780. @item
  781. Fade in first 15 seconds of audio:
  782. @example
  783. afade=t=in:ss=0:d=15
  784. @end example
  785. @item
  786. Fade out last 25 seconds of a 900 seconds audio:
  787. @example
  788. afade=t=out:st=875:d=25
  789. @end example
  790. @end itemize
  791. @section afftdn
  792. Denoise audio samples with FFT.
  793. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  794. @table @option
  795. @item nr
  796. Set the noise reduction in dB, allowed range is 0.01 to 97.
  797. Default value is 12 dB.
  798. @item nf
  799. Set the noise floor in dB, allowed range is -80 to -20.
  800. Default value is -50 dB.
  801. @item nt
  802. Set the noise type.
  803. It accepts the following values:
  804. @table @option
  805. @item w
  806. Select white noise.
  807. @item v
  808. Select vinyl noise.
  809. @item s
  810. Select shellac noise.
  811. @item c
  812. Select custom noise, defined in @code{bn} option.
  813. Default value is white noise.
  814. @end table
  815. @item bn
  816. Set custom band noise for every one of 15 bands.
  817. Bands are separated by ' ' or '|'.
  818. @item rf
  819. Set the residual floor in dB, allowed range is -80 to -20.
  820. Default value is -38 dB.
  821. @item tn
  822. Enable noise tracking. By default is disabled.
  823. With this enabled, noise floor is automatically adjusted.
  824. @item tr
  825. Enable residual tracking. By default is disabled.
  826. @item om
  827. Set the output mode.
  828. It accepts the following values:
  829. @table @option
  830. @item i
  831. Pass input unchanged.
  832. @item o
  833. Pass noise filtered out.
  834. @item n
  835. Pass only noise.
  836. Default value is @var{o}.
  837. @end table
  838. @end table
  839. @subsection Commands
  840. This filter supports the following commands:
  841. @table @option
  842. @item sample_noise, sn
  843. Start or stop measuring noise profile.
  844. Syntax for the command is : "start" or "stop" string.
  845. After measuring noise profile is stopped it will be
  846. automatically applied in filtering.
  847. @item noise_reduction, nr
  848. Change noise reduction. Argument is single float number.
  849. Syntax for the command is : "@var{noise_reduction}"
  850. @item noise_floor, nf
  851. Change noise floor. Argument is single float number.
  852. Syntax for the command is : "@var{noise_floor}"
  853. @item output_mode, om
  854. Change output mode operation.
  855. Syntax for the command is : "i", "o" or "n" string.
  856. @end table
  857. @section afftfilt
  858. Apply arbitrary expressions to samples in frequency domain.
  859. @table @option
  860. @item real
  861. Set frequency domain real expression for each separate channel separated
  862. by '|'. Default is "re".
  863. If the number of input channels is greater than the number of
  864. expressions, the last specified expression is used for the remaining
  865. output channels.
  866. @item imag
  867. Set frequency domain imaginary expression for each separate channel
  868. separated by '|'. Default is "im".
  869. Each expression in @var{real} and @var{imag} can contain the following
  870. constants and functions:
  871. @table @option
  872. @item sr
  873. sample rate
  874. @item b
  875. current frequency bin number
  876. @item nb
  877. number of available bins
  878. @item ch
  879. channel number of the current expression
  880. @item chs
  881. number of channels
  882. @item pts
  883. current frame pts
  884. @item re
  885. current real part of frequency bin of current channel
  886. @item im
  887. current imaginary part of frequency bin of current channel
  888. @item real(b, ch)
  889. Return the value of real part of frequency bin at location (@var{bin},@var{channel})
  890. @item imag(b, ch)
  891. Return the value of imaginary part of frequency bin at location (@var{bin},@var{channel})
  892. @end table
  893. @item win_size
  894. Set window size. Allowed range is from 16 to 131072.
  895. Default is @code{4096}
  896. @item win_func
  897. Set window function. Default is @code{hann}.
  898. @item overlap
  899. Set window overlap. If set to 1, the recommended overlap for selected
  900. window function will be picked. Default is @code{0.75}.
  901. @end table
  902. @subsection Examples
  903. @itemize
  904. @item
  905. Leave almost only low frequencies in audio:
  906. @example
  907. afftfilt="'real=re * (1-clip((b/nb)*b,0,1))':imag='im * (1-clip((b/nb)*b,0,1))'"
  908. @end example
  909. @item
  910. Apply robotize effect:
  911. @example
  912. afftfilt="real='hypot(re,im)*sin(0)':imag='hypot(re,im)*cos(0)':win_size=512:overlap=0.75"
  913. @end example
  914. @item
  915. Apply whisper effect:
  916. @example
  917. afftfilt="real='hypot(re,im)*cos((random(0)*2-1)*2*3.14)':imag='hypot(re,im)*sin((random(1)*2-1)*2*3.14)':win_size=128:overlap=0.8"
  918. @end example
  919. @end itemize
  920. @anchor{afir}
  921. @section afir
  922. Apply an arbitrary Finite Impulse Response filter.
  923. This filter is designed for applying long FIR filters,
  924. up to 60 seconds long.
  925. It can be used as component for digital crossover filters,
  926. room equalization, cross talk cancellation, wavefield synthesis,
  927. auralization, ambiophonics, ambisonics and spatialization.
  928. This filter uses the streams higher than first one as FIR coefficients.
  929. If the non-first stream holds a single channel, it will be used
  930. for all input channels in the first stream, otherwise
  931. the number of channels in the non-first stream must be same as
  932. the number of channels in the first stream.
  933. It accepts the following parameters:
  934. @table @option
  935. @item dry
  936. Set dry gain. This sets input gain.
  937. @item wet
  938. Set wet gain. This sets final output gain.
  939. @item length
  940. Set Impulse Response filter length. Default is 1, which means whole IR is processed.
  941. @item gtype
  942. Enable applying gain measured from power of IR.
  943. Set which approach to use for auto gain measurement.
  944. @table @option
  945. @item none
  946. Do not apply any gain.
  947. @item peak
  948. select peak gain, very conservative approach. This is default value.
  949. @item dc
  950. select DC gain, limited application.
  951. @item gn
  952. select gain to noise approach, this is most popular one.
  953. @end table
  954. @item irgain
  955. Set gain to be applied to IR coefficients before filtering.
  956. Allowed range is 0 to 1. This gain is applied after any gain applied with @var{gtype} option.
  957. @item irfmt
  958. Set format of IR stream. Can be @code{mono} or @code{input}.
  959. Default is @code{input}.
  960. @item maxir
  961. Set max allowed Impulse Response filter duration in seconds. Default is 30 seconds.
  962. Allowed range is 0.1 to 60 seconds.
  963. @item response
  964. Show IR frequency response, magnitude(magenta), phase(green) and group delay(yellow) in additional video stream.
  965. By default it is disabled.
  966. @item channel
  967. Set for which IR channel to display frequency response. By default is first channel
  968. displayed. This option is used only when @var{response} is enabled.
  969. @item size
  970. Set video stream size. This option is used only when @var{response} is enabled.
  971. @item rate
  972. Set video stream frame rate. This option is used only when @var{response} is enabled.
  973. @item minp
  974. Set minimal partition size used for convolution. Default is @var{8192}.
  975. Allowed range is from @var{1} to @var{32768}.
  976. Lower values decreases latency at cost of higher CPU usage.
  977. @item maxp
  978. Set maximal partition size used for convolution. Default is @var{8192}.
  979. Allowed range is from @var{8} to @var{32768}.
  980. Lower values may increase CPU usage.
  981. @item nbirs
  982. Set number of input impulse responses streams which will be switchable at runtime.
  983. Allowed range is from @var{1} to @var{32}. Default is @var{1}.
  984. @item ir
  985. Set IR stream which will be used for convolution, starting from @var{0}, should always be
  986. lower than supplied value by @code{nbirs} option. Default is @var{0}.
  987. This option can be changed at runtime via @ref{commands}.
  988. @end table
  989. @subsection Examples
  990. @itemize
  991. @item
  992. Apply reverb to stream using mono IR file as second input, complete command using ffmpeg:
  993. @example
  994. ffmpeg -i input.wav -i middle_tunnel_1way_mono.wav -lavfi afir output.wav
  995. @end example
  996. @end itemize
  997. @anchor{aformat}
  998. @section aformat
  999. Set output format constraints for the input audio. The framework will
  1000. negotiate the most appropriate format to minimize conversions.
  1001. It accepts the following parameters:
  1002. @table @option
  1003. @item sample_fmts, f
  1004. A '|'-separated list of requested sample formats.
  1005. @item sample_rates, r
  1006. A '|'-separated list of requested sample rates.
  1007. @item channel_layouts, cl
  1008. A '|'-separated list of requested channel layouts.
  1009. See @ref{channel layout syntax,,the Channel Layout section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  1010. for the required syntax.
  1011. @end table
  1012. If a parameter is omitted, all values are allowed.
  1013. Force the output to either unsigned 8-bit or signed 16-bit stereo
  1014. @example
  1015. aformat=sample_fmts=u8|s16:channel_layouts=stereo
  1016. @end example
  1017. @section agate
  1018. A gate is mainly used to reduce lower parts of a signal. This kind of signal
  1019. processing reduces disturbing noise between useful signals.
  1020. Gating is done by detecting the volume below a chosen level @var{threshold}
  1021. and dividing it by the factor set with @var{ratio}. The bottom of the noise
  1022. floor is set via @var{range}. Because an exact manipulation of the signal
  1023. would cause distortion of the waveform the reduction can be levelled over
  1024. time. This is done by setting @var{attack} and @var{release}.
  1025. @var{attack} determines how long the signal has to fall below the threshold
  1026. before any reduction will occur and @var{release} sets the time the signal
  1027. has to rise above the threshold to reduce the reduction again.
  1028. Shorter signals than the chosen attack time will be left untouched.
  1029. @table @option
  1030. @item level_in
  1031. Set input level before filtering.
  1032. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  1033. @item mode
  1034. Set the mode of operation. Can be @code{upward} or @code{downward}.
  1035. Default is @code{downward}. If set to @code{upward} mode, higher parts of signal
  1036. will be amplified, expanding dynamic range in upward direction.
  1037. Otherwise, in case of @code{downward} lower parts of signal will be reduced.
  1038. @item range
  1039. Set the level of gain reduction when the signal is below the threshold.
  1040. Default is 0.06125. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  1041. Setting this to 0 disables reduction and then filter behaves like expander.
  1042. @item threshold
  1043. If a signal rises above this level the gain reduction is released.
  1044. Default is 0.125. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  1045. @item ratio
  1046. Set a ratio by which the signal is reduced.
  1047. Default is 2. Allowed range is from 1 to 9000.
  1048. @item attack
  1049. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain
  1050. reduction stops.
  1051. Default is 20 milliseconds. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.
  1052. @item release
  1053. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before the
  1054. reduction is increased again. Default is 250 milliseconds.
  1055. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.
  1056. @item makeup
  1057. Set amount of amplification of signal after processing.
  1058. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 1 to 64.
  1059. @item knee
  1060. Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.
  1061. Default is 2.828427125. Allowed range is from 1 to 8.
  1062. @item detection
  1063. Choose if exact signal should be taken for detection or an RMS like one.
  1064. Default is @code{rms}. Can be @code{peak} or @code{rms}.
  1065. @item link
  1066. Choose if the average level between all channels or the louder channel affects
  1067. the reduction.
  1068. Default is @code{average}. Can be @code{average} or @code{maximum}.
  1069. @end table
  1070. @section aiir
  1071. Apply an arbitrary Infinite Impulse Response filter.
  1072. It accepts the following parameters:
  1073. @table @option
  1074. @item z
  1075. Set numerator/zeros coefficients.
  1076. @item p
  1077. Set denominator/poles coefficients.
  1078. @item k
  1079. Set channels gains.
  1080. @item dry_gain
  1081. Set input gain.
  1082. @item wet_gain
  1083. Set output gain.
  1084. @item f
  1085. Set coefficients format.
  1086. @table @samp
  1087. @item tf
  1088. transfer function
  1089. @item zp
  1090. Z-plane zeros/poles, cartesian (default)
  1091. @item pr
  1092. Z-plane zeros/poles, polar radians
  1093. @item pd
  1094. Z-plane zeros/poles, polar degrees
  1095. @end table
  1096. @item r
  1097. Set kind of processing.
  1098. Can be @code{d} - direct or @code{s} - serial cascading. Default is @code{s}.
  1099. @item e
  1100. Set filtering precision.
  1101. @table @samp
  1102. @item dbl
  1103. double-precision floating-point (default)
  1104. @item flt
  1105. single-precision floating-point
  1106. @item i32
  1107. 32-bit integers
  1108. @item i16
  1109. 16-bit integers
  1110. @end table
  1111. @item mix
  1112. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  1113. Range is between 0 and 1.
  1114. @item response
  1115. Show IR frequency response, magnitude(magenta), phase(green) and group delay(yellow) in additional video stream.
  1116. By default it is disabled.
  1117. @item channel
  1118. Set for which IR channel to display frequency response. By default is first channel
  1119. displayed. This option is used only when @var{response} is enabled.
  1120. @item size
  1121. Set video stream size. This option is used only when @var{response} is enabled.
  1122. @end table
  1123. Coefficients in @code{tf} format are separated by spaces and are in ascending
  1124. order.
  1125. Coefficients in @code{zp} format are separated by spaces and order of coefficients
  1126. doesn't matter. Coefficients in @code{zp} format are complex numbers with @var{i}
  1127. imaginary unit.
  1128. Different coefficients and gains can be provided for every channel, in such case
  1129. use '|' to separate coefficients or gains. Last provided coefficients will be
  1130. used for all remaining channels.
  1131. @subsection Examples
  1132. @itemize
  1133. @item
  1134. Apply 2 pole elliptic notch at around 5000Hz for 48000 Hz sample rate:
  1135. @example
  1136. aiir=k=1:z=7.957584807809675810E-1 -2.575128568908332300 3.674839853930788710 -2.57512875289799137 7.957586296317130880E-1:p=1 -2.86950072432325953 3.63022088054647218 -2.28075678147272232 6.361362326477423500E-1:f=tf:r=d
  1137. @end example
  1138. @item
  1139. Same as above but in @code{zp} format:
  1140. @example
  1141. aiir=k=0.79575848078096756:z=0.80918701+0.58773007i 0.80918701-0.58773007i 0.80884700+0.58784055i 0.80884700-0.58784055i:p=0.63892345+0.59951235i 0.63892345-0.59951235i 0.79582691+0.44198673i 0.79582691-0.44198673i:f=zp:r=s
  1142. @end example
  1143. @end itemize
  1144. @section alimiter
  1145. The limiter prevents an input signal from rising over a desired threshold.
  1146. This limiter uses lookahead technology to prevent your signal from distorting.
  1147. It means that there is a small delay after the signal is processed. Keep in mind
  1148. that the delay it produces is the attack time you set.
  1149. The filter accepts the following options:
  1150. @table @option
  1151. @item level_in
  1152. Set input gain. Default is 1.
  1153. @item level_out
  1154. Set output gain. Default is 1.
  1155. @item limit
  1156. Don't let signals above this level pass the limiter. Default is 1.
  1157. @item attack
  1158. The limiter will reach its attenuation level in this amount of time in
  1159. milliseconds. Default is 5 milliseconds.
  1160. @item release
  1161. Come back from limiting to attenuation 1.0 in this amount of milliseconds.
  1162. Default is 50 milliseconds.
  1163. @item asc
  1164. When gain reduction is always needed ASC takes care of releasing to an
  1165. average reduction level rather than reaching a reduction of 0 in the release
  1166. time.
  1167. @item asc_level
  1168. Select how much the release time is affected by ASC, 0 means nearly no changes
  1169. in release time while 1 produces higher release times.
  1170. @item level
  1171. Auto level output signal. Default is enabled.
  1172. This normalizes audio back to 0dB if enabled.
  1173. @end table
  1174. Depending on picked setting it is recommended to upsample input 2x or 4x times
  1175. with @ref{aresample} before applying this filter.
  1176. @section allpass
  1177. Apply a two-pole all-pass filter with central frequency (in Hz)
  1178. @var{frequency}, and filter-width @var{width}.
  1179. An all-pass filter changes the audio's frequency to phase relationship
  1180. without changing its frequency to amplitude relationship.
  1181. The filter accepts the following options:
  1182. @table @option
  1183. @item frequency, f
  1184. Set frequency in Hz.
  1185. @item width_type, t
  1186. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  1187. @table @option
  1188. @item h
  1189. Hz
  1190. @item q
  1191. Q-Factor
  1192. @item o
  1193. octave
  1194. @item s
  1195. slope
  1196. @item k
  1197. kHz
  1198. @end table
  1199. @item width, w
  1200. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  1201. @item mix, m
  1202. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  1203. Range is between 0 and 1.
  1204. @item channels, c
  1205. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  1206. @item normalize, n
  1207. Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.
  1208. Enabling it will normalize magnitude response at DC to 0dB.
  1209. @end table
  1210. @subsection Commands
  1211. This filter supports the following commands:
  1212. @table @option
  1213. @item frequency, f
  1214. Change allpass frequency.
  1215. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  1216. @item width_type, t
  1217. Change allpass width_type.
  1218. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  1219. @item width, w
  1220. Change allpass width.
  1221. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  1222. @item mix, m
  1223. Change allpass mix.
  1224. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  1225. @end table
  1226. @section aloop
  1227. Loop audio samples.
  1228. The filter accepts the following options:
  1229. @table @option
  1230. @item loop
  1231. Set the number of loops. Setting this value to -1 will result in infinite loops.
  1232. Default is 0.
  1233. @item size
  1234. Set maximal number of samples. Default is 0.
  1235. @item start
  1236. Set first sample of loop. Default is 0.
  1237. @end table
  1238. @anchor{amerge}
  1239. @section amerge
  1240. Merge two or more audio streams into a single multi-channel stream.
  1241. The filter accepts the following options:
  1242. @table @option
  1243. @item inputs
  1244. Set the number of inputs. Default is 2.
  1245. @end table
  1246. If the channel layouts of the inputs are disjoint, and therefore compatible,
  1247. the channel layout of the output will be set accordingly and the channels
  1248. will be reordered as necessary. If the channel layouts of the inputs are not
  1249. disjoint, the output will have all the channels of the first input then all
  1250. the channels of the second input, in that order, and the channel layout of
  1251. the output will be the default value corresponding to the total number of
  1252. channels.
  1253. For example, if the first input is in 2.1 (FL+FR+LF) and the second input
  1254. is FC+BL+BR, then the output will be in 5.1, with the channels in the
  1255. following order: a1, a2, b1, a3, b2, b3 (a1 is the first channel of the
  1256. first input, b1 is the first channel of the second input).
  1257. On the other hand, if both input are in stereo, the output channels will be
  1258. in the default order: a1, a2, b1, b2, and the channel layout will be
  1259. arbitrarily set to 4.0, which may or may not be the expected value.
  1260. All inputs must have the same sample rate, and format.
  1261. If inputs do not have the same duration, the output will stop with the
  1262. shortest.
  1263. @subsection Examples
  1264. @itemize
  1265. @item
  1266. Merge two mono files into a stereo stream:
  1267. @example
  1268. amovie=left.wav [l] ; amovie=right.mp3 [r] ; [l] [r] amerge
  1269. @end example
  1270. @item
  1271. Multiple merges assuming 1 video stream and 6 audio streams in @file{input.mkv}:
  1272. @example
  1273. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -filter_complex "[0:1][0:2][0:3][0:4][0:5][0:6] amerge=inputs=6" -c:a pcm_s16le output.mkv
  1274. @end example
  1275. @end itemize
  1276. @section amix
  1277. Mixes multiple audio inputs into a single output.
  1278. Note that this filter only supports float samples (the @var{amerge}
  1279. and @var{pan} audio filters support many formats). If the @var{amix}
  1280. input has integer samples then @ref{aresample} will be automatically
  1281. inserted to perform the conversion to float samples.
  1282. For example
  1283. @example
  1284. ffmpeg -i INPUT1 -i INPUT2 -i INPUT3 -filter_complex amix=inputs=3:duration=first:dropout_transition=3 OUTPUT
  1285. @end example
  1286. will mix 3 input audio streams to a single output with the same duration as the
  1287. first input and a dropout transition time of 3 seconds.
  1288. It accepts the following parameters:
  1289. @table @option
  1290. @item inputs
  1291. The number of inputs. If unspecified, it defaults to 2.
  1292. @item duration
  1293. How to determine the end-of-stream.
  1294. @table @option
  1295. @item longest
  1296. The duration of the longest input. (default)
  1297. @item shortest
  1298. The duration of the shortest input.
  1299. @item first
  1300. The duration of the first input.
  1301. @end table
  1302. @item dropout_transition
  1303. The transition time, in seconds, for volume renormalization when an input
  1304. stream ends. The default value is 2 seconds.
  1305. @item weights
  1306. Specify weight of each input audio stream as sequence.
  1307. Each weight is separated by space. By default all inputs have same weight.
  1308. @end table
  1309. @section amultiply
  1310. Multiply first audio stream with second audio stream and store result
  1311. in output audio stream. Multiplication is done by multiplying each
  1312. sample from first stream with sample at same position from second stream.
  1313. With this element-wise multiplication one can create amplitude fades and
  1314. amplitude modulations.
  1315. @section anequalizer
  1316. High-order parametric multiband equalizer for each channel.
  1317. It accepts the following parameters:
  1318. @table @option
  1319. @item params
  1320. This option string is in format:
  1321. "c@var{chn} f=@var{cf} w=@var{w} g=@var{g} t=@var{f} | ..."
  1322. Each equalizer band is separated by '|'.
  1323. @table @option
  1324. @item chn
  1325. Set channel number to which equalization will be applied.
  1326. If input doesn't have that channel the entry is ignored.
  1327. @item f
  1328. Set central frequency for band.
  1329. If input doesn't have that frequency the entry is ignored.
  1330. @item w
  1331. Set band width in hertz.
  1332. @item g
  1333. Set band gain in dB.
  1334. @item t
  1335. Set filter type for band, optional, can be:
  1336. @table @samp
  1337. @item 0
  1338. Butterworth, this is default.
  1339. @item 1
  1340. Chebyshev type 1.
  1341. @item 2
  1342. Chebyshev type 2.
  1343. @end table
  1344. @end table
  1345. @item curves
  1346. With this option activated frequency response of anequalizer is displayed
  1347. in video stream.
  1348. @item size
  1349. Set video stream size. Only useful if curves option is activated.
  1350. @item mgain
  1351. Set max gain that will be displayed. Only useful if curves option is activated.
  1352. Setting this to a reasonable value makes it possible to display gain which is derived from
  1353. neighbour bands which are too close to each other and thus produce higher gain
  1354. when both are activated.
  1355. @item fscale
  1356. Set frequency scale used to draw frequency response in video output.
  1357. Can be linear or logarithmic. Default is logarithmic.
  1358. @item colors
  1359. Set color for each channel curve which is going to be displayed in video stream.
  1360. This is list of color names separated by space or by '|'.
  1361. Unrecognised or missing colors will be replaced by white color.
  1362. @end table
  1363. @subsection Examples
  1364. @itemize
  1365. @item
  1366. Lower gain by 10 of central frequency 200Hz and width 100 Hz
  1367. for first 2 channels using Chebyshev type 1 filter:
  1368. @example
  1369. anequalizer=c0 f=200 w=100 g=-10 t=1|c1 f=200 w=100 g=-10 t=1
  1370. @end example
  1371. @end itemize
  1372. @subsection Commands
  1373. This filter supports the following commands:
  1374. @table @option
  1375. @item change
  1376. Alter existing filter parameters.
  1377. Syntax for the commands is : "@var{fN}|f=@var{freq}|w=@var{width}|g=@var{gain}"
  1378. @var{fN} is existing filter number, starting from 0, if no such filter is available
  1379. error is returned.
  1380. @var{freq} set new frequency parameter.
  1381. @var{width} set new width parameter in herz.
  1382. @var{gain} set new gain parameter in dB.
  1383. Full filter invocation with asendcmd may look like this:
  1384. asendcmd=c='4.0 anequalizer change 0|f=200|w=50|g=1',anequalizer=...
  1385. @end table
  1386. @section anlmdn
  1387. Reduce broadband noise in audio samples using Non-Local Means algorithm.
  1388. Each sample is adjusted by looking for other samples with similar contexts. This
  1389. context similarity is defined by comparing their surrounding patches of size
  1390. @option{p}. Patches are searched in an area of @option{r} around the sample.
  1391. The filter accepts the following options:
  1392. @table @option
  1393. @item s
  1394. Set denoising strength. Allowed range is from 0.00001 to 10. Default value is 0.00001.
  1395. @item p
  1396. Set patch radius duration. Allowed range is from 1 to 100 milliseconds.
  1397. Default value is 2 milliseconds.
  1398. @item r
  1399. Set research radius duration. Allowed range is from 2 to 300 milliseconds.
  1400. Default value is 6 milliseconds.
  1401. @item o
  1402. Set the output mode.
  1403. It accepts the following values:
  1404. @table @option
  1405. @item i
  1406. Pass input unchanged.
  1407. @item o
  1408. Pass noise filtered out.
  1409. @item n
  1410. Pass only noise.
  1411. Default value is @var{o}.
  1412. @end table
  1413. @item m
  1414. Set smooth factor. Default value is @var{11}. Allowed range is from @var{1} to @var{15}.
  1415. @end table
  1416. @subsection Commands
  1417. This filter supports the following commands:
  1418. @table @option
  1419. @item s
  1420. Change denoise strength. Argument is single float number.
  1421. Syntax for the command is : "@var{s}"
  1422. @item o
  1423. Change output mode.
  1424. Syntax for the command is : "i", "o" or "n" string.
  1425. @end table
  1426. @section anlms
  1427. Apply Normalized Least-Mean-Squares algorithm to the first audio stream using the second audio stream.
  1428. This adaptive filter is used to mimic a desired filter by finding the filter coefficients that
  1429. relate to producing the least mean square of the error signal (difference between the desired,
  1430. 2nd input audio stream and the actual signal, the 1st input audio stream).
  1431. A description of the accepted options follows.
  1432. @table @option
  1433. @item order
  1434. Set filter order.
  1435. @item mu
  1436. Set filter mu.
  1437. @item eps
  1438. Set the filter eps.
  1439. @item leakage
  1440. Set the filter leakage.
  1441. @item out_mode
  1442. It accepts the following values:
  1443. @table @option
  1444. @item i
  1445. Pass the 1st input.
  1446. @item d
  1447. Pass the 2nd input.
  1448. @item o
  1449. Pass filtered samples.
  1450. @item n
  1451. Pass difference between desired and filtered samples.
  1452. Default value is @var{o}.
  1453. @end table
  1454. @end table
  1455. @subsection Examples
  1456. @itemize
  1457. @item
  1458. One of many usages of this filter is noise reduction, input audio is filtered
  1459. with same samples that are delayed by fixed amount, one such example for stereo audio is:
  1460. @example
  1461. asplit[a][b],[a]adelay=32S|32S[a],[b][a]anlms=order=128:leakage=0.0005:mu=.5:out_mode=o
  1462. @end example
  1463. @end itemize
  1464. @subsection Commands
  1465. This filter supports the same commands as options, excluding option @code{order}.
  1466. @section anull
  1467. Pass the audio source unchanged to the output.
  1468. @section apad
  1469. Pad the end of an audio stream with silence.
  1470. This can be used together with @command{ffmpeg} @option{-shortest} to
  1471. extend audio streams to the same length as the video stream.
  1472. A description of the accepted options follows.
  1473. @table @option
  1474. @item packet_size
  1475. Set silence packet size. Default value is 4096.
  1476. @item pad_len
  1477. Set the number of samples of silence to add to the end. After the
  1478. value is reached, the stream is terminated. This option is mutually
  1479. exclusive with @option{whole_len}.
  1480. @item whole_len
  1481. Set the minimum total number of samples in the output audio stream. If
  1482. the value is longer than the input audio length, silence is added to
  1483. the end, until the value is reached. This option is mutually exclusive
  1484. with @option{pad_len}.
  1485. @item pad_dur
  1486. Specify the duration of samples of silence to add. See
  1487. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  1488. for the accepted syntax. Used only if set to non-zero value.
  1489. @item whole_dur
  1490. Specify the minimum total duration in the output audio stream. See
  1491. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  1492. for the accepted syntax. Used only if set to non-zero value. If the value is longer than
  1493. the input audio length, silence is added to the end, until the value is reached.
  1494. This option is mutually exclusive with @option{pad_dur}
  1495. @end table
  1496. If neither the @option{pad_len} nor the @option{whole_len} nor @option{pad_dur}
  1497. nor @option{whole_dur} option is set, the filter will add silence to the end of
  1498. the input stream indefinitely.
  1499. @subsection Examples
  1500. @itemize
  1501. @item
  1502. Add 1024 samples of silence to the end of the input:
  1503. @example
  1504. apad=pad_len=1024
  1505. @end example
  1506. @item
  1507. Make sure the audio output will contain at least 10000 samples, pad
  1508. the input with silence if required:
  1509. @example
  1510. apad=whole_len=10000
  1511. @end example
  1512. @item
  1513. Use @command{ffmpeg} to pad the audio input with silence, so that the
  1514. video stream will always result the shortest and will be converted
  1515. until the end in the output file when using the @option{shortest}
  1516. option:
  1517. @example
  1518. ffmpeg -i VIDEO -i AUDIO -filter_complex "[1:0]apad" -shortest OUTPUT
  1519. @end example
  1520. @end itemize
  1521. @section aphaser
  1522. Add a phasing effect to the input audio.
  1523. A phaser filter creates series of peaks and troughs in the frequency spectrum.
  1524. The position of the peaks and troughs are modulated so that they vary over time, creating a sweeping effect.
  1525. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  1526. @table @option
  1527. @item in_gain
  1528. Set input gain. Default is 0.4.
  1529. @item out_gain
  1530. Set output gain. Default is 0.74
  1531. @item delay
  1532. Set delay in milliseconds. Default is 3.0.
  1533. @item decay
  1534. Set decay. Default is 0.4.
  1535. @item speed
  1536. Set modulation speed in Hz. Default is 0.5.
  1537. @item type
  1538. Set modulation type. Default is triangular.
  1539. It accepts the following values:
  1540. @table @samp
  1541. @item triangular, t
  1542. @item sinusoidal, s
  1543. @end table
  1544. @end table
  1545. @section apulsator
  1546. Audio pulsator is something between an autopanner and a tremolo.
  1547. But it can produce funny stereo effects as well. Pulsator changes the volume
  1548. of the left and right channel based on a LFO (low frequency oscillator) with
  1549. different waveforms and shifted phases.
  1550. This filter have the ability to define an offset between left and right
  1551. channel. An offset of 0 means that both LFO shapes match each other.
  1552. The left and right channel are altered equally - a conventional tremolo.
  1553. An offset of 50% means that the shape of the right channel is exactly shifted
  1554. in phase (or moved backwards about half of the frequency) - pulsator acts as
  1555. an autopanner. At 1 both curves match again. Every setting in between moves the
  1556. phase shift gapless between all stages and produces some "bypassing" sounds with
  1557. sine and triangle waveforms. The more you set the offset near 1 (starting from
  1558. the 0.5) the faster the signal passes from the left to the right speaker.
  1559. The filter accepts the following options:
  1560. @table @option
  1561. @item level_in
  1562. Set input gain. By default it is 1. Range is [0.015625 - 64].
  1563. @item level_out
  1564. Set output gain. By default it is 1. Range is [0.015625 - 64].
  1565. @item mode
  1566. Set waveform shape the LFO will use. Can be one of: sine, triangle, square,
  1567. sawup or sawdown. Default is sine.
  1568. @item amount
  1569. Set modulation. Define how much of original signal is affected by the LFO.
  1570. @item offset_l
  1571. Set left channel offset. Default is 0. Allowed range is [0 - 1].
  1572. @item offset_r
  1573. Set right channel offset. Default is 0.5. Allowed range is [0 - 1].
  1574. @item width
  1575. Set pulse width. Default is 1. Allowed range is [0 - 2].
  1576. @item timing
  1577. Set possible timing mode. Can be one of: bpm, ms or hz. Default is hz.
  1578. @item bpm
  1579. Set bpm. Default is 120. Allowed range is [30 - 300]. Only used if timing
  1580. is set to bpm.
  1581. @item ms
  1582. Set ms. Default is 500. Allowed range is [10 - 2000]. Only used if timing
  1583. is set to ms.
  1584. @item hz
  1585. Set frequency in Hz. Default is 2. Allowed range is [0.01 - 100]. Only used
  1586. if timing is set to hz.
  1587. @end table
  1588. @anchor{aresample}
  1589. @section aresample
  1590. Resample the input audio to the specified parameters, using the
  1591. libswresample library. If none are specified then the filter will
  1592. automatically convert between its input and output.
  1593. This filter is also able to stretch/squeeze the audio data to make it match
  1594. the timestamps or to inject silence / cut out audio to make it match the
  1595. timestamps, do a combination of both or do neither.
  1596. The filter accepts the syntax
  1597. [@var{sample_rate}:]@var{resampler_options}, where @var{sample_rate}
  1598. expresses a sample rate and @var{resampler_options} is a list of
  1599. @var{key}=@var{value} pairs, separated by ":". See the
  1600. @ref{Resampler Options,,"Resampler Options" section in the
  1601. ffmpeg-resampler(1) manual,ffmpeg-resampler}
  1602. for the complete list of supported options.
  1603. @subsection Examples
  1604. @itemize
  1605. @item
  1606. Resample the input audio to 44100Hz:
  1607. @example
  1608. aresample=44100
  1609. @end example
  1610. @item
  1611. Stretch/squeeze samples to the given timestamps, with a maximum of 1000
  1612. samples per second compensation:
  1613. @example
  1614. aresample=async=1000
  1615. @end example
  1616. @end itemize
  1617. @section areverse
  1618. Reverse an audio clip.
  1619. Warning: This filter requires memory to buffer the entire clip, so trimming
  1620. is suggested.
  1621. @subsection Examples
  1622. @itemize
  1623. @item
  1624. Take the first 5 seconds of a clip, and reverse it.
  1625. @example
  1626. atrim=end=5,areverse
  1627. @end example
  1628. @end itemize
  1629. @section arnndn
  1630. Reduce noise from speech using Recurrent Neural Networks.
  1631. This filter accepts the following options:
  1632. @table @option
  1633. @item model, m
  1634. Set train model file to load. This option is always required.
  1635. @end table
  1636. @section asetnsamples
  1637. Set the number of samples per each output audio frame.
  1638. The last output packet may contain a different number of samples, as
  1639. the filter will flush all the remaining samples when the input audio
  1640. signals its end.
  1641. The filter accepts the following options:
  1642. @table @option
  1643. @item nb_out_samples, n
  1644. Set the number of frames per each output audio frame. The number is
  1645. intended as the number of samples @emph{per each channel}.
  1646. Default value is 1024.
  1647. @item pad, p
  1648. If set to 1, the filter will pad the last audio frame with zeroes, so
  1649. that the last frame will contain the same number of samples as the
  1650. previous ones. Default value is 1.
  1651. @end table
  1652. For example, to set the number of per-frame samples to 1234 and
  1653. disable padding for the last frame, use:
  1654. @example
  1655. asetnsamples=n=1234:p=0
  1656. @end example
  1657. @section asetrate
  1658. Set the sample rate without altering the PCM data.
  1659. This will result in a change of speed and pitch.
  1660. The filter accepts the following options:
  1661. @table @option
  1662. @item sample_rate, r
  1663. Set the output sample rate. Default is 44100 Hz.
  1664. @end table
  1665. @section ashowinfo
  1666. Show a line containing various information for each input audio frame.
  1667. The input audio is not modified.
  1668. The shown line contains a sequence of key/value pairs of the form
  1669. @var{key}:@var{value}.
  1670. The following values are shown in the output:
  1671. @table @option
  1672. @item n
  1673. The (sequential) number of the input frame, starting from 0.
  1674. @item pts
  1675. The presentation timestamp of the input frame, in time base units; the time base
  1676. depends on the filter input pad, and is usually 1/@var{sample_rate}.
  1677. @item pts_time
  1678. The presentation timestamp of the input frame in seconds.
  1679. @item pos
  1680. position of the frame in the input stream, -1 if this information in
  1681. unavailable and/or meaningless (for example in case of synthetic audio)
  1682. @item fmt
  1683. The sample format.
  1684. @item chlayout
  1685. The channel layout.
  1686. @item rate
  1687. The sample rate for the audio frame.
  1688. @item nb_samples
  1689. The number of samples (per channel) in the frame.
  1690. @item checksum
  1691. The Adler-32 checksum (printed in hexadecimal) of the audio data. For planar
  1692. audio, the data is treated as if all the planes were concatenated.
  1693. @item plane_checksums
  1694. A list of Adler-32 checksums for each data plane.
  1695. @end table
  1696. @section asoftclip
  1697. Apply audio soft clipping.
  1698. Soft clipping is a type of distortion effect where the amplitude of a signal is saturated
  1699. along a smooth curve, rather than the abrupt shape of hard-clipping.
  1700. This filter accepts the following options:
  1701. @table @option
  1702. @item type
  1703. Set type of soft-clipping.
  1704. It accepts the following values:
  1705. @table @option
  1706. @item tanh
  1707. @item atan
  1708. @item cubic
  1709. @item exp
  1710. @item alg
  1711. @item quintic
  1712. @item sin
  1713. @end table
  1714. @item param
  1715. Set additional parameter which controls sigmoid function.
  1716. @end table
  1717. @section asr
  1718. Automatic Speech Recognition
  1719. This filter uses PocketSphinx for speech recognition. To enable
  1720. compilation of this filter, you need to configure FFmpeg with
  1721. @code{--enable-pocketsphinx}.
  1722. It accepts the following options:
  1723. @table @option
  1724. @item rate
  1725. Set sampling rate of input audio. Defaults is @code{16000}.
  1726. This need to match speech models, otherwise one will get poor results.
  1727. @item hmm
  1728. Set dictionary containing acoustic model files.
  1729. @item dict
  1730. Set pronunciation dictionary.
  1731. @item lm
  1732. Set language model file.
  1733. @item lmctl
  1734. Set language model set.
  1735. @item lmname
  1736. Set which language model to use.
  1737. @item logfn
  1738. Set output for log messages.
  1739. @end table
  1740. The filter exports recognized speech as the frame metadata @code{lavfi.asr.text}.
  1741. @anchor{astats}
  1742. @section astats
  1743. Display time domain statistical information about the audio channels.
  1744. Statistics are calculated and displayed for each audio channel and,
  1745. where applicable, an overall figure is also given.
  1746. It accepts the following option:
  1747. @table @option
  1748. @item length
  1749. Short window length in seconds, used for peak and trough RMS measurement.
  1750. Default is @code{0.05} (50 milliseconds). Allowed range is @code{[0.01 - 10]}.
  1751. @item metadata
  1752. Set metadata injection. All the metadata keys are prefixed with @code{lavfi.astats.X},
  1753. where @code{X} is channel number starting from 1 or string @code{Overall}. Default is
  1754. disabled.
  1755. Available keys for each channel are:
  1756. DC_offset
  1757. Min_level
  1758. Max_level
  1759. Min_difference
  1760. Max_difference
  1761. Mean_difference
  1762. RMS_difference
  1763. Peak_level
  1764. RMS_peak
  1765. RMS_trough
  1766. Crest_factor
  1767. Flat_factor
  1768. Peak_count
  1769. Bit_depth
  1770. Dynamic_range
  1771. Zero_crossings
  1772. Zero_crossings_rate
  1773. Number_of_NaNs
  1774. Number_of_Infs
  1775. Number_of_denormals
  1776. and for Overall:
  1777. DC_offset
  1778. Min_level
  1779. Max_level
  1780. Min_difference
  1781. Max_difference
  1782. Mean_difference
  1783. RMS_difference
  1784. Peak_level
  1785. RMS_level
  1786. RMS_peak
  1787. RMS_trough
  1788. Flat_factor
  1789. Peak_count
  1790. Bit_depth
  1791. Number_of_samples
  1792. Number_of_NaNs
  1793. Number_of_Infs
  1794. Number_of_denormals
  1795. For example full key look like this @code{lavfi.astats.1.DC_offset} or
  1796. this @code{lavfi.astats.Overall.Peak_count}.
  1797. For description what each key means read below.
  1798. @item reset
  1799. Set number of frame after which stats are going to be recalculated.
  1800. Default is disabled.
  1801. @item measure_perchannel
  1802. Select the entries which need to be measured per channel. The metadata keys can
  1803. be used as flags, default is @option{all} which measures everything.
  1804. @option{none} disables all per channel measurement.
  1805. @item measure_overall
  1806. Select the entries which need to be measured overall. The metadata keys can
  1807. be used as flags, default is @option{all} which measures everything.
  1808. @option{none} disables all overall measurement.
  1809. @end table
  1810. A description of each shown parameter follows:
  1811. @table @option
  1812. @item DC offset
  1813. Mean amplitude displacement from zero.
  1814. @item Min level
  1815. Minimal sample level.
  1816. @item Max level
  1817. Maximal sample level.
  1818. @item Min difference
  1819. Minimal difference between two consecutive samples.
  1820. @item Max difference
  1821. Maximal difference between two consecutive samples.
  1822. @item Mean difference
  1823. Mean difference between two consecutive samples.
  1824. The average of each difference between two consecutive samples.
  1825. @item RMS difference
  1826. Root Mean Square difference between two consecutive samples.
  1827. @item Peak level dB
  1828. @item RMS level dB
  1829. Standard peak and RMS level measured in dBFS.
  1830. @item RMS peak dB
  1831. @item RMS trough dB
  1832. Peak and trough values for RMS level measured over a short window.
  1833. @item Crest factor
  1834. Standard ratio of peak to RMS level (note: not in dB).
  1835. @item Flat factor
  1836. Flatness (i.e. consecutive samples with the same value) of the signal at its peak levels
  1837. (i.e. either @var{Min level} or @var{Max level}).
  1838. @item Peak count
  1839. Number of occasions (not the number of samples) that the signal attained either
  1840. @var{Min level} or @var{Max level}.
  1841. @item Bit depth
  1842. Overall bit depth of audio. Number of bits used for each sample.
  1843. @item Dynamic range
  1844. Measured dynamic range of audio in dB.
  1845. @item Zero crossings
  1846. Number of points where the waveform crosses the zero level axis.
  1847. @item Zero crossings rate
  1848. Rate of Zero crossings and number of audio samples.
  1849. @end table
  1850. @section atempo
  1851. Adjust audio tempo.
  1852. The filter accepts exactly one parameter, the audio tempo. If not
  1853. specified then the filter will assume nominal 1.0 tempo. Tempo must
  1854. be in the [0.5, 100.0] range.
  1855. Note that tempo greater than 2 will skip some samples rather than
  1856. blend them in. If for any reason this is a concern it is always
  1857. possible to daisy-chain several instances of atempo to achieve the
  1858. desired product tempo.
  1859. @subsection Examples
  1860. @itemize
  1861. @item
  1862. Slow down audio to 80% tempo:
  1863. @example
  1864. atempo=0.8
  1865. @end example
  1866. @item
  1867. To speed up audio to 300% tempo:
  1868. @example
  1869. atempo=3
  1870. @end example
  1871. @item
  1872. To speed up audio to 300% tempo by daisy-chaining two atempo instances:
  1873. @example
  1874. atempo=sqrt(3),atempo=sqrt(3)
  1875. @end example
  1876. @end itemize
  1877. @subsection Commands
  1878. This filter supports the following commands:
  1879. @table @option
  1880. @item tempo
  1881. Change filter tempo scale factor.
  1882. Syntax for the command is : "@var{tempo}"
  1883. @end table
  1884. @section atrim
  1885. Trim the input so that the output contains one continuous subpart of the input.
  1886. It accepts the following parameters:
  1887. @table @option
  1888. @item start
  1889. Timestamp (in seconds) of the start of the section to keep. I.e. the audio
  1890. sample with the timestamp @var{start} will be the first sample in the output.
  1891. @item end
  1892. Specify time of the first audio sample that will be dropped, i.e. the
  1893. audio sample immediately preceding the one with the timestamp @var{end} will be
  1894. the last sample in the output.
  1895. @item start_pts
  1896. Same as @var{start}, except this option sets the start timestamp in samples
  1897. instead of seconds.
  1898. @item end_pts
  1899. Same as @var{end}, except this option sets the end timestamp in samples instead
  1900. of seconds.
  1901. @item duration
  1902. The maximum duration of the output in seconds.
  1903. @item start_sample
  1904. The number of the first sample that should be output.
  1905. @item end_sample
  1906. The number of the first sample that should be dropped.
  1907. @end table
  1908. @option{start}, @option{end}, and @option{duration} are expressed as time
  1909. duration specifications; see
  1910. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  1911. Note that the first two sets of the start/end options and the @option{duration}
  1912. option look at the frame timestamp, while the _sample options simply count the
  1913. samples that pass through the filter. So start/end_pts and start/end_sample will
  1914. give different results when the timestamps are wrong, inexact or do not start at
  1915. zero. Also note that this filter does not modify the timestamps. If you wish
  1916. to have the output timestamps start at zero, insert the asetpts filter after the
  1917. atrim filter.
  1918. If multiple start or end options are set, this filter tries to be greedy and
  1919. keep all samples that match at least one of the specified constraints. To keep
  1920. only the part that matches all the constraints at once, chain multiple atrim
  1921. filters.
  1922. The defaults are such that all the input is kept. So it is possible to set e.g.
  1923. just the end values to keep everything before the specified time.
  1924. Examples:
  1925. @itemize
  1926. @item
  1927. Drop everything except the second minute of input:
  1928. @example
  1929. ffmpeg -i INPUT -af atrim=60:120
  1930. @end example
  1931. @item
  1932. Keep only the first 1000 samples:
  1933. @example
  1934. ffmpeg -i INPUT -af atrim=end_sample=1000
  1935. @end example
  1936. @end itemize
  1937. @section axcorrelate
  1938. Calculate normalized cross-correlation between two input audio streams.
  1939. Resulted samples are always between -1 and 1 inclusive.
  1940. If result is 1 it means two input samples are highly correlated in that selected segment.
  1941. Result 0 means they are not correlated at all.
  1942. If result is -1 it means two input samples are out of phase, which means they cancel each
  1943. other.
  1944. The filter accepts the following options:
  1945. @table @option
  1946. @item size
  1947. Set size of segment over which cross-correlation is calculated.
  1948. Default is 256. Allowed range is from 2 to 131072.
  1949. @item algo
  1950. Set algorithm for cross-correlation. Can be @code{slow} or @code{fast}.
  1951. Default is @code{slow}. Fast algorithm assumes mean values over any given segment
  1952. are always zero and thus need much less calculations to make.
  1953. This is generally not true, but is valid for typical audio streams.
  1954. @end table
  1955. @subsection Examples
  1956. @itemize
  1957. @item
  1958. Calculate correlation between channels in stereo audio stream:
  1959. @example
  1960. ffmpeg -i stereo.wav -af channelsplit,axcorrelate=size=1024:algo=fast correlation.wav
  1961. @end example
  1962. @end itemize
  1963. @section bandpass
  1964. Apply a two-pole Butterworth band-pass filter with central
  1965. frequency @var{frequency}, and (3dB-point) band-width width.
  1966. The @var{csg} option selects a constant skirt gain (peak gain = Q)
  1967. instead of the default: constant 0dB peak gain.
  1968. The filter roll off at 6dB per octave (20dB per decade).
  1969. The filter accepts the following options:
  1970. @table @option
  1971. @item frequency, f
  1972. Set the filter's central frequency. Default is @code{3000}.
  1973. @item csg
  1974. Constant skirt gain if set to 1. Defaults to 0.
  1975. @item width_type, t
  1976. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  1977. @table @option
  1978. @item h
  1979. Hz
  1980. @item q
  1981. Q-Factor
  1982. @item o
  1983. octave
  1984. @item s
  1985. slope
  1986. @item k
  1987. kHz
  1988. @end table
  1989. @item width, w
  1990. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  1991. @item mix, m
  1992. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  1993. Range is between 0 and 1.
  1994. @item channels, c
  1995. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  1996. @item normalize, n
  1997. Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.
  1998. Enabling it will normalize magnitude response at DC to 0dB.
  1999. @end table
  2000. @subsection Commands
  2001. This filter supports the following commands:
  2002. @table @option
  2003. @item frequency, f
  2004. Change bandpass frequency.
  2005. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  2006. @item width_type, t
  2007. Change bandpass width_type.
  2008. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  2009. @item width, w
  2010. Change bandpass width.
  2011. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  2012. @item mix, m
  2013. Change bandpass mix.
  2014. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  2015. @end table
  2016. @section bandreject
  2017. Apply a two-pole Butterworth band-reject filter with central
  2018. frequency @var{frequency}, and (3dB-point) band-width @var{width}.
  2019. The filter roll off at 6dB per octave (20dB per decade).
  2020. The filter accepts the following options:
  2021. @table @option
  2022. @item frequency, f
  2023. Set the filter's central frequency. Default is @code{3000}.
  2024. @item width_type, t
  2025. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  2026. @table @option
  2027. @item h
  2028. Hz
  2029. @item q
  2030. Q-Factor
  2031. @item o
  2032. octave
  2033. @item s
  2034. slope
  2035. @item k
  2036. kHz
  2037. @end table
  2038. @item width, w
  2039. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  2040. @item mix, m
  2041. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  2042. Range is between 0 and 1.
  2043. @item channels, c
  2044. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  2045. @item normalize, n
  2046. Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.
  2047. Enabling it will normalize magnitude response at DC to 0dB.
  2048. @end table
  2049. @subsection Commands
  2050. This filter supports the following commands:
  2051. @table @option
  2052. @item frequency, f
  2053. Change bandreject frequency.
  2054. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  2055. @item width_type, t
  2056. Change bandreject width_type.
  2057. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  2058. @item width, w
  2059. Change bandreject width.
  2060. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  2061. @item mix, m
  2062. Change bandreject mix.
  2063. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  2064. @end table
  2065. @section bass, lowshelf
  2066. Boost or cut the bass (lower) frequencies of the audio using a two-pole
  2067. shelving filter with a response similar to that of a standard
  2068. hi-fi's tone-controls. This is also known as shelving equalisation (EQ).
  2069. The filter accepts the following options:
  2070. @table @option
  2071. @item gain, g
  2072. Give the gain at 0 Hz. Its useful range is about -20
  2073. (for a large cut) to +20 (for a large boost).
  2074. Beware of clipping when using a positive gain.
  2075. @item frequency, f
  2076. Set the filter's central frequency and so can be used
  2077. to extend or reduce the frequency range to be boosted or cut.
  2078. The default value is @code{100} Hz.
  2079. @item width_type, t
  2080. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  2081. @table @option
  2082. @item h
  2083. Hz
  2084. @item q
  2085. Q-Factor
  2086. @item o
  2087. octave
  2088. @item s
  2089. slope
  2090. @item k
  2091. kHz
  2092. @end table
  2093. @item width, w
  2094. Determine how steep is the filter's shelf transition.
  2095. @item mix, m
  2096. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  2097. Range is between 0 and 1.
  2098. @item channels, c
  2099. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  2100. @item normalize, n
  2101. Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.
  2102. Enabling it will normalize magnitude response at DC to 0dB.
  2103. @end table
  2104. @subsection Commands
  2105. This filter supports the following commands:
  2106. @table @option
  2107. @item frequency, f
  2108. Change bass frequency.
  2109. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  2110. @item width_type, t
  2111. Change bass width_type.
  2112. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  2113. @item width, w
  2114. Change bass width.
  2115. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  2116. @item gain, g
  2117. Change bass gain.
  2118. Syntax for the command is : "@var{gain}"
  2119. @item mix, m
  2120. Change bass mix.
  2121. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  2122. @end table
  2123. @section biquad
  2124. Apply a biquad IIR filter with the given coefficients.
  2125. Where @var{b0}, @var{b1}, @var{b2} and @var{a0}, @var{a1}, @var{a2}
  2126. are the numerator and denominator coefficients respectively.
  2127. and @var{channels}, @var{c} specify which channels to filter, by default all
  2128. available are filtered.
  2129. @subsection Commands
  2130. This filter supports the following commands:
  2131. @table @option
  2132. @item a0
  2133. @item a1
  2134. @item a2
  2135. @item b0
  2136. @item b1
  2137. @item b2
  2138. Change biquad parameter.
  2139. Syntax for the command is : "@var{value}"
  2140. @item mix, m
  2141. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  2142. Range is between 0 and 1.
  2143. @item channels, c
  2144. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  2145. @item normalize, n
  2146. Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.
  2147. Enabling it will normalize magnitude response at DC to 0dB.
  2148. @end table
  2149. @section bs2b
  2150. Bauer stereo to binaural transformation, which improves headphone listening of
  2151. stereo audio records.
  2152. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  2153. @code{--enable-libbs2b}.
  2154. It accepts the following parameters:
  2155. @table @option
  2156. @item profile
  2157. Pre-defined crossfeed level.
  2158. @table @option
  2159. @item default
  2160. Default level (fcut=700, feed=50).
  2161. @item cmoy
  2162. Chu Moy circuit (fcut=700, feed=60).
  2163. @item jmeier
  2164. Jan Meier circuit (fcut=650, feed=95).
  2165. @end table
  2166. @item fcut
  2167. Cut frequency (in Hz).
  2168. @item feed
  2169. Feed level (in Hz).
  2170. @end table
  2171. @section channelmap
  2172. Remap input channels to new locations.
  2173. It accepts the following parameters:
  2174. @table @option
  2175. @item map
  2176. Map channels from input to output. The argument is a '|'-separated list of
  2177. mappings, each in the @code{@var{in_channel}-@var{out_channel}} or
  2178. @var{in_channel} form. @var{in_channel} can be either the name of the input
  2179. channel (e.g. FL for front left) or its index in the input channel layout.
  2180. @var{out_channel} is the name of the output channel or its index in the output
  2181. channel layout. If @var{out_channel} is not given then it is implicitly an
  2182. index, starting with zero and increasing by one for each mapping.
  2183. @item channel_layout
  2184. The channel layout of the output stream.
  2185. @end table
  2186. If no mapping is present, the filter will implicitly map input channels to
  2187. output channels, preserving indices.
  2188. @subsection Examples
  2189. @itemize
  2190. @item
  2191. For example, assuming a 5.1+downmix input MOV file,
  2192. @example
  2193. ffmpeg -i in.mov -filter 'channelmap=map=DL-FL|DR-FR' out.wav
  2194. @end example
  2195. will create an output WAV file tagged as stereo from the downmix channels of
  2196. the input.
  2197. @item
  2198. To fix a 5.1 WAV improperly encoded in AAC's native channel order
  2199. @example
  2200. ffmpeg -i in.wav -filter 'channelmap=1|2|0|5|3|4:5.1' out.wav
  2201. @end example
  2202. @end itemize
  2203. @section channelsplit
  2204. Split each channel from an input audio stream into a separate output stream.
  2205. It accepts the following parameters:
  2206. @table @option
  2207. @item channel_layout
  2208. The channel layout of the input stream. The default is "stereo".
  2209. @item channels
  2210. A channel layout describing the channels to be extracted as separate output streams
  2211. or "all" to extract each input channel as a separate stream. The default is "all".
  2212. Choosing channels not present in channel layout in the input will result in an error.
  2213. @end table
  2214. @subsection Examples
  2215. @itemize
  2216. @item
  2217. For example, assuming a stereo input MP3 file,
  2218. @example
  2219. ffmpeg -i in.mp3 -filter_complex channelsplit out.mkv
  2220. @end example
  2221. will create an output Matroska file with two audio streams, one containing only
  2222. the left channel and the other the right channel.
  2223. @item
  2224. Split a 5.1 WAV file into per-channel files:
  2225. @example
  2226. ffmpeg -i in.wav -filter_complex
  2227. 'channelsplit=channel_layout=5.1[FL][FR][FC][LFE][SL][SR]'
  2228. -map '[FL]' front_left.wav -map '[FR]' front_right.wav -map '[FC]'
  2229. front_center.wav -map '[LFE]' lfe.wav -map '[SL]' side_left.wav -map '[SR]'
  2230. side_right.wav
  2231. @end example
  2232. @item
  2233. Extract only LFE from a 5.1 WAV file:
  2234. @example
  2235. ffmpeg -i in.wav -filter_complex 'channelsplit=channel_layout=5.1:channels=LFE[LFE]'
  2236. -map '[LFE]' lfe.wav
  2237. @end example
  2238. @end itemize
  2239. @section chorus
  2240. Add a chorus effect to the audio.
  2241. Can make a single vocal sound like a chorus, but can also be applied to instrumentation.
  2242. Chorus resembles an echo effect with a short delay, but whereas with echo the delay is
  2243. constant, with chorus, it is varied using using sinusoidal or triangular modulation.
  2244. The modulation depth defines the range the modulated delay is played before or after
  2245. the delay. Hence the delayed sound will sound slower or faster, that is the delayed
  2246. sound tuned around the original one, like in a chorus where some vocals are slightly
  2247. off key.
  2248. It accepts the following parameters:
  2249. @table @option
  2250. @item in_gain
  2251. Set input gain. Default is 0.4.
  2252. @item out_gain
  2253. Set output gain. Default is 0.4.
  2254. @item delays
  2255. Set delays. A typical delay is around 40ms to 60ms.
  2256. @item decays
  2257. Set decays.
  2258. @item speeds
  2259. Set speeds.
  2260. @item depths
  2261. Set depths.
  2262. @end table
  2263. @subsection Examples
  2264. @itemize
  2265. @item
  2266. A single delay:
  2267. @example
  2268. chorus=0.7:0.9:55:0.4:0.25:2
  2269. @end example
  2270. @item
  2271. Two delays:
  2272. @example
  2273. chorus=0.6:0.9:50|60:0.4|0.32:0.25|0.4:2|1.3
  2274. @end example
  2275. @item
  2276. Fuller sounding chorus with three delays:
  2277. @example
  2278. chorus=0.5:0.9:50|60|40:0.4|0.32|0.3:0.25|0.4|0.3:2|2.3|1.3
  2279. @end example
  2280. @end itemize
  2281. @section compand
  2282. Compress or expand the audio's dynamic range.
  2283. It accepts the following parameters:
  2284. @table @option
  2285. @item attacks
  2286. @item decays
  2287. A list of times in seconds for each channel over which the instantaneous level
  2288. of the input signal is averaged to determine its volume. @var{attacks} refers to
  2289. increase of volume and @var{decays} refers to decrease of volume. For most
  2290. situations, the attack time (response to the audio getting louder) should be
  2291. shorter than the decay time, because the human ear is more sensitive to sudden
  2292. loud audio than sudden soft audio. A typical value for attack is 0.3 seconds and
  2293. a typical value for decay is 0.8 seconds.
  2294. If specified number of attacks & decays is lower than number of channels, the last
  2295. set attack/decay will be used for all remaining channels.
  2296. @item points
  2297. A list of points for the transfer function, specified in dB relative to the
  2298. maximum possible signal amplitude. Each key points list must be defined using
  2299. the following syntax: @code{x0/y0|x1/y1|x2/y2|....} or
  2300. @code{x0/y0 x1/y1 x2/y2 ....}
  2301. The input values must be in strictly increasing order but the transfer function
  2302. does not have to be monotonically rising. The point @code{0/0} is assumed but
  2303. may be overridden (by @code{0/out-dBn}). Typical values for the transfer
  2304. function are @code{-70/-70|-60/-20|1/0}.
  2305. @item soft-knee
  2306. Set the curve radius in dB for all joints. It defaults to 0.01.
  2307. @item gain
  2308. Set the additional gain in dB to be applied at all points on the transfer
  2309. function. This allows for easy adjustment of the overall gain.
  2310. It defaults to 0.
  2311. @item volume
  2312. Set an initial volume, in dB, to be assumed for each channel when filtering
  2313. starts. This permits the user to supply a nominal level initially, so that, for
  2314. example, a very large gain is not applied to initial signal levels before the
  2315. companding has begun to operate. A typical value for audio which is initially
  2316. quiet is -90 dB. It defaults to 0.
  2317. @item delay
  2318. Set a delay, in seconds. The input audio is analyzed immediately, but audio is
  2319. delayed before being fed to the volume adjuster. Specifying a delay
  2320. approximately equal to the attack/decay times allows the filter to effectively
  2321. operate in predictive rather than reactive mode. It defaults to 0.
  2322. @end table
  2323. @subsection Examples
  2324. @itemize
  2325. @item
  2326. Make music with both quiet and loud passages suitable for listening to in a
  2327. noisy environment:
  2328. @example
  2329. compand=.3|.3:1|1:-90/-60|-60/-40|-40/-30|-20/-20:6:0:-90:0.2
  2330. @end example
  2331. Another example for audio with whisper and explosion parts:
  2332. @example
  2333. compand=0|0:1|1:-90/-900|-70/-70|-30/-9|0/-3:6:0:0:0
  2334. @end example
  2335. @item
  2336. A noise gate for when the noise is at a lower level than the signal:
  2337. @example
  2338. compand=.1|.1:.2|.2:-900/-900|-50.1/-900|-50/-50:.01:0:-90:.1
  2339. @end example
  2340. @item
  2341. Here is another noise gate, this time for when the noise is at a higher level
  2342. than the signal (making it, in some ways, similar to squelch):
  2343. @example
  2344. compand=.1|.1:.1|.1:-45.1/-45.1|-45/-900|0/-900:.01:45:-90:.1
  2345. @end example
  2346. @item
  2347. 2:1 compression starting at -6dB:
  2348. @example
  2349. compand=points=-80/-80|-6/-6|0/-3.8|20/3.5
  2350. @end example
  2351. @item
  2352. 2:1 compression starting at -9dB:
  2353. @example
  2354. compand=points=-80/-80|-9/-9|0/-5.3|20/2.9
  2355. @end example
  2356. @item
  2357. 2:1 compression starting at -12dB:
  2358. @example
  2359. compand=points=-80/-80|-12/-12|0/-6.8|20/1.9
  2360. @end example
  2361. @item
  2362. 2:1 compression starting at -18dB:
  2363. @example
  2364. compand=points=-80/-80|-18/-18|0/-9.8|20/0.7
  2365. @end example
  2366. @item
  2367. 3:1 compression starting at -15dB:
  2368. @example
  2369. compand=points=-80/-80|-15/-15|0/-10.8|20/-5.2
  2370. @end example
  2371. @item
  2372. Compressor/Gate:
  2373. @example
  2374. compand=points=-80/-105|-62/-80|-15.4/-15.4|0/-12|20/-7.6
  2375. @end example
  2376. @item
  2377. Expander:
  2378. @example
  2379. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-169|-54/-80|-49.5/-64.6|-41.1/-41.1|-25.8/-15|-10.8/-4.5|0/0|20/8.3
  2380. @end example
  2381. @item
  2382. Hard limiter at -6dB:
  2383. @example
  2384. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-80|-6/-6|20/-6
  2385. @end example
  2386. @item
  2387. Hard limiter at -12dB:
  2388. @example
  2389. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-80|-12/-12|20/-12
  2390. @end example
  2391. @item
  2392. Hard noise gate at -35 dB:
  2393. @example
  2394. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-115|-35.1/-80|-35/-35|20/20
  2395. @end example
  2396. @item
  2397. Soft limiter:
  2398. @example
  2399. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-80|-12.4/-12.4|-6/-8|0/-6.8|20/-2.8
  2400. @end example
  2401. @end itemize
  2402. @section compensationdelay
  2403. Compensation Delay Line is a metric based delay to compensate differing
  2404. positions of microphones or speakers.
  2405. For example, you have recorded guitar with two microphones placed in
  2406. different locations. Because the front of sound wave has fixed speed in
  2407. normal conditions, the phasing of microphones can vary and depends on
  2408. their location and interposition. The best sound mix can be achieved when
  2409. these microphones are in phase (synchronized). Note that a distance of
  2410. ~30 cm between microphones makes one microphone capture the signal in
  2411. antiphase to the other microphone. That makes the final mix sound moody.
  2412. This filter helps to solve phasing problems by adding different delays
  2413. to each microphone track and make them synchronized.
  2414. The best result can be reached when you take one track as base and
  2415. synchronize other tracks one by one with it.
  2416. Remember that synchronization/delay tolerance depends on sample rate, too.
  2417. Higher sample rates will give more tolerance.
  2418. The filter accepts the following parameters:
  2419. @table @option
  2420. @item mm
  2421. Set millimeters distance. This is compensation distance for fine tuning.
  2422. Default is 0.
  2423. @item cm
  2424. Set cm distance. This is compensation distance for tightening distance setup.
  2425. Default is 0.
  2426. @item m
  2427. Set meters distance. This is compensation distance for hard distance setup.
  2428. Default is 0.
  2429. @item dry
  2430. Set dry amount. Amount of unprocessed (dry) signal.
  2431. Default is 0.
  2432. @item wet
  2433. Set wet amount. Amount of processed (wet) signal.
  2434. Default is 1.
  2435. @item temp
  2436. Set temperature in degrees Celsius. This is the temperature of the environment.
  2437. Default is 20.
  2438. @end table
  2439. @section crossfeed
  2440. Apply headphone crossfeed filter.
  2441. Crossfeed is the process of blending the left and right channels of stereo
  2442. audio recording.
  2443. It is mainly used to reduce extreme stereo separation of low frequencies.
  2444. The intent is to produce more speaker like sound to the listener.
  2445. The filter accepts the following options:
  2446. @table @option
  2447. @item strength
  2448. Set strength of crossfeed. Default is 0.2. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  2449. This sets gain of low shelf filter for side part of stereo image.
  2450. Default is -6dB. Max allowed is -30db when strength is set to 1.
  2451. @item range
  2452. Set soundstage wideness. Default is 0.5. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  2453. This sets cut off frequency of low shelf filter. Default is cut off near
  2454. 1550 Hz. With range set to 1 cut off frequency is set to 2100 Hz.
  2455. @item level_in
  2456. Set input gain. Default is 0.9.
  2457. @item level_out
  2458. Set output gain. Default is 1.
  2459. @end table
  2460. @section crystalizer
  2461. Simple algorithm to expand audio dynamic range.
  2462. The filter accepts the following options:
  2463. @table @option
  2464. @item i
  2465. Sets the intensity of effect (default: 2.0). Must be in range between 0.0
  2466. (unchanged sound) to 10.0 (maximum effect).
  2467. @item c
  2468. Enable clipping. By default is enabled.
  2469. @end table
  2470. @subsection Commands
  2471. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  2472. @section dcshift
  2473. Apply a DC shift to the audio.
  2474. This can be useful to remove a DC offset (caused perhaps by a hardware problem
  2475. in the recording chain) from the audio. The effect of a DC offset is reduced
  2476. headroom and hence volume. The @ref{astats} filter can be used to determine if
  2477. a signal has a DC offset.
  2478. @table @option
  2479. @item shift
  2480. Set the DC shift, allowed range is [-1, 1]. It indicates the amount to shift
  2481. the audio.
  2482. @item limitergain
  2483. Optional. It should have a value much less than 1 (e.g. 0.05 or 0.02) and is
  2484. used to prevent clipping.
  2485. @end table
  2486. @section deesser
  2487. Apply de-essing to the audio samples.
  2488. @table @option
  2489. @item i
  2490. Set intensity for triggering de-essing. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  2491. Default is 0.
  2492. @item m
  2493. Set amount of ducking on treble part of sound. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  2494. Default is 0.5.
  2495. @item f
  2496. How much of original frequency content to keep when de-essing. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  2497. Default is 0.5.
  2498. @item s
  2499. Set the output mode.
  2500. It accepts the following values:
  2501. @table @option
  2502. @item i
  2503. Pass input unchanged.
  2504. @item o
  2505. Pass ess filtered out.
  2506. @item e
  2507. Pass only ess.
  2508. Default value is @var{o}.
  2509. @end table
  2510. @end table
  2511. @section drmeter
  2512. Measure audio dynamic range.
  2513. DR values of 14 and higher is found in very dynamic material. DR of 8 to 13
  2514. is found in transition material. And anything less that 8 have very poor dynamics
  2515. and is very compressed.
  2516. The filter accepts the following options:
  2517. @table @option
  2518. @item length
  2519. Set window length in seconds used to split audio into segments of equal length.
  2520. Default is 3 seconds.
  2521. @end table
  2522. @section dynaudnorm
  2523. Dynamic Audio Normalizer.
  2524. This filter applies a certain amount of gain to the input audio in order
  2525. to bring its peak magnitude to a target level (e.g. 0 dBFS). However, in
  2526. contrast to more "simple" normalization algorithms, the Dynamic Audio
  2527. Normalizer *dynamically* re-adjusts the gain factor to the input audio.
  2528. This allows for applying extra gain to the "quiet" sections of the audio
  2529. while avoiding distortions or clipping the "loud" sections. In other words:
  2530. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer will "even out" the volume of quiet and loud
  2531. sections, in the sense that the volume of each section is brought to the
  2532. same target level. Note, however, that the Dynamic Audio Normalizer achieves
  2533. this goal *without* applying "dynamic range compressing". It will retain 100%
  2534. of the dynamic range *within* each section of the audio file.
  2535. @table @option
  2536. @item framelen, f
  2537. Set the frame length in milliseconds. In range from 10 to 8000 milliseconds.
  2538. Default is 500 milliseconds.
  2539. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer processes the input audio in small chunks,
  2540. referred to as frames. This is required, because a peak magnitude has no
  2541. meaning for just a single sample value. Instead, we need to determine the
  2542. peak magnitude for a contiguous sequence of sample values. While a "standard"
  2543. normalizer would simply use the peak magnitude of the complete file, the
  2544. Dynamic Audio Normalizer determines the peak magnitude individually for each
  2545. frame. The length of a frame is specified in milliseconds. By default, the
  2546. Dynamic Audio Normalizer uses a frame length of 500 milliseconds, which has
  2547. been found to give good results with most files.
  2548. Note that the exact frame length, in number of samples, will be determined
  2549. automatically, based on the sampling rate of the individual input audio file.
  2550. @item gausssize, g
  2551. Set the Gaussian filter window size. In range from 3 to 301, must be odd
  2552. number. Default is 31.
  2553. Probably the most important parameter of the Dynamic Audio Normalizer is the
  2554. @code{window size} of the Gaussian smoothing filter. The filter's window size
  2555. is specified in frames, centered around the current frame. For the sake of
  2556. simplicity, this must be an odd number. Consequently, the default value of 31
  2557. takes into account the current frame, as well as the 15 preceding frames and
  2558. the 15 subsequent frames. Using a larger window results in a stronger
  2559. smoothing effect and thus in less gain variation, i.e. slower gain
  2560. adaptation. Conversely, using a smaller window results in a weaker smoothing
  2561. effect and thus in more gain variation, i.e. faster gain adaptation.
  2562. In other words, the more you increase this value, the more the Dynamic Audio
  2563. Normalizer will behave like a "traditional" normalization filter. On the
  2564. contrary, the more you decrease this value, the more the Dynamic Audio
  2565. Normalizer will behave like a dynamic range compressor.
  2566. @item peak, p
  2567. Set the target peak value. This specifies the highest permissible magnitude
  2568. level for the normalized audio input. This filter will try to approach the
  2569. target peak magnitude as closely as possible, but at the same time it also
  2570. makes sure that the normalized signal will never exceed the peak magnitude.
  2571. A frame's maximum local gain factor is imposed directly by the target peak
  2572. magnitude. The default value is 0.95 and thus leaves a headroom of 5%*.
  2573. It is not recommended to go above this value.
  2574. @item maxgain, m
  2575. Set the maximum gain factor. In range from 1.0 to 100.0. Default is 10.0.
  2576. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer determines the maximum possible (local) gain
  2577. factor for each input frame, i.e. the maximum gain factor that does not
  2578. result in clipping or distortion. The maximum gain factor is determined by
  2579. the frame's highest magnitude sample. However, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer
  2580. additionally bounds the frame's maximum gain factor by a predetermined
  2581. (global) maximum gain factor. This is done in order to avoid excessive gain
  2582. factors in "silent" or almost silent frames. By default, the maximum gain
  2583. factor is 10.0, For most inputs the default value should be sufficient and
  2584. it usually is not recommended to increase this value. Though, for input
  2585. with an extremely low overall volume level, it may be necessary to allow even
  2586. higher gain factors. Note, however, that the Dynamic Audio Normalizer does
  2587. not simply apply a "hard" threshold (i.e. cut off values above the threshold).
  2588. Instead, a "sigmoid" threshold function will be applied. This way, the
  2589. gain factors will smoothly approach the threshold value, but never exceed that
  2590. value.
  2591. @item targetrms, r
  2592. Set the target RMS. In range from 0.0 to 1.0. Default is 0.0 - disabled.
  2593. By default, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer performs "peak" normalization.
  2594. This means that the maximum local gain factor for each frame is defined
  2595. (only) by the frame's highest magnitude sample. This way, the samples can
  2596. be amplified as much as possible without exceeding the maximum signal
  2597. level, i.e. without clipping. Optionally, however, the Dynamic Audio
  2598. Normalizer can also take into account the frame's root mean square,
  2599. abbreviated RMS. In electrical engineering, the RMS is commonly used to
  2600. determine the power of a time-varying signal. It is therefore considered
  2601. that the RMS is a better approximation of the "perceived loudness" than
  2602. just looking at the signal's peak magnitude. Consequently, by adjusting all
  2603. frames to a constant RMS value, a uniform "perceived loudness" can be
  2604. established. If a target RMS value has been specified, a frame's local gain
  2605. factor is defined as the factor that would result in exactly that RMS value.
  2606. Note, however, that the maximum local gain factor is still restricted by the
  2607. frame's highest magnitude sample, in order to prevent clipping.
  2608. @item coupling, n
  2609. Enable channels coupling. By default is enabled.
  2610. By default, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer will amplify all channels by the same
  2611. amount. This means the same gain factor will be applied to all channels, i.e.
  2612. the maximum possible gain factor is determined by the "loudest" channel.
  2613. However, in some recordings, it may happen that the volume of the different
  2614. channels is uneven, e.g. one channel may be "quieter" than the other one(s).
  2615. In this case, this option can be used to disable the channel coupling. This way,
  2616. the gain factor will be determined independently for each channel, depending
  2617. only on the individual channel's highest magnitude sample. This allows for
  2618. harmonizing the volume of the different channels.
  2619. @item correctdc, c
  2620. Enable DC bias correction. By default is disabled.
  2621. An audio signal (in the time domain) is a sequence of sample values.
  2622. In the Dynamic Audio Normalizer these sample values are represented in the
  2623. -1.0 to 1.0 range, regardless of the original input format. Normally, the
  2624. audio signal, or "waveform", should be centered around the zero point.
  2625. That means if we calculate the mean value of all samples in a file, or in a
  2626. single frame, then the result should be 0.0 or at least very close to that
  2627. value. If, however, there is a significant deviation of the mean value from
  2628. 0.0, in either positive or negative direction, this is referred to as a
  2629. DC bias or DC offset. Since a DC bias is clearly undesirable, the Dynamic
  2630. Audio Normalizer provides optional DC bias correction.
  2631. With DC bias correction enabled, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer will determine
  2632. the mean value, or "DC correction" offset, of each input frame and subtract
  2633. that value from all of the frame's sample values which ensures those samples
  2634. are centered around 0.0 again. Also, in order to avoid "gaps" at the frame
  2635. boundaries, the DC correction offset values will be interpolated smoothly
  2636. between neighbouring frames.
  2637. @item altboundary, b
  2638. Enable alternative boundary mode. By default is disabled.
  2639. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer takes into account a certain neighbourhood
  2640. around each frame. This includes the preceding frames as well as the
  2641. subsequent frames. However, for the "boundary" frames, located at the very
  2642. beginning and at the very end of the audio file, not all neighbouring
  2643. frames are available. In particular, for the first few frames in the audio
  2644. file, the preceding frames are not known. And, similarly, for the last few
  2645. frames in the audio file, the subsequent frames are not known. Thus, the
  2646. question arises which gain factors should be assumed for the missing frames
  2647. in the "boundary" region. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer implements two modes
  2648. to deal with this situation. The default boundary mode assumes a gain factor
  2649. of exactly 1.0 for the missing frames, resulting in a smooth "fade in" and
  2650. "fade out" at the beginning and at the end of the input, respectively.
  2651. @item compress, s
  2652. Set the compress factor. In range from 0.0 to 30.0. Default is 0.0.
  2653. By default, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer does not apply "traditional"
  2654. compression. This means that signal peaks will not be pruned and thus the
  2655. full dynamic range will be retained within each local neighbourhood. However,
  2656. in some cases it may be desirable to combine the Dynamic Audio Normalizer's
  2657. normalization algorithm with a more "traditional" compression.
  2658. For this purpose, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer provides an optional compression
  2659. (thresholding) function. If (and only if) the compression feature is enabled,
  2660. all input frames will be processed by a soft knee thresholding function prior
  2661. to the actual normalization process. Put simply, the thresholding function is
  2662. going to prune all samples whose magnitude exceeds a certain threshold value.
  2663. However, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer does not simply apply a fixed threshold
  2664. value. Instead, the threshold value will be adjusted for each individual
  2665. frame.
  2666. In general, smaller parameters result in stronger compression, and vice versa.
  2667. Values below 3.0 are not recommended, because audible distortion may appear.
  2668. @item threshold, t
  2669. Set the target threshold value. This specifies the lowest permissible
  2670. magnitude level for the audio input which will be normalized.
  2671. If input frame volume is above this value frame will be normalized.
  2672. Otherwise frame may not be normalized at all. The default value is set
  2673. to 0, which means all input frames will be normalized.
  2674. This option is mostly useful if digital noise is not wanted to be amplified.
  2675. @end table
  2676. @subsection Commands
  2677. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  2678. @section earwax
  2679. Make audio easier to listen to on headphones.
  2680. This filter adds `cues' to 44.1kHz stereo (i.e. audio CD format) audio
  2681. so that when listened to on headphones the stereo image is moved from
  2682. inside your head (standard for headphones) to outside and in front of
  2683. the listener (standard for speakers).
  2684. Ported from SoX.
  2685. @section equalizer
  2686. Apply a two-pole peaking equalisation (EQ) filter. With this
  2687. filter, the signal-level at and around a selected frequency can
  2688. be increased or decreased, whilst (unlike bandpass and bandreject
  2689. filters) that at all other frequencies is unchanged.
  2690. In order to produce complex equalisation curves, this filter can
  2691. be given several times, each with a different central frequency.
  2692. The filter accepts the following options:
  2693. @table @option
  2694. @item frequency, f
  2695. Set the filter's central frequency in Hz.
  2696. @item width_type, t
  2697. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  2698. @table @option
  2699. @item h
  2700. Hz
  2701. @item q
  2702. Q-Factor
  2703. @item o
  2704. octave
  2705. @item s
  2706. slope
  2707. @item k
  2708. kHz
  2709. @end table
  2710. @item width, w
  2711. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  2712. @item gain, g
  2713. Set the required gain or attenuation in dB.
  2714. Beware of clipping when using a positive gain.
  2715. @item mix, m
  2716. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  2717. Range is between 0 and 1.
  2718. @item channels, c
  2719. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  2720. @item normalize, n
  2721. Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.
  2722. Enabling it will normalize magnitude response at DC to 0dB.
  2723. @end table
  2724. @subsection Examples
  2725. @itemize
  2726. @item
  2727. Attenuate 10 dB at 1000 Hz, with a bandwidth of 200 Hz:
  2728. @example
  2729. equalizer=f=1000:t=h:width=200:g=-10
  2730. @end example
  2731. @item
  2732. Apply 2 dB gain at 1000 Hz with Q 1 and attenuate 5 dB at 100 Hz with Q 2:
  2733. @example
  2734. equalizer=f=1000:t=q:w=1:g=2,equalizer=f=100:t=q:w=2:g=-5
  2735. @end example
  2736. @end itemize
  2737. @subsection Commands
  2738. This filter supports the following commands:
  2739. @table @option
  2740. @item frequency, f
  2741. Change equalizer frequency.
  2742. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  2743. @item width_type, t
  2744. Change equalizer width_type.
  2745. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  2746. @item width, w
  2747. Change equalizer width.
  2748. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  2749. @item gain, g
  2750. Change equalizer gain.
  2751. Syntax for the command is : "@var{gain}"
  2752. @item mix, m
  2753. Change equalizer mix.
  2754. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  2755. @end table
  2756. @section extrastereo
  2757. Linearly increases the difference between left and right channels which
  2758. adds some sort of "live" effect to playback.
  2759. The filter accepts the following options:
  2760. @table @option
  2761. @item m
  2762. Sets the difference coefficient (default: 2.5). 0.0 means mono sound
  2763. (average of both channels), with 1.0 sound will be unchanged, with
  2764. -1.0 left and right channels will be swapped.
  2765. @item c
  2766. Enable clipping. By default is enabled.
  2767. @end table
  2768. @subsection Commands
  2769. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  2770. @section firequalizer
  2771. Apply FIR Equalization using arbitrary frequency response.
  2772. The filter accepts the following option:
  2773. @table @option
  2774. @item gain
  2775. Set gain curve equation (in dB). The expression can contain variables:
  2776. @table @option
  2777. @item f
  2778. the evaluated frequency
  2779. @item sr
  2780. sample rate
  2781. @item ch
  2782. channel number, set to 0 when multichannels evaluation is disabled
  2783. @item chid
  2784. channel id, see libavutil/channel_layout.h, set to the first channel id when
  2785. multichannels evaluation is disabled
  2786. @item chs
  2787. number of channels
  2788. @item chlayout
  2789. channel_layout, see libavutil/channel_layout.h
  2790. @end table
  2791. and functions:
  2792. @table @option
  2793. @item gain_interpolate(f)
  2794. interpolate gain on frequency f based on gain_entry
  2795. @item cubic_interpolate(f)
  2796. same as gain_interpolate, but smoother
  2797. @end table
  2798. This option is also available as command. Default is @code{gain_interpolate(f)}.
  2799. @item gain_entry
  2800. Set gain entry for gain_interpolate function. The expression can
  2801. contain functions:
  2802. @table @option
  2803. @item entry(f, g)
  2804. store gain entry at frequency f with value g
  2805. @end table
  2806. This option is also available as command.
  2807. @item delay
  2808. Set filter delay in seconds. Higher value means more accurate.
  2809. Default is @code{0.01}.
  2810. @item accuracy
  2811. Set filter accuracy in Hz. Lower value means more accurate.
  2812. Default is @code{5}.
  2813. @item wfunc
  2814. Set window function. Acceptable values are:
  2815. @table @option
  2816. @item rectangular
  2817. rectangular window, useful when gain curve is already smooth
  2818. @item hann
  2819. hann window (default)
  2820. @item hamming
  2821. hamming window
  2822. @item blackman
  2823. blackman window
  2824. @item nuttall3
  2825. 3-terms continuous 1st derivative nuttall window
  2826. @item mnuttall3
  2827. minimum 3-terms discontinuous nuttall window
  2828. @item nuttall
  2829. 4-terms continuous 1st derivative nuttall window
  2830. @item bnuttall
  2831. minimum 4-terms discontinuous nuttall (blackman-nuttall) window
  2832. @item bharris
  2833. blackman-harris window
  2834. @item tukey
  2835. tukey window
  2836. @end table
  2837. @item fixed
  2838. If enabled, use fixed number of audio samples. This improves speed when
  2839. filtering with large delay. Default is disabled.
  2840. @item multi
  2841. Enable multichannels evaluation on gain. Default is disabled.
  2842. @item zero_phase
  2843. Enable zero phase mode by subtracting timestamp to compensate delay.
  2844. Default is disabled.
  2845. @item scale
  2846. Set scale used by gain. Acceptable values are:
  2847. @table @option
  2848. @item linlin
  2849. linear frequency, linear gain
  2850. @item linlog
  2851. linear frequency, logarithmic (in dB) gain (default)
  2852. @item loglin
  2853. logarithmic (in octave scale where 20 Hz is 0) frequency, linear gain
  2854. @item loglog
  2855. logarithmic frequency, logarithmic gain
  2856. @end table
  2857. @item dumpfile
  2858. Set file for dumping, suitable for gnuplot.
  2859. @item dumpscale
  2860. Set scale for dumpfile. Acceptable values are same with scale option.
  2861. Default is linlog.
  2862. @item fft2
  2863. Enable 2-channel convolution using complex FFT. This improves speed significantly.
  2864. Default is disabled.
  2865. @item min_phase
  2866. Enable minimum phase impulse response. Default is disabled.
  2867. @end table
  2868. @subsection Examples
  2869. @itemize
  2870. @item
  2871. lowpass at 1000 Hz:
  2872. @example
  2873. firequalizer=gain='if(lt(f,1000), 0, -INF)'
  2874. @end example
  2875. @item
  2876. lowpass at 1000 Hz with gain_entry:
  2877. @example
  2878. firequalizer=gain_entry='entry(1000,0); entry(1001, -INF)'
  2879. @end example
  2880. @item
  2881. custom equalization:
  2882. @example
  2883. firequalizer=gain_entry='entry(100,0); entry(400, -4); entry(1000, -6); entry(2000, 0)'
  2884. @end example
  2885. @item
  2886. higher delay with zero phase to compensate delay:
  2887. @example
  2888. firequalizer=delay=0.1:fixed=on:zero_phase=on
  2889. @end example
  2890. @item
  2891. lowpass on left channel, highpass on right channel:
  2892. @example
  2893. firequalizer=gain='if(eq(chid,1), gain_interpolate(f), if(eq(chid,2), gain_interpolate(1e6+f), 0))'
  2894. :gain_entry='entry(1000, 0); entry(1001,-INF); entry(1e6+1000,0)':multi=on
  2895. @end example
  2896. @end itemize
  2897. @section flanger
  2898. Apply a flanging effect to the audio.
  2899. The filter accepts the following options:
  2900. @table @option
  2901. @item delay
  2902. Set base delay in milliseconds. Range from 0 to 30. Default value is 0.
  2903. @item depth
  2904. Set added sweep delay in milliseconds. Range from 0 to 10. Default value is 2.
  2905. @item regen
  2906. Set percentage regeneration (delayed signal feedback). Range from -95 to 95.
  2907. Default value is 0.
  2908. @item width
  2909. Set percentage of delayed signal mixed with original. Range from 0 to 100.
  2910. Default value is 71.
  2911. @item speed
  2912. Set sweeps per second (Hz). Range from 0.1 to 10. Default value is 0.5.
  2913. @item shape
  2914. Set swept wave shape, can be @var{triangular} or @var{sinusoidal}.
  2915. Default value is @var{sinusoidal}.
  2916. @item phase
  2917. Set swept wave percentage-shift for multi channel. Range from 0 to 100.
  2918. Default value is 25.
  2919. @item interp
  2920. Set delay-line interpolation, @var{linear} or @var{quadratic}.
  2921. Default is @var{linear}.
  2922. @end table
  2923. @section haas
  2924. Apply Haas effect to audio.
  2925. Note that this makes most sense to apply on mono signals.
  2926. With this filter applied to mono signals it give some directionality and
  2927. stretches its stereo image.
  2928. The filter accepts the following options:
  2929. @table @option
  2930. @item level_in
  2931. Set input level. By default is @var{1}, or 0dB
  2932. @item level_out
  2933. Set output level. By default is @var{1}, or 0dB.
  2934. @item side_gain
  2935. Set gain applied to side part of signal. By default is @var{1}.
  2936. @item middle_source
  2937. Set kind of middle source. Can be one of the following:
  2938. @table @samp
  2939. @item left
  2940. Pick left channel.
  2941. @item right
  2942. Pick right channel.
  2943. @item mid
  2944. Pick middle part signal of stereo image.
  2945. @item side
  2946. Pick side part signal of stereo image.
  2947. @end table
  2948. @item middle_phase
  2949. Change middle phase. By default is disabled.
  2950. @item left_delay
  2951. Set left channel delay. By default is @var{2.05} milliseconds.
  2952. @item left_balance
  2953. Set left channel balance. By default is @var{-1}.
  2954. @item left_gain
  2955. Set left channel gain. By default is @var{1}.
  2956. @item left_phase
  2957. Change left phase. By default is disabled.
  2958. @item right_delay
  2959. Set right channel delay. By defaults is @var{2.12} milliseconds.
  2960. @item right_balance
  2961. Set right channel balance. By default is @var{1}.
  2962. @item right_gain
  2963. Set right channel gain. By default is @var{1}.
  2964. @item right_phase
  2965. Change right phase. By default is enabled.
  2966. @end table
  2967. @section hdcd
  2968. Decodes High Definition Compatible Digital (HDCD) data. A 16-bit PCM stream with
  2969. embedded HDCD codes is expanded into a 20-bit PCM stream.
  2970. The filter supports the Peak Extend and Low-level Gain Adjustment features
  2971. of HDCD, and detects the Transient Filter flag.
  2972. @example
  2973. ffmpeg -i HDCD16.flac -af hdcd OUT24.flac
  2974. @end example
  2975. When using the filter with wav, note the default encoding for wav is 16-bit,
  2976. so the resulting 20-bit stream will be truncated back to 16-bit. Use something
  2977. like @command{-acodec pcm_s24le} after the filter to get 24-bit PCM output.
  2978. @example
  2979. ffmpeg -i HDCD16.wav -af hdcd OUT16.wav
  2980. ffmpeg -i HDCD16.wav -af hdcd -c:a pcm_s24le OUT24.wav
  2981. @end example
  2982. The filter accepts the following options:
  2983. @table @option
  2984. @item disable_autoconvert
  2985. Disable any automatic format conversion or resampling in the filter graph.
  2986. @item process_stereo
  2987. Process the stereo channels together. If target_gain does not match between
  2988. channels, consider it invalid and use the last valid target_gain.
  2989. @item cdt_ms
  2990. Set the code detect timer period in ms.
  2991. @item force_pe
  2992. Always extend peaks above -3dBFS even if PE isn't signaled.
  2993. @item analyze_mode
  2994. Replace audio with a solid tone and adjust the amplitude to signal some
  2995. specific aspect of the decoding process. The output file can be loaded in
  2996. an audio editor alongside the original to aid analysis.
  2997. @code{analyze_mode=pe:force_pe=true} can be used to see all samples above the PE level.
  2998. Modes are:
  2999. @table @samp
  3000. @item 0, off
  3001. Disabled
  3002. @item 1, lle
  3003. Gain adjustment level at each sample
  3004. @item 2, pe
  3005. Samples where peak extend occurs
  3006. @item 3, cdt
  3007. Samples where the code detect timer is active
  3008. @item 4, tgm
  3009. Samples where the target gain does not match between channels
  3010. @end table
  3011. @end table
  3012. @section headphone
  3013. Apply head-related transfer functions (HRTFs) to create virtual
  3014. loudspeakers around the user for binaural listening via headphones.
  3015. The HRIRs are provided via additional streams, for each channel
  3016. one stereo input stream is needed.
  3017. The filter accepts the following options:
  3018. @table @option
  3019. @item map
  3020. Set mapping of input streams for convolution.
  3021. The argument is a '|'-separated list of channel names in order as they
  3022. are given as additional stream inputs for filter.
  3023. This also specify number of input streams. Number of input streams
  3024. must be not less than number of channels in first stream plus one.
  3025. @item gain
  3026. Set gain applied to audio. Value is in dB. Default is 0.
  3027. @item type
  3028. Set processing type. Can be @var{time} or @var{freq}. @var{time} is
  3029. processing audio in time domain which is slow.
  3030. @var{freq} is processing audio in frequency domain which is fast.
  3031. Default is @var{freq}.
  3032. @item lfe
  3033. Set custom gain for LFE channels. Value is in dB. Default is 0.
  3034. @item size
  3035. Set size of frame in number of samples which will be processed at once.
  3036. Default value is @var{1024}. Allowed range is from 1024 to 96000.
  3037. @item hrir
  3038. Set format of hrir stream.
  3039. Default value is @var{stereo}. Alternative value is @var{multich}.
  3040. If value is set to @var{stereo}, number of additional streams should
  3041. be greater or equal to number of input channels in first input stream.
  3042. Also each additional stream should have stereo number of channels.
  3043. If value is set to @var{multich}, number of additional streams should
  3044. be exactly one. Also number of input channels of additional stream
  3045. should be equal or greater than twice number of channels of first input
  3046. stream.
  3047. @end table
  3048. @subsection Examples
  3049. @itemize
  3050. @item
  3051. Full example using wav files as coefficients with amovie filters for 7.1 downmix,
  3052. each amovie filter use stereo file with IR coefficients as input.
  3053. The files give coefficients for each position of virtual loudspeaker:
  3054. @example
  3055. ffmpeg -i input.wav
  3056. -filter_complex "amovie=azi_270_ele_0_DFC.wav[sr];amovie=azi_90_ele_0_DFC.wav[sl];amovie=azi_225_ele_0_DFC.wav[br];amovie=azi_135_ele_0_DFC.wav[bl];amovie=azi_0_ele_0_DFC.wav,asplit[fc][lfe];amovie=azi_35_ele_0_DFC.wav[fl];amovie=azi_325_ele_0_DFC.wav[fr];[0:a][fl][fr][fc][lfe][bl][br][sl][sr]headphone=FL|FR|FC|LFE|BL|BR|SL|SR"
  3057. output.wav
  3058. @end example
  3059. @item
  3060. Full example using wav files as coefficients with amovie filters for 7.1 downmix,
  3061. but now in @var{multich} @var{hrir} format.
  3062. @example
  3063. ffmpeg -i input.wav -filter_complex "amovie=minp.wav[hrirs];[0:a][hrirs]headphone=map=FL|FR|FC|LFE|BL|BR|SL|SR:hrir=multich"
  3064. output.wav
  3065. @end example
  3066. @end itemize
  3067. @section highpass
  3068. Apply a high-pass filter with 3dB point frequency.
  3069. The filter can be either single-pole, or double-pole (the default).
  3070. The filter roll off at 6dB per pole per octave (20dB per pole per decade).
  3071. The filter accepts the following options:
  3072. @table @option
  3073. @item frequency, f
  3074. Set frequency in Hz. Default is 3000.
  3075. @item poles, p
  3076. Set number of poles. Default is 2.
  3077. @item width_type, t
  3078. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  3079. @table @option
  3080. @item h
  3081. Hz
  3082. @item q
  3083. Q-Factor
  3084. @item o
  3085. octave
  3086. @item s
  3087. slope
  3088. @item k
  3089. kHz
  3090. @end table
  3091. @item width, w
  3092. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  3093. Applies only to double-pole filter.
  3094. The default is 0.707q and gives a Butterworth response.
  3095. @item mix, m
  3096. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  3097. Range is between 0 and 1.
  3098. @item channels, c
  3099. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  3100. @item normalize, n
  3101. Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.
  3102. Enabling it will normalize magnitude response at DC to 0dB.
  3103. @end table
  3104. @subsection Commands
  3105. This filter supports the following commands:
  3106. @table @option
  3107. @item frequency, f
  3108. Change highpass frequency.
  3109. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  3110. @item width_type, t
  3111. Change highpass width_type.
  3112. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  3113. @item width, w
  3114. Change highpass width.
  3115. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  3116. @item mix, m
  3117. Change highpass mix.
  3118. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  3119. @end table
  3120. @section join
  3121. Join multiple input streams into one multi-channel stream.
  3122. It accepts the following parameters:
  3123. @table @option
  3124. @item inputs
  3125. The number of input streams. It defaults to 2.
  3126. @item channel_layout
  3127. The desired output channel layout. It defaults to stereo.
  3128. @item map
  3129. Map channels from inputs to output. The argument is a '|'-separated list of
  3130. mappings, each in the @code{@var{input_idx}.@var{in_channel}-@var{out_channel}}
  3131. form. @var{input_idx} is the 0-based index of the input stream. @var{in_channel}
  3132. can be either the name of the input channel (e.g. FL for front left) or its
  3133. index in the specified input stream. @var{out_channel} is the name of the output
  3134. channel.
  3135. @end table
  3136. The filter will attempt to guess the mappings when they are not specified
  3137. explicitly. It does so by first trying to find an unused matching input channel
  3138. and if that fails it picks the first unused input channel.
  3139. Join 3 inputs (with properly set channel layouts):
  3140. @example
  3141. ffmpeg -i INPUT1 -i INPUT2 -i INPUT3 -filter_complex join=inputs=3 OUTPUT
  3142. @end example
  3143. Build a 5.1 output from 6 single-channel streams:
  3144. @example
  3145. ffmpeg -i fl -i fr -i fc -i sl -i sr -i lfe -filter_complex
  3146. 'join=inputs=6:channel_layout=5.1:map=0.0-FL|1.0-FR|2.0-FC|3.0-SL|4.0-SR|5.0-LFE'
  3147. out
  3148. @end example
  3149. @section ladspa
  3150. Load a LADSPA (Linux Audio Developer's Simple Plugin API) plugin.
  3151. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  3152. @code{--enable-ladspa}.
  3153. @table @option
  3154. @item file, f
  3155. Specifies the name of LADSPA plugin library to load. If the environment
  3156. variable @env{LADSPA_PATH} is defined, the LADSPA plugin is searched in
  3157. each one of the directories specified by the colon separated list in
  3158. @env{LADSPA_PATH}, otherwise in the standard LADSPA paths, which are in
  3159. this order: @file{HOME/.ladspa/lib/}, @file{/usr/local/lib/ladspa/},
  3160. @file{/usr/lib/ladspa/}.
  3161. @item plugin, p
  3162. Specifies the plugin within the library. Some libraries contain only
  3163. one plugin, but others contain many of them. If this is not set filter
  3164. will list all available plugins within the specified library.
  3165. @item controls, c
  3166. Set the '|' separated list of controls which are zero or more floating point
  3167. values that determine the behavior of the loaded plugin (for example delay,
  3168. threshold or gain).
  3169. Controls need to be defined using the following syntax:
  3170. c0=@var{value0}|c1=@var{value1}|c2=@var{value2}|..., where
  3171. @var{valuei} is the value set on the @var{i}-th control.
  3172. Alternatively they can be also defined using the following syntax:
  3173. @var{value0}|@var{value1}|@var{value2}|..., where
  3174. @var{valuei} is the value set on the @var{i}-th control.
  3175. If @option{controls} is set to @code{help}, all available controls and
  3176. their valid ranges are printed.
  3177. @item sample_rate, s
  3178. Specify the sample rate, default to 44100. Only used if plugin have
  3179. zero inputs.
  3180. @item nb_samples, n
  3181. Set the number of samples per channel per each output frame, default
  3182. is 1024. Only used if plugin have zero inputs.
  3183. @item duration, d
  3184. Set the minimum duration of the sourced audio. See
  3185. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  3186. for the accepted syntax.
  3187. Note that the resulting duration may be greater than the specified duration,
  3188. as the generated audio is always cut at the end of a complete frame.
  3189. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the audio is
  3190. supposed to be generated forever.
  3191. Only used if plugin have zero inputs.
  3192. @end table
  3193. @subsection Examples
  3194. @itemize
  3195. @item
  3196. List all available plugins within amp (LADSPA example plugin) library:
  3197. @example
  3198. ladspa=file=amp
  3199. @end example
  3200. @item
  3201. List all available controls and their valid ranges for @code{vcf_notch}
  3202. plugin from @code{VCF} library:
  3203. @example
  3204. ladspa=f=vcf:p=vcf_notch:c=help
  3205. @end example
  3206. @item
  3207. Simulate low quality audio equipment using @code{Computer Music Toolkit} (CMT)
  3208. plugin library:
  3209. @example
  3210. ladspa=file=cmt:plugin=lofi:controls=c0=22|c1=12|c2=12
  3211. @end example
  3212. @item
  3213. Add reverberation to the audio using TAP-plugins
  3214. (Tom's Audio Processing plugins):
  3215. @example
  3216. ladspa=file=tap_reverb:tap_reverb
  3217. @end example
  3218. @item
  3219. Generate white noise, with 0.2 amplitude:
  3220. @example
  3221. ladspa=file=cmt:noise_source_white:c=c0=.2
  3222. @end example
  3223. @item
  3224. Generate 20 bpm clicks using plugin @code{C* Click - Metronome} from the
  3225. @code{C* Audio Plugin Suite} (CAPS) library:
  3226. @example
  3227. ladspa=file=caps:Click:c=c1=20'
  3228. @end example
  3229. @item
  3230. Apply @code{C* Eq10X2 - Stereo 10-band equaliser} effect:
  3231. @example
  3232. ladspa=caps:Eq10X2:c=c0=-48|c9=-24|c3=12|c4=2
  3233. @end example
  3234. @item
  3235. Increase volume by 20dB using fast lookahead limiter from Steve Harris
  3236. @code{SWH Plugins} collection:
  3237. @example
  3238. ladspa=fast_lookahead_limiter_1913:fastLookaheadLimiter:20|0|2
  3239. @end example
  3240. @item
  3241. Attenuate low frequencies using Multiband EQ from Steve Harris
  3242. @code{SWH Plugins} collection:
  3243. @example
  3244. ladspa=mbeq_1197:mbeq:-24|-24|-24|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0
  3245. @end example
  3246. @item
  3247. Reduce stereo image using @code{Narrower} from the @code{C* Audio Plugin Suite}
  3248. (CAPS) library:
  3249. @example
  3250. ladspa=caps:Narrower
  3251. @end example
  3252. @item
  3253. Another white noise, now using @code{C* Audio Plugin Suite} (CAPS) library:
  3254. @example
  3255. ladspa=caps:White:.2
  3256. @end example
  3257. @item
  3258. Some fractal noise, using @code{C* Audio Plugin Suite} (CAPS) library:
  3259. @example
  3260. ladspa=caps:Fractal:c=c1=1
  3261. @end example
  3262. @item
  3263. Dynamic volume normalization using @code{VLevel} plugin:
  3264. @example
  3265. ladspa=vlevel-ladspa:vlevel_mono
  3266. @end example
  3267. @end itemize
  3268. @subsection Commands
  3269. This filter supports the following commands:
  3270. @table @option
  3271. @item cN
  3272. Modify the @var{N}-th control value.
  3273. If the specified value is not valid, it is ignored and prior one is kept.
  3274. @end table
  3275. @section loudnorm
  3276. EBU R128 loudness normalization. Includes both dynamic and linear normalization modes.
  3277. Support for both single pass (livestreams, files) and double pass (files) modes.
  3278. This algorithm can target IL, LRA, and maximum true peak. To accurately detect true peaks,
  3279. the audio stream will be upsampled to 192 kHz unless the normalization mode is linear.
  3280. Use the @code{-ar} option or @code{aresample} filter to explicitly set an output sample rate.
  3281. The filter accepts the following options:
  3282. @table @option
  3283. @item I, i
  3284. Set integrated loudness target.
  3285. Range is -70.0 - -5.0. Default value is -24.0.
  3286. @item LRA, lra
  3287. Set loudness range target.
  3288. Range is 1.0 - 20.0. Default value is 7.0.
  3289. @item TP, tp
  3290. Set maximum true peak.
  3291. Range is -9.0 - +0.0. Default value is -2.0.
  3292. @item measured_I, measured_i
  3293. Measured IL of input file.
  3294. Range is -99.0 - +0.0.
  3295. @item measured_LRA, measured_lra
  3296. Measured LRA of input file.
  3297. Range is 0.0 - 99.0.
  3298. @item measured_TP, measured_tp
  3299. Measured true peak of input file.
  3300. Range is -99.0 - +99.0.
  3301. @item measured_thresh
  3302. Measured threshold of input file.
  3303. Range is -99.0 - +0.0.
  3304. @item offset
  3305. Set offset gain. Gain is applied before the true-peak limiter.
  3306. Range is -99.0 - +99.0. Default is +0.0.
  3307. @item linear
  3308. Normalize linearly if possible.
  3309. measured_I, measured_LRA, measured_TP, and measured_thresh must also
  3310. to be specified in order to use this mode.
  3311. Options are true or false. Default is true.
  3312. @item dual_mono
  3313. Treat mono input files as "dual-mono". If a mono file is intended for playback
  3314. on a stereo system, its EBU R128 measurement will be perceptually incorrect.
  3315. If set to @code{true}, this option will compensate for this effect.
  3316. Multi-channel input files are not affected by this option.
  3317. Options are true or false. Default is false.
  3318. @item print_format
  3319. Set print format for stats. Options are summary, json, or none.
  3320. Default value is none.
  3321. @end table
  3322. @section lowpass
  3323. Apply a low-pass filter with 3dB point frequency.
  3324. The filter can be either single-pole or double-pole (the default).
  3325. The filter roll off at 6dB per pole per octave (20dB per pole per decade).
  3326. The filter accepts the following options:
  3327. @table @option
  3328. @item frequency, f
  3329. Set frequency in Hz. Default is 500.
  3330. @item poles, p
  3331. Set number of poles. Default is 2.
  3332. @item width_type, t
  3333. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  3334. @table @option
  3335. @item h
  3336. Hz
  3337. @item q
  3338. Q-Factor
  3339. @item o
  3340. octave
  3341. @item s
  3342. slope
  3343. @item k
  3344. kHz
  3345. @end table
  3346. @item width, w
  3347. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  3348. Applies only to double-pole filter.
  3349. The default is 0.707q and gives a Butterworth response.
  3350. @item mix, m
  3351. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  3352. Range is between 0 and 1.
  3353. @item channels, c
  3354. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  3355. @item normalize, n
  3356. Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.
  3357. Enabling it will normalize magnitude response at DC to 0dB.
  3358. @end table
  3359. @subsection Examples
  3360. @itemize
  3361. @item
  3362. Lowpass only LFE channel, it LFE is not present it does nothing:
  3363. @example
  3364. lowpass=c=LFE
  3365. @end example
  3366. @end itemize
  3367. @subsection Commands
  3368. This filter supports the following commands:
  3369. @table @option
  3370. @item frequency, f
  3371. Change lowpass frequency.
  3372. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  3373. @item width_type, t
  3374. Change lowpass width_type.
  3375. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  3376. @item width, w
  3377. Change lowpass width.
  3378. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  3379. @item mix, m
  3380. Change lowpass mix.
  3381. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  3382. @end table
  3383. @section lv2
  3384. Load a LV2 (LADSPA Version 2) plugin.
  3385. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  3386. @code{--enable-lv2}.
  3387. @table @option
  3388. @item plugin, p
  3389. Specifies the plugin URI. You may need to escape ':'.
  3390. @item controls, c
  3391. Set the '|' separated list of controls which are zero or more floating point
  3392. values that determine the behavior of the loaded plugin (for example delay,
  3393. threshold or gain).
  3394. If @option{controls} is set to @code{help}, all available controls and
  3395. their valid ranges are printed.
  3396. @item sample_rate, s
  3397. Specify the sample rate, default to 44100. Only used if plugin have
  3398. zero inputs.
  3399. @item nb_samples, n
  3400. Set the number of samples per channel per each output frame, default
  3401. is 1024. Only used if plugin have zero inputs.
  3402. @item duration, d
  3403. Set the minimum duration of the sourced audio. See
  3404. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  3405. for the accepted syntax.
  3406. Note that the resulting duration may be greater than the specified duration,
  3407. as the generated audio is always cut at the end of a complete frame.
  3408. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the audio is
  3409. supposed to be generated forever.
  3410. Only used if plugin have zero inputs.
  3411. @end table
  3412. @subsection Examples
  3413. @itemize
  3414. @item
  3415. Apply bass enhancer plugin from Calf:
  3416. @example
  3417. lv2=p=http\\\\://calf.sourceforge.net/plugins/BassEnhancer:c=amount=2
  3418. @end example
  3419. @item
  3420. Apply vinyl plugin from Calf:
  3421. @example
  3422. lv2=p=http\\\\://calf.sourceforge.net/plugins/Vinyl:c=drone=0.2|aging=0.5
  3423. @end example
  3424. @item
  3425. Apply bit crusher plugin from ArtyFX:
  3426. @example
  3427. lv2=p=http\\\\://www.openavproductions.com/artyfx#bitta:c=crush=0.3
  3428. @end example
  3429. @end itemize
  3430. @section mcompand
  3431. Multiband Compress or expand the audio's dynamic range.
  3432. The input audio is divided into bands using 4th order Linkwitz-Riley IIRs.
  3433. This is akin to the crossover of a loudspeaker, and results in flat frequency
  3434. response when absent compander action.
  3435. It accepts the following parameters:
  3436. @table @option
  3437. @item args
  3438. This option syntax is:
  3439. attack,decay,[attack,decay..] soft-knee points crossover_frequency [delay [initial_volume [gain]]] | attack,decay ...
  3440. For explanation of each item refer to compand filter documentation.
  3441. @end table
  3442. @anchor{pan}
  3443. @section pan
  3444. Mix channels with specific gain levels. The filter accepts the output
  3445. channel layout followed by a set of channels definitions.
  3446. This filter is also designed to efficiently remap the channels of an audio
  3447. stream.
  3448. The filter accepts parameters of the form:
  3449. "@var{l}|@var{outdef}|@var{outdef}|..."
  3450. @table @option
  3451. @item l
  3452. output channel layout or number of channels
  3453. @item outdef
  3454. output channel specification, of the form:
  3455. "@var{out_name}=[@var{gain}*]@var{in_name}[(+-)[@var{gain}*]@var{in_name}...]"
  3456. @item out_name
  3457. output channel to define, either a channel name (FL, FR, etc.) or a channel
  3458. number (c0, c1, etc.)
  3459. @item gain
  3460. multiplicative coefficient for the channel, 1 leaving the volume unchanged
  3461. @item in_name
  3462. input channel to use, see out_name for details; it is not possible to mix
  3463. named and numbered input channels
  3464. @end table
  3465. If the `=' in a channel specification is replaced by `<', then the gains for
  3466. that specification will be renormalized so that the total is 1, thus
  3467. avoiding clipping noise.
  3468. @subsection Mixing examples
  3469. For example, if you want to down-mix from stereo to mono, but with a bigger
  3470. factor for the left channel:
  3471. @example
  3472. pan=1c|c0=0.9*c0+0.1*c1
  3473. @end example
  3474. A customized down-mix to stereo that works automatically for 3-, 4-, 5- and
  3475. 7-channels surround:
  3476. @example
  3477. pan=stereo| FL < FL + 0.5*FC + 0.6*BL + 0.6*SL | FR < FR + 0.5*FC + 0.6*BR + 0.6*SR
  3478. @end example
  3479. Note that @command{ffmpeg} integrates a default down-mix (and up-mix) system
  3480. that should be preferred (see "-ac" option) unless you have very specific
  3481. needs.
  3482. @subsection Remapping examples
  3483. The channel remapping will be effective if, and only if:
  3484. @itemize
  3485. @item gain coefficients are zeroes or ones,
  3486. @item only one input per channel output,
  3487. @end itemize
  3488. If all these conditions are satisfied, the filter will notify the user ("Pure
  3489. channel mapping detected"), and use an optimized and lossless method to do the
  3490. remapping.
  3491. For example, if you have a 5.1 source and want a stereo audio stream by
  3492. dropping the extra channels:
  3493. @example
  3494. pan="stereo| c0=FL | c1=FR"
  3495. @end example
  3496. Given the same source, you can also switch front left and front right channels
  3497. and keep the input channel layout:
  3498. @example
  3499. pan="5.1| c0=c1 | c1=c0 | c2=c2 | c3=c3 | c4=c4 | c5=c5"
  3500. @end example
  3501. If the input is a stereo audio stream, you can mute the front left channel (and
  3502. still keep the stereo channel layout) with:
  3503. @example
  3504. pan="stereo|c1=c1"
  3505. @end example
  3506. Still with a stereo audio stream input, you can copy the right channel in both
  3507. front left and right:
  3508. @example
  3509. pan="stereo| c0=FR | c1=FR"
  3510. @end example
  3511. @section replaygain
  3512. ReplayGain scanner filter. This filter takes an audio stream as an input and
  3513. outputs it unchanged.
  3514. At end of filtering it displays @code{track_gain} and @code{track_peak}.
  3515. @section resample
  3516. Convert the audio sample format, sample rate and channel layout. It is
  3517. not meant to be used directly.
  3518. @section rubberband
  3519. Apply time-stretching and pitch-shifting with librubberband.
  3520. To enable compilation of this filter, you need to configure FFmpeg with
  3521. @code{--enable-librubberband}.
  3522. The filter accepts the following options:
  3523. @table @option
  3524. @item tempo
  3525. Set tempo scale factor.
  3526. @item pitch
  3527. Set pitch scale factor.
  3528. @item transients
  3529. Set transients detector.
  3530. Possible values are:
  3531. @table @var
  3532. @item crisp
  3533. @item mixed
  3534. @item smooth
  3535. @end table
  3536. @item detector
  3537. Set detector.
  3538. Possible values are:
  3539. @table @var
  3540. @item compound
  3541. @item percussive
  3542. @item soft
  3543. @end table
  3544. @item phase
  3545. Set phase.
  3546. Possible values are:
  3547. @table @var
  3548. @item laminar
  3549. @item independent
  3550. @end table
  3551. @item window
  3552. Set processing window size.
  3553. Possible values are:
  3554. @table @var
  3555. @item standard
  3556. @item short
  3557. @item long
  3558. @end table
  3559. @item smoothing
  3560. Set smoothing.
  3561. Possible values are:
  3562. @table @var
  3563. @item off
  3564. @item on
  3565. @end table
  3566. @item formant
  3567. Enable formant preservation when shift pitching.
  3568. Possible values are:
  3569. @table @var
  3570. @item shifted
  3571. @item preserved
  3572. @end table
  3573. @item pitchq
  3574. Set pitch quality.
  3575. Possible values are:
  3576. @table @var
  3577. @item quality
  3578. @item speed
  3579. @item consistency
  3580. @end table
  3581. @item channels
  3582. Set channels.
  3583. Possible values are:
  3584. @table @var
  3585. @item apart
  3586. @item together
  3587. @end table
  3588. @end table
  3589. @subsection Commands
  3590. This filter supports the following commands:
  3591. @table @option
  3592. @item tempo
  3593. Change filter tempo scale factor.
  3594. Syntax for the command is : "@var{tempo}"
  3595. @item pitch
  3596. Change filter pitch scale factor.
  3597. Syntax for the command is : "@var{pitch}"
  3598. @end table
  3599. @section sidechaincompress
  3600. This filter acts like normal compressor but has the ability to compress
  3601. detected signal using second input signal.
  3602. It needs two input streams and returns one output stream.
  3603. First input stream will be processed depending on second stream signal.
  3604. The filtered signal then can be filtered with other filters in later stages of
  3605. processing. See @ref{pan} and @ref{amerge} filter.
  3606. The filter accepts the following options:
  3607. @table @option
  3608. @item level_in
  3609. Set input gain. Default is 1. Range is between 0.015625 and 64.
  3610. @item mode
  3611. Set mode of compressor operation. Can be @code{upward} or @code{downward}.
  3612. Default is @code{downward}.
  3613. @item threshold
  3614. If a signal of second stream raises above this level it will affect the gain
  3615. reduction of first stream.
  3616. By default is 0.125. Range is between 0.00097563 and 1.
  3617. @item ratio
  3618. Set a ratio about which the signal is reduced. 1:2 means that if the level
  3619. raised 4dB above the threshold, it will be only 2dB above after the reduction.
  3620. Default is 2. Range is between 1 and 20.
  3621. @item attack
  3622. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain
  3623. reduction starts. Default is 20. Range is between 0.01 and 2000.
  3624. @item release
  3625. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before
  3626. reduction is decreased again. Default is 250. Range is between 0.01 and 9000.
  3627. @item makeup
  3628. Set the amount by how much signal will be amplified after processing.
  3629. Default is 1. Range is from 1 to 64.
  3630. @item knee
  3631. Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.
  3632. Default is 2.82843. Range is between 1 and 8.
  3633. @item link
  3634. Choose if the @code{average} level between all channels of side-chain stream
  3635. or the louder(@code{maximum}) channel of side-chain stream affects the
  3636. reduction. Default is @code{average}.
  3637. @item detection
  3638. Should the exact signal be taken in case of @code{peak} or an RMS one in case
  3639. of @code{rms}. Default is @code{rms} which is mainly smoother.
  3640. @item level_sc
  3641. Set sidechain gain. Default is 1. Range is between 0.015625 and 64.
  3642. @item mix
  3643. How much to use compressed signal in output. Default is 1.
  3644. Range is between 0 and 1.
  3645. @end table
  3646. @subsection Commands
  3647. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  3648. @subsection Examples
  3649. @itemize
  3650. @item
  3651. Full ffmpeg example taking 2 audio inputs, 1st input to be compressed
  3652. depending on the signal of 2nd input and later compressed signal to be
  3653. merged with 2nd input:
  3654. @example
  3655. ffmpeg -i main.flac -i sidechain.flac -filter_complex "[1:a]asplit=2[sc][mix];[0:a][sc]sidechaincompress[compr];[compr][mix]amerge"
  3656. @end example
  3657. @end itemize
  3658. @section sidechaingate
  3659. A sidechain gate acts like a normal (wideband) gate but has the ability to
  3660. filter the detected signal before sending it to the gain reduction stage.
  3661. Normally a gate uses the full range signal to detect a level above the
  3662. threshold.
  3663. For example: If you cut all lower frequencies from your sidechain signal
  3664. the gate will decrease the volume of your track only if not enough highs
  3665. appear. With this technique you are able to reduce the resonation of a
  3666. natural drum or remove "rumbling" of muted strokes from a heavily distorted
  3667. guitar.
  3668. It needs two input streams and returns one output stream.
  3669. First input stream will be processed depending on second stream signal.
  3670. The filter accepts the following options:
  3671. @table @option
  3672. @item level_in
  3673. Set input level before filtering.
  3674. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  3675. @item mode
  3676. Set the mode of operation. Can be @code{upward} or @code{downward}.
  3677. Default is @code{downward}. If set to @code{upward} mode, higher parts of signal
  3678. will be amplified, expanding dynamic range in upward direction.
  3679. Otherwise, in case of @code{downward} lower parts of signal will be reduced.
  3680. @item range
  3681. Set the level of gain reduction when the signal is below the threshold.
  3682. Default is 0.06125. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  3683. Setting this to 0 disables reduction and then filter behaves like expander.
  3684. @item threshold
  3685. If a signal rises above this level the gain reduction is released.
  3686. Default is 0.125. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  3687. @item ratio
  3688. Set a ratio about which the signal is reduced.
  3689. Default is 2. Allowed range is from 1 to 9000.
  3690. @item attack
  3691. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain
  3692. reduction stops.
  3693. Default is 20 milliseconds. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.
  3694. @item release
  3695. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before the
  3696. reduction is increased again. Default is 250 milliseconds.
  3697. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.
  3698. @item makeup
  3699. Set amount of amplification of signal after processing.
  3700. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 1 to 64.
  3701. @item knee
  3702. Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.
  3703. Default is 2.828427125. Allowed range is from 1 to 8.
  3704. @item detection
  3705. Choose if exact signal should be taken for detection or an RMS like one.
  3706. Default is rms. Can be peak or rms.
  3707. @item link
  3708. Choose if the average level between all channels or the louder channel affects
  3709. the reduction.
  3710. Default is average. Can be average or maximum.
  3711. @item level_sc
  3712. Set sidechain gain. Default is 1. Range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  3713. @end table
  3714. @section silencedetect
  3715. Detect silence in an audio stream.
  3716. This filter logs a message when it detects that the input audio volume is less
  3717. or equal to a noise tolerance value for a duration greater or equal to the
  3718. minimum detected noise duration.
  3719. The printed times and duration are expressed in seconds. The
  3720. @code{lavfi.silence_start} or @code{lavfi.silence_start.X} metadata key
  3721. is set on the first frame whose timestamp equals or exceeds the detection
  3722. duration and it contains the timestamp of the first frame of the silence.
  3723. The @code{lavfi.silence_duration} or @code{lavfi.silence_duration.X}
  3724. and @code{lavfi.silence_end} or @code{lavfi.silence_end.X} metadata
  3725. keys are set on the first frame after the silence. If @option{mono} is
  3726. enabled, and each channel is evaluated separately, the @code{.X}
  3727. suffixed keys are used, and @code{X} corresponds to the channel number.
  3728. The filter accepts the following options:
  3729. @table @option
  3730. @item noise, n
  3731. Set noise tolerance. Can be specified in dB (in case "dB" is appended to the
  3732. specified value) or amplitude ratio. Default is -60dB, or 0.001.
  3733. @item duration, d
  3734. Set silence duration until notification (default is 2 seconds). See
  3735. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  3736. for the accepted syntax.
  3737. @item mono, m
  3738. Process each channel separately, instead of combined. By default is disabled.
  3739. @end table
  3740. @subsection Examples
  3741. @itemize
  3742. @item
  3743. Detect 5 seconds of silence with -50dB noise tolerance:
  3744. @example
  3745. silencedetect=n=-50dB:d=5
  3746. @end example
  3747. @item
  3748. Complete example with @command{ffmpeg} to detect silence with 0.0001 noise
  3749. tolerance in @file{silence.mp3}:
  3750. @example
  3751. ffmpeg -i silence.mp3 -af silencedetect=noise=0.0001 -f null -
  3752. @end example
  3753. @end itemize
  3754. @section silenceremove
  3755. Remove silence from the beginning, middle or end of the audio.
  3756. The filter accepts the following options:
  3757. @table @option
  3758. @item start_periods
  3759. This value is used to indicate if audio should be trimmed at beginning of
  3760. the audio. A value of zero indicates no silence should be trimmed from the
  3761. beginning. When specifying a non-zero value, it trims audio up until it
  3762. finds non-silence. Normally, when trimming silence from beginning of audio
  3763. the @var{start_periods} will be @code{1} but it can be increased to higher
  3764. values to trim all audio up to specific count of non-silence periods.
  3765. Default value is @code{0}.
  3766. @item start_duration
  3767. Specify the amount of time that non-silence must be detected before it stops
  3768. trimming audio. By increasing the duration, bursts of noises can be treated
  3769. as silence and trimmed off. Default value is @code{0}.
  3770. @item start_threshold
  3771. This indicates what sample value should be treated as silence. For digital
  3772. audio, a value of @code{0} may be fine but for audio recorded from analog,
  3773. you may wish to increase the value to account for background noise.
  3774. Can be specified in dB (in case "dB" is appended to the specified value)
  3775. or amplitude ratio. Default value is @code{0}.
  3776. @item start_silence
  3777. Specify max duration of silence at beginning that will be kept after
  3778. trimming. Default is 0, which is equal to trimming all samples detected
  3779. as silence.
  3780. @item start_mode
  3781. Specify mode of detection of silence end in start of multi-channel audio.
  3782. Can be @var{any} or @var{all}. Default is @var{any}.
  3783. With @var{any}, any sample that is detected as non-silence will cause
  3784. stopped trimming of silence.
  3785. With @var{all}, only if all channels are detected as non-silence will cause
  3786. stopped trimming of silence.
  3787. @item stop_periods
  3788. Set the count for trimming silence from the end of audio.
  3789. To remove silence from the middle of a file, specify a @var{stop_periods}
  3790. that is negative. This value is then treated as a positive value and is
  3791. used to indicate the effect should restart processing as specified by
  3792. @var{start_periods}, making it suitable for removing periods of silence
  3793. in the middle of the audio.
  3794. Default value is @code{0}.
  3795. @item stop_duration
  3796. Specify a duration of silence that must exist before audio is not copied any
  3797. more. By specifying a higher duration, silence that is wanted can be left in
  3798. the audio.
  3799. Default value is @code{0}.
  3800. @item stop_threshold
  3801. This is the same as @option{start_threshold} but for trimming silence from
  3802. the end of audio.
  3803. Can be specified in dB (in case "dB" is appended to the specified value)
  3804. or amplitude ratio. Default value is @code{0}.
  3805. @item stop_silence
  3806. Specify max duration of silence at end that will be kept after
  3807. trimming. Default is 0, which is equal to trimming all samples detected
  3808. as silence.
  3809. @item stop_mode
  3810. Specify mode of detection of silence start in end of multi-channel audio.
  3811. Can be @var{any} or @var{all}. Default is @var{any}.
  3812. With @var{any}, any sample that is detected as non-silence will cause
  3813. stopped trimming of silence.
  3814. With @var{all}, only if all channels are detected as non-silence will cause
  3815. stopped trimming of silence.
  3816. @item detection
  3817. Set how is silence detected. Can be @code{rms} or @code{peak}. Second is faster
  3818. and works better with digital silence which is exactly 0.
  3819. Default value is @code{rms}.
  3820. @item window
  3821. Set duration in number of seconds used to calculate size of window in number
  3822. of samples for detecting silence.
  3823. Default value is @code{0.02}. Allowed range is from @code{0} to @code{10}.
  3824. @end table
  3825. @subsection Examples
  3826. @itemize
  3827. @item
  3828. The following example shows how this filter can be used to start a recording
  3829. that does not contain the delay at the start which usually occurs between
  3830. pressing the record button and the start of the performance:
  3831. @example
  3832. silenceremove=start_periods=1:start_duration=5:start_threshold=0.02
  3833. @end example
  3834. @item
  3835. Trim all silence encountered from beginning to end where there is more than 1
  3836. second of silence in audio:
  3837. @example
  3838. silenceremove=stop_periods=-1:stop_duration=1:stop_threshold=-90dB
  3839. @end example
  3840. @item
  3841. Trim all digital silence samples, using peak detection, from beginning to end
  3842. where there is more than 0 samples of digital silence in audio and digital
  3843. silence is detected in all channels at same positions in stream:
  3844. @example
  3845. silenceremove=window=0:detection=peak:stop_mode=all:start_mode=all:stop_periods=-1:stop_threshold=0
  3846. @end example
  3847. @end itemize
  3848. @section sofalizer
  3849. SOFAlizer uses head-related transfer functions (HRTFs) to create virtual
  3850. loudspeakers around the user for binaural listening via headphones (audio
  3851. formats up to 9 channels supported).
  3852. The HRTFs are stored in SOFA files (see @url{http://www.sofacoustics.org/} for a database).
  3853. SOFAlizer is developed at the Acoustics Research Institute (ARI) of the
  3854. Austrian Academy of Sciences.
  3855. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  3856. @code{--enable-libmysofa}.
  3857. The filter accepts the following options:
  3858. @table @option
  3859. @item sofa
  3860. Set the SOFA file used for rendering.
  3861. @item gain
  3862. Set gain applied to audio. Value is in dB. Default is 0.
  3863. @item rotation
  3864. Set rotation of virtual loudspeakers in deg. Default is 0.
  3865. @item elevation
  3866. Set elevation of virtual speakers in deg. Default is 0.
  3867. @item radius
  3868. Set distance in meters between loudspeakers and the listener with near-field
  3869. HRTFs. Default is 1.
  3870. @item type
  3871. Set processing type. Can be @var{time} or @var{freq}. @var{time} is
  3872. processing audio in time domain which is slow.
  3873. @var{freq} is processing audio in frequency domain which is fast.
  3874. Default is @var{freq}.
  3875. @item speakers
  3876. Set custom positions of virtual loudspeakers. Syntax for this option is:
  3877. <CH> <AZIM> <ELEV>[|<CH> <AZIM> <ELEV>|...].
  3878. Each virtual loudspeaker is described with short channel name following with
  3879. azimuth and elevation in degrees.
  3880. Each virtual loudspeaker description is separated by '|'.
  3881. For example to override front left and front right channel positions use:
  3882. 'speakers=FL 45 15|FR 345 15'.
  3883. Descriptions with unrecognised channel names are ignored.
  3884. @item lfegain
  3885. Set custom gain for LFE channels. Value is in dB. Default is 0.
  3886. @item framesize
  3887. Set custom frame size in number of samples. Default is 1024.
  3888. Allowed range is from 1024 to 96000. Only used if option @samp{type}
  3889. is set to @var{freq}.
  3890. @item normalize
  3891. Should all IRs be normalized upon importing SOFA file.
  3892. By default is enabled.
  3893. @item interpolate
  3894. Should nearest IRs be interpolated with neighbor IRs if exact position
  3895. does not match. By default is disabled.
  3896. @item minphase
  3897. Minphase all IRs upon loading of SOFA file. By default is disabled.
  3898. @item anglestep
  3899. Set neighbor search angle step. Only used if option @var{interpolate} is enabled.
  3900. @item radstep
  3901. Set neighbor search radius step. Only used if option @var{interpolate} is enabled.
  3902. @end table
  3903. @subsection Examples
  3904. @itemize
  3905. @item
  3906. Using ClubFritz6 sofa file:
  3907. @example
  3908. sofalizer=sofa=/path/to/ClubFritz6.sofa:type=freq:radius=1
  3909. @end example
  3910. @item
  3911. Using ClubFritz12 sofa file and bigger radius with small rotation:
  3912. @example
  3913. sofalizer=sofa=/path/to/ClubFritz12.sofa:type=freq:radius=2:rotation=5
  3914. @end example
  3915. @item
  3916. Similar as above but with custom speaker positions for front left, front right, back left and back right
  3917. and also with custom gain:
  3918. @example
  3919. "sofalizer=sofa=/path/to/ClubFritz6.sofa:type=freq:radius=2:speakers=FL 45|FR 315|BL 135|BR 225:gain=28"
  3920. @end example
  3921. @end itemize
  3922. @section stereotools
  3923. This filter has some handy utilities to manage stereo signals, for converting
  3924. M/S stereo recordings to L/R signal while having control over the parameters
  3925. or spreading the stereo image of master track.
  3926. The filter accepts the following options:
  3927. @table @option
  3928. @item level_in
  3929. Set input level before filtering for both channels. Defaults is 1.
  3930. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  3931. @item level_out
  3932. Set output level after filtering for both channels. Defaults is 1.
  3933. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  3934. @item balance_in
  3935. Set input balance between both channels. Default is 0.
  3936. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  3937. @item balance_out
  3938. Set output balance between both channels. Default is 0.
  3939. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  3940. @item softclip
  3941. Enable softclipping. Results in analog distortion instead of harsh digital 0dB
  3942. clipping. Disabled by default.
  3943. @item mutel
  3944. Mute the left channel. Disabled by default.
  3945. @item muter
  3946. Mute the right channel. Disabled by default.
  3947. @item phasel
  3948. Change the phase of the left channel. Disabled by default.
  3949. @item phaser
  3950. Change the phase of the right channel. Disabled by default.
  3951. @item mode
  3952. Set stereo mode. Available values are:
  3953. @table @samp
  3954. @item lr>lr
  3955. Left/Right to Left/Right, this is default.
  3956. @item lr>ms
  3957. Left/Right to Mid/Side.
  3958. @item ms>lr
  3959. Mid/Side to Left/Right.
  3960. @item lr>ll
  3961. Left/Right to Left/Left.
  3962. @item lr>rr
  3963. Left/Right to Right/Right.
  3964. @item lr>l+r
  3965. Left/Right to Left + Right.
  3966. @item lr>rl
  3967. Left/Right to Right/Left.
  3968. @item ms>ll
  3969. Mid/Side to Left/Left.
  3970. @item ms>rr
  3971. Mid/Side to Right/Right.
  3972. @end table
  3973. @item slev
  3974. Set level of side signal. Default is 1.
  3975. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  3976. @item sbal
  3977. Set balance of side signal. Default is 0.
  3978. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  3979. @item mlev
  3980. Set level of the middle signal. Default is 1.
  3981. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  3982. @item mpan
  3983. Set middle signal pan. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  3984. @item base
  3985. Set stereo base between mono and inversed channels. Default is 0.
  3986. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  3987. @item delay
  3988. Set delay in milliseconds how much to delay left from right channel and
  3989. vice versa. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -20 to 20.
  3990. @item sclevel
  3991. Set S/C level. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 1 to 100.
  3992. @item phase
  3993. Set the stereo phase in degrees. Default is 0. Allowed range is from 0 to 360.
  3994. @item bmode_in, bmode_out
  3995. Set balance mode for balance_in/balance_out option.
  3996. Can be one of the following:
  3997. @table @samp
  3998. @item balance
  3999. Classic balance mode. Attenuate one channel at time.
  4000. Gain is raised up to 1.
  4001. @item amplitude
  4002. Similar as classic mode above but gain is raised up to 2.
  4003. @item power
  4004. Equal power distribution, from -6dB to +6dB range.
  4005. @end table
  4006. @end table
  4007. @subsection Examples
  4008. @itemize
  4009. @item
  4010. Apply karaoke like effect:
  4011. @example
  4012. stereotools=mlev=0.015625
  4013. @end example
  4014. @item
  4015. Convert M/S signal to L/R:
  4016. @example
  4017. "stereotools=mode=ms>lr"
  4018. @end example
  4019. @end itemize
  4020. @section stereowiden
  4021. This filter enhance the stereo effect by suppressing signal common to both
  4022. channels and by delaying the signal of left into right and vice versa,
  4023. thereby widening the stereo effect.
  4024. The filter accepts the following options:
  4025. @table @option
  4026. @item delay
  4027. Time in milliseconds of the delay of left signal into right and vice versa.
  4028. Default is 20 milliseconds.
  4029. @item feedback
  4030. Amount of gain in delayed signal into right and vice versa. Gives a delay
  4031. effect of left signal in right output and vice versa which gives widening
  4032. effect. Default is 0.3.
  4033. @item crossfeed
  4034. Cross feed of left into right with inverted phase. This helps in suppressing
  4035. the mono. If the value is 1 it will cancel all the signal common to both
  4036. channels. Default is 0.3.
  4037. @item drymix
  4038. Set level of input signal of original channel. Default is 0.8.
  4039. @end table
  4040. @subsection Commands
  4041. This filter supports the all above options except @code{delay} as @ref{commands}.
  4042. @section superequalizer
  4043. Apply 18 band equalizer.
  4044. The filter accepts the following options:
  4045. @table @option
  4046. @item 1b
  4047. Set 65Hz band gain.
  4048. @item 2b
  4049. Set 92Hz band gain.
  4050. @item 3b
  4051. Set 131Hz band gain.
  4052. @item 4b
  4053. Set 185Hz band gain.
  4054. @item 5b
  4055. Set 262Hz band gain.
  4056. @item 6b
  4057. Set 370Hz band gain.
  4058. @item 7b
  4059. Set 523Hz band gain.
  4060. @item 8b
  4061. Set 740Hz band gain.
  4062. @item 9b
  4063. Set 1047Hz band gain.
  4064. @item 10b
  4065. Set 1480Hz band gain.
  4066. @item 11b
  4067. Set 2093Hz band gain.
  4068. @item 12b
  4069. Set 2960Hz band gain.
  4070. @item 13b
  4071. Set 4186Hz band gain.
  4072. @item 14b
  4073. Set 5920Hz band gain.
  4074. @item 15b
  4075. Set 8372Hz band gain.
  4076. @item 16b
  4077. Set 11840Hz band gain.
  4078. @item 17b
  4079. Set 16744Hz band gain.
  4080. @item 18b
  4081. Set 20000Hz band gain.
  4082. @end table
  4083. @section surround
  4084. Apply audio surround upmix filter.
  4085. This filter allows to produce multichannel output from audio stream.
  4086. The filter accepts the following options:
  4087. @table @option
  4088. @item chl_out
  4089. Set output channel layout. By default, this is @var{5.1}.
  4090. See @ref{channel layout syntax,,the Channel Layout section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  4091. for the required syntax.
  4092. @item chl_in
  4093. Set input channel layout. By default, this is @var{stereo}.
  4094. See @ref{channel layout syntax,,the Channel Layout section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  4095. for the required syntax.
  4096. @item level_in
  4097. Set input volume level. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4098. @item level_out
  4099. Set output volume level. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4100. @item lfe
  4101. Enable LFE channel output if output channel layout has it. By default, this is enabled.
  4102. @item lfe_low
  4103. Set LFE low cut off frequency. By default, this is @var{128} Hz.
  4104. @item lfe_high
  4105. Set LFE high cut off frequency. By default, this is @var{256} Hz.
  4106. @item lfe_mode
  4107. Set LFE mode, can be @var{add} or @var{sub}. Default is @var{add}.
  4108. In @var{add} mode, LFE channel is created from input audio and added to output.
  4109. In @var{sub} mode, LFE channel is created from input audio and added to output but
  4110. also all non-LFE output channels are subtracted with output LFE channel.
  4111. @item angle
  4112. Set angle of stereo surround transform, Allowed range is from @var{0} to @var{360}.
  4113. Default is @var{90}.
  4114. @item fc_in
  4115. Set front center input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4116. @item fc_out
  4117. Set front center output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4118. @item fl_in
  4119. Set front left input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4120. @item fl_out
  4121. Set front left output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4122. @item fr_in
  4123. Set front right input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4124. @item fr_out
  4125. Set front right output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4126. @item sl_in
  4127. Set side left input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4128. @item sl_out
  4129. Set side left output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4130. @item sr_in
  4131. Set side right input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4132. @item sr_out
  4133. Set side right output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4134. @item bl_in
  4135. Set back left input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4136. @item bl_out
  4137. Set back left output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4138. @item br_in
  4139. Set back right input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4140. @item br_out
  4141. Set back right output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4142. @item bc_in
  4143. Set back center input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4144. @item bc_out
  4145. Set back center output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4146. @item lfe_in
  4147. Set LFE input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4148. @item lfe_out
  4149. Set LFE output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4150. @item allx
  4151. Set spread usage of stereo image across X axis for all channels.
  4152. @item ally
  4153. Set spread usage of stereo image across Y axis for all channels.
  4154. @item fcx, flx, frx, blx, brx, slx, srx, bcx
  4155. Set spread usage of stereo image across X axis for each channel.
  4156. @item fcy, fly, fry, bly, bry, sly, sry, bcy
  4157. Set spread usage of stereo image across Y axis for each channel.
  4158. @item win_size
  4159. Set window size. Allowed range is from @var{1024} to @var{65536}. Default size is @var{4096}.
  4160. @item win_func
  4161. Set window function.
  4162. It accepts the following values:
  4163. @table @samp
  4164. @item rect
  4165. @item bartlett
  4166. @item hann, hanning
  4167. @item hamming
  4168. @item blackman
  4169. @item welch
  4170. @item flattop
  4171. @item bharris
  4172. @item bnuttall
  4173. @item bhann
  4174. @item sine
  4175. @item nuttall
  4176. @item lanczos
  4177. @item gauss
  4178. @item tukey
  4179. @item dolph
  4180. @item cauchy
  4181. @item parzen
  4182. @item poisson
  4183. @item bohman
  4184. @end table
  4185. Default is @code{hann}.
  4186. @item overlap
  4187. Set window overlap. If set to 1, the recommended overlap for selected
  4188. window function will be picked. Default is @code{0.5}.
  4189. @end table
  4190. @section treble, highshelf
  4191. Boost or cut treble (upper) frequencies of the audio using a two-pole
  4192. shelving filter with a response similar to that of a standard
  4193. hi-fi's tone-controls. This is also known as shelving equalisation (EQ).
  4194. The filter accepts the following options:
  4195. @table @option
  4196. @item gain, g
  4197. Give the gain at whichever is the lower of ~22 kHz and the
  4198. Nyquist frequency. Its useful range is about -20 (for a large cut)
  4199. to +20 (for a large boost). Beware of clipping when using a positive gain.
  4200. @item frequency, f
  4201. Set the filter's central frequency and so can be used
  4202. to extend or reduce the frequency range to be boosted or cut.
  4203. The default value is @code{3000} Hz.
  4204. @item width_type, t
  4205. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  4206. @table @option
  4207. @item h
  4208. Hz
  4209. @item q
  4210. Q-Factor
  4211. @item o
  4212. octave
  4213. @item s
  4214. slope
  4215. @item k
  4216. kHz
  4217. @end table
  4218. @item width, w
  4219. Determine how steep is the filter's shelf transition.
  4220. @item mix, m
  4221. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  4222. Range is between 0 and 1.
  4223. @item channels, c
  4224. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  4225. @item normalize, n
  4226. Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.
  4227. Enabling it will normalize magnitude response at DC to 0dB.
  4228. @end table
  4229. @subsection Commands
  4230. This filter supports the following commands:
  4231. @table @option
  4232. @item frequency, f
  4233. Change treble frequency.
  4234. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  4235. @item width_type, t
  4236. Change treble width_type.
  4237. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  4238. @item width, w
  4239. Change treble width.
  4240. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  4241. @item gain, g
  4242. Change treble gain.
  4243. Syntax for the command is : "@var{gain}"
  4244. @item mix, m
  4245. Change treble mix.
  4246. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  4247. @end table
  4248. @section tremolo
  4249. Sinusoidal amplitude modulation.
  4250. The filter accepts the following options:
  4251. @table @option
  4252. @item f
  4253. Modulation frequency in Hertz. Modulation frequencies in the subharmonic range
  4254. (20 Hz or lower) will result in a tremolo effect.
  4255. This filter may also be used as a ring modulator by specifying
  4256. a modulation frequency higher than 20 Hz.
  4257. Range is 0.1 - 20000.0. Default value is 5.0 Hz.
  4258. @item d
  4259. Depth of modulation as a percentage. Range is 0.0 - 1.0.
  4260. Default value is 0.5.
  4261. @end table
  4262. @section vibrato
  4263. Sinusoidal phase modulation.
  4264. The filter accepts the following options:
  4265. @table @option
  4266. @item f
  4267. Modulation frequency in Hertz.
  4268. Range is 0.1 - 20000.0. Default value is 5.0 Hz.
  4269. @item d
  4270. Depth of modulation as a percentage. Range is 0.0 - 1.0.
  4271. Default value is 0.5.
  4272. @end table
  4273. @section volume
  4274. Adjust the input audio volume.
  4275. It accepts the following parameters:
  4276. @table @option
  4277. @item volume
  4278. Set audio volume expression.
  4279. Output values are clipped to the maximum value.
  4280. The output audio volume is given by the relation:
  4281. @example
  4282. @var{output_volume} = @var{volume} * @var{input_volume}
  4283. @end example
  4284. The default value for @var{volume} is "1.0".
  4285. @item precision
  4286. This parameter represents the mathematical precision.
  4287. It determines which input sample formats will be allowed, which affects the
  4288. precision of the volume scaling.
  4289. @table @option
  4290. @item fixed
  4291. 8-bit fixed-point; this limits input sample format to U8, S16, and S32.
  4292. @item float
  4293. 32-bit floating-point; this limits input sample format to FLT. (default)
  4294. @item double
  4295. 64-bit floating-point; this limits input sample format to DBL.
  4296. @end table
  4297. @item replaygain
  4298. Choose the behaviour on encountering ReplayGain side data in input frames.
  4299. @table @option
  4300. @item drop
  4301. Remove ReplayGain side data, ignoring its contents (the default).
  4302. @item ignore
  4303. Ignore ReplayGain side data, but leave it in the frame.
  4304. @item track
  4305. Prefer the track gain, if present.
  4306. @item album
  4307. Prefer the album gain, if present.
  4308. @end table
  4309. @item replaygain_preamp
  4310. Pre-amplification gain in dB to apply to the selected replaygain gain.
  4311. Default value for @var{replaygain_preamp} is 0.0.
  4312. @item replaygain_noclip
  4313. Prevent clipping by limiting the gain applied.
  4314. Default value for @var{replaygain_noclip} is 1.
  4315. @item eval
  4316. Set when the volume expression is evaluated.
  4317. It accepts the following values:
  4318. @table @samp
  4319. @item once
  4320. only evaluate expression once during the filter initialization, or
  4321. when the @samp{volume} command is sent
  4322. @item frame
  4323. evaluate expression for each incoming frame
  4324. @end table
  4325. Default value is @samp{once}.
  4326. @end table
  4327. The volume expression can contain the following parameters.
  4328. @table @option
  4329. @item n
  4330. frame number (starting at zero)
  4331. @item nb_channels
  4332. number of channels
  4333. @item nb_consumed_samples
  4334. number of samples consumed by the filter
  4335. @item nb_samples
  4336. number of samples in the current frame
  4337. @item pos
  4338. original frame position in the file
  4339. @item pts
  4340. frame PTS
  4341. @item sample_rate
  4342. sample rate
  4343. @item startpts
  4344. PTS at start of stream
  4345. @item startt
  4346. time at start of stream
  4347. @item t
  4348. frame time
  4349. @item tb
  4350. timestamp timebase
  4351. @item volume
  4352. last set volume value
  4353. @end table
  4354. Note that when @option{eval} is set to @samp{once} only the
  4355. @var{sample_rate} and @var{tb} variables are available, all other
  4356. variables will evaluate to NAN.
  4357. @subsection Commands
  4358. This filter supports the following commands:
  4359. @table @option
  4360. @item volume
  4361. Modify the volume expression.
  4362. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  4363. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  4364. value.
  4365. @end table
  4366. @subsection Examples
  4367. @itemize
  4368. @item
  4369. Halve the input audio volume:
  4370. @example
  4371. volume=volume=0.5
  4372. volume=volume=1/2
  4373. volume=volume=-6.0206dB
  4374. @end example
  4375. In all the above example the named key for @option{volume} can be
  4376. omitted, for example like in:
  4377. @example
  4378. volume=0.5
  4379. @end example
  4380. @item
  4381. Increase input audio power by 6 decibels using fixed-point precision:
  4382. @example
  4383. volume=volume=6dB:precision=fixed
  4384. @end example
  4385. @item
  4386. Fade volume after time 10 with an annihilation period of 5 seconds:
  4387. @example
  4388. volume='if(lt(t,10),1,max(1-(t-10)/5,0))':eval=frame
  4389. @end example
  4390. @end itemize
  4391. @section volumedetect
  4392. Detect the volume of the input video.
  4393. The filter has no parameters. The input is not modified. Statistics about
  4394. the volume will be printed in the log when the input stream end is reached.
  4395. In particular it will show the mean volume (root mean square), maximum
  4396. volume (on a per-sample basis), and the beginning of a histogram of the
  4397. registered volume values (from the maximum value to a cumulated 1/1000 of
  4398. the samples).
  4399. All volumes are in decibels relative to the maximum PCM value.
  4400. @subsection Examples
  4401. Here is an excerpt of the output:
  4402. @example
  4403. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] mean_volume: -27 dB
  4404. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] max_volume: -4 dB
  4405. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_4db: 6
  4406. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_5db: 62
  4407. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_6db: 286
  4408. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_7db: 1042
  4409. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_8db: 2551
  4410. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_9db: 4609
  4411. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_10db: 8409
  4412. @end example
  4413. It means that:
  4414. @itemize
  4415. @item
  4416. The mean square energy is approximately -27 dB, or 10^-2.7.
  4417. @item
  4418. The largest sample is at -4 dB, or more precisely between -4 dB and -5 dB.
  4419. @item
  4420. There are 6 samples at -4 dB, 62 at -5 dB, 286 at -6 dB, etc.
  4421. @end itemize
  4422. In other words, raising the volume by +4 dB does not cause any clipping,
  4423. raising it by +5 dB causes clipping for 6 samples, etc.
  4424. @c man end AUDIO FILTERS
  4425. @chapter Audio Sources
  4426. @c man begin AUDIO SOURCES
  4427. Below is a description of the currently available audio sources.
  4428. @section abuffer
  4429. Buffer audio frames, and make them available to the filter chain.
  4430. This source is mainly intended for a programmatic use, in particular
  4431. through the interface defined in @file{libavfilter/asrc_abuffer.h}.
  4432. It accepts the following parameters:
  4433. @table @option
  4434. @item time_base
  4435. The timebase which will be used for timestamps of submitted frames. It must be
  4436. either a floating-point number or in @var{numerator}/@var{denominator} form.
  4437. @item sample_rate
  4438. The sample rate of the incoming audio buffers.
  4439. @item sample_fmt
  4440. The sample format of the incoming audio buffers.
  4441. Either a sample format name or its corresponding integer representation from
  4442. the enum AVSampleFormat in @file{libavutil/samplefmt.h}
  4443. @item channel_layout
  4444. The channel layout of the incoming audio buffers.
  4445. Either a channel layout name from channel_layout_map in
  4446. @file{libavutil/channel_layout.c} or its corresponding integer representation
  4447. from the AV_CH_LAYOUT_* macros in @file{libavutil/channel_layout.h}
  4448. @item channels
  4449. The number of channels of the incoming audio buffers.
  4450. If both @var{channels} and @var{channel_layout} are specified, then they
  4451. must be consistent.
  4452. @end table
  4453. @subsection Examples
  4454. @example
  4455. abuffer=sample_rate=44100:sample_fmt=s16p:channel_layout=stereo
  4456. @end example
  4457. will instruct the source to accept planar 16bit signed stereo at 44100Hz.
  4458. Since the sample format with name "s16p" corresponds to the number
  4459. 6 and the "stereo" channel layout corresponds to the value 0x3, this is
  4460. equivalent to:
  4461. @example
  4462. abuffer=sample_rate=44100:sample_fmt=6:channel_layout=0x3
  4463. @end example
  4464. @section aevalsrc
  4465. Generate an audio signal specified by an expression.
  4466. This source accepts in input one or more expressions (one for each
  4467. channel), which are evaluated and used to generate a corresponding
  4468. audio signal.
  4469. This source accepts the following options:
  4470. @table @option
  4471. @item exprs
  4472. Set the '|'-separated expressions list for each separate channel. In case the
  4473. @option{channel_layout} option is not specified, the selected channel layout
  4474. depends on the number of provided expressions. Otherwise the last
  4475. specified expression is applied to the remaining output channels.
  4476. @item channel_layout, c
  4477. Set the channel layout. The number of channels in the specified layout
  4478. must be equal to the number of specified expressions.
  4479. @item duration, d
  4480. Set the minimum duration of the sourced audio. See
  4481. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  4482. for the accepted syntax.
  4483. Note that the resulting duration may be greater than the specified
  4484. duration, as the generated audio is always cut at the end of a
  4485. complete frame.
  4486. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the audio is
  4487. supposed to be generated forever.
  4488. @item nb_samples, n
  4489. Set the number of samples per channel per each output frame,
  4490. default to 1024.
  4491. @item sample_rate, s
  4492. Specify the sample rate, default to 44100.
  4493. @end table
  4494. Each expression in @var{exprs} can contain the following constants:
  4495. @table @option
  4496. @item n
  4497. number of the evaluated sample, starting from 0
  4498. @item t
  4499. time of the evaluated sample expressed in seconds, starting from 0
  4500. @item s
  4501. sample rate
  4502. @end table
  4503. @subsection Examples
  4504. @itemize
  4505. @item
  4506. Generate silence:
  4507. @example
  4508. aevalsrc=0
  4509. @end example
  4510. @item
  4511. Generate a sin signal with frequency of 440 Hz, set sample rate to
  4512. 8000 Hz:
  4513. @example
  4514. aevalsrc="sin(440*2*PI*t):s=8000"
  4515. @end example
  4516. @item
  4517. Generate a two channels signal, specify the channel layout (Front
  4518. Center + Back Center) explicitly:
  4519. @example
  4520. aevalsrc="sin(420*2*PI*t)|cos(430*2*PI*t):c=FC|BC"
  4521. @end example
  4522. @item
  4523. Generate white noise:
  4524. @example
  4525. aevalsrc="-2+random(0)"
  4526. @end example
  4527. @item
  4528. Generate an amplitude modulated signal:
  4529. @example
  4530. aevalsrc="sin(10*2*PI*t)*sin(880*2*PI*t)"
  4531. @end example
  4532. @item
  4533. Generate 2.5 Hz binaural beats on a 360 Hz carrier:
  4534. @example
  4535. aevalsrc="0.1*sin(2*PI*(360-2.5/2)*t) | 0.1*sin(2*PI*(360+2.5/2)*t)"
  4536. @end example
  4537. @end itemize
  4538. @section anullsrc
  4539. The null audio source, return unprocessed audio frames. It is mainly useful
  4540. as a template and to be employed in analysis / debugging tools, or as
  4541. the source for filters which ignore the input data (for example the sox
  4542. synth filter).
  4543. This source accepts the following options:
  4544. @table @option
  4545. @item channel_layout, cl
  4546. Specifies the channel layout, and can be either an integer or a string
  4547. representing a channel layout. The default value of @var{channel_layout}
  4548. is "stereo".
  4549. Check the channel_layout_map definition in
  4550. @file{libavutil/channel_layout.c} for the mapping between strings and
  4551. channel layout values.
  4552. @item sample_rate, r
  4553. Specifies the sample rate, and defaults to 44100.
  4554. @item nb_samples, n
  4555. Set the number of samples per requested frames.
  4556. @end table
  4557. @subsection Examples
  4558. @itemize
  4559. @item
  4560. Set the sample rate to 48000 Hz and the channel layout to AV_CH_LAYOUT_MONO.
  4561. @example
  4562. anullsrc=r=48000:cl=4
  4563. @end example
  4564. @item
  4565. Do the same operation with a more obvious syntax:
  4566. @example
  4567. anullsrc=r=48000:cl=mono
  4568. @end example
  4569. @end itemize
  4570. All the parameters need to be explicitly defined.
  4571. @section flite
  4572. Synthesize a voice utterance using the libflite library.
  4573. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  4574. @code{--enable-libflite}.
  4575. Note that versions of the flite library prior to 2.0 are not thread-safe.
  4576. The filter accepts the following options:
  4577. @table @option
  4578. @item list_voices
  4579. If set to 1, list the names of the available voices and exit
  4580. immediately. Default value is 0.
  4581. @item nb_samples, n
  4582. Set the maximum number of samples per frame. Default value is 512.
  4583. @item textfile
  4584. Set the filename containing the text to speak.
  4585. @item text
  4586. Set the text to speak.
  4587. @item voice, v
  4588. Set the voice to use for the speech synthesis. Default value is
  4589. @code{kal}. See also the @var{list_voices} option.
  4590. @end table
  4591. @subsection Examples
  4592. @itemize
  4593. @item
  4594. Read from file @file{speech.txt}, and synthesize the text using the
  4595. standard flite voice:
  4596. @example
  4597. flite=textfile=speech.txt
  4598. @end example
  4599. @item
  4600. Read the specified text selecting the @code{slt} voice:
  4601. @example
  4602. flite=text='So fare thee well, poor devil of a Sub-Sub, whose commentator I am':voice=slt
  4603. @end example
  4604. @item
  4605. Input text to ffmpeg:
  4606. @example
  4607. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i flite=text='So fare thee well, poor devil of a Sub-Sub, whose commentator I am':voice=slt
  4608. @end example
  4609. @item
  4610. Make @file{ffplay} speak the specified text, using @code{flite} and
  4611. the @code{lavfi} device:
  4612. @example
  4613. ffplay -f lavfi flite=text='No more be grieved for which that thou hast done.'
  4614. @end example
  4615. @end itemize
  4616. For more information about libflite, check:
  4617. @url{http://www.festvox.org/flite/}
  4618. @section anoisesrc
  4619. Generate a noise audio signal.
  4620. The filter accepts the following options:
  4621. @table @option
  4622. @item sample_rate, r
  4623. Specify the sample rate. Default value is 48000 Hz.
  4624. @item amplitude, a
  4625. Specify the amplitude (0.0 - 1.0) of the generated audio stream. Default value
  4626. is 1.0.
  4627. @item duration, d
  4628. Specify the duration of the generated audio stream. Not specifying this option
  4629. results in noise with an infinite length.
  4630. @item color, colour, c
  4631. Specify the color of noise. Available noise colors are white, pink, brown,
  4632. blue and violet. Default color is white.
  4633. @item seed, s
  4634. Specify a value used to seed the PRNG.
  4635. @item nb_samples, n
  4636. Set the number of samples per each output frame, default is 1024.
  4637. @end table
  4638. @subsection Examples
  4639. @itemize
  4640. @item
  4641. Generate 60 seconds of pink noise, with a 44.1 kHz sampling rate and an amplitude of 0.5:
  4642. @example
  4643. anoisesrc=d=60:c=pink:r=44100:a=0.5
  4644. @end example
  4645. @end itemize
  4646. @section hilbert
  4647. Generate odd-tap Hilbert transform FIR coefficients.
  4648. The resulting stream can be used with @ref{afir} filter for phase-shifting
  4649. the signal by 90 degrees.
  4650. This is used in many matrix coding schemes and for analytic signal generation.
  4651. The process is often written as a multiplication by i (or j), the imaginary unit.
  4652. The filter accepts the following options:
  4653. @table @option
  4654. @item sample_rate, s
  4655. Set sample rate, default is 44100.
  4656. @item taps, t
  4657. Set length of FIR filter, default is 22051.
  4658. @item nb_samples, n
  4659. Set number of samples per each frame.
  4660. @item win_func, w
  4661. Set window function to be used when generating FIR coefficients.
  4662. @end table
  4663. @section sinc
  4664. Generate a sinc kaiser-windowed low-pass, high-pass, band-pass, or band-reject FIR coefficients.
  4665. The resulting stream can be used with @ref{afir} filter for filtering the audio signal.
  4666. The filter accepts the following options:
  4667. @table @option
  4668. @item sample_rate, r
  4669. Set sample rate, default is 44100.
  4670. @item nb_samples, n
  4671. Set number of samples per each frame. Default is 1024.
  4672. @item hp
  4673. Set high-pass frequency. Default is 0.
  4674. @item lp
  4675. Set low-pass frequency. Default is 0.
  4676. If high-pass frequency is lower than low-pass frequency and low-pass frequency
  4677. is higher than 0 then filter will create band-pass filter coefficients,
  4678. otherwise band-reject filter coefficients.
  4679. @item phase
  4680. Set filter phase response. Default is 50. Allowed range is from 0 to 100.
  4681. @item beta
  4682. Set Kaiser window beta.
  4683. @item att
  4684. Set stop-band attenuation. Default is 120dB, allowed range is from 40 to 180 dB.
  4685. @item round
  4686. Enable rounding, by default is disabled.
  4687. @item hptaps
  4688. Set number of taps for high-pass filter.
  4689. @item lptaps
  4690. Set number of taps for low-pass filter.
  4691. @end table
  4692. @section sine
  4693. Generate an audio signal made of a sine wave with amplitude 1/8.
  4694. The audio signal is bit-exact.
  4695. The filter accepts the following options:
  4696. @table @option
  4697. @item frequency, f
  4698. Set the carrier frequency. Default is 440 Hz.
  4699. @item beep_factor, b
  4700. Enable a periodic beep every second with frequency @var{beep_factor} times
  4701. the carrier frequency. Default is 0, meaning the beep is disabled.
  4702. @item sample_rate, r
  4703. Specify the sample rate, default is 44100.
  4704. @item duration, d
  4705. Specify the duration of the generated audio stream.
  4706. @item samples_per_frame
  4707. Set the number of samples per output frame.
  4708. The expression can contain the following constants:
  4709. @table @option
  4710. @item n
  4711. The (sequential) number of the output audio frame, starting from 0.
  4712. @item pts
  4713. The PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) of the output audio frame,
  4714. expressed in @var{TB} units.
  4715. @item t
  4716. The PTS of the output audio frame, expressed in seconds.
  4717. @item TB
  4718. The timebase of the output audio frames.
  4719. @end table
  4720. Default is @code{1024}.
  4721. @end table
  4722. @subsection Examples
  4723. @itemize
  4724. @item
  4725. Generate a simple 440 Hz sine wave:
  4726. @example
  4727. sine
  4728. @end example
  4729. @item
  4730. Generate a 220 Hz sine wave with a 880 Hz beep each second, for 5 seconds:
  4731. @example
  4732. sine=220:4:d=5
  4733. sine=f=220:b=4:d=5
  4734. sine=frequency=220:beep_factor=4:duration=5
  4735. @end example
  4736. @item
  4737. Generate a 1 kHz sine wave following @code{1602,1601,1602,1601,1602} NTSC
  4738. pattern:
  4739. @example
  4740. sine=1000:samples_per_frame='st(0,mod(n,5)); 1602-not(not(eq(ld(0),1)+eq(ld(0),3)))'
  4741. @end example
  4742. @end itemize
  4743. @c man end AUDIO SOURCES
  4744. @chapter Audio Sinks
  4745. @c man begin AUDIO SINKS
  4746. Below is a description of the currently available audio sinks.
  4747. @section abuffersink
  4748. Buffer audio frames, and make them available to the end of filter chain.
  4749. This sink is mainly intended for programmatic use, in particular
  4750. through the interface defined in @file{libavfilter/buffersink.h}
  4751. or the options system.
  4752. It accepts a pointer to an AVABufferSinkContext structure, which
  4753. defines the incoming buffers' formats, to be passed as the opaque
  4754. parameter to @code{avfilter_init_filter} for initialization.
  4755. @section anullsink
  4756. Null audio sink; do absolutely nothing with the input audio. It is
  4757. mainly useful as a template and for use in analysis / debugging
  4758. tools.
  4759. @c man end AUDIO SINKS
  4760. @chapter Video Filters
  4761. @c man begin VIDEO FILTERS
  4762. When you configure your FFmpeg build, you can disable any of the
  4763. existing filters using @code{--disable-filters}.
  4764. The configure output will show the video filters included in your
  4765. build.
  4766. Below is a description of the currently available video filters.
  4767. @section addroi
  4768. Mark a region of interest in a video frame.
  4769. The frame data is passed through unchanged, but metadata is attached
  4770. to the frame indicating regions of interest which can affect the
  4771. behaviour of later encoding. Multiple regions can be marked by
  4772. applying the filter multiple times.
  4773. @table @option
  4774. @item x
  4775. Region distance in pixels from the left edge of the frame.
  4776. @item y
  4777. Region distance in pixels from the top edge of the frame.
  4778. @item w
  4779. Region width in pixels.
  4780. @item h
  4781. Region height in pixels.
  4782. The parameters @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w} and @var{h} are expressions,
  4783. and may contain the following variables:
  4784. @table @option
  4785. @item iw
  4786. Width of the input frame.
  4787. @item ih
  4788. Height of the input frame.
  4789. @end table
  4790. @item qoffset
  4791. Quantisation offset to apply within the region.
  4792. This must be a real value in the range -1 to +1. A value of zero
  4793. indicates no quality change. A negative value asks for better quality
  4794. (less quantisation), while a positive value asks for worse quality
  4795. (greater quantisation).
  4796. The range is calibrated so that the extreme values indicate the
  4797. largest possible offset - if the rest of the frame is encoded with the
  4798. worst possible quality, an offset of -1 indicates that this region
  4799. should be encoded with the best possible quality anyway. Intermediate
  4800. values are then interpolated in some codec-dependent way.
  4801. For example, in 10-bit H.264 the quantisation parameter varies between
  4802. -12 and 51. A typical qoffset value of -1/10 therefore indicates that
  4803. this region should be encoded with a QP around one-tenth of the full
  4804. range better than the rest of the frame. So, if most of the frame
  4805. were to be encoded with a QP of around 30, this region would get a QP
  4806. of around 24 (an offset of approximately -1/10 * (51 - -12) = -6.3).
  4807. An extreme value of -1 would indicate that this region should be
  4808. encoded with the best possible quality regardless of the treatment of
  4809. the rest of the frame - that is, should be encoded at a QP of -12.
  4810. @item clear
  4811. If set to true, remove any existing regions of interest marked on the
  4812. frame before adding the new one.
  4813. @end table
  4814. @subsection Examples
  4815. @itemize
  4816. @item
  4817. Mark the centre quarter of the frame as interesting.
  4818. @example
  4819. addroi=iw/4:ih/4:iw/2:ih/2:-1/10
  4820. @end example
  4821. @item
  4822. Mark the 100-pixel-wide region on the left edge of the frame as very
  4823. uninteresting (to be encoded at much lower quality than the rest of
  4824. the frame).
  4825. @example
  4826. addroi=0:0:100:ih:+1/5
  4827. @end example
  4828. @end itemize
  4829. @section alphaextract
  4830. Extract the alpha component from the input as a grayscale video. This
  4831. is especially useful with the @var{alphamerge} filter.
  4832. @section alphamerge
  4833. Add or replace the alpha component of the primary input with the
  4834. grayscale value of a second input. This is intended for use with
  4835. @var{alphaextract} to allow the transmission or storage of frame
  4836. sequences that have alpha in a format that doesn't support an alpha
  4837. channel.
  4838. For example, to reconstruct full frames from a normal YUV-encoded video
  4839. and a separate video created with @var{alphaextract}, you might use:
  4840. @example
  4841. movie=in_alpha.mkv [alpha]; [in][alpha] alphamerge [out]
  4842. @end example
  4843. Since this filter is designed for reconstruction, it operates on frame
  4844. sequences without considering timestamps, and terminates when either
  4845. input reaches end of stream. This will cause problems if your encoding
  4846. pipeline drops frames. If you're trying to apply an image as an
  4847. overlay to a video stream, consider the @var{overlay} filter instead.
  4848. @section amplify
  4849. Amplify differences between current pixel and pixels of adjacent frames in
  4850. same pixel location.
  4851. This filter accepts the following options:
  4852. @table @option
  4853. @item radius
  4854. Set frame radius. Default is 2. Allowed range is from 1 to 63.
  4855. For example radius of 3 will instruct filter to calculate average of 7 frames.
  4856. @item factor
  4857. Set factor to amplify difference. Default is 2. Allowed range is from 0 to 65535.
  4858. @item threshold
  4859. Set threshold for difference amplification. Any difference greater or equal to
  4860. this value will not alter source pixel. Default is 10.
  4861. Allowed range is from 0 to 65535.
  4862. @item tolerance
  4863. Set tolerance for difference amplification. Any difference lower to
  4864. this value will not alter source pixel. Default is 0.
  4865. Allowed range is from 0 to 65535.
  4866. @item low
  4867. Set lower limit for changing source pixel. Default is 65535. Allowed range is from 0 to 65535.
  4868. This option controls maximum possible value that will decrease source pixel value.
  4869. @item high
  4870. Set high limit for changing source pixel. Default is 65535. Allowed range is from 0 to 65535.
  4871. This option controls maximum possible value that will increase source pixel value.
  4872. @item planes
  4873. Set which planes to filter. Default is all. Allowed range is from 0 to 15.
  4874. @end table
  4875. @subsection Commands
  4876. This filter supports the following @ref{commands} that corresponds to option of same name:
  4877. @table @option
  4878. @item factor
  4879. @item threshold
  4880. @item tolerance
  4881. @item low
  4882. @item high
  4883. @item planes
  4884. @end table
  4885. @section ass
  4886. Same as the @ref{subtitles} filter, except that it doesn't require libavcodec
  4887. and libavformat to work. On the other hand, it is limited to ASS (Advanced
  4888. Substation Alpha) subtitles files.
  4889. This filter accepts the following option in addition to the common options from
  4890. the @ref{subtitles} filter:
  4891. @table @option
  4892. @item shaping
  4893. Set the shaping engine
  4894. Available values are:
  4895. @table @samp
  4896. @item auto
  4897. The default libass shaping engine, which is the best available.
  4898. @item simple
  4899. Fast, font-agnostic shaper that can do only substitutions
  4900. @item complex
  4901. Slower shaper using OpenType for substitutions and positioning
  4902. @end table
  4903. The default is @code{auto}.
  4904. @end table
  4905. @section atadenoise
  4906. Apply an Adaptive Temporal Averaging Denoiser to the video input.
  4907. The filter accepts the following options:
  4908. @table @option
  4909. @item 0a
  4910. Set threshold A for 1st plane. Default is 0.02.
  4911. Valid range is 0 to 0.3.
  4912. @item 0b
  4913. Set threshold B for 1st plane. Default is 0.04.
  4914. Valid range is 0 to 5.
  4915. @item 1a
  4916. Set threshold A for 2nd plane. Default is 0.02.
  4917. Valid range is 0 to 0.3.
  4918. @item 1b
  4919. Set threshold B for 2nd plane. Default is 0.04.
  4920. Valid range is 0 to 5.
  4921. @item 2a
  4922. Set threshold A for 3rd plane. Default is 0.02.
  4923. Valid range is 0 to 0.3.
  4924. @item 2b
  4925. Set threshold B for 3rd plane. Default is 0.04.
  4926. Valid range is 0 to 5.
  4927. Threshold A is designed to react on abrupt changes in the input signal and
  4928. threshold B is designed to react on continuous changes in the input signal.
  4929. @item s
  4930. Set number of frames filter will use for averaging. Default is 9. Must be odd
  4931. number in range [5, 129].
  4932. @item p
  4933. Set what planes of frame filter will use for averaging. Default is all.
  4934. @item a
  4935. Set what variant of algorithm filter will use for averaging. Default is @code{p} parallel.
  4936. Alternatively can be set to @code{s} serial.
  4937. Parallel can be faster then serial, while other way around is never true.
  4938. Parallel will abort early on first change being greater then thresholds, while serial
  4939. will continue processing other side of frames if they are equal or bellow thresholds.
  4940. @end table
  4941. @subsection Commands
  4942. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options except option @code{s}.
  4943. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  4944. @section avgblur
  4945. Apply average blur filter.
  4946. The filter accepts the following options:
  4947. @table @option
  4948. @item sizeX
  4949. Set horizontal radius size.
  4950. @item planes
  4951. Set which planes to filter. By default all planes are filtered.
  4952. @item sizeY
  4953. Set vertical radius size, if zero it will be same as @code{sizeX}.
  4954. Default is @code{0}.
  4955. @end table
  4956. @subsection Commands
  4957. This filter supports same commands as options.
  4958. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  4959. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  4960. value.
  4961. @section bbox
  4962. Compute the bounding box for the non-black pixels in the input frame
  4963. luminance plane.
  4964. This filter computes the bounding box containing all the pixels with a
  4965. luminance value greater than the minimum allowed value.
  4966. The parameters describing the bounding box are printed on the filter
  4967. log.
  4968. The filter accepts the following option:
  4969. @table @option
  4970. @item min_val
  4971. Set the minimal luminance value. Default is @code{16}.
  4972. @end table
  4973. @section bilateral
  4974. Apply bilateral filter, spatial smoothing while preserving edges.
  4975. The filter accepts the following options:
  4976. @table @option
  4977. @item sigmaS
  4978. Set sigma of gaussian function to calculate spatial weight.
  4979. Allowed range is 0 to 10. Default is 0.1.
  4980. @item sigmaR
  4981. Set sigma of gaussian function to calculate range weight.
  4982. Allowed range is 0 to 1. Default is 0.1.
  4983. @item planes
  4984. Set planes to filter. Default is first only.
  4985. @end table
  4986. @section bitplanenoise
  4987. Show and measure bit plane noise.
  4988. The filter accepts the following options:
  4989. @table @option
  4990. @item bitplane
  4991. Set which plane to analyze. Default is @code{1}.
  4992. @item filter
  4993. Filter out noisy pixels from @code{bitplane} set above.
  4994. Default is disabled.
  4995. @end table
  4996. @section blackdetect
  4997. Detect video intervals that are (almost) completely black. Can be
  4998. useful to detect chapter transitions, commercials, or invalid
  4999. recordings. Output lines contains the time for the start, end and
  5000. duration of the detected black interval expressed in seconds.
  5001. In order to display the output lines, you need to set the loglevel at
  5002. least to the AV_LOG_INFO value.
  5003. The filter accepts the following options:
  5004. @table @option
  5005. @item black_min_duration, d
  5006. Set the minimum detected black duration expressed in seconds. It must
  5007. be a non-negative floating point number.
  5008. Default value is 2.0.
  5009. @item picture_black_ratio_th, pic_th
  5010. Set the threshold for considering a picture "black".
  5011. Express the minimum value for the ratio:
  5012. @example
  5013. @var{nb_black_pixels} / @var{nb_pixels}
  5014. @end example
  5015. for which a picture is considered black.
  5016. Default value is 0.98.
  5017. @item pixel_black_th, pix_th
  5018. Set the threshold for considering a pixel "black".
  5019. The threshold expresses the maximum pixel luminance value for which a
  5020. pixel is considered "black". The provided value is scaled according to
  5021. the following equation:
  5022. @example
  5023. @var{absolute_threshold} = @var{luminance_minimum_value} + @var{pixel_black_th} * @var{luminance_range_size}
  5024. @end example
  5025. @var{luminance_range_size} and @var{luminance_minimum_value} depend on
  5026. the input video format, the range is [0-255] for YUV full-range
  5027. formats and [16-235] for YUV non full-range formats.
  5028. Default value is 0.10.
  5029. @end table
  5030. The following example sets the maximum pixel threshold to the minimum
  5031. value, and detects only black intervals of 2 or more seconds:
  5032. @example
  5033. blackdetect=d=2:pix_th=0.00
  5034. @end example
  5035. @section blackframe
  5036. Detect frames that are (almost) completely black. Can be useful to
  5037. detect chapter transitions or commercials. Output lines consist of
  5038. the frame number of the detected frame, the percentage of blackness,
  5039. the position in the file if known or -1 and the timestamp in seconds.
  5040. In order to display the output lines, you need to set the loglevel at
  5041. least to the AV_LOG_INFO value.
  5042. This filter exports frame metadata @code{lavfi.blackframe.pblack}.
  5043. The value represents the percentage of pixels in the picture that
  5044. are below the threshold value.
  5045. It accepts the following parameters:
  5046. @table @option
  5047. @item amount
  5048. The percentage of the pixels that have to be below the threshold; it defaults to
  5049. @code{98}.
  5050. @item threshold, thresh
  5051. The threshold below which a pixel value is considered black; it defaults to
  5052. @code{32}.
  5053. @end table
  5054. @section blend, tblend
  5055. Blend two video frames into each other.
  5056. The @code{blend} filter takes two input streams and outputs one
  5057. stream, the first input is the "top" layer and second input is
  5058. "bottom" layer. By default, the output terminates when the longest input terminates.
  5059. The @code{tblend} (time blend) filter takes two consecutive frames
  5060. from one single stream, and outputs the result obtained by blending
  5061. the new frame on top of the old frame.
  5062. A description of the accepted options follows.
  5063. @table @option
  5064. @item c0_mode
  5065. @item c1_mode
  5066. @item c2_mode
  5067. @item c3_mode
  5068. @item all_mode
  5069. Set blend mode for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  5070. of @var{all_mode}. Default value is @code{normal}.
  5071. Available values for component modes are:
  5072. @table @samp
  5073. @item addition
  5074. @item grainmerge
  5075. @item and
  5076. @item average
  5077. @item burn
  5078. @item darken
  5079. @item difference
  5080. @item grainextract
  5081. @item divide
  5082. @item dodge
  5083. @item freeze
  5084. @item exclusion
  5085. @item extremity
  5086. @item glow
  5087. @item hardlight
  5088. @item hardmix
  5089. @item heat
  5090. @item lighten
  5091. @item linearlight
  5092. @item multiply
  5093. @item multiply128
  5094. @item negation
  5095. @item normal
  5096. @item or
  5097. @item overlay
  5098. @item phoenix
  5099. @item pinlight
  5100. @item reflect
  5101. @item screen
  5102. @item softlight
  5103. @item subtract
  5104. @item vividlight
  5105. @item xor
  5106. @end table
  5107. @item c0_opacity
  5108. @item c1_opacity
  5109. @item c2_opacity
  5110. @item c3_opacity
  5111. @item all_opacity
  5112. Set blend opacity for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  5113. of @var{all_opacity}. Only used in combination with pixel component blend modes.
  5114. @item c0_expr
  5115. @item c1_expr
  5116. @item c2_expr
  5117. @item c3_expr
  5118. @item all_expr
  5119. Set blend expression for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  5120. of @var{all_expr}. Note that related mode options will be ignored if those are set.
  5121. The expressions can use the following variables:
  5122. @table @option
  5123. @item N
  5124. The sequential number of the filtered frame, starting from @code{0}.
  5125. @item X
  5126. @item Y
  5127. the coordinates of the current sample
  5128. @item W
  5129. @item H
  5130. the width and height of currently filtered plane
  5131. @item SW
  5132. @item SH
  5133. Width and height scale for the plane being filtered. It is the
  5134. ratio between the dimensions of the current plane to the luma plane,
  5135. e.g. for a @code{yuv420p} frame, the values are @code{1,1} for
  5136. the luma plane and @code{0.5,0.5} for the chroma planes.
  5137. @item T
  5138. Time of the current frame, expressed in seconds.
  5139. @item TOP, A
  5140. Value of pixel component at current location for first video frame (top layer).
  5141. @item BOTTOM, B
  5142. Value of pixel component at current location for second video frame (bottom layer).
  5143. @end table
  5144. @end table
  5145. The @code{blend} filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  5146. @subsection Examples
  5147. @itemize
  5148. @item
  5149. Apply transition from bottom layer to top layer in first 10 seconds:
  5150. @example
  5151. blend=all_expr='A*(if(gte(T,10),1,T/10))+B*(1-(if(gte(T,10),1,T/10)))'
  5152. @end example
  5153. @item
  5154. Apply linear horizontal transition from top layer to bottom layer:
  5155. @example
  5156. blend=all_expr='A*(X/W)+B*(1-X/W)'
  5157. @end example
  5158. @item
  5159. Apply 1x1 checkerboard effect:
  5160. @example
  5161. blend=all_expr='if(eq(mod(X,2),mod(Y,2)),A,B)'
  5162. @end example
  5163. @item
  5164. Apply uncover left effect:
  5165. @example
  5166. blend=all_expr='if(gte(N*SW+X,W),A,B)'
  5167. @end example
  5168. @item
  5169. Apply uncover down effect:
  5170. @example
  5171. blend=all_expr='if(gte(Y-N*SH,0),A,B)'
  5172. @end example
  5173. @item
  5174. Apply uncover up-left effect:
  5175. @example
  5176. blend=all_expr='if(gte(T*SH*40+Y,H)*gte((T*40*SW+X)*W/H,W),A,B)'
  5177. @end example
  5178. @item
  5179. Split diagonally video and shows top and bottom layer on each side:
  5180. @example
  5181. blend=all_expr='if(gt(X,Y*(W/H)),A,B)'
  5182. @end example
  5183. @item
  5184. Display differences between the current and the previous frame:
  5185. @example
  5186. tblend=all_mode=grainextract
  5187. @end example
  5188. @end itemize
  5189. @section bm3d
  5190. Denoise frames using Block-Matching 3D algorithm.
  5191. The filter accepts the following options.
  5192. @table @option
  5193. @item sigma
  5194. Set denoising strength. Default value is 1.
  5195. Allowed range is from 0 to 999.9.
  5196. The denoising algorithm is very sensitive to sigma, so adjust it
  5197. according to the source.
  5198. @item block
  5199. Set local patch size. This sets dimensions in 2D.
  5200. @item bstep
  5201. Set sliding step for processing blocks. Default value is 4.
  5202. Allowed range is from 1 to 64.
  5203. Smaller values allows processing more reference blocks and is slower.
  5204. @item group
  5205. Set maximal number of similar blocks for 3rd dimension. Default value is 1.
  5206. When set to 1, no block matching is done. Larger values allows more blocks
  5207. in single group.
  5208. Allowed range is from 1 to 256.
  5209. @item range
  5210. Set radius for search block matching. Default is 9.
  5211. Allowed range is from 1 to INT32_MAX.
  5212. @item mstep
  5213. Set step between two search locations for block matching. Default is 1.
  5214. Allowed range is from 1 to 64. Smaller is slower.
  5215. @item thmse
  5216. Set threshold of mean square error for block matching. Valid range is 0 to
  5217. INT32_MAX.
  5218. @item hdthr
  5219. Set thresholding parameter for hard thresholding in 3D transformed domain.
  5220. Larger values results in stronger hard-thresholding filtering in frequency
  5221. domain.
  5222. @item estim
  5223. Set filtering estimation mode. Can be @code{basic} or @code{final}.
  5224. Default is @code{basic}.
  5225. @item ref
  5226. If enabled, filter will use 2nd stream for block matching.
  5227. Default is disabled for @code{basic} value of @var{estim} option,
  5228. and always enabled if value of @var{estim} is @code{final}.
  5229. @item planes
  5230. Set planes to filter. Default is all available except alpha.
  5231. @end table
  5232. @subsection Examples
  5233. @itemize
  5234. @item
  5235. Basic filtering with bm3d:
  5236. @example
  5237. bm3d=sigma=3:block=4:bstep=2:group=1:estim=basic
  5238. @end example
  5239. @item
  5240. Same as above, but filtering only luma:
  5241. @example
  5242. bm3d=sigma=3:block=4:bstep=2:group=1:estim=basic:planes=1
  5243. @end example
  5244. @item
  5245. Same as above, but with both estimation modes:
  5246. @example
  5247. split[a][b],[a]bm3d=sigma=3:block=4:bstep=2:group=1:estim=basic[a],[b][a]bm3d=sigma=3:block=4:bstep=2:group=16:estim=final:ref=1
  5248. @end example
  5249. @item
  5250. Same as above, but prefilter with @ref{nlmeans} filter instead:
  5251. @example
  5252. split[a][b],[a]nlmeans=s=3:r=7:p=3[a],[b][a]bm3d=sigma=3:block=4:bstep=2:group=16:estim=final:ref=1
  5253. @end example
  5254. @end itemize
  5255. @section boxblur
  5256. Apply a boxblur algorithm to the input video.
  5257. It accepts the following parameters:
  5258. @table @option
  5259. @item luma_radius, lr
  5260. @item luma_power, lp
  5261. @item chroma_radius, cr
  5262. @item chroma_power, cp
  5263. @item alpha_radius, ar
  5264. @item alpha_power, ap
  5265. @end table
  5266. A description of the accepted options follows.
  5267. @table @option
  5268. @item luma_radius, lr
  5269. @item chroma_radius, cr
  5270. @item alpha_radius, ar
  5271. Set an expression for the box radius in pixels used for blurring the
  5272. corresponding input plane.
  5273. The radius value must be a non-negative number, and must not be
  5274. greater than the value of the expression @code{min(w,h)/2} for the
  5275. luma and alpha planes, and of @code{min(cw,ch)/2} for the chroma
  5276. planes.
  5277. Default value for @option{luma_radius} is "2". If not specified,
  5278. @option{chroma_radius} and @option{alpha_radius} default to the
  5279. corresponding value set for @option{luma_radius}.
  5280. The expressions can contain the following constants:
  5281. @table @option
  5282. @item w
  5283. @item h
  5284. The input width and height in pixels.
  5285. @item cw
  5286. @item ch
  5287. The input chroma image width and height in pixels.
  5288. @item hsub
  5289. @item vsub
  5290. The horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example, for the
  5291. pixel format "yuv422p", @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  5292. @end table
  5293. @item luma_power, lp
  5294. @item chroma_power, cp
  5295. @item alpha_power, ap
  5296. Specify how many times the boxblur filter is applied to the
  5297. corresponding plane.
  5298. Default value for @option{luma_power} is 2. If not specified,
  5299. @option{chroma_power} and @option{alpha_power} default to the
  5300. corresponding value set for @option{luma_power}.
  5301. A value of 0 will disable the effect.
  5302. @end table
  5303. @subsection Examples
  5304. @itemize
  5305. @item
  5306. Apply a boxblur filter with the luma, chroma, and alpha radii
  5307. set to 2:
  5308. @example
  5309. boxblur=luma_radius=2:luma_power=1
  5310. boxblur=2:1
  5311. @end example
  5312. @item
  5313. Set the luma radius to 2, and alpha and chroma radius to 0:
  5314. @example
  5315. boxblur=2:1:cr=0:ar=0
  5316. @end example
  5317. @item
  5318. Set the luma and chroma radii to a fraction of the video dimension:
  5319. @example
  5320. boxblur=luma_radius=min(h\,w)/10:luma_power=1:chroma_radius=min(cw\,ch)/10:chroma_power=1
  5321. @end example
  5322. @end itemize
  5323. @section bwdif
  5324. Deinterlace the input video ("bwdif" stands for "Bob Weaver
  5325. Deinterlacing Filter").
  5326. Motion adaptive deinterlacing based on yadif with the use of w3fdif and cubic
  5327. interpolation algorithms.
  5328. It accepts the following parameters:
  5329. @table @option
  5330. @item mode
  5331. The interlacing mode to adopt. It accepts one of the following values:
  5332. @table @option
  5333. @item 0, send_frame
  5334. Output one frame for each frame.
  5335. @item 1, send_field
  5336. Output one frame for each field.
  5337. @end table
  5338. The default value is @code{send_field}.
  5339. @item parity
  5340. The picture field parity assumed for the input interlaced video. It accepts one
  5341. of the following values:
  5342. @table @option
  5343. @item 0, tff
  5344. Assume the top field is first.
  5345. @item 1, bff
  5346. Assume the bottom field is first.
  5347. @item -1, auto
  5348. Enable automatic detection of field parity.
  5349. @end table
  5350. The default value is @code{auto}.
  5351. If the interlacing is unknown or the decoder does not export this information,
  5352. top field first will be assumed.
  5353. @item deint
  5354. Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accepts one of the following
  5355. values:
  5356. @table @option
  5357. @item 0, all
  5358. Deinterlace all frames.
  5359. @item 1, interlaced
  5360. Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.
  5361. @end table
  5362. The default value is @code{all}.
  5363. @end table
  5364. @section chromahold
  5365. Remove all color information for all colors except for certain one.
  5366. The filter accepts the following options:
  5367. @table @option
  5368. @item color
  5369. The color which will not be replaced with neutral chroma.
  5370. @item similarity
  5371. Similarity percentage with the above color.
  5372. 0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.
  5373. @item blend
  5374. Blend percentage.
  5375. 0.0 makes pixels either fully gray, or not gray at all.
  5376. Higher values result in more preserved color.
  5377. @item yuv
  5378. Signals that the color passed is already in YUV instead of RGB.
  5379. Literal colors like "green" or "red" don't make sense with this enabled anymore.
  5380. This can be used to pass exact YUV values as hexadecimal numbers.
  5381. @end table
  5382. @subsection Commands
  5383. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  5384. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  5385. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  5386. value.
  5387. @section chromakey
  5388. YUV colorspace color/chroma keying.
  5389. The filter accepts the following options:
  5390. @table @option
  5391. @item color
  5392. The color which will be replaced with transparency.
  5393. @item similarity
  5394. Similarity percentage with the key color.
  5395. 0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.
  5396. @item blend
  5397. Blend percentage.
  5398. 0.0 makes pixels either fully transparent, or not transparent at all.
  5399. Higher values result in semi-transparent pixels, with a higher transparency
  5400. the more similar the pixels color is to the key color.
  5401. @item yuv
  5402. Signals that the color passed is already in YUV instead of RGB.
  5403. Literal colors like "green" or "red" don't make sense with this enabled anymore.
  5404. This can be used to pass exact YUV values as hexadecimal numbers.
  5405. @end table
  5406. @subsection Commands
  5407. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  5408. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  5409. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  5410. value.
  5411. @subsection Examples
  5412. @itemize
  5413. @item
  5414. Make every green pixel in the input image transparent:
  5415. @example
  5416. ffmpeg -i input.png -vf chromakey=green out.png
  5417. @end example
  5418. @item
  5419. Overlay a greenscreen-video on top of a static black background.
  5420. @example
  5421. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i color=c=black:s=1280x720 -i video.mp4 -shortest -filter_complex "[1:v]chromakey=0x70de77:0.1:0.2[ckout];[0:v][ckout]overlay[out]" -map "[out]" output.mkv
  5422. @end example
  5423. @end itemize
  5424. @section chromashift
  5425. Shift chroma pixels horizontally and/or vertically.
  5426. The filter accepts the following options:
  5427. @table @option
  5428. @item cbh
  5429. Set amount to shift chroma-blue horizontally.
  5430. @item cbv
  5431. Set amount to shift chroma-blue vertically.
  5432. @item crh
  5433. Set amount to shift chroma-red horizontally.
  5434. @item crv
  5435. Set amount to shift chroma-red vertically.
  5436. @item edge
  5437. Set edge mode, can be @var{smear}, default, or @var{warp}.
  5438. @end table
  5439. @subsection Commands
  5440. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  5441. @section ciescope
  5442. Display CIE color diagram with pixels overlaid onto it.
  5443. The filter accepts the following options:
  5444. @table @option
  5445. @item system
  5446. Set color system.
  5447. @table @samp
  5448. @item ntsc, 470m
  5449. @item ebu, 470bg
  5450. @item smpte
  5451. @item 240m
  5452. @item apple
  5453. @item widergb
  5454. @item cie1931
  5455. @item rec709, hdtv
  5456. @item uhdtv, rec2020
  5457. @item dcip3
  5458. @end table
  5459. @item cie
  5460. Set CIE system.
  5461. @table @samp
  5462. @item xyy
  5463. @item ucs
  5464. @item luv
  5465. @end table
  5466. @item gamuts
  5467. Set what gamuts to draw.
  5468. See @code{system} option for available values.
  5469. @item size, s
  5470. Set ciescope size, by default set to 512.
  5471. @item intensity, i
  5472. Set intensity used to map input pixel values to CIE diagram.
  5473. @item contrast
  5474. Set contrast used to draw tongue colors that are out of active color system gamut.
  5475. @item corrgamma
  5476. Correct gamma displayed on scope, by default enabled.
  5477. @item showwhite
  5478. Show white point on CIE diagram, by default disabled.
  5479. @item gamma
  5480. Set input gamma. Used only with XYZ input color space.
  5481. @end table
  5482. @section codecview
  5483. Visualize information exported by some codecs.
  5484. Some codecs can export information through frames using side-data or other
  5485. means. For example, some MPEG based codecs export motion vectors through the
  5486. @var{export_mvs} flag in the codec @option{flags2} option.
  5487. The filter accepts the following option:
  5488. @table @option
  5489. @item mv
  5490. Set motion vectors to visualize.
  5491. Available flags for @var{mv} are:
  5492. @table @samp
  5493. @item pf
  5494. forward predicted MVs of P-frames
  5495. @item bf
  5496. forward predicted MVs of B-frames
  5497. @item bb
  5498. backward predicted MVs of B-frames
  5499. @end table
  5500. @item qp
  5501. Display quantization parameters using the chroma planes.
  5502. @item mv_type, mvt
  5503. Set motion vectors type to visualize. Includes MVs from all frames unless specified by @var{frame_type} option.
  5504. Available flags for @var{mv_type} are:
  5505. @table @samp
  5506. @item fp
  5507. forward predicted MVs
  5508. @item bp
  5509. backward predicted MVs
  5510. @end table
  5511. @item frame_type, ft
  5512. Set frame type to visualize motion vectors of.
  5513. Available flags for @var{frame_type} are:
  5514. @table @samp
  5515. @item if
  5516. intra-coded frames (I-frames)
  5517. @item pf
  5518. predicted frames (P-frames)
  5519. @item bf
  5520. bi-directionally predicted frames (B-frames)
  5521. @end table
  5522. @end table
  5523. @subsection Examples
  5524. @itemize
  5525. @item
  5526. Visualize forward predicted MVs of all frames using @command{ffplay}:
  5527. @example
  5528. ffplay -flags2 +export_mvs input.mp4 -vf codecview=mv_type=fp
  5529. @end example
  5530. @item
  5531. Visualize multi-directionals MVs of P and B-Frames using @command{ffplay}:
  5532. @example
  5533. ffplay -flags2 +export_mvs input.mp4 -vf codecview=mv=pf+bf+bb
  5534. @end example
  5535. @end itemize
  5536. @section colorbalance
  5537. Modify intensity of primary colors (red, green and blue) of input frames.
  5538. The filter allows an input frame to be adjusted in the shadows, midtones or highlights
  5539. regions for the red-cyan, green-magenta or blue-yellow balance.
  5540. A positive adjustment value shifts the balance towards the primary color, a negative
  5541. value towards the complementary color.
  5542. The filter accepts the following options:
  5543. @table @option
  5544. @item rs
  5545. @item gs
  5546. @item bs
  5547. Adjust red, green and blue shadows (darkest pixels).
  5548. @item rm
  5549. @item gm
  5550. @item bm
  5551. Adjust red, green and blue midtones (medium pixels).
  5552. @item rh
  5553. @item gh
  5554. @item bh
  5555. Adjust red, green and blue highlights (brightest pixels).
  5556. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[-1.0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{0}.
  5557. @item pl
  5558. Preserve lightness when changing color balance. Default is disabled.
  5559. @end table
  5560. @subsection Examples
  5561. @itemize
  5562. @item
  5563. Add red color cast to shadows:
  5564. @example
  5565. colorbalance=rs=.3
  5566. @end example
  5567. @end itemize
  5568. @subsection Commands
  5569. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  5570. @section colorchannelmixer
  5571. Adjust video input frames by re-mixing color channels.
  5572. This filter modifies a color channel by adding the values associated to
  5573. the other channels of the same pixels. For example if the value to
  5574. modify is red, the output value will be:
  5575. @example
  5576. @var{red}=@var{red}*@var{rr} + @var{blue}*@var{rb} + @var{green}*@var{rg} + @var{alpha}*@var{ra}
  5577. @end example
  5578. The filter accepts the following options:
  5579. @table @option
  5580. @item rr
  5581. @item rg
  5582. @item rb
  5583. @item ra
  5584. Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output red channel.
  5585. Default is @code{1} for @var{rr}, and @code{0} for @var{rg}, @var{rb} and @var{ra}.
  5586. @item gr
  5587. @item gg
  5588. @item gb
  5589. @item ga
  5590. Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output green channel.
  5591. Default is @code{1} for @var{gg}, and @code{0} for @var{gr}, @var{gb} and @var{ga}.
  5592. @item br
  5593. @item bg
  5594. @item bb
  5595. @item ba
  5596. Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output blue channel.
  5597. Default is @code{1} for @var{bb}, and @code{0} for @var{br}, @var{bg} and @var{ba}.
  5598. @item ar
  5599. @item ag
  5600. @item ab
  5601. @item aa
  5602. Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output alpha channel.
  5603. Default is @code{1} for @var{aa}, and @code{0} for @var{ar}, @var{ag} and @var{ab}.
  5604. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[-2.0, 2.0]}.
  5605. @end table
  5606. @subsection Examples
  5607. @itemize
  5608. @item
  5609. Convert source to grayscale:
  5610. @example
  5611. colorchannelmixer=.3:.4:.3:0:.3:.4:.3:0:.3:.4:.3
  5612. @end example
  5613. @item
  5614. Simulate sepia tones:
  5615. @example
  5616. colorchannelmixer=.393:.769:.189:0:.349:.686:.168:0:.272:.534:.131
  5617. @end example
  5618. @end itemize
  5619. @subsection Commands
  5620. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  5621. @section colorkey
  5622. RGB colorspace color keying.
  5623. The filter accepts the following options:
  5624. @table @option
  5625. @item color
  5626. The color which will be replaced with transparency.
  5627. @item similarity
  5628. Similarity percentage with the key color.
  5629. 0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.
  5630. @item blend
  5631. Blend percentage.
  5632. 0.0 makes pixels either fully transparent, or not transparent at all.
  5633. Higher values result in semi-transparent pixels, with a higher transparency
  5634. the more similar the pixels color is to the key color.
  5635. @end table
  5636. @subsection Examples
  5637. @itemize
  5638. @item
  5639. Make every green pixel in the input image transparent:
  5640. @example
  5641. ffmpeg -i input.png -vf colorkey=green out.png
  5642. @end example
  5643. @item
  5644. Overlay a greenscreen-video on top of a static background image.
  5645. @example
  5646. ffmpeg -i background.png -i video.mp4 -filter_complex "[1:v]colorkey=0x3BBD1E:0.3:0.2[ckout];[0:v][ckout]overlay[out]" -map "[out]" output.flv
  5647. @end example
  5648. @end itemize
  5649. @section colorhold
  5650. Remove all color information for all RGB colors except for certain one.
  5651. The filter accepts the following options:
  5652. @table @option
  5653. @item color
  5654. The color which will not be replaced with neutral gray.
  5655. @item similarity
  5656. Similarity percentage with the above color.
  5657. 0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.
  5658. @item blend
  5659. Blend percentage. 0.0 makes pixels fully gray.
  5660. Higher values result in more preserved color.
  5661. @end table
  5662. @section colorlevels
  5663. Adjust video input frames using levels.
  5664. The filter accepts the following options:
  5665. @table @option
  5666. @item rimin
  5667. @item gimin
  5668. @item bimin
  5669. @item aimin
  5670. Adjust red, green, blue and alpha input black point.
  5671. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[-1.0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{0}.
  5672. @item rimax
  5673. @item gimax
  5674. @item bimax
  5675. @item aimax
  5676. Adjust red, green, blue and alpha input white point.
  5677. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[-1.0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{1}.
  5678. Input levels are used to lighten highlights (bright tones), darken shadows
  5679. (dark tones), change the balance of bright and dark tones.
  5680. @item romin
  5681. @item gomin
  5682. @item bomin
  5683. @item aomin
  5684. Adjust red, green, blue and alpha output black point.
  5685. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{0}.
  5686. @item romax
  5687. @item gomax
  5688. @item bomax
  5689. @item aomax
  5690. Adjust red, green, blue and alpha output white point.
  5691. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{1}.
  5692. Output levels allows manual selection of a constrained output level range.
  5693. @end table
  5694. @subsection Examples
  5695. @itemize
  5696. @item
  5697. Make video output darker:
  5698. @example
  5699. colorlevels=rimin=0.058:gimin=0.058:bimin=0.058
  5700. @end example
  5701. @item
  5702. Increase contrast:
  5703. @example
  5704. colorlevels=rimin=0.039:gimin=0.039:bimin=0.039:rimax=0.96:gimax=0.96:bimax=0.96
  5705. @end example
  5706. @item
  5707. Make video output lighter:
  5708. @example
  5709. colorlevels=rimax=0.902:gimax=0.902:bimax=0.902
  5710. @end example
  5711. @item
  5712. Increase brightness:
  5713. @example
  5714. colorlevels=romin=0.5:gomin=0.5:bomin=0.5
  5715. @end example
  5716. @end itemize
  5717. @section colormatrix
  5718. Convert color matrix.
  5719. The filter accepts the following options:
  5720. @table @option
  5721. @item src
  5722. @item dst
  5723. Specify the source and destination color matrix. Both values must be
  5724. specified.
  5725. The accepted values are:
  5726. @table @samp
  5727. @item bt709
  5728. BT.709
  5729. @item fcc
  5730. FCC
  5731. @item bt601
  5732. BT.601
  5733. @item bt470
  5734. BT.470
  5735. @item bt470bg
  5736. BT.470BG
  5737. @item smpte170m
  5738. SMPTE-170M
  5739. @item smpte240m
  5740. SMPTE-240M
  5741. @item bt2020
  5742. BT.2020
  5743. @end table
  5744. @end table
  5745. For example to convert from BT.601 to SMPTE-240M, use the command:
  5746. @example
  5747. colormatrix=bt601:smpte240m
  5748. @end example
  5749. @section colorspace
  5750. Convert colorspace, transfer characteristics or color primaries.
  5751. Input video needs to have an even size.
  5752. The filter accepts the following options:
  5753. @table @option
  5754. @anchor{all}
  5755. @item all
  5756. Specify all color properties at once.
  5757. The accepted values are:
  5758. @table @samp
  5759. @item bt470m
  5760. BT.470M
  5761. @item bt470bg
  5762. BT.470BG
  5763. @item bt601-6-525
  5764. BT.601-6 525
  5765. @item bt601-6-625
  5766. BT.601-6 625
  5767. @item bt709
  5768. BT.709
  5769. @item smpte170m
  5770. SMPTE-170M
  5771. @item smpte240m
  5772. SMPTE-240M
  5773. @item bt2020
  5774. BT.2020
  5775. @end table
  5776. @anchor{space}
  5777. @item space
  5778. Specify output colorspace.
  5779. The accepted values are:
  5780. @table @samp
  5781. @item bt709
  5782. BT.709
  5783. @item fcc
  5784. FCC
  5785. @item bt470bg
  5786. BT.470BG or BT.601-6 625
  5787. @item smpte170m
  5788. SMPTE-170M or BT.601-6 525
  5789. @item smpte240m
  5790. SMPTE-240M
  5791. @item ycgco
  5792. YCgCo
  5793. @item bt2020ncl
  5794. BT.2020 with non-constant luminance
  5795. @end table
  5796. @anchor{trc}
  5797. @item trc
  5798. Specify output transfer characteristics.
  5799. The accepted values are:
  5800. @table @samp
  5801. @item bt709
  5802. BT.709
  5803. @item bt470m
  5804. BT.470M
  5805. @item bt470bg
  5806. BT.470BG
  5807. @item gamma22
  5808. Constant gamma of 2.2
  5809. @item gamma28
  5810. Constant gamma of 2.8
  5811. @item smpte170m
  5812. SMPTE-170M, BT.601-6 625 or BT.601-6 525
  5813. @item smpte240m
  5814. SMPTE-240M
  5815. @item srgb
  5816. SRGB
  5817. @item iec61966-2-1
  5818. iec61966-2-1
  5819. @item iec61966-2-4
  5820. iec61966-2-4
  5821. @item xvycc
  5822. xvycc
  5823. @item bt2020-10
  5824. BT.2020 for 10-bits content
  5825. @item bt2020-12
  5826. BT.2020 for 12-bits content
  5827. @end table
  5828. @anchor{primaries}
  5829. @item primaries
  5830. Specify output color primaries.
  5831. The accepted values are:
  5832. @table @samp
  5833. @item bt709
  5834. BT.709
  5835. @item bt470m
  5836. BT.470M
  5837. @item bt470bg
  5838. BT.470BG or BT.601-6 625
  5839. @item smpte170m
  5840. SMPTE-170M or BT.601-6 525
  5841. @item smpte240m
  5842. SMPTE-240M
  5843. @item film
  5844. film
  5845. @item smpte431
  5846. SMPTE-431
  5847. @item smpte432
  5848. SMPTE-432
  5849. @item bt2020
  5850. BT.2020
  5851. @item jedec-p22
  5852. JEDEC P22 phosphors
  5853. @end table
  5854. @anchor{range}
  5855. @item range
  5856. Specify output color range.
  5857. The accepted values are:
  5858. @table @samp
  5859. @item tv
  5860. TV (restricted) range
  5861. @item mpeg
  5862. MPEG (restricted) range
  5863. @item pc
  5864. PC (full) range
  5865. @item jpeg
  5866. JPEG (full) range
  5867. @end table
  5868. @item format
  5869. Specify output color format.
  5870. The accepted values are:
  5871. @table @samp
  5872. @item yuv420p
  5873. YUV 4:2:0 planar 8-bits
  5874. @item yuv420p10
  5875. YUV 4:2:0 planar 10-bits
  5876. @item yuv420p12
  5877. YUV 4:2:0 planar 12-bits
  5878. @item yuv422p
  5879. YUV 4:2:2 planar 8-bits
  5880. @item yuv422p10
  5881. YUV 4:2:2 planar 10-bits
  5882. @item yuv422p12
  5883. YUV 4:2:2 planar 12-bits
  5884. @item yuv444p
  5885. YUV 4:4:4 planar 8-bits
  5886. @item yuv444p10
  5887. YUV 4:4:4 planar 10-bits
  5888. @item yuv444p12
  5889. YUV 4:4:4 planar 12-bits
  5890. @end table
  5891. @item fast
  5892. Do a fast conversion, which skips gamma/primary correction. This will take
  5893. significantly less CPU, but will be mathematically incorrect. To get output
  5894. compatible with that produced by the colormatrix filter, use fast=1.
  5895. @item dither
  5896. Specify dithering mode.
  5897. The accepted values are:
  5898. @table @samp
  5899. @item none
  5900. No dithering
  5901. @item fsb
  5902. Floyd-Steinberg dithering
  5903. @end table
  5904. @item wpadapt
  5905. Whitepoint adaptation mode.
  5906. The accepted values are:
  5907. @table @samp
  5908. @item bradford
  5909. Bradford whitepoint adaptation
  5910. @item vonkries
  5911. von Kries whitepoint adaptation
  5912. @item identity
  5913. identity whitepoint adaptation (i.e. no whitepoint adaptation)
  5914. @end table
  5915. @item iall
  5916. Override all input properties at once. Same accepted values as @ref{all}.
  5917. @item ispace
  5918. Override input colorspace. Same accepted values as @ref{space}.
  5919. @item iprimaries
  5920. Override input color primaries. Same accepted values as @ref{primaries}.
  5921. @item itrc
  5922. Override input transfer characteristics. Same accepted values as @ref{trc}.
  5923. @item irange
  5924. Override input color range. Same accepted values as @ref{range}.
  5925. @end table
  5926. The filter converts the transfer characteristics, color space and color
  5927. primaries to the specified user values. The output value, if not specified,
  5928. is set to a default value based on the "all" property. If that property is
  5929. also not specified, the filter will log an error. The output color range and
  5930. format default to the same value as the input color range and format. The
  5931. input transfer characteristics, color space, color primaries and color range
  5932. should be set on the input data. If any of these are missing, the filter will
  5933. log an error and no conversion will take place.
  5934. For example to convert the input to SMPTE-240M, use the command:
  5935. @example
  5936. colorspace=smpte240m
  5937. @end example
  5938. @section convolution
  5939. Apply convolution of 3x3, 5x5, 7x7 or horizontal/vertical up to 49 elements.
  5940. The filter accepts the following options:
  5941. @table @option
  5942. @item 0m
  5943. @item 1m
  5944. @item 2m
  5945. @item 3m
  5946. Set matrix for each plane.
  5947. Matrix is sequence of 9, 25 or 49 signed integers in @var{square} mode,
  5948. and from 1 to 49 odd number of signed integers in @var{row} mode.
  5949. @item 0rdiv
  5950. @item 1rdiv
  5951. @item 2rdiv
  5952. @item 3rdiv
  5953. Set multiplier for calculated value for each plane.
  5954. If unset or 0, it will be sum of all matrix elements.
  5955. @item 0bias
  5956. @item 1bias
  5957. @item 2bias
  5958. @item 3bias
  5959. Set bias for each plane. This value is added to the result of the multiplication.
  5960. Useful for making the overall image brighter or darker. Default is 0.0.
  5961. @item 0mode
  5962. @item 1mode
  5963. @item 2mode
  5964. @item 3mode
  5965. Set matrix mode for each plane. Can be @var{square}, @var{row} or @var{column}.
  5966. Default is @var{square}.
  5967. @end table
  5968. @subsection Examples
  5969. @itemize
  5970. @item
  5971. Apply sharpen:
  5972. @example
  5973. convolution="0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0"
  5974. @end example
  5975. @item
  5976. Apply blur:
  5977. @example
  5978. convolution="1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1/9:1/9:1/9:1/9"
  5979. @end example
  5980. @item
  5981. Apply edge enhance:
  5982. @example
  5983. convolution="0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:5:1:1:1:0:128:128:128"
  5984. @end example
  5985. @item
  5986. Apply edge detect:
  5987. @example
  5988. convolution="0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:5:5:5:1:0:128:128:128"
  5989. @end example
  5990. @item
  5991. Apply laplacian edge detector which includes diagonals:
  5992. @example
  5993. convolution="1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:5:5:5:1:0:128:128:0"
  5994. @end example
  5995. @item
  5996. Apply emboss:
  5997. @example
  5998. convolution="-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2"
  5999. @end example
  6000. @end itemize
  6001. @section convolve
  6002. Apply 2D convolution of video stream in frequency domain using second stream
  6003. as impulse.
  6004. The filter accepts the following options:
  6005. @table @option
  6006. @item planes
  6007. Set which planes to process.
  6008. @item impulse
  6009. Set which impulse video frames will be processed, can be @var{first}
  6010. or @var{all}. Default is @var{all}.
  6011. @end table
  6012. The @code{convolve} filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  6013. @section copy
  6014. Copy the input video source unchanged to the output. This is mainly useful for
  6015. testing purposes.
  6016. @anchor{coreimage}
  6017. @section coreimage
  6018. Video filtering on GPU using Apple's CoreImage API on OSX.
  6019. Hardware acceleration is based on an OpenGL context. Usually, this means it is
  6020. processed by video hardware. However, software-based OpenGL implementations
  6021. exist which means there is no guarantee for hardware processing. It depends on
  6022. the respective OSX.
  6023. There are many filters and image generators provided by Apple that come with a
  6024. large variety of options. The filter has to be referenced by its name along
  6025. with its options.
  6026. The coreimage filter accepts the following options:
  6027. @table @option
  6028. @item list_filters
  6029. List all available filters and generators along with all their respective
  6030. options as well as possible minimum and maximum values along with the default
  6031. values.
  6032. @example
  6033. list_filters=true
  6034. @end example
  6035. @item filter
  6036. Specify all filters by their respective name and options.
  6037. Use @var{list_filters} to determine all valid filter names and options.
  6038. Numerical options are specified by a float value and are automatically clamped
  6039. to their respective value range. Vector and color options have to be specified
  6040. by a list of space separated float values. Character escaping has to be done.
  6041. A special option name @code{default} is available to use default options for a
  6042. filter.
  6043. It is required to specify either @code{default} or at least one of the filter options.
  6044. All omitted options are used with their default values.
  6045. The syntax of the filter string is as follows:
  6046. @example
  6047. filter=<NAME>@@<OPTION>=<VALUE>[@@<OPTION>=<VALUE>][@@...][#<NAME>@@<OPTION>=<VALUE>[@@<OPTION>=<VALUE>][@@...]][#...]
  6048. @end example
  6049. @item output_rect
  6050. Specify a rectangle where the output of the filter chain is copied into the
  6051. input image. It is given by a list of space separated float values:
  6052. @example
  6053. output_rect=x\ y\ width\ height
  6054. @end example
  6055. If not given, the output rectangle equals the dimensions of the input image.
  6056. The output rectangle is automatically cropped at the borders of the input
  6057. image. Negative values are valid for each component.
  6058. @example
  6059. output_rect=25\ 25\ 100\ 100
  6060. @end example
  6061. @end table
  6062. Several filters can be chained for successive processing without GPU-HOST
  6063. transfers allowing for fast processing of complex filter chains.
  6064. Currently, only filters with zero (generators) or exactly one (filters) input
  6065. image and one output image are supported. Also, transition filters are not yet
  6066. usable as intended.
  6067. Some filters generate output images with additional padding depending on the
  6068. respective filter kernel. The padding is automatically removed to ensure the
  6069. filter output has the same size as the input image.
  6070. For image generators, the size of the output image is determined by the
  6071. previous output image of the filter chain or the input image of the whole
  6072. filterchain, respectively. The generators do not use the pixel information of
  6073. this image to generate their output. However, the generated output is
  6074. blended onto this image, resulting in partial or complete coverage of the
  6075. output image.
  6076. The @ref{coreimagesrc} video source can be used for generating input images
  6077. which are directly fed into the filter chain. By using it, providing input
  6078. images by another video source or an input video is not required.
  6079. @subsection Examples
  6080. @itemize
  6081. @item
  6082. List all filters available:
  6083. @example
  6084. coreimage=list_filters=true
  6085. @end example
  6086. @item
  6087. Use the CIBoxBlur filter with default options to blur an image:
  6088. @example
  6089. coreimage=filter=CIBoxBlur@@default
  6090. @end example
  6091. @item
  6092. Use a filter chain with CISepiaTone at default values and CIVignetteEffect with
  6093. its center at 100x100 and a radius of 50 pixels:
  6094. @example
  6095. coreimage=filter=CIBoxBlur@@default#CIVignetteEffect@@inputCenter=100\ 100@@inputRadius=50
  6096. @end example
  6097. @item
  6098. Use nullsrc and CIQRCodeGenerator to create a QR code for the FFmpeg homepage,
  6099. given as complete and escaped command-line for Apple's standard bash shell:
  6100. @example
  6101. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i nullsrc=s=100x100,coreimage=filter=CIQRCodeGenerator@@inputMessage=https\\\\\://FFmpeg.org/@@inputCorrectionLevel=H -frames:v 1 QRCode.png
  6102. @end example
  6103. @end itemize
  6104. @section cover_rect
  6105. Cover a rectangular object
  6106. It accepts the following options:
  6107. @table @option
  6108. @item cover
  6109. Filepath of the optional cover image, needs to be in yuv420.
  6110. @item mode
  6111. Set covering mode.
  6112. It accepts the following values:
  6113. @table @samp
  6114. @item cover
  6115. cover it by the supplied image
  6116. @item blur
  6117. cover it by interpolating the surrounding pixels
  6118. @end table
  6119. Default value is @var{blur}.
  6120. @end table
  6121. @subsection Examples
  6122. @itemize
  6123. @item
  6124. Cover a rectangular object by the supplied image of a given video using @command{ffmpeg}:
  6125. @example
  6126. ffmpeg -i file.ts -vf find_rect=newref.pgm,cover_rect=cover.jpg:mode=cover new.mkv
  6127. @end example
  6128. @end itemize
  6129. @section crop
  6130. Crop the input video to given dimensions.
  6131. It accepts the following parameters:
  6132. @table @option
  6133. @item w, out_w
  6134. The width of the output video. It defaults to @code{iw}.
  6135. This expression is evaluated only once during the filter
  6136. configuration, or when the @samp{w} or @samp{out_w} command is sent.
  6137. @item h, out_h
  6138. The height of the output video. It defaults to @code{ih}.
  6139. This expression is evaluated only once during the filter
  6140. configuration, or when the @samp{h} or @samp{out_h} command is sent.
  6141. @item x
  6142. The horizontal position, in the input video, of the left edge of the output
  6143. video. It defaults to @code{(in_w-out_w)/2}.
  6144. This expression is evaluated per-frame.
  6145. @item y
  6146. The vertical position, in the input video, of the top edge of the output video.
  6147. It defaults to @code{(in_h-out_h)/2}.
  6148. This expression is evaluated per-frame.
  6149. @item keep_aspect
  6150. If set to 1 will force the output display aspect ratio
  6151. to be the same of the input, by changing the output sample aspect
  6152. ratio. It defaults to 0.
  6153. @item exact
  6154. Enable exact cropping. If enabled, subsampled videos will be cropped at exact
  6155. width/height/x/y as specified and will not be rounded to nearest smaller value.
  6156. It defaults to 0.
  6157. @end table
  6158. The @var{out_w}, @var{out_h}, @var{x}, @var{y} parameters are
  6159. expressions containing the following constants:
  6160. @table @option
  6161. @item x
  6162. @item y
  6163. The computed values for @var{x} and @var{y}. They are evaluated for
  6164. each new frame.
  6165. @item in_w
  6166. @item in_h
  6167. The input width and height.
  6168. @item iw
  6169. @item ih
  6170. These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
  6171. @item out_w
  6172. @item out_h
  6173. The output (cropped) width and height.
  6174. @item ow
  6175. @item oh
  6176. These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}.
  6177. @item a
  6178. same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
  6179. @item sar
  6180. input sample aspect ratio
  6181. @item dar
  6182. input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{iw} / @var{ih}) * @var{sar}
  6183. @item hsub
  6184. @item vsub
  6185. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  6186. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  6187. @item n
  6188. The number of the input frame, starting from 0.
  6189. @item pos
  6190. the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown
  6191. @item t
  6192. The timestamp expressed in seconds. It's NAN if the input timestamp is unknown.
  6193. @end table
  6194. The expression for @var{out_w} may depend on the value of @var{out_h},
  6195. and the expression for @var{out_h} may depend on @var{out_w}, but they
  6196. cannot depend on @var{x} and @var{y}, as @var{x} and @var{y} are
  6197. evaluated after @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}.
  6198. The @var{x} and @var{y} parameters specify the expressions for the
  6199. position of the top-left corner of the output (non-cropped) area. They
  6200. are evaluated for each frame. If the evaluated value is not valid, it
  6201. is approximated to the nearest valid value.
  6202. The expression for @var{x} may depend on @var{y}, and the expression
  6203. for @var{y} may depend on @var{x}.
  6204. @subsection Examples
  6205. @itemize
  6206. @item
  6207. Crop area with size 100x100 at position (12,34).
  6208. @example
  6209. crop=100:100:12:34
  6210. @end example
  6211. Using named options, the example above becomes:
  6212. @example
  6213. crop=w=100:h=100:x=12:y=34
  6214. @end example
  6215. @item
  6216. Crop the central input area with size 100x100:
  6217. @example
  6218. crop=100:100
  6219. @end example
  6220. @item
  6221. Crop the central input area with size 2/3 of the input video:
  6222. @example
  6223. crop=2/3*in_w:2/3*in_h
  6224. @end example
  6225. @item
  6226. Crop the input video central square:
  6227. @example
  6228. crop=out_w=in_h
  6229. crop=in_h
  6230. @end example
  6231. @item
  6232. Delimit the rectangle with the top-left corner placed at position
  6233. 100:100 and the right-bottom corner corresponding to the right-bottom
  6234. corner of the input image.
  6235. @example
  6236. crop=in_w-100:in_h-100:100:100
  6237. @end example
  6238. @item
  6239. Crop 10 pixels from the left and right borders, and 20 pixels from
  6240. the top and bottom borders
  6241. @example
  6242. crop=in_w-2*10:in_h-2*20
  6243. @end example
  6244. @item
  6245. Keep only the bottom right quarter of the input image:
  6246. @example
  6247. crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:in_w/2:in_h/2
  6248. @end example
  6249. @item
  6250. Crop height for getting Greek harmony:
  6251. @example
  6252. crop=in_w:1/PHI*in_w
  6253. @end example
  6254. @item
  6255. Apply trembling effect:
  6256. @example
  6257. crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:(in_w-out_w)/2+((in_w-out_w)/2)*sin(n/10):(in_h-out_h)/2 +((in_h-out_h)/2)*sin(n/7)
  6258. @end example
  6259. @item
  6260. Apply erratic camera effect depending on timestamp:
  6261. @example
  6262. crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:(in_w-out_w)/2+((in_w-out_w)/2)*sin(t*10):(in_h-out_h)/2 +((in_h-out_h)/2)*sin(t*13)"
  6263. @end example
  6264. @item
  6265. Set x depending on the value of y:
  6266. @example
  6267. crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:y:10+10*sin(n/10)
  6268. @end example
  6269. @end itemize
  6270. @subsection Commands
  6271. This filter supports the following commands:
  6272. @table @option
  6273. @item w, out_w
  6274. @item h, out_h
  6275. @item x
  6276. @item y
  6277. Set width/height of the output video and the horizontal/vertical position
  6278. in the input video.
  6279. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  6280. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  6281. value.
  6282. @end table
  6283. @section cropdetect
  6284. Auto-detect the crop size.
  6285. It calculates the necessary cropping parameters and prints the
  6286. recommended parameters via the logging system. The detected dimensions
  6287. correspond to the non-black area of the input video.
  6288. It accepts the following parameters:
  6289. @table @option
  6290. @item limit
  6291. Set higher black value threshold, which can be optionally specified
  6292. from nothing (0) to everything (255 for 8-bit based formats). An intensity
  6293. value greater to the set value is considered non-black. It defaults to 24.
  6294. You can also specify a value between 0.0 and 1.0 which will be scaled depending
  6295. on the bitdepth of the pixel format.
  6296. @item round
  6297. The value which the width/height should be divisible by. It defaults to
  6298. 16. The offset is automatically adjusted to center the video. Use 2 to
  6299. get only even dimensions (needed for 4:2:2 video). 16 is best when
  6300. encoding to most video codecs.
  6301. @item reset_count, reset
  6302. Set the counter that determines after how many frames cropdetect will
  6303. reset the previously detected largest video area and start over to
  6304. detect the current optimal crop area. Default value is 0.
  6305. This can be useful when channel logos distort the video area. 0
  6306. indicates 'never reset', and returns the largest area encountered during
  6307. playback.
  6308. @end table
  6309. @anchor{cue}
  6310. @section cue
  6311. Delay video filtering until a given wallclock timestamp. The filter first
  6312. passes on @option{preroll} amount of frames, then it buffers at most
  6313. @option{buffer} amount of frames and waits for the cue. After reaching the cue
  6314. it forwards the buffered frames and also any subsequent frames coming in its
  6315. input.
  6316. The filter can be used synchronize the output of multiple ffmpeg processes for
  6317. realtime output devices like decklink. By putting the delay in the filtering
  6318. chain and pre-buffering frames the process can pass on data to output almost
  6319. immediately after the target wallclock timestamp is reached.
  6320. Perfect frame accuracy cannot be guaranteed, but the result is good enough for
  6321. some use cases.
  6322. @table @option
  6323. @item cue
  6324. The cue timestamp expressed in a UNIX timestamp in microseconds. Default is 0.
  6325. @item preroll
  6326. The duration of content to pass on as preroll expressed in seconds. Default is 0.
  6327. @item buffer
  6328. The maximum duration of content to buffer before waiting for the cue expressed
  6329. in seconds. Default is 0.
  6330. @end table
  6331. @anchor{curves}
  6332. @section curves
  6333. Apply color adjustments using curves.
  6334. This filter is similar to the Adobe Photoshop and GIMP curves tools. Each
  6335. component (red, green and blue) has its values defined by @var{N} key points
  6336. tied from each other using a smooth curve. The x-axis represents the pixel
  6337. values from the input frame, and the y-axis the new pixel values to be set for
  6338. the output frame.
  6339. By default, a component curve is defined by the two points @var{(0;0)} and
  6340. @var{(1;1)}. This creates a straight line where each original pixel value is
  6341. "adjusted" to its own value, which means no change to the image.
  6342. The filter allows you to redefine these two points and add some more. A new
  6343. curve (using a natural cubic spline interpolation) will be define to pass
  6344. smoothly through all these new coordinates. The new defined points needs to be
  6345. strictly increasing over the x-axis, and their @var{x} and @var{y} values must
  6346. be in the @var{[0;1]} interval. If the computed curves happened to go outside
  6347. the vector spaces, the values will be clipped accordingly.
  6348. The filter accepts the following options:
  6349. @table @option
  6350. @item preset
  6351. Select one of the available color presets. This option can be used in addition
  6352. to the @option{r}, @option{g}, @option{b} parameters; in this case, the later
  6353. options takes priority on the preset values.
  6354. Available presets are:
  6355. @table @samp
  6356. @item none
  6357. @item color_negative
  6358. @item cross_process
  6359. @item darker
  6360. @item increase_contrast
  6361. @item lighter
  6362. @item linear_contrast
  6363. @item medium_contrast
  6364. @item negative
  6365. @item strong_contrast
  6366. @item vintage
  6367. @end table
  6368. Default is @code{none}.
  6369. @item master, m
  6370. Set the master key points. These points will define a second pass mapping. It
  6371. is sometimes called a "luminance" or "value" mapping. It can be used with
  6372. @option{r}, @option{g}, @option{b} or @option{all} since it acts like a
  6373. post-processing LUT.
  6374. @item red, r
  6375. Set the key points for the red component.
  6376. @item green, g
  6377. Set the key points for the green component.
  6378. @item blue, b
  6379. Set the key points for the blue component.
  6380. @item all
  6381. Set the key points for all components (not including master).
  6382. Can be used in addition to the other key points component
  6383. options. In this case, the unset component(s) will fallback on this
  6384. @option{all} setting.
  6385. @item psfile
  6386. Specify a Photoshop curves file (@code{.acv}) to import the settings from.
  6387. @item plot
  6388. Save Gnuplot script of the curves in specified file.
  6389. @end table
  6390. To avoid some filtergraph syntax conflicts, each key points list need to be
  6391. defined using the following syntax: @code{x0/y0 x1/y1 x2/y2 ...}.
  6392. @subsection Examples
  6393. @itemize
  6394. @item
  6395. Increase slightly the middle level of blue:
  6396. @example
  6397. curves=blue='0/0 0.5/0.58 1/1'
  6398. @end example
  6399. @item
  6400. Vintage effect:
  6401. @example
  6402. curves=r='0/0.11 .42/.51 1/0.95':g='0/0 0.50/0.48 1/1':b='0/0.22 .49/.44 1/0.8'
  6403. @end example
  6404. Here we obtain the following coordinates for each components:
  6405. @table @var
  6406. @item red
  6407. @code{(0;0.11) (0.42;0.51) (1;0.95)}
  6408. @item green
  6409. @code{(0;0) (0.50;0.48) (1;1)}
  6410. @item blue
  6411. @code{(0;0.22) (0.49;0.44) (1;0.80)}
  6412. @end table
  6413. @item
  6414. The previous example can also be achieved with the associated built-in preset:
  6415. @example
  6416. curves=preset=vintage
  6417. @end example
  6418. @item
  6419. Or simply:
  6420. @example
  6421. curves=vintage
  6422. @end example
  6423. @item
  6424. Use a Photoshop preset and redefine the points of the green component:
  6425. @example
  6426. curves=psfile='MyCurvesPresets/purple.acv':green='0/0 0.45/0.53 1/1'
  6427. @end example
  6428. @item
  6429. Check out the curves of the @code{cross_process} profile using @command{ffmpeg}
  6430. and @command{gnuplot}:
  6431. @example
  6432. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i color -vf curves=cross_process:plot=/tmp/curves.plt -frames:v 1 -f null -
  6433. gnuplot -p /tmp/curves.plt
  6434. @end example
  6435. @end itemize
  6436. @section datascope
  6437. Video data analysis filter.
  6438. This filter shows hexadecimal pixel values of part of video.
  6439. The filter accepts the following options:
  6440. @table @option
  6441. @item size, s
  6442. Set output video size.
  6443. @item x
  6444. Set x offset from where to pick pixels.
  6445. @item y
  6446. Set y offset from where to pick pixels.
  6447. @item mode
  6448. Set scope mode, can be one of the following:
  6449. @table @samp
  6450. @item mono
  6451. Draw hexadecimal pixel values with white color on black background.
  6452. @item color
  6453. Draw hexadecimal pixel values with input video pixel color on black
  6454. background.
  6455. @item color2
  6456. Draw hexadecimal pixel values on color background picked from input video,
  6457. the text color is picked in such way so its always visible.
  6458. @end table
  6459. @item axis
  6460. Draw rows and columns numbers on left and top of video.
  6461. @item opacity
  6462. Set background opacity.
  6463. @item format
  6464. Set display number format. Can be @code{hex}, or @code{dec}. Default is @code{hex}.
  6465. @end table
  6466. @section dctdnoiz
  6467. Denoise frames using 2D DCT (frequency domain filtering).
  6468. This filter is not designed for real time.
  6469. The filter accepts the following options:
  6470. @table @option
  6471. @item sigma, s
  6472. Set the noise sigma constant.
  6473. This @var{sigma} defines a hard threshold of @code{3 * sigma}; every DCT
  6474. coefficient (absolute value) below this threshold with be dropped.
  6475. If you need a more advanced filtering, see @option{expr}.
  6476. Default is @code{0}.
  6477. @item overlap
  6478. Set number overlapping pixels for each block. Since the filter can be slow, you
  6479. may want to reduce this value, at the cost of a less effective filter and the
  6480. risk of various artefacts.
  6481. If the overlapping value doesn't permit processing the whole input width or
  6482. height, a warning will be displayed and according borders won't be denoised.
  6483. Default value is @var{blocksize}-1, which is the best possible setting.
  6484. @item expr, e
  6485. Set the coefficient factor expression.
  6486. For each coefficient of a DCT block, this expression will be evaluated as a
  6487. multiplier value for the coefficient.
  6488. If this is option is set, the @option{sigma} option will be ignored.
  6489. The absolute value of the coefficient can be accessed through the @var{c}
  6490. variable.
  6491. @item n
  6492. Set the @var{blocksize} using the number of bits. @code{1<<@var{n}} defines the
  6493. @var{blocksize}, which is the width and height of the processed blocks.
  6494. The default value is @var{3} (8x8) and can be raised to @var{4} for a
  6495. @var{blocksize} of 16x16. Note that changing this setting has huge consequences
  6496. on the speed processing. Also, a larger block size does not necessarily means a
  6497. better de-noising.
  6498. @end table
  6499. @subsection Examples
  6500. Apply a denoise with a @option{sigma} of @code{4.5}:
  6501. @example
  6502. dctdnoiz=4.5
  6503. @end example
  6504. The same operation can be achieved using the expression system:
  6505. @example
  6506. dctdnoiz=e='gte(c, 4.5*3)'
  6507. @end example
  6508. Violent denoise using a block size of @code{16x16}:
  6509. @example
  6510. dctdnoiz=15:n=4
  6511. @end example
  6512. @section deband
  6513. Remove banding artifacts from input video.
  6514. It works by replacing banded pixels with average value of referenced pixels.
  6515. The filter accepts the following options:
  6516. @table @option
  6517. @item 1thr
  6518. @item 2thr
  6519. @item 3thr
  6520. @item 4thr
  6521. Set banding detection threshold for each plane. Default is 0.02.
  6522. Valid range is 0.00003 to 0.5.
  6523. If difference between current pixel and reference pixel is less than threshold,
  6524. it will be considered as banded.
  6525. @item range, r
  6526. Banding detection range in pixels. Default is 16. If positive, random number
  6527. in range 0 to set value will be used. If negative, exact absolute value
  6528. will be used.
  6529. The range defines square of four pixels around current pixel.
  6530. @item direction, d
  6531. Set direction in radians from which four pixel will be compared. If positive,
  6532. random direction from 0 to set direction will be picked. If negative, exact of
  6533. absolute value will be picked. For example direction 0, -PI or -2*PI radians
  6534. will pick only pixels on same row and -PI/2 will pick only pixels on same
  6535. column.
  6536. @item blur, b
  6537. If enabled, current pixel is compared with average value of all four
  6538. surrounding pixels. The default is enabled. If disabled current pixel is
  6539. compared with all four surrounding pixels. The pixel is considered banded
  6540. if only all four differences with surrounding pixels are less than threshold.
  6541. @item coupling, c
  6542. If enabled, current pixel is changed if and only if all pixel components are banded,
  6543. e.g. banding detection threshold is triggered for all color components.
  6544. The default is disabled.
  6545. @end table
  6546. @section deblock
  6547. Remove blocking artifacts from input video.
  6548. The filter accepts the following options:
  6549. @table @option
  6550. @item filter
  6551. Set filter type, can be @var{weak} or @var{strong}. Default is @var{strong}.
  6552. This controls what kind of deblocking is applied.
  6553. @item block
  6554. Set size of block, allowed range is from 4 to 512. Default is @var{8}.
  6555. @item alpha
  6556. @item beta
  6557. @item gamma
  6558. @item delta
  6559. Set blocking detection thresholds. Allowed range is 0 to 1.
  6560. Defaults are: @var{0.098} for @var{alpha} and @var{0.05} for the rest.
  6561. Using higher threshold gives more deblocking strength.
  6562. Setting @var{alpha} controls threshold detection at exact edge of block.
  6563. Remaining options controls threshold detection near the edge. Each one for
  6564. below/above or left/right. Setting any of those to @var{0} disables
  6565. deblocking.
  6566. @item planes
  6567. Set planes to filter. Default is to filter all available planes.
  6568. @end table
  6569. @subsection Examples
  6570. @itemize
  6571. @item
  6572. Deblock using weak filter and block size of 4 pixels.
  6573. @example
  6574. deblock=filter=weak:block=4
  6575. @end example
  6576. @item
  6577. Deblock using strong filter, block size of 4 pixels and custom thresholds for
  6578. deblocking more edges.
  6579. @example
  6580. deblock=filter=strong:block=4:alpha=0.12:beta=0.07:gamma=0.06:delta=0.05
  6581. @end example
  6582. @item
  6583. Similar as above, but filter only first plane.
  6584. @example
  6585. deblock=filter=strong:block=4:alpha=0.12:beta=0.07:gamma=0.06:delta=0.05:planes=1
  6586. @end example
  6587. @item
  6588. Similar as above, but filter only second and third plane.
  6589. @example
  6590. deblock=filter=strong:block=4:alpha=0.12:beta=0.07:gamma=0.06:delta=0.05:planes=6
  6591. @end example
  6592. @end itemize
  6593. @anchor{decimate}
  6594. @section decimate
  6595. Drop duplicated frames at regular intervals.
  6596. The filter accepts the following options:
  6597. @table @option
  6598. @item cycle
  6599. Set the number of frames from which one will be dropped. Setting this to
  6600. @var{N} means one frame in every batch of @var{N} frames will be dropped.
  6601. Default is @code{5}.
  6602. @item dupthresh
  6603. Set the threshold for duplicate detection. If the difference metric for a frame
  6604. is less than or equal to this value, then it is declared as duplicate. Default
  6605. is @code{1.1}
  6606. @item scthresh
  6607. Set scene change threshold. Default is @code{15}.
  6608. @item blockx
  6609. @item blocky
  6610. Set the size of the x and y-axis blocks used during metric calculations.
  6611. Larger blocks give better noise suppression, but also give worse detection of
  6612. small movements. Must be a power of two. Default is @code{32}.
  6613. @item ppsrc
  6614. Mark main input as a pre-processed input and activate clean source input
  6615. stream. This allows the input to be pre-processed with various filters to help
  6616. the metrics calculation while keeping the frame selection lossless. When set to
  6617. @code{1}, the first stream is for the pre-processed input, and the second
  6618. stream is the clean source from where the kept frames are chosen. Default is
  6619. @code{0}.
  6620. @item chroma
  6621. Set whether or not chroma is considered in the metric calculations. Default is
  6622. @code{1}.
  6623. @end table
  6624. @section deconvolve
  6625. Apply 2D deconvolution of video stream in frequency domain using second stream
  6626. as impulse.
  6627. The filter accepts the following options:
  6628. @table @option
  6629. @item planes
  6630. Set which planes to process.
  6631. @item impulse
  6632. Set which impulse video frames will be processed, can be @var{first}
  6633. or @var{all}. Default is @var{all}.
  6634. @item noise
  6635. Set noise when doing divisions. Default is @var{0.0000001}. Useful when width
  6636. and height are not same and not power of 2 or if stream prior to convolving
  6637. had noise.
  6638. @end table
  6639. The @code{deconvolve} filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  6640. @section dedot
  6641. Reduce cross-luminance (dot-crawl) and cross-color (rainbows) from video.
  6642. It accepts the following options:
  6643. @table @option
  6644. @item m
  6645. Set mode of operation. Can be combination of @var{dotcrawl} for cross-luminance reduction and/or
  6646. @var{rainbows} for cross-color reduction.
  6647. @item lt
  6648. Set spatial luma threshold. Lower values increases reduction of cross-luminance.
  6649. @item tl
  6650. Set tolerance for temporal luma. Higher values increases reduction of cross-luminance.
  6651. @item tc
  6652. Set tolerance for chroma temporal variation. Higher values increases reduction of cross-color.
  6653. @item ct
  6654. Set temporal chroma threshold. Lower values increases reduction of cross-color.
  6655. @end table
  6656. @section deflate
  6657. Apply deflate effect to the video.
  6658. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) average by taking into account
  6659. only values lower than the pixel.
  6660. It accepts the following options:
  6661. @table @option
  6662. @item threshold0
  6663. @item threshold1
  6664. @item threshold2
  6665. @item threshold3
  6666. Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.
  6667. If 0, plane will remain unchanged.
  6668. @end table
  6669. @subsection Commands
  6670. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  6671. @section deflicker
  6672. Remove temporal frame luminance variations.
  6673. It accepts the following options:
  6674. @table @option
  6675. @item size, s
  6676. Set moving-average filter size in frames. Default is 5. Allowed range is 2 - 129.
  6677. @item mode, m
  6678. Set averaging mode to smooth temporal luminance variations.
  6679. Available values are:
  6680. @table @samp
  6681. @item am
  6682. Arithmetic mean
  6683. @item gm
  6684. Geometric mean
  6685. @item hm
  6686. Harmonic mean
  6687. @item qm
  6688. Quadratic mean
  6689. @item cm
  6690. Cubic mean
  6691. @item pm
  6692. Power mean
  6693. @item median
  6694. Median
  6695. @end table
  6696. @item bypass
  6697. Do not actually modify frame. Useful when one only wants metadata.
  6698. @end table
  6699. @section dejudder
  6700. Remove judder produced by partially interlaced telecined content.
  6701. Judder can be introduced, for instance, by @ref{pullup} filter. If the original
  6702. source was partially telecined content then the output of @code{pullup,dejudder}
  6703. will have a variable frame rate. May change the recorded frame rate of the
  6704. container. Aside from that change, this filter will not affect constant frame
  6705. rate video.
  6706. The option available in this filter is:
  6707. @table @option
  6708. @item cycle
  6709. Specify the length of the window over which the judder repeats.
  6710. Accepts any integer greater than 1. Useful values are:
  6711. @table @samp
  6712. @item 4
  6713. If the original was telecined from 24 to 30 fps (Film to NTSC).
  6714. @item 5
  6715. If the original was telecined from 25 to 30 fps (PAL to NTSC).
  6716. @item 20
  6717. If a mixture of the two.
  6718. @end table
  6719. The default is @samp{4}.
  6720. @end table
  6721. @section delogo
  6722. Suppress a TV station logo by a simple interpolation of the surrounding
  6723. pixels. Just set a rectangle covering the logo and watch it disappear
  6724. (and sometimes something even uglier appear - your mileage may vary).
  6725. It accepts the following parameters:
  6726. @table @option
  6727. @item x
  6728. @item y
  6729. Specify the top left corner coordinates of the logo. They must be
  6730. specified.
  6731. @item w
  6732. @item h
  6733. Specify the width and height of the logo to clear. They must be
  6734. specified.
  6735. @item band, t
  6736. Specify the thickness of the fuzzy edge of the rectangle (added to
  6737. @var{w} and @var{h}). The default value is 1. This option is
  6738. deprecated, setting higher values should no longer be necessary and
  6739. is not recommended.
  6740. @item show
  6741. When set to 1, a green rectangle is drawn on the screen to simplify
  6742. finding the right @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w}, and @var{h} parameters.
  6743. The default value is 0.
  6744. The rectangle is drawn on the outermost pixels which will be (partly)
  6745. replaced with interpolated values. The values of the next pixels
  6746. immediately outside this rectangle in each direction will be used to
  6747. compute the interpolated pixel values inside the rectangle.
  6748. @end table
  6749. @subsection Examples
  6750. @itemize
  6751. @item
  6752. Set a rectangle covering the area with top left corner coordinates 0,0
  6753. and size 100x77, and a band of size 10:
  6754. @example
  6755. delogo=x=0:y=0:w=100:h=77:band=10
  6756. @end example
  6757. @end itemize
  6758. @section derain
  6759. Remove the rain in the input image/video by applying the derain methods based on
  6760. convolutional neural networks. Supported models:
  6761. @itemize
  6762. @item
  6763. Recurrent Squeeze-and-Excitation Context Aggregation Net (RESCAN).
  6764. See @url{http://openaccess.thecvf.com/content_ECCV_2018/papers/Xia_Li_Recurrent_Squeeze-and-Excitation_Context_ECCV_2018_paper.pdf}.
  6765. @end itemize
  6766. Training as well as model generation scripts are provided in
  6767. the repository at @url{https://github.com/XueweiMeng/derain_filter.git}.
  6768. Native model files (.model) can be generated from TensorFlow model
  6769. files (.pb) by using tools/python/convert.py
  6770. The filter accepts the following options:
  6771. @table @option
  6772. @item filter_type
  6773. Specify which filter to use. This option accepts the following values:
  6774. @table @samp
  6775. @item derain
  6776. Derain filter. To conduct derain filter, you need to use a derain model.
  6777. @item dehaze
  6778. Dehaze filter. To conduct dehaze filter, you need to use a dehaze model.
  6779. @end table
  6780. Default value is @samp{derain}.
  6781. @item dnn_backend
  6782. Specify which DNN backend to use for model loading and execution. This option accepts
  6783. the following values:
  6784. @table @samp
  6785. @item native
  6786. Native implementation of DNN loading and execution.
  6787. @item tensorflow
  6788. TensorFlow backend. To enable this backend you
  6789. need to install the TensorFlow for C library (see
  6790. @url{https://www.tensorflow.org/install/install_c}) and configure FFmpeg with
  6791. @code{--enable-libtensorflow}
  6792. @end table
  6793. Default value is @samp{native}.
  6794. @item model
  6795. Set path to model file specifying network architecture and its parameters.
  6796. Note that different backends use different file formats. TensorFlow and native
  6797. backend can load files for only its format.
  6798. @end table
  6799. @section deshake
  6800. Attempt to fix small changes in horizontal and/or vertical shift. This
  6801. filter helps remove camera shake from hand-holding a camera, bumping a
  6802. tripod, moving on a vehicle, etc.
  6803. The filter accepts the following options:
  6804. @table @option
  6805. @item x
  6806. @item y
  6807. @item w
  6808. @item h
  6809. Specify a rectangular area where to limit the search for motion
  6810. vectors.
  6811. If desired the search for motion vectors can be limited to a
  6812. rectangular area of the frame defined by its top left corner, width
  6813. and height. These parameters have the same meaning as the drawbox
  6814. filter which can be used to visualise the position of the bounding
  6815. box.
  6816. This is useful when simultaneous movement of subjects within the frame
  6817. might be confused for camera motion by the motion vector search.
  6818. If any or all of @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w} and @var{h} are set to -1
  6819. then the full frame is used. This allows later options to be set
  6820. without specifying the bounding box for the motion vector search.
  6821. Default - search the whole frame.
  6822. @item rx
  6823. @item ry
  6824. Specify the maximum extent of movement in x and y directions in the
  6825. range 0-64 pixels. Default 16.
  6826. @item edge
  6827. Specify how to generate pixels to fill blanks at the edge of the
  6828. frame. Available values are:
  6829. @table @samp
  6830. @item blank, 0
  6831. Fill zeroes at blank locations
  6832. @item original, 1
  6833. Original image at blank locations
  6834. @item clamp, 2
  6835. Extruded edge value at blank locations
  6836. @item mirror, 3
  6837. Mirrored edge at blank locations
  6838. @end table
  6839. Default value is @samp{mirror}.
  6840. @item blocksize
  6841. Specify the blocksize to use for motion search. Range 4-128 pixels,
  6842. default 8.
  6843. @item contrast
  6844. Specify the contrast threshold for blocks. Only blocks with more than
  6845. the specified contrast (difference between darkest and lightest
  6846. pixels) will be considered. Range 1-255, default 125.
  6847. @item search
  6848. Specify the search strategy. Available values are:
  6849. @table @samp
  6850. @item exhaustive, 0
  6851. Set exhaustive search
  6852. @item less, 1
  6853. Set less exhaustive search.
  6854. @end table
  6855. Default value is @samp{exhaustive}.
  6856. @item filename
  6857. If set then a detailed log of the motion search is written to the
  6858. specified file.
  6859. @end table
  6860. @section despill
  6861. Remove unwanted contamination of foreground colors, caused by reflected color of
  6862. greenscreen or bluescreen.
  6863. This filter accepts the following options:
  6864. @table @option
  6865. @item type
  6866. Set what type of despill to use.
  6867. @item mix
  6868. Set how spillmap will be generated.
  6869. @item expand
  6870. Set how much to get rid of still remaining spill.
  6871. @item red
  6872. Controls amount of red in spill area.
  6873. @item green
  6874. Controls amount of green in spill area.
  6875. Should be -1 for greenscreen.
  6876. @item blue
  6877. Controls amount of blue in spill area.
  6878. Should be -1 for bluescreen.
  6879. @item brightness
  6880. Controls brightness of spill area, preserving colors.
  6881. @item alpha
  6882. Modify alpha from generated spillmap.
  6883. @end table
  6884. @section detelecine
  6885. Apply an exact inverse of the telecine operation. It requires a predefined
  6886. pattern specified using the pattern option which must be the same as that passed
  6887. to the telecine filter.
  6888. This filter accepts the following options:
  6889. @table @option
  6890. @item first_field
  6891. @table @samp
  6892. @item top, t
  6893. top field first
  6894. @item bottom, b
  6895. bottom field first
  6896. The default value is @code{top}.
  6897. @end table
  6898. @item pattern
  6899. A string of numbers representing the pulldown pattern you wish to apply.
  6900. The default value is @code{23}.
  6901. @item start_frame
  6902. A number representing position of the first frame with respect to the telecine
  6903. pattern. This is to be used if the stream is cut. The default value is @code{0}.
  6904. @end table
  6905. @section dilation
  6906. Apply dilation effect to the video.
  6907. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) maximum.
  6908. It accepts the following options:
  6909. @table @option
  6910. @item threshold0
  6911. @item threshold1
  6912. @item threshold2
  6913. @item threshold3
  6914. Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.
  6915. If 0, plane will remain unchanged.
  6916. @item coordinates
  6917. Flag which specifies the pixel to refer to. Default is 255 i.e. all eight
  6918. pixels are used.
  6919. Flags to local 3x3 coordinates maps like this:
  6920. 1 2 3
  6921. 4 5
  6922. 6 7 8
  6923. @end table
  6924. @subsection Commands
  6925. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  6926. @section displace
  6927. Displace pixels as indicated by second and third input stream.
  6928. It takes three input streams and outputs one stream, the first input is the
  6929. source, and second and third input are displacement maps.
  6930. The second input specifies how much to displace pixels along the
  6931. x-axis, while the third input specifies how much to displace pixels
  6932. along the y-axis.
  6933. If one of displacement map streams terminates, last frame from that
  6934. displacement map will be used.
  6935. Note that once generated, displacements maps can be reused over and over again.
  6936. A description of the accepted options follows.
  6937. @table @option
  6938. @item edge
  6939. Set displace behavior for pixels that are out of range.
  6940. Available values are:
  6941. @table @samp
  6942. @item blank
  6943. Missing pixels are replaced by black pixels.
  6944. @item smear
  6945. Adjacent pixels will spread out to replace missing pixels.
  6946. @item wrap
  6947. Out of range pixels are wrapped so they point to pixels of other side.
  6948. @item mirror
  6949. Out of range pixels will be replaced with mirrored pixels.
  6950. @end table
  6951. Default is @samp{smear}.
  6952. @end table
  6953. @subsection Examples
  6954. @itemize
  6955. @item
  6956. Add ripple effect to rgb input of video size hd720:
  6957. @example
  6958. ffmpeg -i INPUT -f lavfi -i nullsrc=s=hd720,lutrgb=128:128:128 -f lavfi -i nullsrc=s=hd720,geq='r=128+30*sin(2*PI*X/400+T):g=128+30*sin(2*PI*X/400+T):b=128+30*sin(2*PI*X/400+T)' -lavfi '[0][1][2]displace' OUTPUT
  6959. @end example
  6960. @item
  6961. Add wave effect to rgb input of video size hd720:
  6962. @example
  6963. ffmpeg -i INPUT -f lavfi -i nullsrc=hd720,geq='r=128+80*(sin(sqrt((X-W/2)*(X-W/2)+(Y-H/2)*(Y-H/2))/220*2*PI+T)):g=128+80*(sin(sqrt((X-W/2)*(X-W/2)+(Y-H/2)*(Y-H/2))/220*2*PI+T)):b=128+80*(sin(sqrt((X-W/2)*(X-W/2)+(Y-H/2)*(Y-H/2))/220*2*PI+T))' -lavfi '[1]split[x][y],[0][x][y]displace' OUTPUT
  6964. @end example
  6965. @end itemize
  6966. @section dnn_processing
  6967. Do image processing with deep neural networks. It works together with another filter
  6968. which converts the pixel format of the Frame to what the dnn network requires.
  6969. The filter accepts the following options:
  6970. @table @option
  6971. @item dnn_backend
  6972. Specify which DNN backend to use for model loading and execution. This option accepts
  6973. the following values:
  6974. @table @samp
  6975. @item native
  6976. Native implementation of DNN loading and execution.
  6977. @item tensorflow
  6978. TensorFlow backend. To enable this backend you
  6979. need to install the TensorFlow for C library (see
  6980. @url{https://www.tensorflow.org/install/install_c}) and configure FFmpeg with
  6981. @code{--enable-libtensorflow}
  6982. @end table
  6983. Default value is @samp{native}.
  6984. @item model
  6985. Set path to model file specifying network architecture and its parameters.
  6986. Note that different backends use different file formats. TensorFlow and native
  6987. backend can load files for only its format.
  6988. Native model file (.model) can be generated from TensorFlow model file (.pb) by using tools/python/convert.py
  6989. @item input
  6990. Set the input name of the dnn network.
  6991. @item output
  6992. Set the output name of the dnn network.
  6993. @end table
  6994. @itemize
  6995. @item
  6996. Halve the red channle of the frame with format rgb24:
  6997. @example
  6998. ffmpeg -i input.jpg -vf format=rgb24,dnn_processing=model=halve_first_channel.model:input=dnn_in:output=dnn_out:dnn_backend=native out.native.png
  6999. @end example
  7000. @item
  7001. Halve the pixel value of the frame with format gray32f:
  7002. @example
  7003. ffmpeg -i input.jpg -vf format=grayf32,dnn_processing=model=halve_gray_float.model:input=dnn_in:output=dnn_out:dnn_backend=native -y out.native.png
  7004. @end example
  7005. @end itemize
  7006. @section drawbox
  7007. Draw a colored box on the input image.
  7008. It accepts the following parameters:
  7009. @table @option
  7010. @item x
  7011. @item y
  7012. The expressions which specify the top left corner coordinates of the box. It defaults to 0.
  7013. @item width, w
  7014. @item height, h
  7015. The expressions which specify the width and height of the box; if 0 they are interpreted as
  7016. the input width and height. It defaults to 0.
  7017. @item color, c
  7018. Specify the color of the box to write. For the general syntax of this option,
  7019. check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}. If the special
  7020. value @code{invert} is used, the box edge color is the same as the
  7021. video with inverted luma.
  7022. @item thickness, t
  7023. The expression which sets the thickness of the box edge.
  7024. A value of @code{fill} will create a filled box. Default value is @code{3}.
  7025. See below for the list of accepted constants.
  7026. @item replace
  7027. Applicable if the input has alpha. With value @code{1}, the pixels of the painted box
  7028. will overwrite the video's color and alpha pixels.
  7029. Default is @code{0}, which composites the box onto the input, leaving the video's alpha intact.
  7030. @end table
  7031. The parameters for @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w} and @var{h} and @var{t} are expressions containing the
  7032. following constants:
  7033. @table @option
  7034. @item dar
  7035. The input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}.
  7036. @item hsub
  7037. @item vsub
  7038. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  7039. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  7040. @item in_h, ih
  7041. @item in_w, iw
  7042. The input width and height.
  7043. @item sar
  7044. The input sample aspect ratio.
  7045. @item x
  7046. @item y
  7047. The x and y offset coordinates where the box is drawn.
  7048. @item w
  7049. @item h
  7050. The width and height of the drawn box.
  7051. @item t
  7052. The thickness of the drawn box.
  7053. These constants allow the @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w}, @var{h} and @var{t} expressions to refer to
  7054. each other, so you may for example specify @code{y=x/dar} or @code{h=w/dar}.
  7055. @end table
  7056. @subsection Examples
  7057. @itemize
  7058. @item
  7059. Draw a black box around the edge of the input image:
  7060. @example
  7061. drawbox
  7062. @end example
  7063. @item
  7064. Draw a box with color red and an opacity of 50%:
  7065. @example
  7066. drawbox=10:20:200:60:red@@0.5
  7067. @end example
  7068. The previous example can be specified as:
  7069. @example
  7070. drawbox=x=10:y=20:w=200:h=60:color=red@@0.5
  7071. @end example
  7072. @item
  7073. Fill the box with pink color:
  7074. @example
  7075. drawbox=x=10:y=10:w=100:h=100:color=pink@@0.5:t=fill
  7076. @end example
  7077. @item
  7078. Draw a 2-pixel red 2.40:1 mask:
  7079. @example
  7080. drawbox=x=-t:y=0.5*(ih-iw/2.4)-t:w=iw+t*2:h=iw/2.4+t*2:t=2:c=red
  7081. @end example
  7082. @end itemize
  7083. @subsection Commands
  7084. This filter supports same commands as options.
  7085. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  7086. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  7087. value.
  7088. @anchor{drawgraph}
  7089. @section drawgraph
  7090. Draw a graph using input video metadata.
  7091. It accepts the following parameters:
  7092. @table @option
  7093. @item m1
  7094. Set 1st frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.
  7095. @item fg1
  7096. Set 1st foreground color expression.
  7097. @item m2
  7098. Set 2nd frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.
  7099. @item fg2
  7100. Set 2nd foreground color expression.
  7101. @item m3
  7102. Set 3rd frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.
  7103. @item fg3
  7104. Set 3rd foreground color expression.
  7105. @item m4
  7106. Set 4th frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.
  7107. @item fg4
  7108. Set 4th foreground color expression.
  7109. @item min
  7110. Set minimal value of metadata value.
  7111. @item max
  7112. Set maximal value of metadata value.
  7113. @item bg
  7114. Set graph background color. Default is white.
  7115. @item mode
  7116. Set graph mode.
  7117. Available values for mode is:
  7118. @table @samp
  7119. @item bar
  7120. @item dot
  7121. @item line
  7122. @end table
  7123. Default is @code{line}.
  7124. @item slide
  7125. Set slide mode.
  7126. Available values for slide is:
  7127. @table @samp
  7128. @item frame
  7129. Draw new frame when right border is reached.
  7130. @item replace
  7131. Replace old columns with new ones.
  7132. @item scroll
  7133. Scroll from right to left.
  7134. @item rscroll
  7135. Scroll from left to right.
  7136. @item picture
  7137. Draw single picture.
  7138. @end table
  7139. Default is @code{frame}.
  7140. @item size
  7141. Set size of graph video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  7142. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  7143. The default value is @code{900x256}.
  7144. @item rate, r
  7145. Set the output frame rate. Default value is @code{25}.
  7146. The foreground color expressions can use the following variables:
  7147. @table @option
  7148. @item MIN
  7149. Minimal value of metadata value.
  7150. @item MAX
  7151. Maximal value of metadata value.
  7152. @item VAL
  7153. Current metadata key value.
  7154. @end table
  7155. The color is defined as 0xAABBGGRR.
  7156. @end table
  7157. Example using metadata from @ref{signalstats} filter:
  7158. @example
  7159. signalstats,drawgraph=lavfi.signalstats.YAVG:min=0:max=255
  7160. @end example
  7161. Example using metadata from @ref{ebur128} filter:
  7162. @example
  7163. ebur128=metadata=1,adrawgraph=lavfi.r128.M:min=-120:max=5
  7164. @end example
  7165. @section drawgrid
  7166. Draw a grid on the input image.
  7167. It accepts the following parameters:
  7168. @table @option
  7169. @item x
  7170. @item y
  7171. The expressions which specify the coordinates of some point of grid intersection (meant to configure offset). Both default to 0.
  7172. @item width, w
  7173. @item height, h
  7174. The expressions which specify the width and height of the grid cell, if 0 they are interpreted as the
  7175. input width and height, respectively, minus @code{thickness}, so image gets
  7176. framed. Default to 0.
  7177. @item color, c
  7178. Specify the color of the grid. For the general syntax of this option,
  7179. check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}. If the special
  7180. value @code{invert} is used, the grid color is the same as the
  7181. video with inverted luma.
  7182. @item thickness, t
  7183. The expression which sets the thickness of the grid line. Default value is @code{1}.
  7184. See below for the list of accepted constants.
  7185. @item replace
  7186. Applicable if the input has alpha. With @code{1} the pixels of the painted grid
  7187. will overwrite the video's color and alpha pixels.
  7188. Default is @code{0}, which composites the grid onto the input, leaving the video's alpha intact.
  7189. @end table
  7190. The parameters for @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w} and @var{h} and @var{t} are expressions containing the
  7191. following constants:
  7192. @table @option
  7193. @item dar
  7194. The input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}.
  7195. @item hsub
  7196. @item vsub
  7197. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  7198. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  7199. @item in_h, ih
  7200. @item in_w, iw
  7201. The input grid cell width and height.
  7202. @item sar
  7203. The input sample aspect ratio.
  7204. @item x
  7205. @item y
  7206. The x and y coordinates of some point of grid intersection (meant to configure offset).
  7207. @item w
  7208. @item h
  7209. The width and height of the drawn cell.
  7210. @item t
  7211. The thickness of the drawn cell.
  7212. These constants allow the @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w}, @var{h} and @var{t} expressions to refer to
  7213. each other, so you may for example specify @code{y=x/dar} or @code{h=w/dar}.
  7214. @end table
  7215. @subsection Examples
  7216. @itemize
  7217. @item
  7218. Draw a grid with cell 100x100 pixels, thickness 2 pixels, with color red and an opacity of 50%:
  7219. @example
  7220. drawgrid=width=100:height=100:thickness=2:color=red@@0.5
  7221. @end example
  7222. @item
  7223. Draw a white 3x3 grid with an opacity of 50%:
  7224. @example
  7225. drawgrid=w=iw/3:h=ih/3:t=2:c=white@@0.5
  7226. @end example
  7227. @end itemize
  7228. @subsection Commands
  7229. This filter supports same commands as options.
  7230. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  7231. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  7232. value.
  7233. @anchor{drawtext}
  7234. @section drawtext
  7235. Draw a text string or text from a specified file on top of a video, using the
  7236. libfreetype library.
  7237. To enable compilation of this filter, you need to configure FFmpeg with
  7238. @code{--enable-libfreetype}.
  7239. To enable default font fallback and the @var{font} option you need to
  7240. configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-libfontconfig}.
  7241. To enable the @var{text_shaping} option, you need to configure FFmpeg with
  7242. @code{--enable-libfribidi}.
  7243. @subsection Syntax
  7244. It accepts the following parameters:
  7245. @table @option
  7246. @item box
  7247. Used to draw a box around text using the background color.
  7248. The value must be either 1 (enable) or 0 (disable).
  7249. The default value of @var{box} is 0.
  7250. @item boxborderw
  7251. Set the width of the border to be drawn around the box using @var{boxcolor}.
  7252. The default value of @var{boxborderw} is 0.
  7253. @item boxcolor
  7254. The color to be used for drawing box around text. For the syntax of this
  7255. option, check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  7256. The default value of @var{boxcolor} is "white".
  7257. @item line_spacing
  7258. Set the line spacing in pixels of the border to be drawn around the box using @var{box}.
  7259. The default value of @var{line_spacing} is 0.
  7260. @item borderw
  7261. Set the width of the border to be drawn around the text using @var{bordercolor}.
  7262. The default value of @var{borderw} is 0.
  7263. @item bordercolor
  7264. Set the color to be used for drawing border around text. For the syntax of this
  7265. option, check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  7266. The default value of @var{bordercolor} is "black".
  7267. @item expansion
  7268. Select how the @var{text} is expanded. Can be either @code{none},
  7269. @code{strftime} (deprecated) or
  7270. @code{normal} (default). See the @ref{drawtext_expansion, Text expansion} section
  7271. below for details.
  7272. @item basetime
  7273. Set a start time for the count. Value is in microseconds. Only applied
  7274. in the deprecated strftime expansion mode. To emulate in normal expansion
  7275. mode use the @code{pts} function, supplying the start time (in seconds)
  7276. as the second argument.
  7277. @item fix_bounds
  7278. If true, check and fix text coords to avoid clipping.
  7279. @item fontcolor
  7280. The color to be used for drawing fonts. For the syntax of this option, check
  7281. the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  7282. The default value of @var{fontcolor} is "black".
  7283. @item fontcolor_expr
  7284. String which is expanded the same way as @var{text} to obtain dynamic
  7285. @var{fontcolor} value. By default this option has empty value and is not
  7286. processed. When this option is set, it overrides @var{fontcolor} option.
  7287. @item font
  7288. The font family to be used for drawing text. By default Sans.
  7289. @item fontfile
  7290. The font file to be used for drawing text. The path must be included.
  7291. This parameter is mandatory if the fontconfig support is disabled.
  7292. @item alpha
  7293. Draw the text applying alpha blending. The value can
  7294. be a number between 0.0 and 1.0.
  7295. The expression accepts the same variables @var{x, y} as well.
  7296. The default value is 1.
  7297. Please see @var{fontcolor_expr}.
  7298. @item fontsize
  7299. The font size to be used for drawing text.
  7300. The default value of @var{fontsize} is 16.
  7301. @item text_shaping
  7302. If set to 1, attempt to shape the text (for example, reverse the order of
  7303. right-to-left text and join Arabic characters) before drawing it.
  7304. Otherwise, just draw the text exactly as given.
  7305. By default 1 (if supported).
  7306. @item ft_load_flags
  7307. The flags to be used for loading the fonts.
  7308. The flags map the corresponding flags supported by libfreetype, and are
  7309. a combination of the following values:
  7310. @table @var
  7311. @item default
  7312. @item no_scale
  7313. @item no_hinting
  7314. @item render
  7315. @item no_bitmap
  7316. @item vertical_layout
  7317. @item force_autohint
  7318. @item crop_bitmap
  7319. @item pedantic
  7320. @item ignore_global_advance_width
  7321. @item no_recurse
  7322. @item ignore_transform
  7323. @item monochrome
  7324. @item linear_design
  7325. @item no_autohint
  7326. @end table
  7327. Default value is "default".
  7328. For more information consult the documentation for the FT_LOAD_*
  7329. libfreetype flags.
  7330. @item shadowcolor
  7331. The color to be used for drawing a shadow behind the drawn text. For the
  7332. syntax of this option, check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the
  7333. ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  7334. The default value of @var{shadowcolor} is "black".
  7335. @item shadowx
  7336. @item shadowy
  7337. The x and y offsets for the text shadow position with respect to the
  7338. position of the text. They can be either positive or negative
  7339. values. The default value for both is "0".
  7340. @item start_number
  7341. The starting frame number for the n/frame_num variable. The default value
  7342. is "0".
  7343. @item tabsize
  7344. The size in number of spaces to use for rendering the tab.
  7345. Default value is 4.
  7346. @item timecode
  7347. Set the initial timecode representation in "hh:mm:ss[:;.]ff"
  7348. format. It can be used with or without text parameter. @var{timecode_rate}
  7349. option must be specified.
  7350. @item timecode_rate, rate, r
  7351. Set the timecode frame rate (timecode only). Value will be rounded to nearest
  7352. integer. Minimum value is "1".
  7353. Drop-frame timecode is supported for frame rates 30 & 60.
  7354. @item tc24hmax
  7355. If set to 1, the output of the timecode option will wrap around at 24 hours.
  7356. Default is 0 (disabled).
  7357. @item text
  7358. The text string to be drawn. The text must be a sequence of UTF-8
  7359. encoded characters.
  7360. This parameter is mandatory if no file is specified with the parameter
  7361. @var{textfile}.
  7362. @item textfile
  7363. A text file containing text to be drawn. The text must be a sequence
  7364. of UTF-8 encoded characters.
  7365. This parameter is mandatory if no text string is specified with the
  7366. parameter @var{text}.
  7367. If both @var{text} and @var{textfile} are specified, an error is thrown.
  7368. @item reload
  7369. If set to 1, the @var{textfile} will be reloaded before each frame.
  7370. Be sure to update it atomically, or it may be read partially, or even fail.
  7371. @item x
  7372. @item y
  7373. The expressions which specify the offsets where text will be drawn
  7374. within the video frame. They are relative to the top/left border of the
  7375. output image.
  7376. The default value of @var{x} and @var{y} is "0".
  7377. See below for the list of accepted constants and functions.
  7378. @end table
  7379. The parameters for @var{x} and @var{y} are expressions containing the
  7380. following constants and functions:
  7381. @table @option
  7382. @item dar
  7383. input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}
  7384. @item hsub
  7385. @item vsub
  7386. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  7387. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  7388. @item line_h, lh
  7389. the height of each text line
  7390. @item main_h, h, H
  7391. the input height
  7392. @item main_w, w, W
  7393. the input width
  7394. @item max_glyph_a, ascent
  7395. the maximum distance from the baseline to the highest/upper grid
  7396. coordinate used to place a glyph outline point, for all the rendered
  7397. glyphs.
  7398. It is a positive value, due to the grid's orientation with the Y axis
  7399. upwards.
  7400. @item max_glyph_d, descent
  7401. the maximum distance from the baseline to the lowest grid coordinate
  7402. used to place a glyph outline point, for all the rendered glyphs.
  7403. This is a negative value, due to the grid's orientation, with the Y axis
  7404. upwards.
  7405. @item max_glyph_h
  7406. maximum glyph height, that is the maximum height for all the glyphs
  7407. contained in the rendered text, it is equivalent to @var{ascent} -
  7408. @var{descent}.
  7409. @item max_glyph_w
  7410. maximum glyph width, that is the maximum width for all the glyphs
  7411. contained in the rendered text
  7412. @item n
  7413. the number of input frame, starting from 0
  7414. @item rand(min, max)
  7415. return a random number included between @var{min} and @var{max}
  7416. @item sar
  7417. The input sample aspect ratio.
  7418. @item t
  7419. timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown
  7420. @item text_h, th
  7421. the height of the rendered text
  7422. @item text_w, tw
  7423. the width of the rendered text
  7424. @item x
  7425. @item y
  7426. the x and y offset coordinates where the text is drawn.
  7427. These parameters allow the @var{x} and @var{y} expressions to refer
  7428. to each other, so you can for example specify @code{y=x/dar}.
  7429. @item pict_type
  7430. A one character description of the current frame's picture type.
  7431. @item pkt_pos
  7432. The current packet's position in the input file or stream
  7433. (in bytes, from the start of the input). A value of -1 indicates
  7434. this info is not available.
  7435. @item pkt_duration
  7436. The current packet's duration, in seconds.
  7437. @item pkt_size
  7438. The current packet's size (in bytes).
  7439. @end table
  7440. @anchor{drawtext_expansion}
  7441. @subsection Text expansion
  7442. If @option{expansion} is set to @code{strftime},
  7443. the filter recognizes strftime() sequences in the provided text and
  7444. expands them accordingly. Check the documentation of strftime(). This
  7445. feature is deprecated.
  7446. If @option{expansion} is set to @code{none}, the text is printed verbatim.
  7447. If @option{expansion} is set to @code{normal} (which is the default),
  7448. the following expansion mechanism is used.
  7449. The backslash character @samp{\}, followed by any character, always expands to
  7450. the second character.
  7451. Sequences of the form @code{%@{...@}} are expanded. The text between the
  7452. braces is a function name, possibly followed by arguments separated by ':'.
  7453. If the arguments contain special characters or delimiters (':' or '@}'),
  7454. they should be escaped.
  7455. Note that they probably must also be escaped as the value for the
  7456. @option{text} option in the filter argument string and as the filter
  7457. argument in the filtergraph description, and possibly also for the shell,
  7458. that makes up to four levels of escaping; using a text file avoids these
  7459. problems.
  7460. The following functions are available:
  7461. @table @command
  7462. @item expr, e
  7463. The expression evaluation result.
  7464. It must take one argument specifying the expression to be evaluated,
  7465. which accepts the same constants and functions as the @var{x} and
  7466. @var{y} values. Note that not all constants should be used, for
  7467. example the text size is not known when evaluating the expression, so
  7468. the constants @var{text_w} and @var{text_h} will have an undefined
  7469. value.
  7470. @item expr_int_format, eif
  7471. Evaluate the expression's value and output as formatted integer.
  7472. The first argument is the expression to be evaluated, just as for the @var{expr} function.
  7473. The second argument specifies the output format. Allowed values are @samp{x},
  7474. @samp{X}, @samp{d} and @samp{u}. They are treated exactly as in the
  7475. @code{printf} function.
  7476. The third parameter is optional and sets the number of positions taken by the output.
  7477. It can be used to add padding with zeros from the left.
  7478. @item gmtime
  7479. The time at which the filter is running, expressed in UTC.
  7480. It can accept an argument: a strftime() format string.
  7481. @item localtime
  7482. The time at which the filter is running, expressed in the local time zone.
  7483. It can accept an argument: a strftime() format string.
  7484. @item metadata
  7485. Frame metadata. Takes one or two arguments.
  7486. The first argument is mandatory and specifies the metadata key.
  7487. The second argument is optional and specifies a default value, used when the
  7488. metadata key is not found or empty.
  7489. Available metadata can be identified by inspecting entries
  7490. starting with TAG included within each frame section
  7491. printed by running @code{ffprobe -show_frames}.
  7492. String metadata generated in filters leading to
  7493. the drawtext filter are also available.
  7494. @item n, frame_num
  7495. The frame number, starting from 0.
  7496. @item pict_type
  7497. A one character description of the current picture type.
  7498. @item pts
  7499. The timestamp of the current frame.
  7500. It can take up to three arguments.
  7501. The first argument is the format of the timestamp; it defaults to @code{flt}
  7502. for seconds as a decimal number with microsecond accuracy; @code{hms} stands
  7503. for a formatted @var{[-]HH:MM:SS.mmm} timestamp with millisecond accuracy.
  7504. @code{gmtime} stands for the timestamp of the frame formatted as UTC time;
  7505. @code{localtime} stands for the timestamp of the frame formatted as
  7506. local time zone time.
  7507. The second argument is an offset added to the timestamp.
  7508. If the format is set to @code{hms}, a third argument @code{24HH} may be
  7509. supplied to present the hour part of the formatted timestamp in 24h format
  7510. (00-23).
  7511. If the format is set to @code{localtime} or @code{gmtime},
  7512. a third argument may be supplied: a strftime() format string.
  7513. By default, @var{YYYY-MM-DD HH:MM:SS} format will be used.
  7514. @end table
  7515. @subsection Commands
  7516. This filter supports altering parameters via commands:
  7517. @table @option
  7518. @item reinit
  7519. Alter existing filter parameters.
  7520. Syntax for the argument is the same as for filter invocation, e.g.
  7521. @example
  7522. fontsize=56:fontcolor=green:text='Hello World'
  7523. @end example
  7524. Full filter invocation with sendcmd would look like this:
  7525. @example
  7526. sendcmd=c='56.0 drawtext reinit fontsize=56\:fontcolor=green\:text=Hello\\ World'
  7527. @end example
  7528. @end table
  7529. If the entire argument can't be parsed or applied as valid values then the filter will
  7530. continue with its existing parameters.
  7531. @subsection Examples
  7532. @itemize
  7533. @item
  7534. Draw "Test Text" with font FreeSerif, using the default values for the
  7535. optional parameters.
  7536. @example
  7537. drawtext="fontfile=/usr/share/fonts/truetype/freefont/FreeSerif.ttf: text='Test Text'"
  7538. @end example
  7539. @item
  7540. Draw 'Test Text' with font FreeSerif of size 24 at position x=100
  7541. and y=50 (counting from the top-left corner of the screen), text is
  7542. yellow with a red box around it. Both the text and the box have an
  7543. opacity of 20%.
  7544. @example
  7545. drawtext="fontfile=/usr/share/fonts/truetype/freefont/FreeSerif.ttf: text='Test Text':\
  7546. x=100: y=50: fontsize=24: fontcolor=yellow@@0.2: box=1: boxcolor=red@@0.2"
  7547. @end example
  7548. Note that the double quotes are not necessary if spaces are not used
  7549. within the parameter list.
  7550. @item
  7551. Show the text at the center of the video frame:
  7552. @example
  7553. drawtext="fontsize=30:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text='hello world':x=(w-text_w)/2:y=(h-text_h)/2"
  7554. @end example
  7555. @item
  7556. Show the text at a random position, switching to a new position every 30 seconds:
  7557. @example
  7558. drawtext="fontsize=30:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text='hello world':x=if(eq(mod(t\,30)\,0)\,rand(0\,(w-text_w))\,x):y=if(eq(mod(t\,30)\,0)\,rand(0\,(h-text_h))\,y)"
  7559. @end example
  7560. @item
  7561. Show a text line sliding from right to left in the last row of the video
  7562. frame. The file @file{LONG_LINE} is assumed to contain a single line
  7563. with no newlines.
  7564. @example
  7565. drawtext="fontsize=15:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=LONG_LINE:y=h-line_h:x=-50*t"
  7566. @end example
  7567. @item
  7568. Show the content of file @file{CREDITS} off the bottom of the frame and scroll up.
  7569. @example
  7570. drawtext="fontsize=20:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:textfile=CREDITS:y=h-20*t"
  7571. @end example
  7572. @item
  7573. Draw a single green letter "g", at the center of the input video.
  7574. The glyph baseline is placed at half screen height.
  7575. @example
  7576. drawtext="fontsize=60:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:fontcolor=green:text=g:x=(w-max_glyph_w)/2:y=h/2-ascent"
  7577. @end example
  7578. @item
  7579. Show text for 1 second every 3 seconds:
  7580. @example
  7581. drawtext="fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:fontcolor=white:x=100:y=x/dar:enable=lt(mod(t\,3)\,1):text='blink'"
  7582. @end example
  7583. @item
  7584. Use fontconfig to set the font. Note that the colons need to be escaped.
  7585. @example
  7586. drawtext='fontfile=Linux Libertine O-40\:style=Semibold:text=FFmpeg'
  7587. @end example
  7588. @item
  7589. Print the date of a real-time encoding (see strftime(3)):
  7590. @example
  7591. drawtext='fontfile=FreeSans.ttf:text=%@{localtime\:%a %b %d %Y@}'
  7592. @end example
  7593. @item
  7594. Show text fading in and out (appearing/disappearing):
  7595. @example
  7596. #!/bin/sh
  7597. DS=1.0 # display start
  7598. DE=10.0 # display end
  7599. FID=1.5 # fade in duration
  7600. FOD=5 # fade out duration
  7601. ffplay -f lavfi "color,drawtext=text=TEST:fontsize=50:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:fontcolor_expr=ff0000%@{eif\\\\: clip(255*(1*between(t\\, $DS + $FID\\, $DE - $FOD) + ((t - $DS)/$FID)*between(t\\, $DS\\, $DS + $FID) + (-(t - $DE)/$FOD)*between(t\\, $DE - $FOD\\, $DE) )\\, 0\\, 255) \\\\: x\\\\: 2 @}"
  7602. @end example
  7603. @item
  7604. Horizontally align multiple separate texts. Note that @option{max_glyph_a}
  7605. and the @option{fontsize} value are included in the @option{y} offset.
  7606. @example
  7607. drawtext=fontfile=FreeSans.ttf:text=DOG:fontsize=24:x=10:y=20+24-max_glyph_a,
  7608. drawtext=fontfile=FreeSans.ttf:text=cow:fontsize=24:x=80:y=20+24-max_glyph_a
  7609. @end example
  7610. @item
  7611. Plot special @var{lavf.image2dec.source_basename} metadata onto each frame if
  7612. such metadata exists. Otherwise, plot the string "NA". Note that image2 demuxer
  7613. must have option @option{-export_path_metadata 1} for the special metadata fields
  7614. to be available for filters.
  7615. @example
  7616. drawtext="fontsize=20:fontcolor=white:fontfile=FreeSans.ttf:text='%@{metadata\:lavf.image2dec.source_basename\:NA@}':x=10:y=10"
  7617. @end example
  7618. @end itemize
  7619. For more information about libfreetype, check:
  7620. @url{http://www.freetype.org/}.
  7621. For more information about fontconfig, check:
  7622. @url{http://freedesktop.org/software/fontconfig/fontconfig-user.html}.
  7623. For more information about libfribidi, check:
  7624. @url{http://fribidi.org/}.
  7625. @section edgedetect
  7626. Detect and draw edges. The filter uses the Canny Edge Detection algorithm.
  7627. The filter accepts the following options:
  7628. @table @option
  7629. @item low
  7630. @item high
  7631. Set low and high threshold values used by the Canny thresholding
  7632. algorithm.
  7633. The high threshold selects the "strong" edge pixels, which are then
  7634. connected through 8-connectivity with the "weak" edge pixels selected
  7635. by the low threshold.
  7636. @var{low} and @var{high} threshold values must be chosen in the range
  7637. [0,1], and @var{low} should be lesser or equal to @var{high}.
  7638. Default value for @var{low} is @code{20/255}, and default value for @var{high}
  7639. is @code{50/255}.
  7640. @item mode
  7641. Define the drawing mode.
  7642. @table @samp
  7643. @item wires
  7644. Draw white/gray wires on black background.
  7645. @item colormix
  7646. Mix the colors to create a paint/cartoon effect.
  7647. @item canny
  7648. Apply Canny edge detector on all selected planes.
  7649. @end table
  7650. Default value is @var{wires}.
  7651. @item planes
  7652. Select planes for filtering. By default all available planes are filtered.
  7653. @end table
  7654. @subsection Examples
  7655. @itemize
  7656. @item
  7657. Standard edge detection with custom values for the hysteresis thresholding:
  7658. @example
  7659. edgedetect=low=0.1:high=0.4
  7660. @end example
  7661. @item
  7662. Painting effect without thresholding:
  7663. @example
  7664. edgedetect=mode=colormix:high=0
  7665. @end example
  7666. @end itemize
  7667. @section elbg
  7668. Apply a posterize effect using the ELBG (Enhanced LBG) algorithm.
  7669. For each input image, the filter will compute the optimal mapping from
  7670. the input to the output given the codebook length, that is the number
  7671. of distinct output colors.
  7672. This filter accepts the following options.
  7673. @table @option
  7674. @item codebook_length, l
  7675. Set codebook length. The value must be a positive integer, and
  7676. represents the number of distinct output colors. Default value is 256.
  7677. @item nb_steps, n
  7678. Set the maximum number of iterations to apply for computing the optimal
  7679. mapping. The higher the value the better the result and the higher the
  7680. computation time. Default value is 1.
  7681. @item seed, s
  7682. Set a random seed, must be an integer included between 0 and
  7683. UINT32_MAX. If not specified, or if explicitly set to -1, the filter
  7684. will try to use a good random seed on a best effort basis.
  7685. @item pal8
  7686. Set pal8 output pixel format. This option does not work with codebook
  7687. length greater than 256.
  7688. @end table
  7689. @section entropy
  7690. Measure graylevel entropy in histogram of color channels of video frames.
  7691. It accepts the following parameters:
  7692. @table @option
  7693. @item mode
  7694. Can be either @var{normal} or @var{diff}. Default is @var{normal}.
  7695. @var{diff} mode measures entropy of histogram delta values, absolute differences
  7696. between neighbour histogram values.
  7697. @end table
  7698. @section eq
  7699. Set brightness, contrast, saturation and approximate gamma adjustment.
  7700. The filter accepts the following options:
  7701. @table @option
  7702. @item contrast
  7703. Set the contrast expression. The value must be a float value in range
  7704. @code{-1000.0} to @code{1000.0}. The default value is "1".
  7705. @item brightness
  7706. Set the brightness expression. The value must be a float value in
  7707. range @code{-1.0} to @code{1.0}. The default value is "0".
  7708. @item saturation
  7709. Set the saturation expression. The value must be a float in
  7710. range @code{0.0} to @code{3.0}. The default value is "1".
  7711. @item gamma
  7712. Set the gamma expression. The value must be a float in range
  7713. @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}. The default value is "1".
  7714. @item gamma_r
  7715. Set the gamma expression for red. The value must be a float in
  7716. range @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}. The default value is "1".
  7717. @item gamma_g
  7718. Set the gamma expression for green. The value must be a float in range
  7719. @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}. The default value is "1".
  7720. @item gamma_b
  7721. Set the gamma expression for blue. The value must be a float in range
  7722. @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}. The default value is "1".
  7723. @item gamma_weight
  7724. Set the gamma weight expression. It can be used to reduce the effect
  7725. of a high gamma value on bright image areas, e.g. keep them from
  7726. getting overamplified and just plain white. The value must be a float
  7727. in range @code{0.0} to @code{1.0}. A value of @code{0.0} turns the
  7728. gamma correction all the way down while @code{1.0} leaves it at its
  7729. full strength. Default is "1".
  7730. @item eval
  7731. Set when the expressions for brightness, contrast, saturation and
  7732. gamma expressions are evaluated.
  7733. It accepts the following values:
  7734. @table @samp
  7735. @item init
  7736. only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or
  7737. when a command is processed
  7738. @item frame
  7739. evaluate expressions for each incoming frame
  7740. @end table
  7741. Default value is @samp{init}.
  7742. @end table
  7743. The expressions accept the following parameters:
  7744. @table @option
  7745. @item n
  7746. frame count of the input frame starting from 0
  7747. @item pos
  7748. byte position of the corresponding packet in the input file, NAN if
  7749. unspecified
  7750. @item r
  7751. frame rate of the input video, NAN if the input frame rate is unknown
  7752. @item t
  7753. timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown
  7754. @end table
  7755. @subsection Commands
  7756. The filter supports the following commands:
  7757. @table @option
  7758. @item contrast
  7759. Set the contrast expression.
  7760. @item brightness
  7761. Set the brightness expression.
  7762. @item saturation
  7763. Set the saturation expression.
  7764. @item gamma
  7765. Set the gamma expression.
  7766. @item gamma_r
  7767. Set the gamma_r expression.
  7768. @item gamma_g
  7769. Set gamma_g expression.
  7770. @item gamma_b
  7771. Set gamma_b expression.
  7772. @item gamma_weight
  7773. Set gamma_weight expression.
  7774. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  7775. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  7776. value.
  7777. @end table
  7778. @section erosion
  7779. Apply erosion effect to the video.
  7780. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) minimum.
  7781. It accepts the following options:
  7782. @table @option
  7783. @item threshold0
  7784. @item threshold1
  7785. @item threshold2
  7786. @item threshold3
  7787. Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.
  7788. If 0, plane will remain unchanged.
  7789. @item coordinates
  7790. Flag which specifies the pixel to refer to. Default is 255 i.e. all eight
  7791. pixels are used.
  7792. Flags to local 3x3 coordinates maps like this:
  7793. 1 2 3
  7794. 4 5
  7795. 6 7 8
  7796. @end table
  7797. @subsection Commands
  7798. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  7799. @section extractplanes
  7800. Extract color channel components from input video stream into
  7801. separate grayscale video streams.
  7802. The filter accepts the following option:
  7803. @table @option
  7804. @item planes
  7805. Set plane(s) to extract.
  7806. Available values for planes are:
  7807. @table @samp
  7808. @item y
  7809. @item u
  7810. @item v
  7811. @item a
  7812. @item r
  7813. @item g
  7814. @item b
  7815. @end table
  7816. Choosing planes not available in the input will result in an error.
  7817. That means you cannot select @code{r}, @code{g}, @code{b} planes
  7818. with @code{y}, @code{u}, @code{v} planes at same time.
  7819. @end table
  7820. @subsection Examples
  7821. @itemize
  7822. @item
  7823. Extract luma, u and v color channel component from input video frame
  7824. into 3 grayscale outputs:
  7825. @example
  7826. ffmpeg -i video.avi -filter_complex 'extractplanes=y+u+v[y][u][v]' -map '[y]' y.avi -map '[u]' u.avi -map '[v]' v.avi
  7827. @end example
  7828. @end itemize
  7829. @section fade
  7830. Apply a fade-in/out effect to the input video.
  7831. It accepts the following parameters:
  7832. @table @option
  7833. @item type, t
  7834. The effect type can be either "in" for a fade-in, or "out" for a fade-out
  7835. effect.
  7836. Default is @code{in}.
  7837. @item start_frame, s
  7838. Specify the number of the frame to start applying the fade
  7839. effect at. Default is 0.
  7840. @item nb_frames, n
  7841. The number of frames that the fade effect lasts. At the end of the
  7842. fade-in effect, the output video will have the same intensity as the input video.
  7843. At the end of the fade-out transition, the output video will be filled with the
  7844. selected @option{color}.
  7845. Default is 25.
  7846. @item alpha
  7847. If set to 1, fade only alpha channel, if one exists on the input.
  7848. Default value is 0.
  7849. @item start_time, st
  7850. Specify the timestamp (in seconds) of the frame to start to apply the fade
  7851. effect. If both start_frame and start_time are specified, the fade will start at
  7852. whichever comes last. Default is 0.
  7853. @item duration, d
  7854. The number of seconds for which the fade effect has to last. At the end of the
  7855. fade-in effect the output video will have the same intensity as the input video,
  7856. at the end of the fade-out transition the output video will be filled with the
  7857. selected @option{color}.
  7858. If both duration and nb_frames are specified, duration is used. Default is 0
  7859. (nb_frames is used by default).
  7860. @item color, c
  7861. Specify the color of the fade. Default is "black".
  7862. @end table
  7863. @subsection Examples
  7864. @itemize
  7865. @item
  7866. Fade in the first 30 frames of video:
  7867. @example
  7868. fade=in:0:30
  7869. @end example
  7870. The command above is equivalent to:
  7871. @example
  7872. fade=t=in:s=0:n=30
  7873. @end example
  7874. @item
  7875. Fade out the last 45 frames of a 200-frame video:
  7876. @example
  7877. fade=out:155:45
  7878. fade=type=out:start_frame=155:nb_frames=45
  7879. @end example
  7880. @item
  7881. Fade in the first 25 frames and fade out the last 25 frames of a 1000-frame video:
  7882. @example
  7883. fade=in:0:25, fade=out:975:25
  7884. @end example
  7885. @item
  7886. Make the first 5 frames yellow, then fade in from frame 5-24:
  7887. @example
  7888. fade=in:5:20:color=yellow
  7889. @end example
  7890. @item
  7891. Fade in alpha over first 25 frames of video:
  7892. @example
  7893. fade=in:0:25:alpha=1
  7894. @end example
  7895. @item
  7896. Make the first 5.5 seconds black, then fade in for 0.5 seconds:
  7897. @example
  7898. fade=t=in:st=5.5:d=0.5
  7899. @end example
  7900. @end itemize
  7901. @section fftdnoiz
  7902. Denoise frames using 3D FFT (frequency domain filtering).
  7903. The filter accepts the following options:
  7904. @table @option
  7905. @item sigma
  7906. Set the noise sigma constant. This sets denoising strength.
  7907. Default value is 1. Allowed range is from 0 to 30.
  7908. Using very high sigma with low overlap may give blocking artifacts.
  7909. @item amount
  7910. Set amount of denoising. By default all detected noise is reduced.
  7911. Default value is 1. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  7912. @item block
  7913. Set size of block, Default is 4, can be 3, 4, 5 or 6.
  7914. Actual size of block in pixels is 2 to power of @var{block}, so by default
  7915. block size in pixels is 2^4 which is 16.
  7916. @item overlap
  7917. Set block overlap. Default is 0.5. Allowed range is from 0.2 to 0.8.
  7918. @item prev
  7919. Set number of previous frames to use for denoising. By default is set to 0.
  7920. @item next
  7921. Set number of next frames to to use for denoising. By default is set to 0.
  7922. @item planes
  7923. Set planes which will be filtered, by default are all available filtered
  7924. except alpha.
  7925. @end table
  7926. @section fftfilt
  7927. Apply arbitrary expressions to samples in frequency domain
  7928. @table @option
  7929. @item dc_Y
  7930. Adjust the dc value (gain) of the luma plane of the image. The filter
  7931. accepts an integer value in range @code{0} to @code{1000}. The default
  7932. value is set to @code{0}.
  7933. @item dc_U
  7934. Adjust the dc value (gain) of the 1st chroma plane of the image. The
  7935. filter accepts an integer value in range @code{0} to @code{1000}. The
  7936. default value is set to @code{0}.
  7937. @item dc_V
  7938. Adjust the dc value (gain) of the 2nd chroma plane of the image. The
  7939. filter accepts an integer value in range @code{0} to @code{1000}. The
  7940. default value is set to @code{0}.
  7941. @item weight_Y
  7942. Set the frequency domain weight expression for the luma plane.
  7943. @item weight_U
  7944. Set the frequency domain weight expression for the 1st chroma plane.
  7945. @item weight_V
  7946. Set the frequency domain weight expression for the 2nd chroma plane.
  7947. @item eval
  7948. Set when the expressions are evaluated.
  7949. It accepts the following values:
  7950. @table @samp
  7951. @item init
  7952. Only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization.
  7953. @item frame
  7954. Evaluate expressions for each incoming frame.
  7955. @end table
  7956. Default value is @samp{init}.
  7957. The filter accepts the following variables:
  7958. @item X
  7959. @item Y
  7960. The coordinates of the current sample.
  7961. @item W
  7962. @item H
  7963. The width and height of the image.
  7964. @item N
  7965. The number of input frame, starting from 0.
  7966. @end table
  7967. @subsection Examples
  7968. @itemize
  7969. @item
  7970. High-pass:
  7971. @example
  7972. fftfilt=dc_Y=128:weight_Y='squish(1-(Y+X)/100)'
  7973. @end example
  7974. @item
  7975. Low-pass:
  7976. @example
  7977. fftfilt=dc_Y=0:weight_Y='squish((Y+X)/100-1)'
  7978. @end example
  7979. @item
  7980. Sharpen:
  7981. @example
  7982. fftfilt=dc_Y=0:weight_Y='1+squish(1-(Y+X)/100)'
  7983. @end example
  7984. @item
  7985. Blur:
  7986. @example
  7987. fftfilt=dc_Y=0:weight_Y='exp(-4 * ((Y+X)/(W+H)))'
  7988. @end example
  7989. @end itemize
  7990. @section field
  7991. Extract a single field from an interlaced image using stride
  7992. arithmetic to avoid wasting CPU time. The output frames are marked as
  7993. non-interlaced.
  7994. The filter accepts the following options:
  7995. @table @option
  7996. @item type
  7997. Specify whether to extract the top (if the value is @code{0} or
  7998. @code{top}) or the bottom field (if the value is @code{1} or
  7999. @code{bottom}).
  8000. @end table
  8001. @section fieldhint
  8002. Create new frames by copying the top and bottom fields from surrounding frames
  8003. supplied as numbers by the hint file.
  8004. @table @option
  8005. @item hint
  8006. Set file containing hints: absolute/relative frame numbers.
  8007. There must be one line for each frame in a clip. Each line must contain two
  8008. numbers separated by the comma, optionally followed by @code{-} or @code{+}.
  8009. Numbers supplied on each line of file can not be out of [N-1,N+1] where N
  8010. is current frame number for @code{absolute} mode or out of [-1, 1] range
  8011. for @code{relative} mode. First number tells from which frame to pick up top
  8012. field and second number tells from which frame to pick up bottom field.
  8013. If optionally followed by @code{+} output frame will be marked as interlaced,
  8014. else if followed by @code{-} output frame will be marked as progressive, else
  8015. it will be marked same as input frame.
  8016. If optionally followed by @code{t} output frame will use only top field, or in
  8017. case of @code{b} it will use only bottom field.
  8018. If line starts with @code{#} or @code{;} that line is skipped.
  8019. @item mode
  8020. Can be item @code{absolute} or @code{relative}. Default is @code{absolute}.
  8021. @end table
  8022. Example of first several lines of @code{hint} file for @code{relative} mode:
  8023. @example
  8024. 0,0 - # first frame
  8025. 1,0 - # second frame, use third's frame top field and second's frame bottom field
  8026. 1,0 - # third frame, use fourth's frame top field and third's frame bottom field
  8027. 1,0 -
  8028. 0,0 -
  8029. 0,0 -
  8030. 1,0 -
  8031. 1,0 -
  8032. 1,0 -
  8033. 0,0 -
  8034. 0,0 -
  8035. 1,0 -
  8036. 1,0 -
  8037. 1,0 -
  8038. 0,0 -
  8039. @end example
  8040. @section fieldmatch
  8041. Field matching filter for inverse telecine. It is meant to reconstruct the
  8042. progressive frames from a telecined stream. The filter does not drop duplicated
  8043. frames, so to achieve a complete inverse telecine @code{fieldmatch} needs to be
  8044. followed by a decimation filter such as @ref{decimate} in the filtergraph.
  8045. The separation of the field matching and the decimation is notably motivated by
  8046. the possibility of inserting a de-interlacing filter fallback between the two.
  8047. If the source has mixed telecined and real interlaced content,
  8048. @code{fieldmatch} will not be able to match fields for the interlaced parts.
  8049. But these remaining combed frames will be marked as interlaced, and thus can be
  8050. de-interlaced by a later filter such as @ref{yadif} before decimation.
  8051. In addition to the various configuration options, @code{fieldmatch} can take an
  8052. optional second stream, activated through the @option{ppsrc} option. If
  8053. enabled, the frames reconstruction will be based on the fields and frames from
  8054. this second stream. This allows the first input to be pre-processed in order to
  8055. help the various algorithms of the filter, while keeping the output lossless
  8056. (assuming the fields are matched properly). Typically, a field-aware denoiser,
  8057. or brightness/contrast adjustments can help.
  8058. Note that this filter uses the same algorithms as TIVTC/TFM (AviSynth project)
  8059. and VIVTC/VFM (VapourSynth project). The later is a light clone of TFM from
  8060. which @code{fieldmatch} is based on. While the semantic and usage are very
  8061. close, some behaviour and options names can differ.
  8062. The @ref{decimate} filter currently only works for constant frame rate input.
  8063. If your input has mixed telecined (30fps) and progressive content with a lower
  8064. framerate like 24fps use the following filterchain to produce the necessary cfr
  8065. stream: @code{dejudder,fps=30000/1001,fieldmatch,decimate}.
  8066. The filter accepts the following options:
  8067. @table @option
  8068. @item order
  8069. Specify the assumed field order of the input stream. Available values are:
  8070. @table @samp
  8071. @item auto
  8072. Auto detect parity (use FFmpeg's internal parity value).
  8073. @item bff
  8074. Assume bottom field first.
  8075. @item tff
  8076. Assume top field first.
  8077. @end table
  8078. Note that it is sometimes recommended not to trust the parity announced by the
  8079. stream.
  8080. Default value is @var{auto}.
  8081. @item mode
  8082. Set the matching mode or strategy to use. @option{pc} mode is the safest in the
  8083. sense that it won't risk creating jerkiness due to duplicate frames when
  8084. possible, but if there are bad edits or blended fields it will end up
  8085. outputting combed frames when a good match might actually exist. On the other
  8086. hand, @option{pcn_ub} mode is the most risky in terms of creating jerkiness,
  8087. but will almost always find a good frame if there is one. The other values are
  8088. all somewhere in between @option{pc} and @option{pcn_ub} in terms of risking
  8089. jerkiness and creating duplicate frames versus finding good matches in sections
  8090. with bad edits, orphaned fields, blended fields, etc.
  8091. More details about p/c/n/u/b are available in @ref{p/c/n/u/b meaning} section.
  8092. Available values are:
  8093. @table @samp
  8094. @item pc
  8095. 2-way matching (p/c)
  8096. @item pc_n
  8097. 2-way matching, and trying 3rd match if still combed (p/c + n)
  8098. @item pc_u
  8099. 2-way matching, and trying 3rd match (same order) if still combed (p/c + u)
  8100. @item pc_n_ub
  8101. 2-way matching, trying 3rd match if still combed, and trying 4th/5th matches if
  8102. still combed (p/c + n + u/b)
  8103. @item pcn
  8104. 3-way matching (p/c/n)
  8105. @item pcn_ub
  8106. 3-way matching, and trying 4th/5th matches if all 3 of the original matches are
  8107. detected as combed (p/c/n + u/b)
  8108. @end table
  8109. The parenthesis at the end indicate the matches that would be used for that
  8110. mode assuming @option{order}=@var{tff} (and @option{field} on @var{auto} or
  8111. @var{top}).
  8112. In terms of speed @option{pc} mode is by far the fastest and @option{pcn_ub} is
  8113. the slowest.
  8114. Default value is @var{pc_n}.
  8115. @item ppsrc
  8116. Mark the main input stream as a pre-processed input, and enable the secondary
  8117. input stream as the clean source to pick the fields from. See the filter
  8118. introduction for more details. It is similar to the @option{clip2} feature from
  8119. VFM/TFM.
  8120. Default value is @code{0} (disabled).
  8121. @item field
  8122. Set the field to match from. It is recommended to set this to the same value as
  8123. @option{order} unless you experience matching failures with that setting. In
  8124. certain circumstances changing the field that is used to match from can have a
  8125. large impact on matching performance. Available values are:
  8126. @table @samp
  8127. @item auto
  8128. Automatic (same value as @option{order}).
  8129. @item bottom
  8130. Match from the bottom field.
  8131. @item top
  8132. Match from the top field.
  8133. @end table
  8134. Default value is @var{auto}.
  8135. @item mchroma
  8136. Set whether or not chroma is included during the match comparisons. In most
  8137. cases it is recommended to leave this enabled. You should set this to @code{0}
  8138. only if your clip has bad chroma problems such as heavy rainbowing or other
  8139. artifacts. Setting this to @code{0} could also be used to speed things up at
  8140. the cost of some accuracy.
  8141. Default value is @code{1}.
  8142. @item y0
  8143. @item y1
  8144. These define an exclusion band which excludes the lines between @option{y0} and
  8145. @option{y1} from being included in the field matching decision. An exclusion
  8146. band can be used to ignore subtitles, a logo, or other things that may
  8147. interfere with the matching. @option{y0} sets the starting scan line and
  8148. @option{y1} sets the ending line; all lines in between @option{y0} and
  8149. @option{y1} (including @option{y0} and @option{y1}) will be ignored. Setting
  8150. @option{y0} and @option{y1} to the same value will disable the feature.
  8151. @option{y0} and @option{y1} defaults to @code{0}.
  8152. @item scthresh
  8153. Set the scene change detection threshold as a percentage of maximum change on
  8154. the luma plane. Good values are in the @code{[8.0, 14.0]} range. Scene change
  8155. detection is only relevant in case @option{combmatch}=@var{sc}. The range for
  8156. @option{scthresh} is @code{[0.0, 100.0]}.
  8157. Default value is @code{12.0}.
  8158. @item combmatch
  8159. When @option{combatch} is not @var{none}, @code{fieldmatch} will take into
  8160. account the combed scores of matches when deciding what match to use as the
  8161. final match. Available values are:
  8162. @table @samp
  8163. @item none
  8164. No final matching based on combed scores.
  8165. @item sc
  8166. Combed scores are only used when a scene change is detected.
  8167. @item full
  8168. Use combed scores all the time.
  8169. @end table
  8170. Default is @var{sc}.
  8171. @item combdbg
  8172. Force @code{fieldmatch} to calculate the combed metrics for certain matches and
  8173. print them. This setting is known as @option{micout} in TFM/VFM vocabulary.
  8174. Available values are:
  8175. @table @samp
  8176. @item none
  8177. No forced calculation.
  8178. @item pcn
  8179. Force p/c/n calculations.
  8180. @item pcnub
  8181. Force p/c/n/u/b calculations.
  8182. @end table
  8183. Default value is @var{none}.
  8184. @item cthresh
  8185. This is the area combing threshold used for combed frame detection. This
  8186. essentially controls how "strong" or "visible" combing must be to be detected.
  8187. Larger values mean combing must be more visible and smaller values mean combing
  8188. can be less visible or strong and still be detected. Valid settings are from
  8189. @code{-1} (every pixel will be detected as combed) to @code{255} (no pixel will
  8190. be detected as combed). This is basically a pixel difference value. A good
  8191. range is @code{[8, 12]}.
  8192. Default value is @code{9}.
  8193. @item chroma
  8194. Sets whether or not chroma is considered in the combed frame decision. Only
  8195. disable this if your source has chroma problems (rainbowing, etc.) that are
  8196. causing problems for the combed frame detection with chroma enabled. Actually,
  8197. using @option{chroma}=@var{0} is usually more reliable, except for the case
  8198. where there is chroma only combing in the source.
  8199. Default value is @code{0}.
  8200. @item blockx
  8201. @item blocky
  8202. Respectively set the x-axis and y-axis size of the window used during combed
  8203. frame detection. This has to do with the size of the area in which
  8204. @option{combpel} pixels are required to be detected as combed for a frame to be
  8205. declared combed. See the @option{combpel} parameter description for more info.
  8206. Possible values are any number that is a power of 2 starting at 4 and going up
  8207. to 512.
  8208. Default value is @code{16}.
  8209. @item combpel
  8210. The number of combed pixels inside any of the @option{blocky} by
  8211. @option{blockx} size blocks on the frame for the frame to be detected as
  8212. combed. While @option{cthresh} controls how "visible" the combing must be, this
  8213. setting controls "how much" combing there must be in any localized area (a
  8214. window defined by the @option{blockx} and @option{blocky} settings) on the
  8215. frame. Minimum value is @code{0} and maximum is @code{blocky x blockx} (at
  8216. which point no frames will ever be detected as combed). This setting is known
  8217. as @option{MI} in TFM/VFM vocabulary.
  8218. Default value is @code{80}.
  8219. @end table
  8220. @anchor{p/c/n/u/b meaning}
  8221. @subsection p/c/n/u/b meaning
  8222. @subsubsection p/c/n
  8223. We assume the following telecined stream:
  8224. @example
  8225. Top fields: 1 2 2 3 4
  8226. Bottom fields: 1 2 3 4 4
  8227. @end example
  8228. The numbers correspond to the progressive frame the fields relate to. Here, the
  8229. first two frames are progressive, the 3rd and 4th are combed, and so on.
  8230. When @code{fieldmatch} is configured to run a matching from bottom
  8231. (@option{field}=@var{bottom}) this is how this input stream get transformed:
  8232. @example
  8233. Input stream:
  8234. T 1 2 2 3 4
  8235. B 1 2 3 4 4 <-- matching reference
  8236. Matches: c c n n c
  8237. Output stream:
  8238. T 1 2 3 4 4
  8239. B 1 2 3 4 4
  8240. @end example
  8241. As a result of the field matching, we can see that some frames get duplicated.
  8242. To perform a complete inverse telecine, you need to rely on a decimation filter
  8243. after this operation. See for instance the @ref{decimate} filter.
  8244. The same operation now matching from top fields (@option{field}=@var{top})
  8245. looks like this:
  8246. @example
  8247. Input stream:
  8248. T 1 2 2 3 4 <-- matching reference
  8249. B 1 2 3 4 4
  8250. Matches: c c p p c
  8251. Output stream:
  8252. T 1 2 2 3 4
  8253. B 1 2 2 3 4
  8254. @end example
  8255. In these examples, we can see what @var{p}, @var{c} and @var{n} mean;
  8256. basically, they refer to the frame and field of the opposite parity:
  8257. @itemize
  8258. @item @var{p} matches the field of the opposite parity in the previous frame
  8259. @item @var{c} matches the field of the opposite parity in the current frame
  8260. @item @var{n} matches the field of the opposite parity in the next frame
  8261. @end itemize
  8262. @subsubsection u/b
  8263. The @var{u} and @var{b} matching are a bit special in the sense that they match
  8264. from the opposite parity flag. In the following examples, we assume that we are
  8265. currently matching the 2nd frame (Top:2, bottom:2). According to the match, a
  8266. 'x' is placed above and below each matched fields.
  8267. With bottom matching (@option{field}=@var{bottom}):
  8268. @example
  8269. Match: c p n b u
  8270. x x x x x
  8271. Top 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2
  8272. Bottom 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3
  8273. x x x x x
  8274. Output frames:
  8275. 2 1 2 2 2
  8276. 2 2 2 1 3
  8277. @end example
  8278. With top matching (@option{field}=@var{top}):
  8279. @example
  8280. Match: c p n b u
  8281. x x x x x
  8282. Top 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2
  8283. Bottom 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3
  8284. x x x x x
  8285. Output frames:
  8286. 2 2 2 1 2
  8287. 2 1 3 2 2
  8288. @end example
  8289. @subsection Examples
  8290. Simple IVTC of a top field first telecined stream:
  8291. @example
  8292. fieldmatch=order=tff:combmatch=none, decimate
  8293. @end example
  8294. Advanced IVTC, with fallback on @ref{yadif} for still combed frames:
  8295. @example
  8296. fieldmatch=order=tff:combmatch=full, yadif=deint=interlaced, decimate
  8297. @end example
  8298. @section fieldorder
  8299. Transform the field order of the input video.
  8300. It accepts the following parameters:
  8301. @table @option
  8302. @item order
  8303. The output field order. Valid values are @var{tff} for top field first or @var{bff}
  8304. for bottom field first.
  8305. @end table
  8306. The default value is @samp{tff}.
  8307. The transformation is done by shifting the picture content up or down
  8308. by one line, and filling the remaining line with appropriate picture content.
  8309. This method is consistent with most broadcast field order converters.
  8310. If the input video is not flagged as being interlaced, or it is already
  8311. flagged as being of the required output field order, then this filter does
  8312. not alter the incoming video.
  8313. It is very useful when converting to or from PAL DV material,
  8314. which is bottom field first.
  8315. For example:
  8316. @example
  8317. ffmpeg -i in.vob -vf "fieldorder=bff" out.dv
  8318. @end example
  8319. @section fifo, afifo
  8320. Buffer input images and send them when they are requested.
  8321. It is mainly useful when auto-inserted by the libavfilter
  8322. framework.
  8323. It does not take parameters.
  8324. @section fillborders
  8325. Fill borders of the input video, without changing video stream dimensions.
  8326. Sometimes video can have garbage at the four edges and you may not want to
  8327. crop video input to keep size multiple of some number.
  8328. This filter accepts the following options:
  8329. @table @option
  8330. @item left
  8331. Number of pixels to fill from left border.
  8332. @item right
  8333. Number of pixels to fill from right border.
  8334. @item top
  8335. Number of pixels to fill from top border.
  8336. @item bottom
  8337. Number of pixels to fill from bottom border.
  8338. @item mode
  8339. Set fill mode.
  8340. It accepts the following values:
  8341. @table @samp
  8342. @item smear
  8343. fill pixels using outermost pixels
  8344. @item mirror
  8345. fill pixels using mirroring
  8346. @item fixed
  8347. fill pixels with constant value
  8348. @end table
  8349. Default is @var{smear}.
  8350. @item color
  8351. Set color for pixels in fixed mode. Default is @var{black}.
  8352. @end table
  8353. @subsection Commands
  8354. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  8355. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  8356. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  8357. value.
  8358. @section find_rect
  8359. Find a rectangular object
  8360. It accepts the following options:
  8361. @table @option
  8362. @item object
  8363. Filepath of the object image, needs to be in gray8.
  8364. @item threshold
  8365. Detection threshold, default is 0.5.
  8366. @item mipmaps
  8367. Number of mipmaps, default is 3.
  8368. @item xmin, ymin, xmax, ymax
  8369. Specifies the rectangle in which to search.
  8370. @end table
  8371. @subsection Examples
  8372. @itemize
  8373. @item
  8374. Cover a rectangular object by the supplied image of a given video using @command{ffmpeg}:
  8375. @example
  8376. ffmpeg -i file.ts -vf find_rect=newref.pgm,cover_rect=cover.jpg:mode=cover new.mkv
  8377. @end example
  8378. @end itemize
  8379. @section floodfill
  8380. Flood area with values of same pixel components with another values.
  8381. It accepts the following options:
  8382. @table @option
  8383. @item x
  8384. Set pixel x coordinate.
  8385. @item y
  8386. Set pixel y coordinate.
  8387. @item s0
  8388. Set source #0 component value.
  8389. @item s1
  8390. Set source #1 component value.
  8391. @item s2
  8392. Set source #2 component value.
  8393. @item s3
  8394. Set source #3 component value.
  8395. @item d0
  8396. Set destination #0 component value.
  8397. @item d1
  8398. Set destination #1 component value.
  8399. @item d2
  8400. Set destination #2 component value.
  8401. @item d3
  8402. Set destination #3 component value.
  8403. @end table
  8404. @anchor{format}
  8405. @section format
  8406. Convert the input video to one of the specified pixel formats.
  8407. Libavfilter will try to pick one that is suitable as input to
  8408. the next filter.
  8409. It accepts the following parameters:
  8410. @table @option
  8411. @item pix_fmts
  8412. A '|'-separated list of pixel format names, such as
  8413. "pix_fmts=yuv420p|monow|rgb24".
  8414. @end table
  8415. @subsection Examples
  8416. @itemize
  8417. @item
  8418. Convert the input video to the @var{yuv420p} format
  8419. @example
  8420. format=pix_fmts=yuv420p
  8421. @end example
  8422. Convert the input video to any of the formats in the list
  8423. @example
  8424. format=pix_fmts=yuv420p|yuv444p|yuv410p
  8425. @end example
  8426. @end itemize
  8427. @anchor{fps}
  8428. @section fps
  8429. Convert the video to specified constant frame rate by duplicating or dropping
  8430. frames as necessary.
  8431. It accepts the following parameters:
  8432. @table @option
  8433. @item fps
  8434. The desired output frame rate. The default is @code{25}.
  8435. @item start_time
  8436. Assume the first PTS should be the given value, in seconds. This allows for
  8437. padding/trimming at the start of stream. By default, no assumption is made
  8438. about the first frame's expected PTS, so no padding or trimming is done.
  8439. For example, this could be set to 0 to pad the beginning with duplicates of
  8440. the first frame if a video stream starts after the audio stream or to trim any
  8441. frames with a negative PTS.
  8442. @item round
  8443. Timestamp (PTS) rounding method.
  8444. Possible values are:
  8445. @table @option
  8446. @item zero
  8447. round towards 0
  8448. @item inf
  8449. round away from 0
  8450. @item down
  8451. round towards -infinity
  8452. @item up
  8453. round towards +infinity
  8454. @item near
  8455. round to nearest
  8456. @end table
  8457. The default is @code{near}.
  8458. @item eof_action
  8459. Action performed when reading the last frame.
  8460. Possible values are:
  8461. @table @option
  8462. @item round
  8463. Use same timestamp rounding method as used for other frames.
  8464. @item pass
  8465. Pass through last frame if input duration has not been reached yet.
  8466. @end table
  8467. The default is @code{round}.
  8468. @end table
  8469. Alternatively, the options can be specified as a flat string:
  8470. @var{fps}[:@var{start_time}[:@var{round}]].
  8471. See also the @ref{setpts} filter.
  8472. @subsection Examples
  8473. @itemize
  8474. @item
  8475. A typical usage in order to set the fps to 25:
  8476. @example
  8477. fps=fps=25
  8478. @end example
  8479. @item
  8480. Sets the fps to 24, using abbreviation and rounding method to round to nearest:
  8481. @example
  8482. fps=fps=film:round=near
  8483. @end example
  8484. @end itemize
  8485. @section framepack
  8486. Pack two different video streams into a stereoscopic video, setting proper
  8487. metadata on supported codecs. The two views should have the same size and
  8488. framerate and processing will stop when the shorter video ends. Please note
  8489. that you may conveniently adjust view properties with the @ref{scale} and
  8490. @ref{fps} filters.
  8491. It accepts the following parameters:
  8492. @table @option
  8493. @item format
  8494. The desired packing format. Supported values are:
  8495. @table @option
  8496. @item sbs
  8497. The views are next to each other (default).
  8498. @item tab
  8499. The views are on top of each other.
  8500. @item lines
  8501. The views are packed by line.
  8502. @item columns
  8503. The views are packed by column.
  8504. @item frameseq
  8505. The views are temporally interleaved.
  8506. @end table
  8507. @end table
  8508. Some examples:
  8509. @example
  8510. # Convert left and right views into a frame-sequential video
  8511. ffmpeg -i LEFT -i RIGHT -filter_complex framepack=frameseq OUTPUT
  8512. # Convert views into a side-by-side video with the same output resolution as the input
  8513. ffmpeg -i LEFT -i RIGHT -filter_complex [0:v]scale=w=iw/2[left],[1:v]scale=w=iw/2[right],[left][right]framepack=sbs OUTPUT
  8514. @end example
  8515. @section framerate
  8516. Change the frame rate by interpolating new video output frames from the source
  8517. frames.
  8518. This filter is not designed to function correctly with interlaced media. If
  8519. you wish to change the frame rate of interlaced media then you are required
  8520. to deinterlace before this filter and re-interlace after this filter.
  8521. A description of the accepted options follows.
  8522. @table @option
  8523. @item fps
  8524. Specify the output frames per second. This option can also be specified
  8525. as a value alone. The default is @code{50}.
  8526. @item interp_start
  8527. Specify the start of a range where the output frame will be created as a
  8528. linear interpolation of two frames. The range is [@code{0}-@code{255}],
  8529. the default is @code{15}.
  8530. @item interp_end
  8531. Specify the end of a range where the output frame will be created as a
  8532. linear interpolation of two frames. The range is [@code{0}-@code{255}],
  8533. the default is @code{240}.
  8534. @item scene
  8535. Specify the level at which a scene change is detected as a value between
  8536. 0 and 100 to indicate a new scene; a low value reflects a low
  8537. probability for the current frame to introduce a new scene, while a higher
  8538. value means the current frame is more likely to be one.
  8539. The default is @code{8.2}.
  8540. @item flags
  8541. Specify flags influencing the filter process.
  8542. Available value for @var{flags} is:
  8543. @table @option
  8544. @item scene_change_detect, scd
  8545. Enable scene change detection using the value of the option @var{scene}.
  8546. This flag is enabled by default.
  8547. @end table
  8548. @end table
  8549. @section framestep
  8550. Select one frame every N-th frame.
  8551. This filter accepts the following option:
  8552. @table @option
  8553. @item step
  8554. Select frame after every @code{step} frames.
  8555. Allowed values are positive integers higher than 0. Default value is @code{1}.
  8556. @end table
  8557. @section freezedetect
  8558. Detect frozen video.
  8559. This filter logs a message and sets frame metadata when it detects that the
  8560. input video has no significant change in content during a specified duration.
  8561. Video freeze detection calculates the mean average absolute difference of all
  8562. the components of video frames and compares it to a noise floor.
  8563. The printed times and duration are expressed in seconds. The
  8564. @code{lavfi.freezedetect.freeze_start} metadata key is set on the first frame
  8565. whose timestamp equals or exceeds the detection duration and it contains the
  8566. timestamp of the first frame of the freeze. The
  8567. @code{lavfi.freezedetect.freeze_duration} and
  8568. @code{lavfi.freezedetect.freeze_end} metadata keys are set on the first frame
  8569. after the freeze.
  8570. The filter accepts the following options:
  8571. @table @option
  8572. @item noise, n
  8573. Set noise tolerance. Can be specified in dB (in case "dB" is appended to the
  8574. specified value) or as a difference ratio between 0 and 1. Default is -60dB, or
  8575. 0.001.
  8576. @item duration, d
  8577. Set freeze duration until notification (default is 2 seconds).
  8578. @end table
  8579. @section freezeframes
  8580. Freeze video frames.
  8581. This filter freezes video frames using frame from 2nd input.
  8582. The filter accepts the following options:
  8583. @table @option
  8584. @item first
  8585. Set number of first frame from which to start freeze.
  8586. @item last
  8587. Set number of last frame from which to end freeze.
  8588. @item replace
  8589. Set number of frame from 2nd input which will be used instead of replaced frames.
  8590. @end table
  8591. @anchor{frei0r}
  8592. @section frei0r
  8593. Apply a frei0r effect to the input video.
  8594. To enable the compilation of this filter, you need to install the frei0r
  8595. header and configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-frei0r}.
  8596. It accepts the following parameters:
  8597. @table @option
  8598. @item filter_name
  8599. The name of the frei0r effect to load. If the environment variable
  8600. @env{FREI0R_PATH} is defined, the frei0r effect is searched for in each of the
  8601. directories specified by the colon-separated list in @env{FREI0R_PATH}.
  8602. Otherwise, the standard frei0r paths are searched, in this order:
  8603. @file{HOME/.frei0r-1/lib/}, @file{/usr/local/lib/frei0r-1/},
  8604. @file{/usr/lib/frei0r-1/}.
  8605. @item filter_params
  8606. A '|'-separated list of parameters to pass to the frei0r effect.
  8607. @end table
  8608. A frei0r effect parameter can be a boolean (its value is either
  8609. "y" or "n"), a double, a color (specified as
  8610. @var{R}/@var{G}/@var{B}, where @var{R}, @var{G}, and @var{B} are floating point
  8611. numbers between 0.0 and 1.0, inclusive) or a color description as specified in the
  8612. @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils},
  8613. a position (specified as @var{X}/@var{Y}, where
  8614. @var{X} and @var{Y} are floating point numbers) and/or a string.
  8615. The number and types of parameters depend on the loaded effect. If an
  8616. effect parameter is not specified, the default value is set.
  8617. @subsection Examples
  8618. @itemize
  8619. @item
  8620. Apply the distort0r effect, setting the first two double parameters:
  8621. @example
  8622. frei0r=filter_name=distort0r:filter_params=0.5|0.01
  8623. @end example
  8624. @item
  8625. Apply the colordistance effect, taking a color as the first parameter:
  8626. @example
  8627. frei0r=colordistance:0.2/0.3/0.4
  8628. frei0r=colordistance:violet
  8629. frei0r=colordistance:0x112233
  8630. @end example
  8631. @item
  8632. Apply the perspective effect, specifying the top left and top right image
  8633. positions:
  8634. @example
  8635. frei0r=perspective:0.2/0.2|0.8/0.2
  8636. @end example
  8637. @end itemize
  8638. For more information, see
  8639. @url{http://frei0r.dyne.org}
  8640. @section fspp
  8641. Apply fast and simple postprocessing. It is a faster version of @ref{spp}.
  8642. It splits (I)DCT into horizontal/vertical passes. Unlike the simple post-
  8643. processing filter, one of them is performed once per block, not per pixel.
  8644. This allows for much higher speed.
  8645. The filter accepts the following options:
  8646. @table @option
  8647. @item quality
  8648. Set quality. This option defines the number of levels for averaging. It accepts
  8649. an integer in the range 4-5. Default value is @code{4}.
  8650. @item qp
  8651. Force a constant quantization parameter. It accepts an integer in range 0-63.
  8652. If not set, the filter will use the QP from the video stream (if available).
  8653. @item strength
  8654. Set filter strength. It accepts an integer in range -15 to 32. Lower values mean
  8655. more details but also more artifacts, while higher values make the image smoother
  8656. but also blurrier. Default value is @code{0} − PSNR optimal.
  8657. @item use_bframe_qp
  8658. Enable the use of the QP from the B-Frames if set to @code{1}. Using this
  8659. option may cause flicker since the B-Frames have often larger QP. Default is
  8660. @code{0} (not enabled).
  8661. @end table
  8662. @section gblur
  8663. Apply Gaussian blur filter.
  8664. The filter accepts the following options:
  8665. @table @option
  8666. @item sigma
  8667. Set horizontal sigma, standard deviation of Gaussian blur. Default is @code{0.5}.
  8668. @item steps
  8669. Set number of steps for Gaussian approximation. Default is @code{1}.
  8670. @item planes
  8671. Set which planes to filter. By default all planes are filtered.
  8672. @item sigmaV
  8673. Set vertical sigma, if negative it will be same as @code{sigma}.
  8674. Default is @code{-1}.
  8675. @end table
  8676. @subsection Commands
  8677. This filter supports same commands as options.
  8678. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  8679. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  8680. value.
  8681. @section geq
  8682. Apply generic equation to each pixel.
  8683. The filter accepts the following options:
  8684. @table @option
  8685. @item lum_expr, lum
  8686. Set the luminance expression.
  8687. @item cb_expr, cb
  8688. Set the chrominance blue expression.
  8689. @item cr_expr, cr
  8690. Set the chrominance red expression.
  8691. @item alpha_expr, a
  8692. Set the alpha expression.
  8693. @item red_expr, r
  8694. Set the red expression.
  8695. @item green_expr, g
  8696. Set the green expression.
  8697. @item blue_expr, b
  8698. Set the blue expression.
  8699. @end table
  8700. The colorspace is selected according to the specified options. If one
  8701. of the @option{lum_expr}, @option{cb_expr}, or @option{cr_expr}
  8702. options is specified, the filter will automatically select a YCbCr
  8703. colorspace. If one of the @option{red_expr}, @option{green_expr}, or
  8704. @option{blue_expr} options is specified, it will select an RGB
  8705. colorspace.
  8706. If one of the chrominance expression is not defined, it falls back on the other
  8707. one. If no alpha expression is specified it will evaluate to opaque value.
  8708. If none of chrominance expressions are specified, they will evaluate
  8709. to the luminance expression.
  8710. The expressions can use the following variables and functions:
  8711. @table @option
  8712. @item N
  8713. The sequential number of the filtered frame, starting from @code{0}.
  8714. @item X
  8715. @item Y
  8716. The coordinates of the current sample.
  8717. @item W
  8718. @item H
  8719. The width and height of the image.
  8720. @item SW
  8721. @item SH
  8722. Width and height scale depending on the currently filtered plane. It is the
  8723. ratio between the corresponding luma plane number of pixels and the current
  8724. plane ones. E.g. for YUV4:2:0 the values are @code{1,1} for the luma plane, and
  8725. @code{0.5,0.5} for chroma planes.
  8726. @item T
  8727. Time of the current frame, expressed in seconds.
  8728. @item p(x, y)
  8729. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the current
  8730. plane.
  8731. @item lum(x, y)
  8732. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the luminance
  8733. plane.
  8734. @item cb(x, y)
  8735. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the
  8736. blue-difference chroma plane. Return 0 if there is no such plane.
  8737. @item cr(x, y)
  8738. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the
  8739. red-difference chroma plane. Return 0 if there is no such plane.
  8740. @item r(x, y)
  8741. @item g(x, y)
  8742. @item b(x, y)
  8743. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the
  8744. red/green/blue component. Return 0 if there is no such component.
  8745. @item alpha(x, y)
  8746. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the alpha
  8747. plane. Return 0 if there is no such plane.
  8748. @item interpolation
  8749. Set one of interpolation methods:
  8750. @table @option
  8751. @item nearest, n
  8752. @item bilinear, b
  8753. @end table
  8754. Default is bilinear.
  8755. @end table
  8756. For functions, if @var{x} and @var{y} are outside the area, the value will be
  8757. automatically clipped to the closer edge.
  8758. @subsection Examples
  8759. @itemize
  8760. @item
  8761. Flip the image horizontally:
  8762. @example
  8763. geq=p(W-X\,Y)
  8764. @end example
  8765. @item
  8766. Generate a bidimensional sine wave, with angle @code{PI/3} and a
  8767. wavelength of 100 pixels:
  8768. @example
  8769. geq=128 + 100*sin(2*(PI/100)*(cos(PI/3)*(X-50*T) + sin(PI/3)*Y)):128:128
  8770. @end example
  8771. @item
  8772. Generate a fancy enigmatic moving light:
  8773. @example
  8774. nullsrc=s=256x256,geq=random(1)/hypot(X-cos(N*0.07)*W/2-W/2\,Y-sin(N*0.09)*H/2-H/2)^2*1000000*sin(N*0.02):128:128
  8775. @end example
  8776. @item
  8777. Generate a quick emboss effect:
  8778. @example
  8779. format=gray,geq=lum_expr='(p(X,Y)+(256-p(X-4,Y-4)))/2'
  8780. @end example
  8781. @item
  8782. Modify RGB components depending on pixel position:
  8783. @example
  8784. geq=r='X/W*r(X,Y)':g='(1-X/W)*g(X,Y)':b='(H-Y)/H*b(X,Y)'
  8785. @end example
  8786. @item
  8787. Create a radial gradient that is the same size as the input (also see
  8788. the @ref{vignette} filter):
  8789. @example
  8790. geq=lum=255*gauss((X/W-0.5)*3)*gauss((Y/H-0.5)*3)/gauss(0)/gauss(0),format=gray
  8791. @end example
  8792. @end itemize
  8793. @section gradfun
  8794. Fix the banding artifacts that are sometimes introduced into nearly flat
  8795. regions by truncation to 8-bit color depth.
  8796. Interpolate the gradients that should go where the bands are, and
  8797. dither them.
  8798. It is designed for playback only. Do not use it prior to
  8799. lossy compression, because compression tends to lose the dither and
  8800. bring back the bands.
  8801. It accepts the following parameters:
  8802. @table @option
  8803. @item strength
  8804. The maximum amount by which the filter will change any one pixel. This is also
  8805. the threshold for detecting nearly flat regions. Acceptable values range from
  8806. .51 to 64; the default value is 1.2. Out-of-range values will be clipped to the
  8807. valid range.
  8808. @item radius
  8809. The neighborhood to fit the gradient to. A larger radius makes for smoother
  8810. gradients, but also prevents the filter from modifying the pixels near detailed
  8811. regions. Acceptable values are 8-32; the default value is 16. Out-of-range
  8812. values will be clipped to the valid range.
  8813. @end table
  8814. Alternatively, the options can be specified as a flat string:
  8815. @var{strength}[:@var{radius}]
  8816. @subsection Examples
  8817. @itemize
  8818. @item
  8819. Apply the filter with a @code{3.5} strength and radius of @code{8}:
  8820. @example
  8821. gradfun=3.5:8
  8822. @end example
  8823. @item
  8824. Specify radius, omitting the strength (which will fall-back to the default
  8825. value):
  8826. @example
  8827. gradfun=radius=8
  8828. @end example
  8829. @end itemize
  8830. @anchor{graphmonitor}
  8831. @section graphmonitor
  8832. Show various filtergraph stats.
  8833. With this filter one can debug complete filtergraph.
  8834. Especially issues with links filling with queued frames.
  8835. The filter accepts the following options:
  8836. @table @option
  8837. @item size, s
  8838. Set video output size. Default is @var{hd720}.
  8839. @item opacity, o
  8840. Set video opacity. Default is @var{0.9}. Allowed range is from @var{0} to @var{1}.
  8841. @item mode, m
  8842. Set output mode, can be @var{fulll} or @var{compact}.
  8843. In @var{compact} mode only filters with some queued frames have displayed stats.
  8844. @item flags, f
  8845. Set flags which enable which stats are shown in video.
  8846. Available values for flags are:
  8847. @table @samp
  8848. @item queue
  8849. Display number of queued frames in each link.
  8850. @item frame_count_in
  8851. Display number of frames taken from filter.
  8852. @item frame_count_out
  8853. Display number of frames given out from filter.
  8854. @item pts
  8855. Display current filtered frame pts.
  8856. @item time
  8857. Display current filtered frame time.
  8858. @item timebase
  8859. Display time base for filter link.
  8860. @item format
  8861. Display used format for filter link.
  8862. @item size
  8863. Display video size or number of audio channels in case of audio used by filter link.
  8864. @item rate
  8865. Display video frame rate or sample rate in case of audio used by filter link.
  8866. @end table
  8867. @item rate, r
  8868. Set upper limit for video rate of output stream, Default value is @var{25}.
  8869. This guarantee that output video frame rate will not be higher than this value.
  8870. @end table
  8871. @section greyedge
  8872. A color constancy variation filter which estimates scene illumination via grey edge algorithm
  8873. and corrects the scene colors accordingly.
  8874. See: @url{https://staff.science.uva.nl/th.gevers/pub/GeversTIP07.pdf}
  8875. The filter accepts the following options:
  8876. @table @option
  8877. @item difford
  8878. The order of differentiation to be applied on the scene. Must be chosen in the range
  8879. [0,2] and default value is 1.
  8880. @item minknorm
  8881. The Minkowski parameter to be used for calculating the Minkowski distance. Must
  8882. be chosen in the range [0,20] and default value is 1. Set to 0 for getting
  8883. max value instead of calculating Minkowski distance.
  8884. @item sigma
  8885. The standard deviation of Gaussian blur to be applied on the scene. Must be
  8886. chosen in the range [0,1024.0] and default value = 1. floor( @var{sigma} * break_off_sigma(3) )
  8887. can't be equal to 0 if @var{difford} is greater than 0.
  8888. @end table
  8889. @subsection Examples
  8890. @itemize
  8891. @item
  8892. Grey Edge:
  8893. @example
  8894. greyedge=difford=1:minknorm=5:sigma=2
  8895. @end example
  8896. @item
  8897. Max Edge:
  8898. @example
  8899. greyedge=difford=1:minknorm=0:sigma=2
  8900. @end example
  8901. @end itemize
  8902. @anchor{haldclut}
  8903. @section haldclut
  8904. Apply a Hald CLUT to a video stream.
  8905. First input is the video stream to process, and second one is the Hald CLUT.
  8906. The Hald CLUT input can be a simple picture or a complete video stream.
  8907. The filter accepts the following options:
  8908. @table @option
  8909. @item shortest
  8910. Force termination when the shortest input terminates. Default is @code{0}.
  8911. @item repeatlast
  8912. Continue applying the last CLUT after the end of the stream. A value of
  8913. @code{0} disable the filter after the last frame of the CLUT is reached.
  8914. Default is @code{1}.
  8915. @end table
  8916. @code{haldclut} also has the same interpolation options as @ref{lut3d} (both
  8917. filters share the same internals).
  8918. This filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  8919. More information about the Hald CLUT can be found on Eskil Steenberg's website
  8920. (Hald CLUT author) at @url{http://www.quelsolaar.com/technology/clut.html}.
  8921. @subsection Workflow examples
  8922. @subsubsection Hald CLUT video stream
  8923. Generate an identity Hald CLUT stream altered with various effects:
  8924. @example
  8925. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i @ref{haldclutsrc}=8 -vf "hue=H=2*PI*t:s=sin(2*PI*t)+1, curves=cross_process" -t 10 -c:v ffv1 clut.nut
  8926. @end example
  8927. Note: make sure you use a lossless codec.
  8928. Then use it with @code{haldclut} to apply it on some random stream:
  8929. @example
  8930. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i mandelbrot -i clut.nut -filter_complex '[0][1] haldclut' -t 20 mandelclut.mkv
  8931. @end example
  8932. The Hald CLUT will be applied to the 10 first seconds (duration of
  8933. @file{clut.nut}), then the latest picture of that CLUT stream will be applied
  8934. to the remaining frames of the @code{mandelbrot} stream.
  8935. @subsubsection Hald CLUT with preview
  8936. A Hald CLUT is supposed to be a squared image of @code{Level*Level*Level} by
  8937. @code{Level*Level*Level} pixels. For a given Hald CLUT, FFmpeg will select the
  8938. biggest possible square starting at the top left of the picture. The remaining
  8939. padding pixels (bottom or right) will be ignored. This area can be used to add
  8940. a preview of the Hald CLUT.
  8941. Typically, the following generated Hald CLUT will be supported by the
  8942. @code{haldclut} filter:
  8943. @example
  8944. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i @ref{haldclutsrc}=8 -vf "
  8945. pad=iw+320 [padded_clut];
  8946. smptebars=s=320x256, split [a][b];
  8947. [padded_clut][a] overlay=W-320:h, curves=color_negative [main];
  8948. [main][b] overlay=W-320" -frames:v 1 clut.png
  8949. @end example
  8950. It contains the original and a preview of the effect of the CLUT: SMPTE color
  8951. bars are displayed on the right-top, and below the same color bars processed by
  8952. the color changes.
  8953. Then, the effect of this Hald CLUT can be visualized with:
  8954. @example
  8955. ffplay input.mkv -vf "movie=clut.png, [in] haldclut"
  8956. @end example
  8957. @section hflip
  8958. Flip the input video horizontally.
  8959. For example, to horizontally flip the input video with @command{ffmpeg}:
  8960. @example
  8961. ffmpeg -i in.avi -vf "hflip" out.avi
  8962. @end example
  8963. @section histeq
  8964. This filter applies a global color histogram equalization on a
  8965. per-frame basis.
  8966. It can be used to correct video that has a compressed range of pixel
  8967. intensities. The filter redistributes the pixel intensities to
  8968. equalize their distribution across the intensity range. It may be
  8969. viewed as an "automatically adjusting contrast filter". This filter is
  8970. useful only for correcting degraded or poorly captured source
  8971. video.
  8972. The filter accepts the following options:
  8973. @table @option
  8974. @item strength
  8975. Determine the amount of equalization to be applied. As the strength
  8976. is reduced, the distribution of pixel intensities more-and-more
  8977. approaches that of the input frame. The value must be a float number
  8978. in the range [0,1] and defaults to 0.200.
  8979. @item intensity
  8980. Set the maximum intensity that can generated and scale the output
  8981. values appropriately. The strength should be set as desired and then
  8982. the intensity can be limited if needed to avoid washing-out. The value
  8983. must be a float number in the range [0,1] and defaults to 0.210.
  8984. @item antibanding
  8985. Set the antibanding level. If enabled the filter will randomly vary
  8986. the luminance of output pixels by a small amount to avoid banding of
  8987. the histogram. Possible values are @code{none}, @code{weak} or
  8988. @code{strong}. It defaults to @code{none}.
  8989. @end table
  8990. @anchor{histogram}
  8991. @section histogram
  8992. Compute and draw a color distribution histogram for the input video.
  8993. The computed histogram is a representation of the color component
  8994. distribution in an image.
  8995. Standard histogram displays the color components distribution in an image.
  8996. Displays color graph for each color component. Shows distribution of
  8997. the Y, U, V, A or R, G, B components, depending on input format, in the
  8998. current frame. Below each graph a color component scale meter is shown.
  8999. The filter accepts the following options:
  9000. @table @option
  9001. @item level_height
  9002. Set height of level. Default value is @code{200}.
  9003. Allowed range is [50, 2048].
  9004. @item scale_height
  9005. Set height of color scale. Default value is @code{12}.
  9006. Allowed range is [0, 40].
  9007. @item display_mode
  9008. Set display mode.
  9009. It accepts the following values:
  9010. @table @samp
  9011. @item stack
  9012. Per color component graphs are placed below each other.
  9013. @item parade
  9014. Per color component graphs are placed side by side.
  9015. @item overlay
  9016. Presents information identical to that in the @code{parade}, except
  9017. that the graphs representing color components are superimposed directly
  9018. over one another.
  9019. @end table
  9020. Default is @code{stack}.
  9021. @item levels_mode
  9022. Set mode. Can be either @code{linear}, or @code{logarithmic}.
  9023. Default is @code{linear}.
  9024. @item components
  9025. Set what color components to display.
  9026. Default is @code{7}.
  9027. @item fgopacity
  9028. Set foreground opacity. Default is @code{0.7}.
  9029. @item bgopacity
  9030. Set background opacity. Default is @code{0.5}.
  9031. @end table
  9032. @subsection Examples
  9033. @itemize
  9034. @item
  9035. Calculate and draw histogram:
  9036. @example
  9037. ffplay -i input -vf histogram
  9038. @end example
  9039. @end itemize
  9040. @anchor{hqdn3d}
  9041. @section hqdn3d
  9042. This is a high precision/quality 3d denoise filter. It aims to reduce
  9043. image noise, producing smooth images and making still images really
  9044. still. It should enhance compressibility.
  9045. It accepts the following optional parameters:
  9046. @table @option
  9047. @item luma_spatial
  9048. A non-negative floating point number which specifies spatial luma strength.
  9049. It defaults to 4.0.
  9050. @item chroma_spatial
  9051. A non-negative floating point number which specifies spatial chroma strength.
  9052. It defaults to 3.0*@var{luma_spatial}/4.0.
  9053. @item luma_tmp
  9054. A floating point number which specifies luma temporal strength. It defaults to
  9055. 6.0*@var{luma_spatial}/4.0.
  9056. @item chroma_tmp
  9057. A floating point number which specifies chroma temporal strength. It defaults to
  9058. @var{luma_tmp}*@var{chroma_spatial}/@var{luma_spatial}.
  9059. @end table
  9060. @subsection Commands
  9061. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  9062. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  9063. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  9064. value.
  9065. @anchor{hwdownload}
  9066. @section hwdownload
  9067. Download hardware frames to system memory.
  9068. The input must be in hardware frames, and the output a non-hardware format.
  9069. Not all formats will be supported on the output - it may be necessary to insert
  9070. an additional @option{format} filter immediately following in the graph to get
  9071. the output in a supported format.
  9072. @section hwmap
  9073. Map hardware frames to system memory or to another device.
  9074. This filter has several different modes of operation; which one is used depends
  9075. on the input and output formats:
  9076. @itemize
  9077. @item
  9078. Hardware frame input, normal frame output
  9079. Map the input frames to system memory and pass them to the output. If the
  9080. original hardware frame is later required (for example, after overlaying
  9081. something else on part of it), the @option{hwmap} filter can be used again
  9082. in the next mode to retrieve it.
  9083. @item
  9084. Normal frame input, hardware frame output
  9085. If the input is actually a software-mapped hardware frame, then unmap it -
  9086. that is, return the original hardware frame.
  9087. Otherwise, a device must be provided. Create new hardware surfaces on that
  9088. device for the output, then map them back to the software format at the input
  9089. and give those frames to the preceding filter. This will then act like the
  9090. @option{hwupload} filter, but may be able to avoid an additional copy when
  9091. the input is already in a compatible format.
  9092. @item
  9093. Hardware frame input and output
  9094. A device must be supplied for the output, either directly or with the
  9095. @option{derive_device} option. The input and output devices must be of
  9096. different types and compatible - the exact meaning of this is
  9097. system-dependent, but typically it means that they must refer to the same
  9098. underlying hardware context (for example, refer to the same graphics card).
  9099. If the input frames were originally created on the output device, then unmap
  9100. to retrieve the original frames.
  9101. Otherwise, map the frames to the output device - create new hardware frames
  9102. on the output corresponding to the frames on the input.
  9103. @end itemize
  9104. The following additional parameters are accepted:
  9105. @table @option
  9106. @item mode
  9107. Set the frame mapping mode. Some combination of:
  9108. @table @var
  9109. @item read
  9110. The mapped frame should be readable.
  9111. @item write
  9112. The mapped frame should be writeable.
  9113. @item overwrite
  9114. The mapping will always overwrite the entire frame.
  9115. This may improve performance in some cases, as the original contents of the
  9116. frame need not be loaded.
  9117. @item direct
  9118. The mapping must not involve any copying.
  9119. Indirect mappings to copies of frames are created in some cases where either
  9120. direct mapping is not possible or it would have unexpected properties.
  9121. Setting this flag ensures that the mapping is direct and will fail if that is
  9122. not possible.
  9123. @end table
  9124. Defaults to @var{read+write} if not specified.
  9125. @item derive_device @var{type}
  9126. Rather than using the device supplied at initialisation, instead derive a new
  9127. device of type @var{type} from the device the input frames exist on.
  9128. @item reverse
  9129. In a hardware to hardware mapping, map in reverse - create frames in the sink
  9130. and map them back to the source. This may be necessary in some cases where
  9131. a mapping in one direction is required but only the opposite direction is
  9132. supported by the devices being used.
  9133. This option is dangerous - it may break the preceding filter in undefined
  9134. ways if there are any additional constraints on that filter's output.
  9135. Do not use it without fully understanding the implications of its use.
  9136. @end table
  9137. @anchor{hwupload}
  9138. @section hwupload
  9139. Upload system memory frames to hardware surfaces.
  9140. The device to upload to must be supplied when the filter is initialised. If
  9141. using ffmpeg, select the appropriate device with the @option{-filter_hw_device}
  9142. option.
  9143. @anchor{hwupload_cuda}
  9144. @section hwupload_cuda
  9145. Upload system memory frames to a CUDA device.
  9146. It accepts the following optional parameters:
  9147. @table @option
  9148. @item device
  9149. The number of the CUDA device to use
  9150. @end table
  9151. @section hqx
  9152. Apply a high-quality magnification filter designed for pixel art. This filter
  9153. was originally created by Maxim Stepin.
  9154. It accepts the following option:
  9155. @table @option
  9156. @item n
  9157. Set the scaling dimension: @code{2} for @code{hq2x}, @code{3} for
  9158. @code{hq3x} and @code{4} for @code{hq4x}.
  9159. Default is @code{3}.
  9160. @end table
  9161. @section hstack
  9162. Stack input videos horizontally.
  9163. All streams must be of same pixel format and of same height.
  9164. Note that this filter is faster than using @ref{overlay} and @ref{pad} filter
  9165. to create same output.
  9166. The filter accepts the following option:
  9167. @table @option
  9168. @item inputs
  9169. Set number of input streams. Default is 2.
  9170. @item shortest
  9171. If set to 1, force the output to terminate when the shortest input
  9172. terminates. Default value is 0.
  9173. @end table
  9174. @section hue
  9175. Modify the hue and/or the saturation of the input.
  9176. It accepts the following parameters:
  9177. @table @option
  9178. @item h
  9179. Specify the hue angle as a number of degrees. It accepts an expression,
  9180. and defaults to "0".
  9181. @item s
  9182. Specify the saturation in the [-10,10] range. It accepts an expression and
  9183. defaults to "1".
  9184. @item H
  9185. Specify the hue angle as a number of radians. It accepts an
  9186. expression, and defaults to "0".
  9187. @item b
  9188. Specify the brightness in the [-10,10] range. It accepts an expression and
  9189. defaults to "0".
  9190. @end table
  9191. @option{h} and @option{H} are mutually exclusive, and can't be
  9192. specified at the same time.
  9193. The @option{b}, @option{h}, @option{H} and @option{s} option values are
  9194. expressions containing the following constants:
  9195. @table @option
  9196. @item n
  9197. frame count of the input frame starting from 0
  9198. @item pts
  9199. presentation timestamp of the input frame expressed in time base units
  9200. @item r
  9201. frame rate of the input video, NAN if the input frame rate is unknown
  9202. @item t
  9203. timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown
  9204. @item tb
  9205. time base of the input video
  9206. @end table
  9207. @subsection Examples
  9208. @itemize
  9209. @item
  9210. Set the hue to 90 degrees and the saturation to 1.0:
  9211. @example
  9212. hue=h=90:s=1
  9213. @end example
  9214. @item
  9215. Same command but expressing the hue in radians:
  9216. @example
  9217. hue=H=PI/2:s=1
  9218. @end example
  9219. @item
  9220. Rotate hue and make the saturation swing between 0
  9221. and 2 over a period of 1 second:
  9222. @example
  9223. hue="H=2*PI*t: s=sin(2*PI*t)+1"
  9224. @end example
  9225. @item
  9226. Apply a 3 seconds saturation fade-in effect starting at 0:
  9227. @example
  9228. hue="s=min(t/3\,1)"
  9229. @end example
  9230. The general fade-in expression can be written as:
  9231. @example
  9232. hue="s=min(0\, max((t-START)/DURATION\, 1))"
  9233. @end example
  9234. @item
  9235. Apply a 3 seconds saturation fade-out effect starting at 5 seconds:
  9236. @example
  9237. hue="s=max(0\, min(1\, (8-t)/3))"
  9238. @end example
  9239. The general fade-out expression can be written as:
  9240. @example
  9241. hue="s=max(0\, min(1\, (START+DURATION-t)/DURATION))"
  9242. @end example
  9243. @end itemize
  9244. @subsection Commands
  9245. This filter supports the following commands:
  9246. @table @option
  9247. @item b
  9248. @item s
  9249. @item h
  9250. @item H
  9251. Modify the hue and/or the saturation and/or brightness of the input video.
  9252. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  9253. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  9254. value.
  9255. @end table
  9256. @section hysteresis
  9257. Grow first stream into second stream by connecting components.
  9258. This makes it possible to build more robust edge masks.
  9259. This filter accepts the following options:
  9260. @table @option
  9261. @item planes
  9262. Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be
  9263. copied from first stream.
  9264. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  9265. @item threshold
  9266. Set threshold which is used in filtering. If pixel component value is higher than
  9267. this value filter algorithm for connecting components is activated.
  9268. By default value is 0.
  9269. @end table
  9270. @section idet
  9271. Detect video interlacing type.
  9272. This filter tries to detect if the input frames are interlaced, progressive,
  9273. top or bottom field first. It will also try to detect fields that are
  9274. repeated between adjacent frames (a sign of telecine).
  9275. Single frame detection considers only immediately adjacent frames when classifying each frame.
  9276. Multiple frame detection incorporates the classification history of previous frames.
  9277. The filter will log these metadata values:
  9278. @table @option
  9279. @item single.current_frame
  9280. Detected type of current frame using single-frame detection. One of:
  9281. ``tff'' (top field first), ``bff'' (bottom field first),
  9282. ``progressive'', or ``undetermined''
  9283. @item single.tff
  9284. Cumulative number of frames detected as top field first using single-frame detection.
  9285. @item multiple.tff
  9286. Cumulative number of frames detected as top field first using multiple-frame detection.
  9287. @item single.bff
  9288. Cumulative number of frames detected as bottom field first using single-frame detection.
  9289. @item multiple.current_frame
  9290. Detected type of current frame using multiple-frame detection. One of:
  9291. ``tff'' (top field first), ``bff'' (bottom field first),
  9292. ``progressive'', or ``undetermined''
  9293. @item multiple.bff
  9294. Cumulative number of frames detected as bottom field first using multiple-frame detection.
  9295. @item single.progressive
  9296. Cumulative number of frames detected as progressive using single-frame detection.
  9297. @item multiple.progressive
  9298. Cumulative number of frames detected as progressive using multiple-frame detection.
  9299. @item single.undetermined
  9300. Cumulative number of frames that could not be classified using single-frame detection.
  9301. @item multiple.undetermined
  9302. Cumulative number of frames that could not be classified using multiple-frame detection.
  9303. @item repeated.current_frame
  9304. Which field in the current frame is repeated from the last. One of ``neither'', ``top'', or ``bottom''.
  9305. @item repeated.neither
  9306. Cumulative number of frames with no repeated field.
  9307. @item repeated.top
  9308. Cumulative number of frames with the top field repeated from the previous frame's top field.
  9309. @item repeated.bottom
  9310. Cumulative number of frames with the bottom field repeated from the previous frame's bottom field.
  9311. @end table
  9312. The filter accepts the following options:
  9313. @table @option
  9314. @item intl_thres
  9315. Set interlacing threshold.
  9316. @item prog_thres
  9317. Set progressive threshold.
  9318. @item rep_thres
  9319. Threshold for repeated field detection.
  9320. @item half_life
  9321. Number of frames after which a given frame's contribution to the
  9322. statistics is halved (i.e., it contributes only 0.5 to its
  9323. classification). The default of 0 means that all frames seen are given
  9324. full weight of 1.0 forever.
  9325. @item analyze_interlaced_flag
  9326. When this is not 0 then idet will use the specified number of frames to determine
  9327. if the interlaced flag is accurate, it will not count undetermined frames.
  9328. If the flag is found to be accurate it will be used without any further
  9329. computations, if it is found to be inaccurate it will be cleared without any
  9330. further computations. This allows inserting the idet filter as a low computational
  9331. method to clean up the interlaced flag
  9332. @end table
  9333. @section il
  9334. Deinterleave or interleave fields.
  9335. This filter allows one to process interlaced images fields without
  9336. deinterlacing them. Deinterleaving splits the input frame into 2
  9337. fields (so called half pictures). Odd lines are moved to the top
  9338. half of the output image, even lines to the bottom half.
  9339. You can process (filter) them independently and then re-interleave them.
  9340. The filter accepts the following options:
  9341. @table @option
  9342. @item luma_mode, l
  9343. @item chroma_mode, c
  9344. @item alpha_mode, a
  9345. Available values for @var{luma_mode}, @var{chroma_mode} and
  9346. @var{alpha_mode} are:
  9347. @table @samp
  9348. @item none
  9349. Do nothing.
  9350. @item deinterleave, d
  9351. Deinterleave fields, placing one above the other.
  9352. @item interleave, i
  9353. Interleave fields. Reverse the effect of deinterleaving.
  9354. @end table
  9355. Default value is @code{none}.
  9356. @item luma_swap, ls
  9357. @item chroma_swap, cs
  9358. @item alpha_swap, as
  9359. Swap luma/chroma/alpha fields. Exchange even & odd lines. Default value is @code{0}.
  9360. @end table
  9361. @subsection Commands
  9362. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  9363. @section inflate
  9364. Apply inflate effect to the video.
  9365. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) average by taking into account
  9366. only values higher than the pixel.
  9367. It accepts the following options:
  9368. @table @option
  9369. @item threshold0
  9370. @item threshold1
  9371. @item threshold2
  9372. @item threshold3
  9373. Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.
  9374. If 0, plane will remain unchanged.
  9375. @end table
  9376. @subsection Commands
  9377. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  9378. @section interlace
  9379. Simple interlacing filter from progressive contents. This interleaves upper (or
  9380. lower) lines from odd frames with lower (or upper) lines from even frames,
  9381. halving the frame rate and preserving image height.
  9382. @example
  9383. Original Original New Frame
  9384. Frame 'j' Frame 'j+1' (tff)
  9385. ========== =========== ==================
  9386. Line 0 --------------------> Frame 'j' Line 0
  9387. Line 1 Line 1 ----> Frame 'j+1' Line 1
  9388. Line 2 ---------------------> Frame 'j' Line 2
  9389. Line 3 Line 3 ----> Frame 'j+1' Line 3
  9390. ... ... ...
  9391. New Frame + 1 will be generated by Frame 'j+2' and Frame 'j+3' and so on
  9392. @end example
  9393. It accepts the following optional parameters:
  9394. @table @option
  9395. @item scan
  9396. This determines whether the interlaced frame is taken from the even
  9397. (tff - default) or odd (bff) lines of the progressive frame.
  9398. @item lowpass
  9399. Vertical lowpass filter to avoid twitter interlacing and
  9400. reduce moire patterns.
  9401. @table @samp
  9402. @item 0, off
  9403. Disable vertical lowpass filter
  9404. @item 1, linear
  9405. Enable linear filter (default)
  9406. @item 2, complex
  9407. Enable complex filter. This will slightly less reduce twitter and moire
  9408. but better retain detail and subjective sharpness impression.
  9409. @end table
  9410. @end table
  9411. @section kerndeint
  9412. Deinterlace input video by applying Donald Graft's adaptive kernel
  9413. deinterling. Work on interlaced parts of a video to produce
  9414. progressive frames.
  9415. The description of the accepted parameters follows.
  9416. @table @option
  9417. @item thresh
  9418. Set the threshold which affects the filter's tolerance when
  9419. determining if a pixel line must be processed. It must be an integer
  9420. in the range [0,255] and defaults to 10. A value of 0 will result in
  9421. applying the process on every pixels.
  9422. @item map
  9423. Paint pixels exceeding the threshold value to white if set to 1.
  9424. Default is 0.
  9425. @item order
  9426. Set the fields order. Swap fields if set to 1, leave fields alone if
  9427. 0. Default is 0.
  9428. @item sharp
  9429. Enable additional sharpening if set to 1. Default is 0.
  9430. @item twoway
  9431. Enable twoway sharpening if set to 1. Default is 0.
  9432. @end table
  9433. @subsection Examples
  9434. @itemize
  9435. @item
  9436. Apply default values:
  9437. @example
  9438. kerndeint=thresh=10:map=0:order=0:sharp=0:twoway=0
  9439. @end example
  9440. @item
  9441. Enable additional sharpening:
  9442. @example
  9443. kerndeint=sharp=1
  9444. @end example
  9445. @item
  9446. Paint processed pixels in white:
  9447. @example
  9448. kerndeint=map=1
  9449. @end example
  9450. @end itemize
  9451. @section lagfun
  9452. Slowly update darker pixels.
  9453. This filter makes short flashes of light appear longer.
  9454. This filter accepts the following options:
  9455. @table @option
  9456. @item decay
  9457. Set factor for decaying. Default is .95. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  9458. @item planes
  9459. Set which planes to filter. Default is all. Allowed range is from 0 to 15.
  9460. @end table
  9461. @section lenscorrection
  9462. Correct radial lens distortion
  9463. This filter can be used to correct for radial distortion as can result from the use
  9464. of wide angle lenses, and thereby re-rectify the image. To find the right parameters
  9465. one can use tools available for example as part of opencv or simply trial-and-error.
  9466. To use opencv use the calibration sample (under samples/cpp) from the opencv sources
  9467. and extract the k1 and k2 coefficients from the resulting matrix.
  9468. Note that effectively the same filter is available in the open-source tools Krita and
  9469. Digikam from the KDE project.
  9470. In contrast to the @ref{vignette} filter, which can also be used to compensate lens errors,
  9471. this filter corrects the distortion of the image, whereas @ref{vignette} corrects the
  9472. brightness distribution, so you may want to use both filters together in certain
  9473. cases, though you will have to take care of ordering, i.e. whether vignetting should
  9474. be applied before or after lens correction.
  9475. @subsection Options
  9476. The filter accepts the following options:
  9477. @table @option
  9478. @item cx
  9479. Relative x-coordinate of the focal point of the image, and thereby the center of the
  9480. distortion. This value has a range [0,1] and is expressed as fractions of the image
  9481. width. Default is 0.5.
  9482. @item cy
  9483. Relative y-coordinate of the focal point of the image, and thereby the center of the
  9484. distortion. This value has a range [0,1] and is expressed as fractions of the image
  9485. height. Default is 0.5.
  9486. @item k1
  9487. Coefficient of the quadratic correction term. This value has a range [-1,1]. 0 means
  9488. no correction. Default is 0.
  9489. @item k2
  9490. Coefficient of the double quadratic correction term. This value has a range [-1,1].
  9491. 0 means no correction. Default is 0.
  9492. @end table
  9493. The formula that generates the correction is:
  9494. @var{r_src} = @var{r_tgt} * (1 + @var{k1} * (@var{r_tgt} / @var{r_0})^2 + @var{k2} * (@var{r_tgt} / @var{r_0})^4)
  9495. where @var{r_0} is halve of the image diagonal and @var{r_src} and @var{r_tgt} are the
  9496. distances from the focal point in the source and target images, respectively.
  9497. @section lensfun
  9498. Apply lens correction via the lensfun library (@url{http://lensfun.sourceforge.net/}).
  9499. The @code{lensfun} filter requires the camera make, camera model, and lens model
  9500. to apply the lens correction. The filter will load the lensfun database and
  9501. query it to find the corresponding camera and lens entries in the database. As
  9502. long as these entries can be found with the given options, the filter can
  9503. perform corrections on frames. Note that incomplete strings will result in the
  9504. filter choosing the best match with the given options, and the filter will
  9505. output the chosen camera and lens models (logged with level "info"). You must
  9506. provide the make, camera model, and lens model as they are required.
  9507. The filter accepts the following options:
  9508. @table @option
  9509. @item make
  9510. The make of the camera (for example, "Canon"). This option is required.
  9511. @item model
  9512. The model of the camera (for example, "Canon EOS 100D"). This option is
  9513. required.
  9514. @item lens_model
  9515. The model of the lens (for example, "Canon EF-S 18-55mm f/3.5-5.6 IS STM"). This
  9516. option is required.
  9517. @item mode
  9518. The type of correction to apply. The following values are valid options:
  9519. @table @samp
  9520. @item vignetting
  9521. Enables fixing lens vignetting.
  9522. @item geometry
  9523. Enables fixing lens geometry. This is the default.
  9524. @item subpixel
  9525. Enables fixing chromatic aberrations.
  9526. @item vig_geo
  9527. Enables fixing lens vignetting and lens geometry.
  9528. @item vig_subpixel
  9529. Enables fixing lens vignetting and chromatic aberrations.
  9530. @item distortion
  9531. Enables fixing both lens geometry and chromatic aberrations.
  9532. @item all
  9533. Enables all possible corrections.
  9534. @end table
  9535. @item focal_length
  9536. The focal length of the image/video (zoom; expected constant for video). For
  9537. example, a 18--55mm lens has focal length range of [18--55], so a value in that
  9538. range should be chosen when using that lens. Default 18.
  9539. @item aperture
  9540. The aperture of the image/video (expected constant for video). Note that
  9541. aperture is only used for vignetting correction. Default 3.5.
  9542. @item focus_distance
  9543. The focus distance of the image/video (expected constant for video). Note that
  9544. focus distance is only used for vignetting and only slightly affects the
  9545. vignetting correction process. If unknown, leave it at the default value (which
  9546. is 1000).
  9547. @item scale
  9548. The scale factor which is applied after transformation. After correction the
  9549. video is no longer necessarily rectangular. This parameter controls how much of
  9550. the resulting image is visible. The value 0 means that a value will be chosen
  9551. automatically such that there is little or no unmapped area in the output
  9552. image. 1.0 means that no additional scaling is done. Lower values may result
  9553. in more of the corrected image being visible, while higher values may avoid
  9554. unmapped areas in the output.
  9555. @item target_geometry
  9556. The target geometry of the output image/video. The following values are valid
  9557. options:
  9558. @table @samp
  9559. @item rectilinear (default)
  9560. @item fisheye
  9561. @item panoramic
  9562. @item equirectangular
  9563. @item fisheye_orthographic
  9564. @item fisheye_stereographic
  9565. @item fisheye_equisolid
  9566. @item fisheye_thoby
  9567. @end table
  9568. @item reverse
  9569. Apply the reverse of image correction (instead of correcting distortion, apply
  9570. it).
  9571. @item interpolation
  9572. The type of interpolation used when correcting distortion. The following values
  9573. are valid options:
  9574. @table @samp
  9575. @item nearest
  9576. @item linear (default)
  9577. @item lanczos
  9578. @end table
  9579. @end table
  9580. @subsection Examples
  9581. @itemize
  9582. @item
  9583. Apply lens correction with make "Canon", camera model "Canon EOS 100D", and lens
  9584. model "Canon EF-S 18-55mm f/3.5-5.6 IS STM" with focal length of "18" and
  9585. aperture of "8.0".
  9586. @example
  9587. ffmpeg -i input.mov -vf lensfun=make=Canon:model="Canon EOS 100D":lens_model="Canon EF-S 18-55mm f/3.5-5.6 IS STM":focal_length=18:aperture=8 -c:v h264 -b:v 8000k output.mov
  9588. @end example
  9589. @item
  9590. Apply the same as before, but only for the first 5 seconds of video.
  9591. @example
  9592. ffmpeg -i input.mov -vf lensfun=make=Canon:model="Canon EOS 100D":lens_model="Canon EF-S 18-55mm f/3.5-5.6 IS STM":focal_length=18:aperture=8:enable='lte(t\,5)' -c:v h264 -b:v 8000k output.mov
  9593. @end example
  9594. @end itemize
  9595. @section libvmaf
  9596. Obtain the VMAF (Video Multi-Method Assessment Fusion)
  9597. score between two input videos.
  9598. The obtained VMAF score is printed through the logging system.
  9599. It requires Netflix's vmaf library (libvmaf) as a pre-requisite.
  9600. After installing the library it can be enabled using:
  9601. @code{./configure --enable-libvmaf --enable-version3}.
  9602. If no model path is specified it uses the default model: @code{vmaf_v0.6.1.pkl}.
  9603. The filter has following options:
  9604. @table @option
  9605. @item model_path
  9606. Set the model path which is to be used for SVM.
  9607. Default value: @code{"/usr/local/share/model/vmaf_v0.6.1.pkl"}
  9608. @item log_path
  9609. Set the file path to be used to store logs.
  9610. @item log_fmt
  9611. Set the format of the log file (xml or json).
  9612. @item enable_transform
  9613. This option can enable/disable the @code{score_transform} applied to the final predicted VMAF score,
  9614. if you have specified score_transform option in the input parameter file passed to @code{run_vmaf_training.py}
  9615. Default value: @code{false}
  9616. @item phone_model
  9617. Invokes the phone model which will generate VMAF scores higher than in the
  9618. regular model, which is more suitable for laptop, TV, etc. viewing conditions.
  9619. Default value: @code{false}
  9620. @item psnr
  9621. Enables computing psnr along with vmaf.
  9622. Default value: @code{false}
  9623. @item ssim
  9624. Enables computing ssim along with vmaf.
  9625. Default value: @code{false}
  9626. @item ms_ssim
  9627. Enables computing ms_ssim along with vmaf.
  9628. Default value: @code{false}
  9629. @item pool
  9630. Set the pool method to be used for computing vmaf.
  9631. Options are @code{min}, @code{harmonic_mean} or @code{mean} (default).
  9632. @item n_threads
  9633. Set number of threads to be used when computing vmaf.
  9634. Default value: @code{0}, which makes use of all available logical processors.
  9635. @item n_subsample
  9636. Set interval for frame subsampling used when computing vmaf.
  9637. Default value: @code{1}
  9638. @item enable_conf_interval
  9639. Enables confidence interval.
  9640. Default value: @code{false}
  9641. @end table
  9642. This filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  9643. @subsection Examples
  9644. @itemize
  9645. @item
  9646. On the below examples the input file @file{main.mpg} being processed is
  9647. compared with the reference file @file{ref.mpg}.
  9648. @example
  9649. ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mpg -lavfi libvmaf -f null -
  9650. @end example
  9651. @item
  9652. Example with options:
  9653. @example
  9654. ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mpg -lavfi libvmaf="psnr=1:log_fmt=json" -f null -
  9655. @end example
  9656. @item
  9657. Example with options and different containers:
  9658. @example
  9659. ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mkv -lavfi "[0:v]settb=AVTB,setpts=PTS-STARTPTS[main];[1:v]settb=AVTB,setpts=PTS-STARTPTS[ref];[main][ref]libvmaf=psnr=1:log_fmt=json" -f null -
  9660. @end example
  9661. @end itemize
  9662. @section limiter
  9663. Limits the pixel components values to the specified range [min, max].
  9664. The filter accepts the following options:
  9665. @table @option
  9666. @item min
  9667. Lower bound. Defaults to the lowest allowed value for the input.
  9668. @item max
  9669. Upper bound. Defaults to the highest allowed value for the input.
  9670. @item planes
  9671. Specify which planes will be processed. Defaults to all available.
  9672. @end table
  9673. @section loop
  9674. Loop video frames.
  9675. The filter accepts the following options:
  9676. @table @option
  9677. @item loop
  9678. Set the number of loops. Setting this value to -1 will result in infinite loops.
  9679. Default is 0.
  9680. @item size
  9681. Set maximal size in number of frames. Default is 0.
  9682. @item start
  9683. Set first frame of loop. Default is 0.
  9684. @end table
  9685. @subsection Examples
  9686. @itemize
  9687. @item
  9688. Loop single first frame infinitely:
  9689. @example
  9690. loop=loop=-1:size=1:start=0
  9691. @end example
  9692. @item
  9693. Loop single first frame 10 times:
  9694. @example
  9695. loop=loop=10:size=1:start=0
  9696. @end example
  9697. @item
  9698. Loop 10 first frames 5 times:
  9699. @example
  9700. loop=loop=5:size=10:start=0
  9701. @end example
  9702. @end itemize
  9703. @section lut1d
  9704. Apply a 1D LUT to an input video.
  9705. The filter accepts the following options:
  9706. @table @option
  9707. @item file
  9708. Set the 1D LUT file name.
  9709. Currently supported formats:
  9710. @table @samp
  9711. @item cube
  9712. Iridas
  9713. @item csp
  9714. cineSpace
  9715. @end table
  9716. @item interp
  9717. Select interpolation mode.
  9718. Available values are:
  9719. @table @samp
  9720. @item nearest
  9721. Use values from the nearest defined point.
  9722. @item linear
  9723. Interpolate values using the linear interpolation.
  9724. @item cosine
  9725. Interpolate values using the cosine interpolation.
  9726. @item cubic
  9727. Interpolate values using the cubic interpolation.
  9728. @item spline
  9729. Interpolate values using the spline interpolation.
  9730. @end table
  9731. @end table
  9732. @anchor{lut3d}
  9733. @section lut3d
  9734. Apply a 3D LUT to an input video.
  9735. The filter accepts the following options:
  9736. @table @option
  9737. @item file
  9738. Set the 3D LUT file name.
  9739. Currently supported formats:
  9740. @table @samp
  9741. @item 3dl
  9742. AfterEffects
  9743. @item cube
  9744. Iridas
  9745. @item dat
  9746. DaVinci
  9747. @item m3d
  9748. Pandora
  9749. @item csp
  9750. cineSpace
  9751. @end table
  9752. @item interp
  9753. Select interpolation mode.
  9754. Available values are:
  9755. @table @samp
  9756. @item nearest
  9757. Use values from the nearest defined point.
  9758. @item trilinear
  9759. Interpolate values using the 8 points defining a cube.
  9760. @item tetrahedral
  9761. Interpolate values using a tetrahedron.
  9762. @end table
  9763. @end table
  9764. @section lumakey
  9765. Turn certain luma values into transparency.
  9766. The filter accepts the following options:
  9767. @table @option
  9768. @item threshold
  9769. Set the luma which will be used as base for transparency.
  9770. Default value is @code{0}.
  9771. @item tolerance
  9772. Set the range of luma values to be keyed out.
  9773. Default value is @code{0.01}.
  9774. @item softness
  9775. Set the range of softness. Default value is @code{0}.
  9776. Use this to control gradual transition from zero to full transparency.
  9777. @end table
  9778. @subsection Commands
  9779. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  9780. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  9781. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  9782. value.
  9783. @section lut, lutrgb, lutyuv
  9784. Compute a look-up table for binding each pixel component input value
  9785. to an output value, and apply it to the input video.
  9786. @var{lutyuv} applies a lookup table to a YUV input video, @var{lutrgb}
  9787. to an RGB input video.
  9788. These filters accept the following parameters:
  9789. @table @option
  9790. @item c0
  9791. set first pixel component expression
  9792. @item c1
  9793. set second pixel component expression
  9794. @item c2
  9795. set third pixel component expression
  9796. @item c3
  9797. set fourth pixel component expression, corresponds to the alpha component
  9798. @item r
  9799. set red component expression
  9800. @item g
  9801. set green component expression
  9802. @item b
  9803. set blue component expression
  9804. @item a
  9805. alpha component expression
  9806. @item y
  9807. set Y/luminance component expression
  9808. @item u
  9809. set U/Cb component expression
  9810. @item v
  9811. set V/Cr component expression
  9812. @end table
  9813. Each of them specifies the expression to use for computing the lookup table for
  9814. the corresponding pixel component values.
  9815. The exact component associated to each of the @var{c*} options depends on the
  9816. format in input.
  9817. The @var{lut} filter requires either YUV or RGB pixel formats in input,
  9818. @var{lutrgb} requires RGB pixel formats in input, and @var{lutyuv} requires YUV.
  9819. The expressions can contain the following constants and functions:
  9820. @table @option
  9821. @item w
  9822. @item h
  9823. The input width and height.
  9824. @item val
  9825. The input value for the pixel component.
  9826. @item clipval
  9827. The input value, clipped to the @var{minval}-@var{maxval} range.
  9828. @item maxval
  9829. The maximum value for the pixel component.
  9830. @item minval
  9831. The minimum value for the pixel component.
  9832. @item negval
  9833. The negated value for the pixel component value, clipped to the
  9834. @var{minval}-@var{maxval} range; it corresponds to the expression
  9835. "maxval-clipval+minval".
  9836. @item clip(val)
  9837. The computed value in @var{val}, clipped to the
  9838. @var{minval}-@var{maxval} range.
  9839. @item gammaval(gamma)
  9840. The computed gamma correction value of the pixel component value,
  9841. clipped to the @var{minval}-@var{maxval} range. It corresponds to the
  9842. expression
  9843. "pow((clipval-minval)/(maxval-minval)\,@var{gamma})*(maxval-minval)+minval"
  9844. @end table
  9845. All expressions default to "val".
  9846. @subsection Examples
  9847. @itemize
  9848. @item
  9849. Negate input video:
  9850. @example
  9851. lutrgb="r=maxval+minval-val:g=maxval+minval-val:b=maxval+minval-val"
  9852. lutyuv="y=maxval+minval-val:u=maxval+minval-val:v=maxval+minval-val"
  9853. @end example
  9854. The above is the same as:
  9855. @example
  9856. lutrgb="r=negval:g=negval:b=negval"
  9857. lutyuv="y=negval:u=negval:v=negval"
  9858. @end example
  9859. @item
  9860. Negate luminance:
  9861. @example
  9862. lutyuv=y=negval
  9863. @end example
  9864. @item
  9865. Remove chroma components, turning the video into a graytone image:
  9866. @example
  9867. lutyuv="u=128:v=128"
  9868. @end example
  9869. @item
  9870. Apply a luma burning effect:
  9871. @example
  9872. lutyuv="y=2*val"
  9873. @end example
  9874. @item
  9875. Remove green and blue components:
  9876. @example
  9877. lutrgb="g=0:b=0"
  9878. @end example
  9879. @item
  9880. Set a constant alpha channel value on input:
  9881. @example
  9882. format=rgba,lutrgb=a="maxval-minval/2"
  9883. @end example
  9884. @item
  9885. Correct luminance gamma by a factor of 0.5:
  9886. @example
  9887. lutyuv=y=gammaval(0.5)
  9888. @end example
  9889. @item
  9890. Discard least significant bits of luma:
  9891. @example
  9892. lutyuv=y='bitand(val, 128+64+32)'
  9893. @end example
  9894. @item
  9895. Technicolor like effect:
  9896. @example
  9897. lutyuv=u='(val-maxval/2)*2+maxval/2':v='(val-maxval/2)*2+maxval/2'
  9898. @end example
  9899. @end itemize
  9900. @section lut2, tlut2
  9901. The @code{lut2} filter takes two input streams and outputs one
  9902. stream.
  9903. The @code{tlut2} (time lut2) filter takes two consecutive frames
  9904. from one single stream.
  9905. This filter accepts the following parameters:
  9906. @table @option
  9907. @item c0
  9908. set first pixel component expression
  9909. @item c1
  9910. set second pixel component expression
  9911. @item c2
  9912. set third pixel component expression
  9913. @item c3
  9914. set fourth pixel component expression, corresponds to the alpha component
  9915. @item d
  9916. set output bit depth, only available for @code{lut2} filter. By default is 0,
  9917. which means bit depth is automatically picked from first input format.
  9918. @end table
  9919. Each of them specifies the expression to use for computing the lookup table for
  9920. the corresponding pixel component values.
  9921. The exact component associated to each of the @var{c*} options depends on the
  9922. format in inputs.
  9923. The expressions can contain the following constants:
  9924. @table @option
  9925. @item w
  9926. @item h
  9927. The input width and height.
  9928. @item x
  9929. The first input value for the pixel component.
  9930. @item y
  9931. The second input value for the pixel component.
  9932. @item bdx
  9933. The first input video bit depth.
  9934. @item bdy
  9935. The second input video bit depth.
  9936. @end table
  9937. All expressions default to "x".
  9938. @subsection Examples
  9939. @itemize
  9940. @item
  9941. Highlight differences between two RGB video streams:
  9942. @example
  9943. lut2='ifnot(x-y,0,pow(2,bdx)-1):ifnot(x-y,0,pow(2,bdx)-1):ifnot(x-y,0,pow(2,bdx)-1)'
  9944. @end example
  9945. @item
  9946. Highlight differences between two YUV video streams:
  9947. @example
  9948. lut2='ifnot(x-y,0,pow(2,bdx)-1):ifnot(x-y,pow(2,bdx-1),pow(2,bdx)-1):ifnot(x-y,pow(2,bdx-1),pow(2,bdx)-1)'
  9949. @end example
  9950. @item
  9951. Show max difference between two video streams:
  9952. @example
  9953. lut2='if(lt(x,y),0,if(gt(x,y),pow(2,bdx)-1,pow(2,bdx-1))):if(lt(x,y),0,if(gt(x,y),pow(2,bdx)-1,pow(2,bdx-1))):if(lt(x,y),0,if(gt(x,y),pow(2,bdx)-1,pow(2,bdx-1)))'
  9954. @end example
  9955. @end itemize
  9956. @section maskedclamp
  9957. Clamp the first input stream with the second input and third input stream.
  9958. Returns the value of first stream to be between second input
  9959. stream - @code{undershoot} and third input stream + @code{overshoot}.
  9960. This filter accepts the following options:
  9961. @table @option
  9962. @item undershoot
  9963. Default value is @code{0}.
  9964. @item overshoot
  9965. Default value is @code{0}.
  9966. @item planes
  9967. Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be
  9968. copied from first stream.
  9969. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  9970. @end table
  9971. @section maskedmax
  9972. Merge the second and third input stream into output stream using absolute differences
  9973. between second input stream and first input stream and absolute difference between
  9974. third input stream and first input stream. The picked value will be from second input
  9975. stream if second absolute difference is greater than first one or from third input stream
  9976. otherwise.
  9977. This filter accepts the following options:
  9978. @table @option
  9979. @item planes
  9980. Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be
  9981. copied from first stream.
  9982. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  9983. @end table
  9984. @section maskedmerge
  9985. Merge the first input stream with the second input stream using per pixel
  9986. weights in the third input stream.
  9987. A value of 0 in the third stream pixel component means that pixel component
  9988. from first stream is returned unchanged, while maximum value (eg. 255 for
  9989. 8-bit videos) means that pixel component from second stream is returned
  9990. unchanged. Intermediate values define the amount of merging between both
  9991. input stream's pixel components.
  9992. This filter accepts the following options:
  9993. @table @option
  9994. @item planes
  9995. Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be
  9996. copied from first stream.
  9997. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  9998. @end table
  9999. @section maskedmin
  10000. Merge the second and third input stream into output stream using absolute differences
  10001. between second input stream and first input stream and absolute difference between
  10002. third input stream and first input stream. The picked value will be from second input
  10003. stream if second absolute difference is less than first one or from third input stream
  10004. otherwise.
  10005. This filter accepts the following options:
  10006. @table @option
  10007. @item planes
  10008. Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be
  10009. copied from first stream.
  10010. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  10011. @end table
  10012. @section maskfun
  10013. Create mask from input video.
  10014. For example it is useful to create motion masks after @code{tblend} filter.
  10015. This filter accepts the following options:
  10016. @table @option
  10017. @item low
  10018. Set low threshold. Any pixel component lower or exact than this value will be set to 0.
  10019. @item high
  10020. Set high threshold. Any pixel component higher than this value will be set to max value
  10021. allowed for current pixel format.
  10022. @item planes
  10023. Set planes to filter, by default all available planes are filtered.
  10024. @item fill
  10025. Fill all frame pixels with this value.
  10026. @item sum
  10027. Set max average pixel value for frame. If sum of all pixel components is higher that this
  10028. average, output frame will be completely filled with value set by @var{fill} option.
  10029. Typically useful for scene changes when used in combination with @code{tblend} filter.
  10030. @end table
  10031. @section mcdeint
  10032. Apply motion-compensation deinterlacing.
  10033. It needs one field per frame as input and must thus be used together
  10034. with yadif=1/3 or equivalent.
  10035. This filter accepts the following options:
  10036. @table @option
  10037. @item mode
  10038. Set the deinterlacing mode.
  10039. It accepts one of the following values:
  10040. @table @samp
  10041. @item fast
  10042. @item medium
  10043. @item slow
  10044. use iterative motion estimation
  10045. @item extra_slow
  10046. like @samp{slow}, but use multiple reference frames.
  10047. @end table
  10048. Default value is @samp{fast}.
  10049. @item parity
  10050. Set the picture field parity assumed for the input video. It must be
  10051. one of the following values:
  10052. @table @samp
  10053. @item 0, tff
  10054. assume top field first
  10055. @item 1, bff
  10056. assume bottom field first
  10057. @end table
  10058. Default value is @samp{bff}.
  10059. @item qp
  10060. Set per-block quantization parameter (QP) used by the internal
  10061. encoder.
  10062. Higher values should result in a smoother motion vector field but less
  10063. optimal individual vectors. Default value is 1.
  10064. @end table
  10065. @section median
  10066. Pick median pixel from certain rectangle defined by radius.
  10067. This filter accepts the following options:
  10068. @table @option
  10069. @item radius
  10070. Set horizontal radius size. Default value is @code{1}.
  10071. Allowed range is integer from 1 to 127.
  10072. @item planes
  10073. Set which planes to process. Default is @code{15}, which is all available planes.
  10074. @item radiusV
  10075. Set vertical radius size. Default value is @code{0}.
  10076. Allowed range is integer from 0 to 127.
  10077. If it is 0, value will be picked from horizontal @code{radius} option.
  10078. @end table
  10079. @subsection Commands
  10080. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  10081. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  10082. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  10083. value.
  10084. @section mergeplanes
  10085. Merge color channel components from several video streams.
  10086. The filter accepts up to 4 input streams, and merge selected input
  10087. planes to the output video.
  10088. This filter accepts the following options:
  10089. @table @option
  10090. @item mapping
  10091. Set input to output plane mapping. Default is @code{0}.
  10092. The mappings is specified as a bitmap. It should be specified as a
  10093. hexadecimal number in the form 0xAa[Bb[Cc[Dd]]]. 'Aa' describes the
  10094. mapping for the first plane of the output stream. 'A' sets the number of
  10095. the input stream to use (from 0 to 3), and 'a' the plane number of the
  10096. corresponding input to use (from 0 to 3). The rest of the mappings is
  10097. similar, 'Bb' describes the mapping for the output stream second
  10098. plane, 'Cc' describes the mapping for the output stream third plane and
  10099. 'Dd' describes the mapping for the output stream fourth plane.
  10100. @item format
  10101. Set output pixel format. Default is @code{yuva444p}.
  10102. @end table
  10103. @subsection Examples
  10104. @itemize
  10105. @item
  10106. Merge three gray video streams of same width and height into single video stream:
  10107. @example
  10108. [a0][a1][a2]mergeplanes=0x001020:yuv444p
  10109. @end example
  10110. @item
  10111. Merge 1st yuv444p stream and 2nd gray video stream into yuva444p video stream:
  10112. @example
  10113. [a0][a1]mergeplanes=0x00010210:yuva444p
  10114. @end example
  10115. @item
  10116. Swap Y and A plane in yuva444p stream:
  10117. @example
  10118. format=yuva444p,mergeplanes=0x03010200:yuva444p
  10119. @end example
  10120. @item
  10121. Swap U and V plane in yuv420p stream:
  10122. @example
  10123. format=yuv420p,mergeplanes=0x000201:yuv420p
  10124. @end example
  10125. @item
  10126. Cast a rgb24 clip to yuv444p:
  10127. @example
  10128. format=rgb24,mergeplanes=0x000102:yuv444p
  10129. @end example
  10130. @end itemize
  10131. @section mestimate
  10132. Estimate and export motion vectors using block matching algorithms.
  10133. Motion vectors are stored in frame side data to be used by other filters.
  10134. This filter accepts the following options:
  10135. @table @option
  10136. @item method
  10137. Specify the motion estimation method. Accepts one of the following values:
  10138. @table @samp
  10139. @item esa
  10140. Exhaustive search algorithm.
  10141. @item tss
  10142. Three step search algorithm.
  10143. @item tdls
  10144. Two dimensional logarithmic search algorithm.
  10145. @item ntss
  10146. New three step search algorithm.
  10147. @item fss
  10148. Four step search algorithm.
  10149. @item ds
  10150. Diamond search algorithm.
  10151. @item hexbs
  10152. Hexagon-based search algorithm.
  10153. @item epzs
  10154. Enhanced predictive zonal search algorithm.
  10155. @item umh
  10156. Uneven multi-hexagon search algorithm.
  10157. @end table
  10158. Default value is @samp{esa}.
  10159. @item mb_size
  10160. Macroblock size. Default @code{16}.
  10161. @item search_param
  10162. Search parameter. Default @code{7}.
  10163. @end table
  10164. @section midequalizer
  10165. Apply Midway Image Equalization effect using two video streams.
  10166. Midway Image Equalization adjusts a pair of images to have the same
  10167. histogram, while maintaining their dynamics as much as possible. It's
  10168. useful for e.g. matching exposures from a pair of stereo cameras.
  10169. This filter has two inputs and one output, which must be of same pixel format, but
  10170. may be of different sizes. The output of filter is first input adjusted with
  10171. midway histogram of both inputs.
  10172. This filter accepts the following option:
  10173. @table @option
  10174. @item planes
  10175. Set which planes to process. Default is @code{15}, which is all available planes.
  10176. @end table
  10177. @section minterpolate
  10178. Convert the video to specified frame rate using motion interpolation.
  10179. This filter accepts the following options:
  10180. @table @option
  10181. @item fps
  10182. Specify the output frame rate. This can be rational e.g. @code{60000/1001}. Frames are dropped if @var{fps} is lower than source fps. Default @code{60}.
  10183. @item mi_mode
  10184. Motion interpolation mode. Following values are accepted:
  10185. @table @samp
  10186. @item dup
  10187. Duplicate previous or next frame for interpolating new ones.
  10188. @item blend
  10189. Blend source frames. Interpolated frame is mean of previous and next frames.
  10190. @item mci
  10191. Motion compensated interpolation. Following options are effective when this mode is selected:
  10192. @table @samp
  10193. @item mc_mode
  10194. Motion compensation mode. Following values are accepted:
  10195. @table @samp
  10196. @item obmc
  10197. Overlapped block motion compensation.
  10198. @item aobmc
  10199. Adaptive overlapped block motion compensation. Window weighting coefficients are controlled adaptively according to the reliabilities of the neighboring motion vectors to reduce oversmoothing.
  10200. @end table
  10201. Default mode is @samp{obmc}.
  10202. @item me_mode
  10203. Motion estimation mode. Following values are accepted:
  10204. @table @samp
  10205. @item bidir
  10206. Bidirectional motion estimation. Motion vectors are estimated for each source frame in both forward and backward directions.
  10207. @item bilat
  10208. Bilateral motion estimation. Motion vectors are estimated directly for interpolated frame.
  10209. @end table
  10210. Default mode is @samp{bilat}.
  10211. @item me
  10212. The algorithm to be used for motion estimation. Following values are accepted:
  10213. @table @samp
  10214. @item esa
  10215. Exhaustive search algorithm.
  10216. @item tss
  10217. Three step search algorithm.
  10218. @item tdls
  10219. Two dimensional logarithmic search algorithm.
  10220. @item ntss
  10221. New three step search algorithm.
  10222. @item fss
  10223. Four step search algorithm.
  10224. @item ds
  10225. Diamond search algorithm.
  10226. @item hexbs
  10227. Hexagon-based search algorithm.
  10228. @item epzs
  10229. Enhanced predictive zonal search algorithm.
  10230. @item umh
  10231. Uneven multi-hexagon search algorithm.
  10232. @end table
  10233. Default algorithm is @samp{epzs}.
  10234. @item mb_size
  10235. Macroblock size. Default @code{16}.
  10236. @item search_param
  10237. Motion estimation search parameter. Default @code{32}.
  10238. @item vsbmc
  10239. Enable variable-size block motion compensation. Motion estimation is applied with smaller block sizes at object boundaries in order to make the them less blur. Default is @code{0} (disabled).
  10240. @end table
  10241. @end table
  10242. @item scd
  10243. Scene change detection method. Scene change leads motion vectors to be in random direction. Scene change detection replace interpolated frames by duplicate ones. May not be needed for other modes. Following values are accepted:
  10244. @table @samp
  10245. @item none
  10246. Disable scene change detection.
  10247. @item fdiff
  10248. Frame difference. Corresponding pixel values are compared and if it satisfies @var{scd_threshold} scene change is detected.
  10249. @end table
  10250. Default method is @samp{fdiff}.
  10251. @item scd_threshold
  10252. Scene change detection threshold. Default is @code{5.0}.
  10253. @end table
  10254. @section mix
  10255. Mix several video input streams into one video stream.
  10256. A description of the accepted options follows.
  10257. @table @option
  10258. @item nb_inputs
  10259. The number of inputs. If unspecified, it defaults to 2.
  10260. @item weights
  10261. Specify weight of each input video stream as sequence.
  10262. Each weight is separated by space. If number of weights
  10263. is smaller than number of @var{frames} last specified
  10264. weight will be used for all remaining unset weights.
  10265. @item scale
  10266. Specify scale, if it is set it will be multiplied with sum
  10267. of each weight multiplied with pixel values to give final destination
  10268. pixel value. By default @var{scale} is auto scaled to sum of weights.
  10269. @item duration
  10270. Specify how end of stream is determined.
  10271. @table @samp
  10272. @item longest
  10273. The duration of the longest input. (default)
  10274. @item shortest
  10275. The duration of the shortest input.
  10276. @item first
  10277. The duration of the first input.
  10278. @end table
  10279. @end table
  10280. @section mpdecimate
  10281. Drop frames that do not differ greatly from the previous frame in
  10282. order to reduce frame rate.
  10283. The main use of this filter is for very-low-bitrate encoding
  10284. (e.g. streaming over dialup modem), but it could in theory be used for
  10285. fixing movies that were inverse-telecined incorrectly.
  10286. A description of the accepted options follows.
  10287. @table @option
  10288. @item max
  10289. Set the maximum number of consecutive frames which can be dropped (if
  10290. positive), or the minimum interval between dropped frames (if
  10291. negative). If the value is 0, the frame is dropped disregarding the
  10292. number of previous sequentially dropped frames.
  10293. Default value is 0.
  10294. @item hi
  10295. @item lo
  10296. @item frac
  10297. Set the dropping threshold values.
  10298. Values for @option{hi} and @option{lo} are for 8x8 pixel blocks and
  10299. represent actual pixel value differences, so a threshold of 64
  10300. corresponds to 1 unit of difference for each pixel, or the same spread
  10301. out differently over the block.
  10302. A frame is a candidate for dropping if no 8x8 blocks differ by more
  10303. than a threshold of @option{hi}, and if no more than @option{frac} blocks (1
  10304. meaning the whole image) differ by more than a threshold of @option{lo}.
  10305. Default value for @option{hi} is 64*12, default value for @option{lo} is
  10306. 64*5, and default value for @option{frac} is 0.33.
  10307. @end table
  10308. @section negate
  10309. Negate (invert) the input video.
  10310. It accepts the following option:
  10311. @table @option
  10312. @item negate_alpha
  10313. With value 1, it negates the alpha component, if present. Default value is 0.
  10314. @end table
  10315. @anchor{nlmeans}
  10316. @section nlmeans
  10317. Denoise frames using Non-Local Means algorithm.
  10318. Each pixel is adjusted by looking for other pixels with similar contexts. This
  10319. context similarity is defined by comparing their surrounding patches of size
  10320. @option{p}x@option{p}. Patches are searched in an area of @option{r}x@option{r}
  10321. around the pixel.
  10322. Note that the research area defines centers for patches, which means some
  10323. patches will be made of pixels outside that research area.
  10324. The filter accepts the following options.
  10325. @table @option
  10326. @item s
  10327. Set denoising strength. Default is 1.0. Must be in range [1.0, 30.0].
  10328. @item p
  10329. Set patch size. Default is 7. Must be odd number in range [0, 99].
  10330. @item pc
  10331. Same as @option{p} but for chroma planes.
  10332. The default value is @var{0} and means automatic.
  10333. @item r
  10334. Set research size. Default is 15. Must be odd number in range [0, 99].
  10335. @item rc
  10336. Same as @option{r} but for chroma planes.
  10337. The default value is @var{0} and means automatic.
  10338. @end table
  10339. @section nnedi
  10340. Deinterlace video using neural network edge directed interpolation.
  10341. This filter accepts the following options:
  10342. @table @option
  10343. @item weights
  10344. Mandatory option, without binary file filter can not work.
  10345. Currently file can be found here:
  10346. https://github.com/dubhater/vapoursynth-nnedi3/blob/master/src/nnedi3_weights.bin
  10347. @item deint
  10348. Set which frames to deinterlace, by default it is @code{all}.
  10349. Can be @code{all} or @code{interlaced}.
  10350. @item field
  10351. Set mode of operation.
  10352. Can be one of the following:
  10353. @table @samp
  10354. @item af
  10355. Use frame flags, both fields.
  10356. @item a
  10357. Use frame flags, single field.
  10358. @item t
  10359. Use top field only.
  10360. @item b
  10361. Use bottom field only.
  10362. @item tf
  10363. Use both fields, top first.
  10364. @item bf
  10365. Use both fields, bottom first.
  10366. @end table
  10367. @item planes
  10368. Set which planes to process, by default filter process all frames.
  10369. @item nsize
  10370. Set size of local neighborhood around each pixel, used by the predictor neural
  10371. network.
  10372. Can be one of the following:
  10373. @table @samp
  10374. @item s8x6
  10375. @item s16x6
  10376. @item s32x6
  10377. @item s48x6
  10378. @item s8x4
  10379. @item s16x4
  10380. @item s32x4
  10381. @end table
  10382. @item nns
  10383. Set the number of neurons in predictor neural network.
  10384. Can be one of the following:
  10385. @table @samp
  10386. @item n16
  10387. @item n32
  10388. @item n64
  10389. @item n128
  10390. @item n256
  10391. @end table
  10392. @item qual
  10393. Controls the number of different neural network predictions that are blended
  10394. together to compute the final output value. Can be @code{fast}, default or
  10395. @code{slow}.
  10396. @item etype
  10397. Set which set of weights to use in the predictor.
  10398. Can be one of the following:
  10399. @table @samp
  10400. @item a
  10401. weights trained to minimize absolute error
  10402. @item s
  10403. weights trained to minimize squared error
  10404. @end table
  10405. @item pscrn
  10406. Controls whether or not the prescreener neural network is used to decide
  10407. which pixels should be processed by the predictor neural network and which
  10408. can be handled by simple cubic interpolation.
  10409. The prescreener is trained to know whether cubic interpolation will be
  10410. sufficient for a pixel or whether it should be predicted by the predictor nn.
  10411. The computational complexity of the prescreener nn is much less than that of
  10412. the predictor nn. Since most pixels can be handled by cubic interpolation,
  10413. using the prescreener generally results in much faster processing.
  10414. The prescreener is pretty accurate, so the difference between using it and not
  10415. using it is almost always unnoticeable.
  10416. Can be one of the following:
  10417. @table @samp
  10418. @item none
  10419. @item original
  10420. @item new
  10421. @end table
  10422. Default is @code{new}.
  10423. @item fapprox
  10424. Set various debugging flags.
  10425. @end table
  10426. @section noformat
  10427. Force libavfilter not to use any of the specified pixel formats for the
  10428. input to the next filter.
  10429. It accepts the following parameters:
  10430. @table @option
  10431. @item pix_fmts
  10432. A '|'-separated list of pixel format names, such as
  10433. pix_fmts=yuv420p|monow|rgb24".
  10434. @end table
  10435. @subsection Examples
  10436. @itemize
  10437. @item
  10438. Force libavfilter to use a format different from @var{yuv420p} for the
  10439. input to the vflip filter:
  10440. @example
  10441. noformat=pix_fmts=yuv420p,vflip
  10442. @end example
  10443. @item
  10444. Convert the input video to any of the formats not contained in the list:
  10445. @example
  10446. noformat=yuv420p|yuv444p|yuv410p
  10447. @end example
  10448. @end itemize
  10449. @section noise
  10450. Add noise on video input frame.
  10451. The filter accepts the following options:
  10452. @table @option
  10453. @item all_seed
  10454. @item c0_seed
  10455. @item c1_seed
  10456. @item c2_seed
  10457. @item c3_seed
  10458. Set noise seed for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  10459. of @var{all_seed}. Default value is @code{123457}.
  10460. @item all_strength, alls
  10461. @item c0_strength, c0s
  10462. @item c1_strength, c1s
  10463. @item c2_strength, c2s
  10464. @item c3_strength, c3s
  10465. Set noise strength for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  10466. @var{all_strength}. Default value is @code{0}. Allowed range is [0, 100].
  10467. @item all_flags, allf
  10468. @item c0_flags, c0f
  10469. @item c1_flags, c1f
  10470. @item c2_flags, c2f
  10471. @item c3_flags, c3f
  10472. Set pixel component flags or set flags for all components if @var{all_flags}.
  10473. Available values for component flags are:
  10474. @table @samp
  10475. @item a
  10476. averaged temporal noise (smoother)
  10477. @item p
  10478. mix random noise with a (semi)regular pattern
  10479. @item t
  10480. temporal noise (noise pattern changes between frames)
  10481. @item u
  10482. uniform noise (gaussian otherwise)
  10483. @end table
  10484. @end table
  10485. @subsection Examples
  10486. Add temporal and uniform noise to input video:
  10487. @example
  10488. noise=alls=20:allf=t+u
  10489. @end example
  10490. @section normalize
  10491. Normalize RGB video (aka histogram stretching, contrast stretching).
  10492. See: https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Normalization_(image_processing)
  10493. For each channel of each frame, the filter computes the input range and maps
  10494. it linearly to the user-specified output range. The output range defaults
  10495. to the full dynamic range from pure black to pure white.
  10496. Temporal smoothing can be used on the input range to reduce flickering (rapid
  10497. changes in brightness) caused when small dark or bright objects enter or leave
  10498. the scene. This is similar to the auto-exposure (automatic gain control) on a
  10499. video camera, and, like a video camera, it may cause a period of over- or
  10500. under-exposure of the video.
  10501. The R,G,B channels can be normalized independently, which may cause some
  10502. color shifting, or linked together as a single channel, which prevents
  10503. color shifting. Linked normalization preserves hue. Independent normalization
  10504. does not, so it can be used to remove some color casts. Independent and linked
  10505. normalization can be combined in any ratio.
  10506. The normalize filter accepts the following options:
  10507. @table @option
  10508. @item blackpt
  10509. @item whitept
  10510. Colors which define the output range. The minimum input value is mapped to
  10511. the @var{blackpt}. The maximum input value is mapped to the @var{whitept}.
  10512. The defaults are black and white respectively. Specifying white for
  10513. @var{blackpt} and black for @var{whitept} will give color-inverted,
  10514. normalized video. Shades of grey can be used to reduce the dynamic range
  10515. (contrast). Specifying saturated colors here can create some interesting
  10516. effects.
  10517. @item smoothing
  10518. The number of previous frames to use for temporal smoothing. The input range
  10519. of each channel is smoothed using a rolling average over the current frame
  10520. and the @var{smoothing} previous frames. The default is 0 (no temporal
  10521. smoothing).
  10522. @item independence
  10523. Controls the ratio of independent (color shifting) channel normalization to
  10524. linked (color preserving) normalization. 0.0 is fully linked, 1.0 is fully
  10525. independent. Defaults to 1.0 (fully independent).
  10526. @item strength
  10527. Overall strength of the filter. 1.0 is full strength. 0.0 is a rather
  10528. expensive no-op. Defaults to 1.0 (full strength).
  10529. @end table
  10530. @subsection Commands
  10531. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options, excluding @var{smoothing} option.
  10532. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  10533. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  10534. value.
  10535. @subsection Examples
  10536. Stretch video contrast to use the full dynamic range, with no temporal
  10537. smoothing; may flicker depending on the source content:
  10538. @example
  10539. normalize=blackpt=black:whitept=white:smoothing=0
  10540. @end example
  10541. As above, but with 50 frames of temporal smoothing; flicker should be
  10542. reduced, depending on the source content:
  10543. @example
  10544. normalize=blackpt=black:whitept=white:smoothing=50
  10545. @end example
  10546. As above, but with hue-preserving linked channel normalization:
  10547. @example
  10548. normalize=blackpt=black:whitept=white:smoothing=50:independence=0
  10549. @end example
  10550. As above, but with half strength:
  10551. @example
  10552. normalize=blackpt=black:whitept=white:smoothing=50:independence=0:strength=0.5
  10553. @end example
  10554. Map the darkest input color to red, the brightest input color to cyan:
  10555. @example
  10556. normalize=blackpt=red:whitept=cyan
  10557. @end example
  10558. @section null
  10559. Pass the video source unchanged to the output.
  10560. @section ocr
  10561. Optical Character Recognition
  10562. This filter uses Tesseract for optical character recognition. To enable
  10563. compilation of this filter, you need to configure FFmpeg with
  10564. @code{--enable-libtesseract}.
  10565. It accepts the following options:
  10566. @table @option
  10567. @item datapath
  10568. Set datapath to tesseract data. Default is to use whatever was
  10569. set at installation.
  10570. @item language
  10571. Set language, default is "eng".
  10572. @item whitelist
  10573. Set character whitelist.
  10574. @item blacklist
  10575. Set character blacklist.
  10576. @end table
  10577. The filter exports recognized text as the frame metadata @code{lavfi.ocr.text}.
  10578. The filter exports confidence of recognized words as the frame metadata @code{lavfi.ocr.confidence}.
  10579. @section ocv
  10580. Apply a video transform using libopencv.
  10581. To enable this filter, install the libopencv library and headers and
  10582. configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-libopencv}.
  10583. It accepts the following parameters:
  10584. @table @option
  10585. @item filter_name
  10586. The name of the libopencv filter to apply.
  10587. @item filter_params
  10588. The parameters to pass to the libopencv filter. If not specified, the default
  10589. values are assumed.
  10590. @end table
  10591. Refer to the official libopencv documentation for more precise
  10592. information:
  10593. @url{http://docs.opencv.org/master/modules/imgproc/doc/filtering.html}
  10594. Several libopencv filters are supported; see the following subsections.
  10595. @anchor{dilate}
  10596. @subsection dilate
  10597. Dilate an image by using a specific structuring element.
  10598. It corresponds to the libopencv function @code{cvDilate}.
  10599. It accepts the parameters: @var{struct_el}|@var{nb_iterations}.
  10600. @var{struct_el} represents a structuring element, and has the syntax:
  10601. @var{cols}x@var{rows}+@var{anchor_x}x@var{anchor_y}/@var{shape}
  10602. @var{cols} and @var{rows} represent the number of columns and rows of
  10603. the structuring element, @var{anchor_x} and @var{anchor_y} the anchor
  10604. point, and @var{shape} the shape for the structuring element. @var{shape}
  10605. must be "rect", "cross", "ellipse", or "custom".
  10606. If the value for @var{shape} is "custom", it must be followed by a
  10607. string of the form "=@var{filename}". The file with name
  10608. @var{filename} is assumed to represent a binary image, with each
  10609. printable character corresponding to a bright pixel. When a custom
  10610. @var{shape} is used, @var{cols} and @var{rows} are ignored, the number
  10611. or columns and rows of the read file are assumed instead.
  10612. The default value for @var{struct_el} is "3x3+0x0/rect".
  10613. @var{nb_iterations} specifies the number of times the transform is
  10614. applied to the image, and defaults to 1.
  10615. Some examples:
  10616. @example
  10617. # Use the default values
  10618. ocv=dilate
  10619. # Dilate using a structuring element with a 5x5 cross, iterating two times
  10620. ocv=filter_name=dilate:filter_params=5x5+2x2/cross|2
  10621. # Read the shape from the file diamond.shape, iterating two times.
  10622. # The file diamond.shape may contain a pattern of characters like this
  10623. # *
  10624. # ***
  10625. # *****
  10626. # ***
  10627. # *
  10628. # The specified columns and rows are ignored
  10629. # but the anchor point coordinates are not
  10630. ocv=dilate:0x0+2x2/custom=diamond.shape|2
  10631. @end example
  10632. @subsection erode
  10633. Erode an image by using a specific structuring element.
  10634. It corresponds to the libopencv function @code{cvErode}.
  10635. It accepts the parameters: @var{struct_el}:@var{nb_iterations},
  10636. with the same syntax and semantics as the @ref{dilate} filter.
  10637. @subsection smooth
  10638. Smooth the input video.
  10639. The filter takes the following parameters:
  10640. @var{type}|@var{param1}|@var{param2}|@var{param3}|@var{param4}.
  10641. @var{type} is the type of smooth filter to apply, and must be one of
  10642. the following values: "blur", "blur_no_scale", "median", "gaussian",
  10643. or "bilateral". The default value is "gaussian".
  10644. The meaning of @var{param1}, @var{param2}, @var{param3}, and @var{param4}
  10645. depends on the smooth type. @var{param1} and
  10646. @var{param2} accept integer positive values or 0. @var{param3} and
  10647. @var{param4} accept floating point values.
  10648. The default value for @var{param1} is 3. The default value for the
  10649. other parameters is 0.
  10650. These parameters correspond to the parameters assigned to the
  10651. libopencv function @code{cvSmooth}.
  10652. @section oscilloscope
  10653. 2D Video Oscilloscope.
  10654. Useful to measure spatial impulse, step responses, chroma delays, etc.
  10655. It accepts the following parameters:
  10656. @table @option
  10657. @item x
  10658. Set scope center x position.
  10659. @item y
  10660. Set scope center y position.
  10661. @item s
  10662. Set scope size, relative to frame diagonal.
  10663. @item t
  10664. Set scope tilt/rotation.
  10665. @item o
  10666. Set trace opacity.
  10667. @item tx
  10668. Set trace center x position.
  10669. @item ty
  10670. Set trace center y position.
  10671. @item tw
  10672. Set trace width, relative to width of frame.
  10673. @item th
  10674. Set trace height, relative to height of frame.
  10675. @item c
  10676. Set which components to trace. By default it traces first three components.
  10677. @item g
  10678. Draw trace grid. By default is enabled.
  10679. @item st
  10680. Draw some statistics. By default is enabled.
  10681. @item sc
  10682. Draw scope. By default is enabled.
  10683. @end table
  10684. @subsection Commands
  10685. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  10686. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  10687. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  10688. value.
  10689. @subsection Examples
  10690. @itemize
  10691. @item
  10692. Inspect full first row of video frame.
  10693. @example
  10694. oscilloscope=x=0.5:y=0:s=1
  10695. @end example
  10696. @item
  10697. Inspect full last row of video frame.
  10698. @example
  10699. oscilloscope=x=0.5:y=1:s=1
  10700. @end example
  10701. @item
  10702. Inspect full 5th line of video frame of height 1080.
  10703. @example
  10704. oscilloscope=x=0.5:y=5/1080:s=1
  10705. @end example
  10706. @item
  10707. Inspect full last column of video frame.
  10708. @example
  10709. oscilloscope=x=1:y=0.5:s=1:t=1
  10710. @end example
  10711. @end itemize
  10712. @anchor{overlay}
  10713. @section overlay
  10714. Overlay one video on top of another.
  10715. It takes two inputs and has one output. The first input is the "main"
  10716. video on which the second input is overlaid.
  10717. It accepts the following parameters:
  10718. A description of the accepted options follows.
  10719. @table @option
  10720. @item x
  10721. @item y
  10722. Set the expression for the x and y coordinates of the overlaid video
  10723. on the main video. Default value is "0" for both expressions. In case
  10724. the expression is invalid, it is set to a huge value (meaning that the
  10725. overlay will not be displayed within the output visible area).
  10726. @item eof_action
  10727. See @ref{framesync}.
  10728. @item eval
  10729. Set when the expressions for @option{x}, and @option{y} are evaluated.
  10730. It accepts the following values:
  10731. @table @samp
  10732. @item init
  10733. only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or
  10734. when a command is processed
  10735. @item frame
  10736. evaluate expressions for each incoming frame
  10737. @end table
  10738. Default value is @samp{frame}.
  10739. @item shortest
  10740. See @ref{framesync}.
  10741. @item format
  10742. Set the format for the output video.
  10743. It accepts the following values:
  10744. @table @samp
  10745. @item yuv420
  10746. force YUV420 output
  10747. @item yuv422
  10748. force YUV422 output
  10749. @item yuv444
  10750. force YUV444 output
  10751. @item rgb
  10752. force packed RGB output
  10753. @item gbrp
  10754. force planar RGB output
  10755. @item auto
  10756. automatically pick format
  10757. @end table
  10758. Default value is @samp{yuv420}.
  10759. @item repeatlast
  10760. See @ref{framesync}.
  10761. @item alpha
  10762. Set format of alpha of the overlaid video, it can be @var{straight} or
  10763. @var{premultiplied}. Default is @var{straight}.
  10764. @end table
  10765. The @option{x}, and @option{y} expressions can contain the following
  10766. parameters.
  10767. @table @option
  10768. @item main_w, W
  10769. @item main_h, H
  10770. The main input width and height.
  10771. @item overlay_w, w
  10772. @item overlay_h, h
  10773. The overlay input width and height.
  10774. @item x
  10775. @item y
  10776. The computed values for @var{x} and @var{y}. They are evaluated for
  10777. each new frame.
  10778. @item hsub
  10779. @item vsub
  10780. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values of the output
  10781. format. For example for the pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and
  10782. @var{vsub} is 1.
  10783. @item n
  10784. the number of input frame, starting from 0
  10785. @item pos
  10786. the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown
  10787. @item t
  10788. The timestamp, expressed in seconds. It's NAN if the input timestamp is unknown.
  10789. @end table
  10790. This filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  10791. Note that the @var{n}, @var{pos}, @var{t} variables are available only
  10792. when evaluation is done @emph{per frame}, and will evaluate to NAN
  10793. when @option{eval} is set to @samp{init}.
  10794. Be aware that frames are taken from each input video in timestamp
  10795. order, hence, if their initial timestamps differ, it is a good idea
  10796. to pass the two inputs through a @var{setpts=PTS-STARTPTS} filter to
  10797. have them begin in the same zero timestamp, as the example for
  10798. the @var{movie} filter does.
  10799. You can chain together more overlays but you should test the
  10800. efficiency of such approach.
  10801. @subsection Commands
  10802. This filter supports the following commands:
  10803. @table @option
  10804. @item x
  10805. @item y
  10806. Modify the x and y of the overlay input.
  10807. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  10808. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  10809. value.
  10810. @end table
  10811. @subsection Examples
  10812. @itemize
  10813. @item
  10814. Draw the overlay at 10 pixels from the bottom right corner of the main
  10815. video:
  10816. @example
  10817. overlay=main_w-overlay_w-10:main_h-overlay_h-10
  10818. @end example
  10819. Using named options the example above becomes:
  10820. @example
  10821. overlay=x=main_w-overlay_w-10:y=main_h-overlay_h-10
  10822. @end example
  10823. @item
  10824. Insert a transparent PNG logo in the bottom left corner of the input,
  10825. using the @command{ffmpeg} tool with the @code{-filter_complex} option:
  10826. @example
  10827. ffmpeg -i input -i logo -filter_complex 'overlay=10:main_h-overlay_h-10' output
  10828. @end example
  10829. @item
  10830. Insert 2 different transparent PNG logos (second logo on bottom
  10831. right corner) using the @command{ffmpeg} tool:
  10832. @example
  10833. ffmpeg -i input -i logo1 -i logo2 -filter_complex 'overlay=x=10:y=H-h-10,overlay=x=W-w-10:y=H-h-10' output
  10834. @end example
  10835. @item
  10836. Add a transparent color layer on top of the main video; @code{WxH}
  10837. must specify the size of the main input to the overlay filter:
  10838. @example
  10839. color=color=red@@.3:size=WxH [over]; [in][over] overlay [out]
  10840. @end example
  10841. @item
  10842. Play an original video and a filtered version (here with the deshake
  10843. filter) side by side using the @command{ffplay} tool:
  10844. @example
  10845. ffplay input.avi -vf 'split[a][b]; [a]pad=iw*2:ih[src]; [b]deshake[filt]; [src][filt]overlay=w'
  10846. @end example
  10847. The above command is the same as:
  10848. @example
  10849. ffplay input.avi -vf 'split[b], pad=iw*2[src], [b]deshake, [src]overlay=w'
  10850. @end example
  10851. @item
  10852. Make a sliding overlay appearing from the left to the right top part of the
  10853. screen starting since time 2:
  10854. @example
  10855. overlay=x='if(gte(t,2), -w+(t-2)*20, NAN)':y=0
  10856. @end example
  10857. @item
  10858. Compose output by putting two input videos side to side:
  10859. @example
  10860. ffmpeg -i left.avi -i right.avi -filter_complex "
  10861. nullsrc=size=200x100 [background];
  10862. [0:v] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS, scale=100x100 [left];
  10863. [1:v] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS, scale=100x100 [right];
  10864. [background][left] overlay=shortest=1 [background+left];
  10865. [background+left][right] overlay=shortest=1:x=100 [left+right]
  10866. "
  10867. @end example
  10868. @item
  10869. Mask 10-20 seconds of a video by applying the delogo filter to a section
  10870. @example
  10871. ffmpeg -i test.avi -codec:v:0 wmv2 -ar 11025 -b:v 9000k
  10872. -vf '[in]split[split_main][split_delogo];[split_delogo]trim=start=360:end=371,delogo=0:0:640:480[delogoed];[split_main][delogoed]overlay=eof_action=pass[out]'
  10873. masked.avi
  10874. @end example
  10875. @item
  10876. Chain several overlays in cascade:
  10877. @example
  10878. nullsrc=s=200x200 [bg];
  10879. testsrc=s=100x100, split=4 [in0][in1][in2][in3];
  10880. [in0] lutrgb=r=0, [bg] overlay=0:0 [mid0];
  10881. [in1] lutrgb=g=0, [mid0] overlay=100:0 [mid1];
  10882. [in2] lutrgb=b=0, [mid1] overlay=0:100 [mid2];
  10883. [in3] null, [mid2] overlay=100:100 [out0]
  10884. @end example
  10885. @end itemize
  10886. @section owdenoise
  10887. Apply Overcomplete Wavelet denoiser.
  10888. The filter accepts the following options:
  10889. @table @option
  10890. @item depth
  10891. Set depth.
  10892. Larger depth values will denoise lower frequency components more, but
  10893. slow down filtering.
  10894. Must be an int in the range 8-16, default is @code{8}.
  10895. @item luma_strength, ls
  10896. Set luma strength.
  10897. Must be a double value in the range 0-1000, default is @code{1.0}.
  10898. @item chroma_strength, cs
  10899. Set chroma strength.
  10900. Must be a double value in the range 0-1000, default is @code{1.0}.
  10901. @end table
  10902. @anchor{pad}
  10903. @section pad
  10904. Add paddings to the input image, and place the original input at the
  10905. provided @var{x}, @var{y} coordinates.
  10906. It accepts the following parameters:
  10907. @table @option
  10908. @item width, w
  10909. @item height, h
  10910. Specify an expression for the size of the output image with the
  10911. paddings added. If the value for @var{width} or @var{height} is 0, the
  10912. corresponding input size is used for the output.
  10913. The @var{width} expression can reference the value set by the
  10914. @var{height} expression, and vice versa.
  10915. The default value of @var{width} and @var{height} is 0.
  10916. @item x
  10917. @item y
  10918. Specify the offsets to place the input image at within the padded area,
  10919. with respect to the top/left border of the output image.
  10920. The @var{x} expression can reference the value set by the @var{y}
  10921. expression, and vice versa.
  10922. The default value of @var{x} and @var{y} is 0.
  10923. If @var{x} or @var{y} evaluate to a negative number, they'll be changed
  10924. so the input image is centered on the padded area.
  10925. @item color
  10926. Specify the color of the padded area. For the syntax of this option,
  10927. check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils
  10928. manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  10929. The default value of @var{color} is "black".
  10930. @item eval
  10931. Specify when to evaluate @var{width}, @var{height}, @var{x} and @var{y} expression.
  10932. It accepts the following values:
  10933. @table @samp
  10934. @item init
  10935. Only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or when
  10936. a command is processed.
  10937. @item frame
  10938. Evaluate expressions for each incoming frame.
  10939. @end table
  10940. Default value is @samp{init}.
  10941. @item aspect
  10942. Pad to aspect instead to a resolution.
  10943. @end table
  10944. The value for the @var{width}, @var{height}, @var{x}, and @var{y}
  10945. options are expressions containing the following constants:
  10946. @table @option
  10947. @item in_w
  10948. @item in_h
  10949. The input video width and height.
  10950. @item iw
  10951. @item ih
  10952. These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
  10953. @item out_w
  10954. @item out_h
  10955. The output width and height (the size of the padded area), as
  10956. specified by the @var{width} and @var{height} expressions.
  10957. @item ow
  10958. @item oh
  10959. These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}.
  10960. @item x
  10961. @item y
  10962. The x and y offsets as specified by the @var{x} and @var{y}
  10963. expressions, or NAN if not yet specified.
  10964. @item a
  10965. same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
  10966. @item sar
  10967. input sample aspect ratio
  10968. @item dar
  10969. input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{iw} / @var{ih}) * @var{sar}
  10970. @item hsub
  10971. @item vsub
  10972. The horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  10973. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  10974. @end table
  10975. @subsection Examples
  10976. @itemize
  10977. @item
  10978. Add paddings with the color "violet" to the input video. The output video
  10979. size is 640x480, and the top-left corner of the input video is placed at
  10980. column 0, row 40
  10981. @example
  10982. pad=640:480:0:40:violet
  10983. @end example
  10984. The example above is equivalent to the following command:
  10985. @example
  10986. pad=width=640:height=480:x=0:y=40:color=violet
  10987. @end example
  10988. @item
  10989. Pad the input to get an output with dimensions increased by 3/2,
  10990. and put the input video at the center of the padded area:
  10991. @example
  10992. pad="3/2*iw:3/2*ih:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"
  10993. @end example
  10994. @item
  10995. Pad the input to get a squared output with size equal to the maximum
  10996. value between the input width and height, and put the input video at
  10997. the center of the padded area:
  10998. @example
  10999. pad="max(iw\,ih):ow:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"
  11000. @end example
  11001. @item
  11002. Pad the input to get a final w/h ratio of 16:9:
  11003. @example
  11004. pad="ih*16/9:ih:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"
  11005. @end example
  11006. @item
  11007. In case of anamorphic video, in order to set the output display aspect
  11008. correctly, it is necessary to use @var{sar} in the expression,
  11009. according to the relation:
  11010. @example
  11011. (ih * X / ih) * sar = output_dar
  11012. X = output_dar / sar
  11013. @end example
  11014. Thus the previous example needs to be modified to:
  11015. @example
  11016. pad="ih*16/9/sar:ih:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"
  11017. @end example
  11018. @item
  11019. Double the output size and put the input video in the bottom-right
  11020. corner of the output padded area:
  11021. @example
  11022. pad="2*iw:2*ih:ow-iw:oh-ih"
  11023. @end example
  11024. @end itemize
  11025. @anchor{palettegen}
  11026. @section palettegen
  11027. Generate one palette for a whole video stream.
  11028. It accepts the following options:
  11029. @table @option
  11030. @item max_colors
  11031. Set the maximum number of colors to quantize in the palette.
  11032. Note: the palette will still contain 256 colors; the unused palette entries
  11033. will be black.
  11034. @item reserve_transparent
  11035. Create a palette of 255 colors maximum and reserve the last one for
  11036. transparency. Reserving the transparency color is useful for GIF optimization.
  11037. If not set, the maximum of colors in the palette will be 256. You probably want
  11038. to disable this option for a standalone image.
  11039. Set by default.
  11040. @item transparency_color
  11041. Set the color that will be used as background for transparency.
  11042. @item stats_mode
  11043. Set statistics mode.
  11044. It accepts the following values:
  11045. @table @samp
  11046. @item full
  11047. Compute full frame histograms.
  11048. @item diff
  11049. Compute histograms only for the part that differs from previous frame. This
  11050. might be relevant to give more importance to the moving part of your input if
  11051. the background is static.
  11052. @item single
  11053. Compute new histogram for each frame.
  11054. @end table
  11055. Default value is @var{full}.
  11056. @end table
  11057. The filter also exports the frame metadata @code{lavfi.color_quant_ratio}
  11058. (@code{nb_color_in / nb_color_out}) which you can use to evaluate the degree of
  11059. color quantization of the palette. This information is also visible at
  11060. @var{info} logging level.
  11061. @subsection Examples
  11062. @itemize
  11063. @item
  11064. Generate a representative palette of a given video using @command{ffmpeg}:
  11065. @example
  11066. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -vf palettegen palette.png
  11067. @end example
  11068. @end itemize
  11069. @section paletteuse
  11070. Use a palette to downsample an input video stream.
  11071. The filter takes two inputs: one video stream and a palette. The palette must
  11072. be a 256 pixels image.
  11073. It accepts the following options:
  11074. @table @option
  11075. @item dither
  11076. Select dithering mode. Available algorithms are:
  11077. @table @samp
  11078. @item bayer
  11079. Ordered 8x8 bayer dithering (deterministic)
  11080. @item heckbert
  11081. Dithering as defined by Paul Heckbert in 1982 (simple error diffusion).
  11082. Note: this dithering is sometimes considered "wrong" and is included as a
  11083. reference.
  11084. @item floyd_steinberg
  11085. Floyd and Steingberg dithering (error diffusion)
  11086. @item sierra2
  11087. Frankie Sierra dithering v2 (error diffusion)
  11088. @item sierra2_4a
  11089. Frankie Sierra dithering v2 "Lite" (error diffusion)
  11090. @end table
  11091. Default is @var{sierra2_4a}.
  11092. @item bayer_scale
  11093. When @var{bayer} dithering is selected, this option defines the scale of the
  11094. pattern (how much the crosshatch pattern is visible). A low value means more
  11095. visible pattern for less banding, and higher value means less visible pattern
  11096. at the cost of more banding.
  11097. The option must be an integer value in the range [0,5]. Default is @var{2}.
  11098. @item diff_mode
  11099. If set, define the zone to process
  11100. @table @samp
  11101. @item rectangle
  11102. Only the changing rectangle will be reprocessed. This is similar to GIF
  11103. cropping/offsetting compression mechanism. This option can be useful for speed
  11104. if only a part of the image is changing, and has use cases such as limiting the
  11105. scope of the error diffusal @option{dither} to the rectangle that bounds the
  11106. moving scene (it leads to more deterministic output if the scene doesn't change
  11107. much, and as a result less moving noise and better GIF compression).
  11108. @end table
  11109. Default is @var{none}.
  11110. @item new
  11111. Take new palette for each output frame.
  11112. @item alpha_threshold
  11113. Sets the alpha threshold for transparency. Alpha values above this threshold
  11114. will be treated as completely opaque, and values below this threshold will be
  11115. treated as completely transparent.
  11116. The option must be an integer value in the range [0,255]. Default is @var{128}.
  11117. @end table
  11118. @subsection Examples
  11119. @itemize
  11120. @item
  11121. Use a palette (generated for example with @ref{palettegen}) to encode a GIF
  11122. using @command{ffmpeg}:
  11123. @example
  11124. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -i palette.png -lavfi paletteuse output.gif
  11125. @end example
  11126. @end itemize
  11127. @section perspective
  11128. Correct perspective of video not recorded perpendicular to the screen.
  11129. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  11130. @table @option
  11131. @item x0
  11132. @item y0
  11133. @item x1
  11134. @item y1
  11135. @item x2
  11136. @item y2
  11137. @item x3
  11138. @item y3
  11139. Set coordinates expression for top left, top right, bottom left and bottom right corners.
  11140. Default values are @code{0:0:W:0:0:H:W:H} with which perspective will remain unchanged.
  11141. If the @code{sense} option is set to @code{source}, then the specified points will be sent
  11142. to the corners of the destination. If the @code{sense} option is set to @code{destination},
  11143. then the corners of the source will be sent to the specified coordinates.
  11144. The expressions can use the following variables:
  11145. @table @option
  11146. @item W
  11147. @item H
  11148. the width and height of video frame.
  11149. @item in
  11150. Input frame count.
  11151. @item on
  11152. Output frame count.
  11153. @end table
  11154. @item interpolation
  11155. Set interpolation for perspective correction.
  11156. It accepts the following values:
  11157. @table @samp
  11158. @item linear
  11159. @item cubic
  11160. @end table
  11161. Default value is @samp{linear}.
  11162. @item sense
  11163. Set interpretation of coordinate options.
  11164. It accepts the following values:
  11165. @table @samp
  11166. @item 0, source
  11167. Send point in the source specified by the given coordinates to
  11168. the corners of the destination.
  11169. @item 1, destination
  11170. Send the corners of the source to the point in the destination specified
  11171. by the given coordinates.
  11172. Default value is @samp{source}.
  11173. @end table
  11174. @item eval
  11175. Set when the expressions for coordinates @option{x0,y0,...x3,y3} are evaluated.
  11176. It accepts the following values:
  11177. @table @samp
  11178. @item init
  11179. only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or
  11180. when a command is processed
  11181. @item frame
  11182. evaluate expressions for each incoming frame
  11183. @end table
  11184. Default value is @samp{init}.
  11185. @end table
  11186. @section phase
  11187. Delay interlaced video by one field time so that the field order changes.
  11188. The intended use is to fix PAL movies that have been captured with the
  11189. opposite field order to the film-to-video transfer.
  11190. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  11191. @table @option
  11192. @item mode
  11193. Set phase mode.
  11194. It accepts the following values:
  11195. @table @samp
  11196. @item t
  11197. Capture field order top-first, transfer bottom-first.
  11198. Filter will delay the bottom field.
  11199. @item b
  11200. Capture field order bottom-first, transfer top-first.
  11201. Filter will delay the top field.
  11202. @item p
  11203. Capture and transfer with the same field order. This mode only exists
  11204. for the documentation of the other options to refer to, but if you
  11205. actually select it, the filter will faithfully do nothing.
  11206. @item a
  11207. Capture field order determined automatically by field flags, transfer
  11208. opposite.
  11209. Filter selects among @samp{t} and @samp{b} modes on a frame by frame
  11210. basis using field flags. If no field information is available,
  11211. then this works just like @samp{u}.
  11212. @item u
  11213. Capture unknown or varying, transfer opposite.
  11214. Filter selects among @samp{t} and @samp{b} on a frame by frame basis by
  11215. analyzing the images and selecting the alternative that produces best
  11216. match between the fields.
  11217. @item T
  11218. Capture top-first, transfer unknown or varying.
  11219. Filter selects among @samp{t} and @samp{p} using image analysis.
  11220. @item B
  11221. Capture bottom-first, transfer unknown or varying.
  11222. Filter selects among @samp{b} and @samp{p} using image analysis.
  11223. @item A
  11224. Capture determined by field flags, transfer unknown or varying.
  11225. Filter selects among @samp{t}, @samp{b} and @samp{p} using field flags and
  11226. image analysis. If no field information is available, then this works just
  11227. like @samp{U}. This is the default mode.
  11228. @item U
  11229. Both capture and transfer unknown or varying.
  11230. Filter selects among @samp{t}, @samp{b} and @samp{p} using image analysis only.
  11231. @end table
  11232. @end table
  11233. @section photosensitivity
  11234. Reduce various flashes in video, so to help users with epilepsy.
  11235. It accepts the following options:
  11236. @table @option
  11237. @item frames, f
  11238. Set how many frames to use when filtering. Default is 30.
  11239. @item threshold, t
  11240. Set detection threshold factor. Default is 1.
  11241. Lower is stricter.
  11242. @item skip
  11243. Set how many pixels to skip when sampling frames. Default is 1.
  11244. Allowed range is from 1 to 1024.
  11245. @item bypass
  11246. Leave frames unchanged. Default is disabled.
  11247. @end table
  11248. @section pixdesctest
  11249. Pixel format descriptor test filter, mainly useful for internal
  11250. testing. The output video should be equal to the input video.
  11251. For example:
  11252. @example
  11253. format=monow, pixdesctest
  11254. @end example
  11255. can be used to test the monowhite pixel format descriptor definition.
  11256. @section pixscope
  11257. Display sample values of color channels. Mainly useful for checking color
  11258. and levels. Minimum supported resolution is 640x480.
  11259. The filters accept the following options:
  11260. @table @option
  11261. @item x
  11262. Set scope X position, relative offset on X axis.
  11263. @item y
  11264. Set scope Y position, relative offset on Y axis.
  11265. @item w
  11266. Set scope width.
  11267. @item h
  11268. Set scope height.
  11269. @item o
  11270. Set window opacity. This window also holds statistics about pixel area.
  11271. @item wx
  11272. Set window X position, relative offset on X axis.
  11273. @item wy
  11274. Set window Y position, relative offset on Y axis.
  11275. @end table
  11276. @section pp
  11277. Enable the specified chain of postprocessing subfilters using libpostproc. This
  11278. library should be automatically selected with a GPL build (@code{--enable-gpl}).
  11279. Subfilters must be separated by '/' and can be disabled by prepending a '-'.
  11280. Each subfilter and some options have a short and a long name that can be used
  11281. interchangeably, i.e. dr/dering are the same.
  11282. The filters accept the following options:
  11283. @table @option
  11284. @item subfilters
  11285. Set postprocessing subfilters string.
  11286. @end table
  11287. All subfilters share common options to determine their scope:
  11288. @table @option
  11289. @item a/autoq
  11290. Honor the quality commands for this subfilter.
  11291. @item c/chrom
  11292. Do chrominance filtering, too (default).
  11293. @item y/nochrom
  11294. Do luminance filtering only (no chrominance).
  11295. @item n/noluma
  11296. Do chrominance filtering only (no luminance).
  11297. @end table
  11298. These options can be appended after the subfilter name, separated by a '|'.
  11299. Available subfilters are:
  11300. @table @option
  11301. @item hb/hdeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
  11302. Horizontal deblocking filter
  11303. @table @option
  11304. @item difference
  11305. Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: @code{32}).
  11306. @item flatness
  11307. Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: @code{39}).
  11308. @end table
  11309. @item vb/vdeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
  11310. Vertical deblocking filter
  11311. @table @option
  11312. @item difference
  11313. Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: @code{32}).
  11314. @item flatness
  11315. Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: @code{39}).
  11316. @end table
  11317. @item ha/hadeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
  11318. Accurate horizontal deblocking filter
  11319. @table @option
  11320. @item difference
  11321. Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: @code{32}).
  11322. @item flatness
  11323. Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: @code{39}).
  11324. @end table
  11325. @item va/vadeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
  11326. Accurate vertical deblocking filter
  11327. @table @option
  11328. @item difference
  11329. Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: @code{32}).
  11330. @item flatness
  11331. Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: @code{39}).
  11332. @end table
  11333. @end table
  11334. The horizontal and vertical deblocking filters share the difference and
  11335. flatness values so you cannot set different horizontal and vertical
  11336. thresholds.
  11337. @table @option
  11338. @item h1/x1hdeblock
  11339. Experimental horizontal deblocking filter
  11340. @item v1/x1vdeblock
  11341. Experimental vertical deblocking filter
  11342. @item dr/dering
  11343. Deringing filter
  11344. @item tn/tmpnoise[|threshold1[|threshold2[|threshold3]]], temporal noise reducer
  11345. @table @option
  11346. @item threshold1
  11347. larger -> stronger filtering
  11348. @item threshold2
  11349. larger -> stronger filtering
  11350. @item threshold3
  11351. larger -> stronger filtering
  11352. @end table
  11353. @item al/autolevels[:f/fullyrange], automatic brightness / contrast correction
  11354. @table @option
  11355. @item f/fullyrange
  11356. Stretch luminance to @code{0-255}.
  11357. @end table
  11358. @item lb/linblenddeint
  11359. Linear blend deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by
  11360. filtering all lines with a @code{(1 2 1)} filter.
  11361. @item li/linipoldeint
  11362. Linear interpolating deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by
  11363. linearly interpolating every second line.
  11364. @item ci/cubicipoldeint
  11365. Cubic interpolating deinterlacing filter deinterlaces the given block by
  11366. cubically interpolating every second line.
  11367. @item md/mediandeint
  11368. Median deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by applying a
  11369. median filter to every second line.
  11370. @item fd/ffmpegdeint
  11371. FFmpeg deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by filtering every
  11372. second line with a @code{(-1 4 2 4 -1)} filter.
  11373. @item l5/lowpass5
  11374. Vertically applied FIR lowpass deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given
  11375. block by filtering all lines with a @code{(-1 2 6 2 -1)} filter.
  11376. @item fq/forceQuant[|quantizer]
  11377. Overrides the quantizer table from the input with the constant quantizer you
  11378. specify.
  11379. @table @option
  11380. @item quantizer
  11381. Quantizer to use
  11382. @end table
  11383. @item de/default
  11384. Default pp filter combination (@code{hb|a,vb|a,dr|a})
  11385. @item fa/fast
  11386. Fast pp filter combination (@code{h1|a,v1|a,dr|a})
  11387. @item ac
  11388. High quality pp filter combination (@code{ha|a|128|7,va|a,dr|a})
  11389. @end table
  11390. @subsection Examples
  11391. @itemize
  11392. @item
  11393. Apply horizontal and vertical deblocking, deringing and automatic
  11394. brightness/contrast:
  11395. @example
  11396. pp=hb/vb/dr/al
  11397. @end example
  11398. @item
  11399. Apply default filters without brightness/contrast correction:
  11400. @example
  11401. pp=de/-al
  11402. @end example
  11403. @item
  11404. Apply default filters and temporal denoiser:
  11405. @example
  11406. pp=default/tmpnoise|1|2|3
  11407. @end example
  11408. @item
  11409. Apply deblocking on luminance only, and switch vertical deblocking on or off
  11410. automatically depending on available CPU time:
  11411. @example
  11412. pp=hb|y/vb|a
  11413. @end example
  11414. @end itemize
  11415. @section pp7
  11416. Apply Postprocessing filter 7. It is variant of the @ref{spp} filter,
  11417. similar to spp = 6 with 7 point DCT, where only the center sample is
  11418. used after IDCT.
  11419. The filter accepts the following options:
  11420. @table @option
  11421. @item qp
  11422. Force a constant quantization parameter. It accepts an integer in range
  11423. 0 to 63. If not set, the filter will use the QP from the video stream
  11424. (if available).
  11425. @item mode
  11426. Set thresholding mode. Available modes are:
  11427. @table @samp
  11428. @item hard
  11429. Set hard thresholding.
  11430. @item soft
  11431. Set soft thresholding (better de-ringing effect, but likely blurrier).
  11432. @item medium
  11433. Set medium thresholding (good results, default).
  11434. @end table
  11435. @end table
  11436. @section premultiply
  11437. Apply alpha premultiply effect to input video stream using first plane
  11438. of second stream as alpha.
  11439. Both streams must have same dimensions and same pixel format.
  11440. The filter accepts the following option:
  11441. @table @option
  11442. @item planes
  11443. Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.
  11444. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  11445. @item inplace
  11446. Do not require 2nd input for processing, instead use alpha plane from input stream.
  11447. @end table
  11448. @section prewitt
  11449. Apply prewitt operator to input video stream.
  11450. The filter accepts the following option:
  11451. @table @option
  11452. @item planes
  11453. Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.
  11454. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  11455. @item scale
  11456. Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.
  11457. @item delta
  11458. Set value which will be added to filtered result.
  11459. @end table
  11460. @anchor{program_opencl}
  11461. @section program_opencl
  11462. Filter video using an OpenCL program.
  11463. @table @option
  11464. @item source
  11465. OpenCL program source file.
  11466. @item kernel
  11467. Kernel name in program.
  11468. @item inputs
  11469. Number of inputs to the filter. Defaults to 1.
  11470. @item size, s
  11471. Size of output frames. Defaults to the same as the first input.
  11472. @end table
  11473. The program source file must contain a kernel function with the given name,
  11474. which will be run once for each plane of the output. Each run on a plane
  11475. gets enqueued as a separate 2D global NDRange with one work-item for each
  11476. pixel to be generated. The global ID offset for each work-item is therefore
  11477. the coordinates of a pixel in the destination image.
  11478. The kernel function needs to take the following arguments:
  11479. @itemize
  11480. @item
  11481. Destination image, @var{__write_only image2d_t}.
  11482. This image will become the output; the kernel should write all of it.
  11483. @item
  11484. Frame index, @var{unsigned int}.
  11485. This is a counter starting from zero and increasing by one for each frame.
  11486. @item
  11487. Source images, @var{__read_only image2d_t}.
  11488. These are the most recent images on each input. The kernel may read from
  11489. them to generate the output, but they can't be written to.
  11490. @end itemize
  11491. Example programs:
  11492. @itemize
  11493. @item
  11494. Copy the input to the output (output must be the same size as the input).
  11495. @verbatim
  11496. __kernel void copy(__write_only image2d_t destination,
  11497. unsigned int index,
  11498. __read_only image2d_t source)
  11499. {
  11500. const sampler_t sampler = CLK_NORMALIZED_COORDS_FALSE;
  11501. int2 location = (int2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
  11502. float4 value = read_imagef(source, sampler, location);
  11503. write_imagef(destination, location, value);
  11504. }
  11505. @end verbatim
  11506. @item
  11507. Apply a simple transformation, rotating the input by an amount increasing
  11508. with the index counter. Pixel values are linearly interpolated by the
  11509. sampler, and the output need not have the same dimensions as the input.
  11510. @verbatim
  11511. __kernel void rotate_image(__write_only image2d_t dst,
  11512. unsigned int index,
  11513. __read_only image2d_t src)
  11514. {
  11515. const sampler_t sampler = (CLK_NORMALIZED_COORDS_FALSE |
  11516. CLK_FILTER_LINEAR);
  11517. float angle = (float)index / 100.0f;
  11518. float2 dst_dim = convert_float2(get_image_dim(dst));
  11519. float2 src_dim = convert_float2(get_image_dim(src));
  11520. float2 dst_cen = dst_dim / 2.0f;
  11521. float2 src_cen = src_dim / 2.0f;
  11522. int2 dst_loc = (int2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
  11523. float2 dst_pos = convert_float2(dst_loc) - dst_cen;
  11524. float2 src_pos = {
  11525. cos(angle) * dst_pos.x - sin(angle) * dst_pos.y,
  11526. sin(angle) * dst_pos.x + cos(angle) * dst_pos.y
  11527. };
  11528. src_pos = src_pos * src_dim / dst_dim;
  11529. float2 src_loc = src_pos + src_cen;
  11530. if (src_loc.x < 0.0f || src_loc.y < 0.0f ||
  11531. src_loc.x > src_dim.x || src_loc.y > src_dim.y)
  11532. write_imagef(dst, dst_loc, 0.5f);
  11533. else
  11534. write_imagef(dst, dst_loc, read_imagef(src, sampler, src_loc));
  11535. }
  11536. @end verbatim
  11537. @item
  11538. Blend two inputs together, with the amount of each input used varying
  11539. with the index counter.
  11540. @verbatim
  11541. __kernel void blend_images(__write_only image2d_t dst,
  11542. unsigned int index,
  11543. __read_only image2d_t src1,
  11544. __read_only image2d_t src2)
  11545. {
  11546. const sampler_t sampler = (CLK_NORMALIZED_COORDS_FALSE |
  11547. CLK_FILTER_LINEAR);
  11548. float blend = (cos((float)index / 50.0f) + 1.0f) / 2.0f;
  11549. int2 dst_loc = (int2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
  11550. int2 src1_loc = dst_loc * get_image_dim(src1) / get_image_dim(dst);
  11551. int2 src2_loc = dst_loc * get_image_dim(src2) / get_image_dim(dst);
  11552. float4 val1 = read_imagef(src1, sampler, src1_loc);
  11553. float4 val2 = read_imagef(src2, sampler, src2_loc);
  11554. write_imagef(dst, dst_loc, val1 * blend + val2 * (1.0f - blend));
  11555. }
  11556. @end verbatim
  11557. @end itemize
  11558. @section pseudocolor
  11559. Alter frame colors in video with pseudocolors.
  11560. This filter accepts the following options:
  11561. @table @option
  11562. @item c0
  11563. set pixel first component expression
  11564. @item c1
  11565. set pixel second component expression
  11566. @item c2
  11567. set pixel third component expression
  11568. @item c3
  11569. set pixel fourth component expression, corresponds to the alpha component
  11570. @item i
  11571. set component to use as base for altering colors
  11572. @end table
  11573. Each of them specifies the expression to use for computing the lookup table for
  11574. the corresponding pixel component values.
  11575. The expressions can contain the following constants and functions:
  11576. @table @option
  11577. @item w
  11578. @item h
  11579. The input width and height.
  11580. @item val
  11581. The input value for the pixel component.
  11582. @item ymin, umin, vmin, amin
  11583. The minimum allowed component value.
  11584. @item ymax, umax, vmax, amax
  11585. The maximum allowed component value.
  11586. @end table
  11587. All expressions default to "val".
  11588. @subsection Examples
  11589. @itemize
  11590. @item
  11591. Change too high luma values to gradient:
  11592. @example
  11593. pseudocolor="'if(between(val,ymax,amax),lerp(ymin,ymax,(val-ymax)/(amax-ymax)),-1):if(between(val,ymax,amax),lerp(umax,umin,(val-ymax)/(amax-ymax)),-1):if(between(val,ymax,amax),lerp(vmin,vmax,(val-ymax)/(amax-ymax)),-1):-1'"
  11594. @end example
  11595. @end itemize
  11596. @section psnr
  11597. Obtain the average, maximum and minimum PSNR (Peak Signal to Noise
  11598. Ratio) between two input videos.
  11599. This filter takes in input two input videos, the first input is
  11600. considered the "main" source and is passed unchanged to the
  11601. output. The second input is used as a "reference" video for computing
  11602. the PSNR.
  11603. Both video inputs must have the same resolution and pixel format for
  11604. this filter to work correctly. Also it assumes that both inputs
  11605. have the same number of frames, which are compared one by one.
  11606. The obtained average PSNR is printed through the logging system.
  11607. The filter stores the accumulated MSE (mean squared error) of each
  11608. frame, and at the end of the processing it is averaged across all frames
  11609. equally, and the following formula is applied to obtain the PSNR:
  11610. @example
  11611. PSNR = 10*log10(MAX^2/MSE)
  11612. @end example
  11613. Where MAX is the average of the maximum values of each component of the
  11614. image.
  11615. The description of the accepted parameters follows.
  11616. @table @option
  11617. @item stats_file, f
  11618. If specified the filter will use the named file to save the PSNR of
  11619. each individual frame. When filename equals "-" the data is sent to
  11620. standard output.
  11621. @item stats_version
  11622. Specifies which version of the stats file format to use. Details of
  11623. each format are written below.
  11624. Default value is 1.
  11625. @item stats_add_max
  11626. Determines whether the max value is output to the stats log.
  11627. Default value is 0.
  11628. Requires stats_version >= 2. If this is set and stats_version < 2,
  11629. the filter will return an error.
  11630. @end table
  11631. This filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  11632. The file printed if @var{stats_file} is selected, contains a sequence of
  11633. key/value pairs of the form @var{key}:@var{value} for each compared
  11634. couple of frames.
  11635. If a @var{stats_version} greater than 1 is specified, a header line precedes
  11636. the list of per-frame-pair stats, with key value pairs following the frame
  11637. format with the following parameters:
  11638. @table @option
  11639. @item psnr_log_version
  11640. The version of the log file format. Will match @var{stats_version}.
  11641. @item fields
  11642. A comma separated list of the per-frame-pair parameters included in
  11643. the log.
  11644. @end table
  11645. A description of each shown per-frame-pair parameter follows:
  11646. @table @option
  11647. @item n
  11648. sequential number of the input frame, starting from 1
  11649. @item mse_avg
  11650. Mean Square Error pixel-by-pixel average difference of the compared
  11651. frames, averaged over all the image components.
  11652. @item mse_y, mse_u, mse_v, mse_r, mse_g, mse_b, mse_a
  11653. Mean Square Error pixel-by-pixel average difference of the compared
  11654. frames for the component specified by the suffix.
  11655. @item psnr_y, psnr_u, psnr_v, psnr_r, psnr_g, psnr_b, psnr_a
  11656. Peak Signal to Noise ratio of the compared frames for the component
  11657. specified by the suffix.
  11658. @item max_avg, max_y, max_u, max_v
  11659. Maximum allowed value for each channel, and average over all
  11660. channels.
  11661. @end table
  11662. @subsection Examples
  11663. @itemize
  11664. @item
  11665. For example:
  11666. @example
  11667. movie=ref_movie.mpg, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
  11668. [main][ref] psnr="stats_file=stats.log" [out]
  11669. @end example
  11670. On this example the input file being processed is compared with the
  11671. reference file @file{ref_movie.mpg}. The PSNR of each individual frame
  11672. is stored in @file{stats.log}.
  11673. @item
  11674. Another example with different containers:
  11675. @example
  11676. ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mkv -lavfi "[0:v]settb=AVTB,setpts=PTS-STARTPTS[main];[1:v]settb=AVTB,setpts=PTS-STARTPTS[ref];[main][ref]psnr" -f null -
  11677. @end example
  11678. @end itemize
  11679. @anchor{pullup}
  11680. @section pullup
  11681. Pulldown reversal (inverse telecine) filter, capable of handling mixed
  11682. hard-telecine, 24000/1001 fps progressive, and 30000/1001 fps progressive
  11683. content.
  11684. The pullup filter is designed to take advantage of future context in making
  11685. its decisions. This filter is stateless in the sense that it does not lock
  11686. onto a pattern to follow, but it instead looks forward to the following
  11687. fields in order to identify matches and rebuild progressive frames.
  11688. To produce content with an even framerate, insert the fps filter after
  11689. pullup, use @code{fps=24000/1001} if the input frame rate is 29.97fps,
  11690. @code{fps=24} for 30fps and the (rare) telecined 25fps input.
  11691. The filter accepts the following options:
  11692. @table @option
  11693. @item jl
  11694. @item jr
  11695. @item jt
  11696. @item jb
  11697. These options set the amount of "junk" to ignore at the left, right, top, and
  11698. bottom of the image, respectively. Left and right are in units of 8 pixels,
  11699. while top and bottom are in units of 2 lines.
  11700. The default is 8 pixels on each side.
  11701. @item sb
  11702. Set the strict breaks. Setting this option to 1 will reduce the chances of
  11703. filter generating an occasional mismatched frame, but it may also cause an
  11704. excessive number of frames to be dropped during high motion sequences.
  11705. Conversely, setting it to -1 will make filter match fields more easily.
  11706. This may help processing of video where there is slight blurring between
  11707. the fields, but may also cause there to be interlaced frames in the output.
  11708. Default value is @code{0}.
  11709. @item mp
  11710. Set the metric plane to use. It accepts the following values:
  11711. @table @samp
  11712. @item l
  11713. Use luma plane.
  11714. @item u
  11715. Use chroma blue plane.
  11716. @item v
  11717. Use chroma red plane.
  11718. @end table
  11719. This option may be set to use chroma plane instead of the default luma plane
  11720. for doing filter's computations. This may improve accuracy on very clean
  11721. source material, but more likely will decrease accuracy, especially if there
  11722. is chroma noise (rainbow effect) or any grayscale video.
  11723. The main purpose of setting @option{mp} to a chroma plane is to reduce CPU
  11724. load and make pullup usable in realtime on slow machines.
  11725. @end table
  11726. For best results (without duplicated frames in the output file) it is
  11727. necessary to change the output frame rate. For example, to inverse
  11728. telecine NTSC input:
  11729. @example
  11730. ffmpeg -i input -vf pullup -r 24000/1001 ...
  11731. @end example
  11732. @section qp
  11733. Change video quantization parameters (QP).
  11734. The filter accepts the following option:
  11735. @table @option
  11736. @item qp
  11737. Set expression for quantization parameter.
  11738. @end table
  11739. The expression is evaluated through the eval API and can contain, among others,
  11740. the following constants:
  11741. @table @var
  11742. @item known
  11743. 1 if index is not 129, 0 otherwise.
  11744. @item qp
  11745. Sequential index starting from -129 to 128.
  11746. @end table
  11747. @subsection Examples
  11748. @itemize
  11749. @item
  11750. Some equation like:
  11751. @example
  11752. qp=2+2*sin(PI*qp)
  11753. @end example
  11754. @end itemize
  11755. @section random
  11756. Flush video frames from internal cache of frames into a random order.
  11757. No frame is discarded.
  11758. Inspired by @ref{frei0r} nervous filter.
  11759. @table @option
  11760. @item frames
  11761. Set size in number of frames of internal cache, in range from @code{2} to
  11762. @code{512}. Default is @code{30}.
  11763. @item seed
  11764. Set seed for random number generator, must be an integer included between
  11765. @code{0} and @code{UINT32_MAX}. If not specified, or if explicitly set to
  11766. less than @code{0}, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a
  11767. best effort basis.
  11768. @end table
  11769. @section readeia608
  11770. Read closed captioning (EIA-608) information from the top lines of a video frame.
  11771. This filter adds frame metadata for @code{lavfi.readeia608.X.cc} and
  11772. @code{lavfi.readeia608.X.line}, where @code{X} is the number of the identified line
  11773. with EIA-608 data (starting from 0). A description of each metadata value follows:
  11774. @table @option
  11775. @item lavfi.readeia608.X.cc
  11776. The two bytes stored as EIA-608 data (printed in hexadecimal).
  11777. @item lavfi.readeia608.X.line
  11778. The number of the line on which the EIA-608 data was identified and read.
  11779. @end table
  11780. This filter accepts the following options:
  11781. @table @option
  11782. @item scan_min
  11783. Set the line to start scanning for EIA-608 data. Default is @code{0}.
  11784. @item scan_max
  11785. Set the line to end scanning for EIA-608 data. Default is @code{29}.
  11786. @item spw
  11787. Set the ratio of width reserved for sync code detection.
  11788. Default is @code{0.27}. Allowed range is @code{[0.1 - 0.7]}.
  11789. @item chp
  11790. Enable checking the parity bit. In the event of a parity error, the filter will output
  11791. @code{0x00} for that character. Default is false.
  11792. @item lp
  11793. Lowpass lines prior to further processing. Default is enabled.
  11794. @end table
  11795. @subsection Examples
  11796. @itemize
  11797. @item
  11798. Output a csv with presentation time and the first two lines of identified EIA-608 captioning data.
  11799. @example
  11800. ffprobe -f lavfi -i movie=captioned_video.mov,readeia608 -show_entries frame=pkt_pts_time:frame_tags=lavfi.readeia608.0.cc,lavfi.readeia608.1.cc -of csv
  11801. @end example
  11802. @end itemize
  11803. @section readvitc
  11804. Read vertical interval timecode (VITC) information from the top lines of a
  11805. video frame.
  11806. The filter adds frame metadata key @code{lavfi.readvitc.tc_str} with the
  11807. timecode value, if a valid timecode has been detected. Further metadata key
  11808. @code{lavfi.readvitc.found} is set to 0/1 depending on whether
  11809. timecode data has been found or not.
  11810. This filter accepts the following options:
  11811. @table @option
  11812. @item scan_max
  11813. Set the maximum number of lines to scan for VITC data. If the value is set to
  11814. @code{-1} the full video frame is scanned. Default is @code{45}.
  11815. @item thr_b
  11816. Set the luma threshold for black. Accepts float numbers in the range [0.0,1.0],
  11817. default value is @code{0.2}. The value must be equal or less than @code{thr_w}.
  11818. @item thr_w
  11819. Set the luma threshold for white. Accepts float numbers in the range [0.0,1.0],
  11820. default value is @code{0.6}. The value must be equal or greater than @code{thr_b}.
  11821. @end table
  11822. @subsection Examples
  11823. @itemize
  11824. @item
  11825. Detect and draw VITC data onto the video frame; if no valid VITC is detected,
  11826. draw @code{--:--:--:--} as a placeholder:
  11827. @example
  11828. ffmpeg -i input.avi -filter:v 'readvitc,drawtext=fontfile=FreeMono.ttf:text=%@{metadata\\:lavfi.readvitc.tc_str\\:--\\\\\\:--\\\\\\:--\\\\\\:--@}:x=(w-tw)/2:y=400-ascent'
  11829. @end example
  11830. @end itemize
  11831. @section remap
  11832. Remap pixels using 2nd: Xmap and 3rd: Ymap input video stream.
  11833. Destination pixel at position (X, Y) will be picked from source (x, y) position
  11834. where x = Xmap(X, Y) and y = Ymap(X, Y). If mapping values are out of range, zero
  11835. value for pixel will be used for destination pixel.
  11836. Xmap and Ymap input video streams must be of same dimensions. Output video stream
  11837. will have Xmap/Ymap video stream dimensions.
  11838. Xmap and Ymap input video streams are 16bit depth, single channel.
  11839. @table @option
  11840. @item format
  11841. Specify pixel format of output from this filter. Can be @code{color} or @code{gray}.
  11842. Default is @code{color}.
  11843. @end table
  11844. @section removegrain
  11845. The removegrain filter is a spatial denoiser for progressive video.
  11846. @table @option
  11847. @item m0
  11848. Set mode for the first plane.
  11849. @item m1
  11850. Set mode for the second plane.
  11851. @item m2
  11852. Set mode for the third plane.
  11853. @item m3
  11854. Set mode for the fourth plane.
  11855. @end table
  11856. Range of mode is from 0 to 24. Description of each mode follows:
  11857. @table @var
  11858. @item 0
  11859. Leave input plane unchanged. Default.
  11860. @item 1
  11861. Clips the pixel with the minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.
  11862. @item 2
  11863. Clips the pixel with the second minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.
  11864. @item 3
  11865. Clips the pixel with the third minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.
  11866. @item 4
  11867. Clips the pixel with the fourth minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.
  11868. This is equivalent to a median filter.
  11869. @item 5
  11870. Line-sensitive clipping giving the minimal change.
  11871. @item 6
  11872. Line-sensitive clipping, intermediate.
  11873. @item 7
  11874. Line-sensitive clipping, intermediate.
  11875. @item 8
  11876. Line-sensitive clipping, intermediate.
  11877. @item 9
  11878. Line-sensitive clipping on a line where the neighbours pixels are the closest.
  11879. @item 10
  11880. Replaces the target pixel with the closest neighbour.
  11881. @item 11
  11882. [1 2 1] horizontal and vertical kernel blur.
  11883. @item 12
  11884. Same as mode 11.
  11885. @item 13
  11886. Bob mode, interpolates top field from the line where the neighbours
  11887. pixels are the closest.
  11888. @item 14
  11889. Bob mode, interpolates bottom field from the line where the neighbours
  11890. pixels are the closest.
  11891. @item 15
  11892. Bob mode, interpolates top field. Same as 13 but with a more complicated
  11893. interpolation formula.
  11894. @item 16
  11895. Bob mode, interpolates bottom field. Same as 14 but with a more complicated
  11896. interpolation formula.
  11897. @item 17
  11898. Clips the pixel with the minimum and maximum of respectively the maximum and
  11899. minimum of each pair of opposite neighbour pixels.
  11900. @item 18
  11901. Line-sensitive clipping using opposite neighbours whose greatest distance from
  11902. the current pixel is minimal.
  11903. @item 19
  11904. Replaces the pixel with the average of its 8 neighbours.
  11905. @item 20
  11906. Averages the 9 pixels ([1 1 1] horizontal and vertical blur).
  11907. @item 21
  11908. Clips pixels using the averages of opposite neighbour.
  11909. @item 22
  11910. Same as mode 21 but simpler and faster.
  11911. @item 23
  11912. Small edge and halo removal, but reputed useless.
  11913. @item 24
  11914. Similar as 23.
  11915. @end table
  11916. @section removelogo
  11917. Suppress a TV station logo, using an image file to determine which
  11918. pixels comprise the logo. It works by filling in the pixels that
  11919. comprise the logo with neighboring pixels.
  11920. The filter accepts the following options:
  11921. @table @option
  11922. @item filename, f
  11923. Set the filter bitmap file, which can be any image format supported by
  11924. libavformat. The width and height of the image file must match those of the
  11925. video stream being processed.
  11926. @end table
  11927. Pixels in the provided bitmap image with a value of zero are not
  11928. considered part of the logo, non-zero pixels are considered part of
  11929. the logo. If you use white (255) for the logo and black (0) for the
  11930. rest, you will be safe. For making the filter bitmap, it is
  11931. recommended to take a screen capture of a black frame with the logo
  11932. visible, and then using a threshold filter followed by the erode
  11933. filter once or twice.
  11934. If needed, little splotches can be fixed manually. Remember that if
  11935. logo pixels are not covered, the filter quality will be much
  11936. reduced. Marking too many pixels as part of the logo does not hurt as
  11937. much, but it will increase the amount of blurring needed to cover over
  11938. the image and will destroy more information than necessary, and extra
  11939. pixels will slow things down on a large logo.
  11940. @section repeatfields
  11941. This filter uses the repeat_field flag from the Video ES headers and hard repeats
  11942. fields based on its value.
  11943. @section reverse
  11944. Reverse a video clip.
  11945. Warning: This filter requires memory to buffer the entire clip, so trimming
  11946. is suggested.
  11947. @subsection Examples
  11948. @itemize
  11949. @item
  11950. Take the first 5 seconds of a clip, and reverse it.
  11951. @example
  11952. trim=end=5,reverse
  11953. @end example
  11954. @end itemize
  11955. @section rgbashift
  11956. Shift R/G/B/A pixels horizontally and/or vertically.
  11957. The filter accepts the following options:
  11958. @table @option
  11959. @item rh
  11960. Set amount to shift red horizontally.
  11961. @item rv
  11962. Set amount to shift red vertically.
  11963. @item gh
  11964. Set amount to shift green horizontally.
  11965. @item gv
  11966. Set amount to shift green vertically.
  11967. @item bh
  11968. Set amount to shift blue horizontally.
  11969. @item bv
  11970. Set amount to shift blue vertically.
  11971. @item ah
  11972. Set amount to shift alpha horizontally.
  11973. @item av
  11974. Set amount to shift alpha vertically.
  11975. @item edge
  11976. Set edge mode, can be @var{smear}, default, or @var{warp}.
  11977. @end table
  11978. @subsection Commands
  11979. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  11980. @section roberts
  11981. Apply roberts cross operator to input video stream.
  11982. The filter accepts the following option:
  11983. @table @option
  11984. @item planes
  11985. Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.
  11986. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  11987. @item scale
  11988. Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.
  11989. @item delta
  11990. Set value which will be added to filtered result.
  11991. @end table
  11992. @section rotate
  11993. Rotate video by an arbitrary angle expressed in radians.
  11994. The filter accepts the following options:
  11995. A description of the optional parameters follows.
  11996. @table @option
  11997. @item angle, a
  11998. Set an expression for the angle by which to rotate the input video
  11999. clockwise, expressed as a number of radians. A negative value will
  12000. result in a counter-clockwise rotation. By default it is set to "0".
  12001. This expression is evaluated for each frame.
  12002. @item out_w, ow
  12003. Set the output width expression, default value is "iw".
  12004. This expression is evaluated just once during configuration.
  12005. @item out_h, oh
  12006. Set the output height expression, default value is "ih".
  12007. This expression is evaluated just once during configuration.
  12008. @item bilinear
  12009. Enable bilinear interpolation if set to 1, a value of 0 disables
  12010. it. Default value is 1.
  12011. @item fillcolor, c
  12012. Set the color used to fill the output area not covered by the rotated
  12013. image. For the general syntax of this option, check the
  12014. @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  12015. If the special value "none" is selected then no
  12016. background is printed (useful for example if the background is never shown).
  12017. Default value is "black".
  12018. @end table
  12019. The expressions for the angle and the output size can contain the
  12020. following constants and functions:
  12021. @table @option
  12022. @item n
  12023. sequential number of the input frame, starting from 0. It is always NAN
  12024. before the first frame is filtered.
  12025. @item t
  12026. time in seconds of the input frame, it is set to 0 when the filter is
  12027. configured. It is always NAN before the first frame is filtered.
  12028. @item hsub
  12029. @item vsub
  12030. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  12031. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  12032. @item in_w, iw
  12033. @item in_h, ih
  12034. the input video width and height
  12035. @item out_w, ow
  12036. @item out_h, oh
  12037. the output width and height, that is the size of the padded area as
  12038. specified by the @var{width} and @var{height} expressions
  12039. @item rotw(a)
  12040. @item roth(a)
  12041. the minimal width/height required for completely containing the input
  12042. video rotated by @var{a} radians.
  12043. These are only available when computing the @option{out_w} and
  12044. @option{out_h} expressions.
  12045. @end table
  12046. @subsection Examples
  12047. @itemize
  12048. @item
  12049. Rotate the input by PI/6 radians clockwise:
  12050. @example
  12051. rotate=PI/6
  12052. @end example
  12053. @item
  12054. Rotate the input by PI/6 radians counter-clockwise:
  12055. @example
  12056. rotate=-PI/6
  12057. @end example
  12058. @item
  12059. Rotate the input by 45 degrees clockwise:
  12060. @example
  12061. rotate=45*PI/180
  12062. @end example
  12063. @item
  12064. Apply a constant rotation with period T, starting from an angle of PI/3:
  12065. @example
  12066. rotate=PI/3+2*PI*t/T
  12067. @end example
  12068. @item
  12069. Make the input video rotation oscillating with a period of T
  12070. seconds and an amplitude of A radians:
  12071. @example
  12072. rotate=A*sin(2*PI/T*t)
  12073. @end example
  12074. @item
  12075. Rotate the video, output size is chosen so that the whole rotating
  12076. input video is always completely contained in the output:
  12077. @example
  12078. rotate='2*PI*t:ow=hypot(iw,ih):oh=ow'
  12079. @end example
  12080. @item
  12081. Rotate the video, reduce the output size so that no background is ever
  12082. shown:
  12083. @example
  12084. rotate=2*PI*t:ow='min(iw,ih)/sqrt(2)':oh=ow:c=none
  12085. @end example
  12086. @end itemize
  12087. @subsection Commands
  12088. The filter supports the following commands:
  12089. @table @option
  12090. @item a, angle
  12091. Set the angle expression.
  12092. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  12093. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  12094. value.
  12095. @end table
  12096. @section sab
  12097. Apply Shape Adaptive Blur.
  12098. The filter accepts the following options:
  12099. @table @option
  12100. @item luma_radius, lr
  12101. Set luma blur filter strength, must be a value in range 0.1-4.0, default
  12102. value is 1.0. A greater value will result in a more blurred image, and
  12103. in slower processing.
  12104. @item luma_pre_filter_radius, lpfr
  12105. Set luma pre-filter radius, must be a value in the 0.1-2.0 range, default
  12106. value is 1.0.
  12107. @item luma_strength, ls
  12108. Set luma maximum difference between pixels to still be considered, must
  12109. be a value in the 0.1-100.0 range, default value is 1.0.
  12110. @item chroma_radius, cr
  12111. Set chroma blur filter strength, must be a value in range -0.9-4.0. A
  12112. greater value will result in a more blurred image, and in slower
  12113. processing.
  12114. @item chroma_pre_filter_radius, cpfr
  12115. Set chroma pre-filter radius, must be a value in the -0.9-2.0 range.
  12116. @item chroma_strength, cs
  12117. Set chroma maximum difference between pixels to still be considered,
  12118. must be a value in the -0.9-100.0 range.
  12119. @end table
  12120. Each chroma option value, if not explicitly specified, is set to the
  12121. corresponding luma option value.
  12122. @anchor{scale}
  12123. @section scale
  12124. Scale (resize) the input video, using the libswscale library.
  12125. The scale filter forces the output display aspect ratio to be the same
  12126. of the input, by changing the output sample aspect ratio.
  12127. If the input image format is different from the format requested by
  12128. the next filter, the scale filter will convert the input to the
  12129. requested format.
  12130. @subsection Options
  12131. The filter accepts the following options, or any of the options
  12132. supported by the libswscale scaler.
  12133. See @ref{scaler_options,,the ffmpeg-scaler manual,ffmpeg-scaler} for
  12134. the complete list of scaler options.
  12135. @table @option
  12136. @item width, w
  12137. @item height, h
  12138. Set the output video dimension expression. Default value is the input
  12139. dimension.
  12140. If the @var{width} or @var{w} value is 0, the input width is used for
  12141. the output. If the @var{height} or @var{h} value is 0, the input height
  12142. is used for the output.
  12143. If one and only one of the values is -n with n >= 1, the scale filter
  12144. will use a value that maintains the aspect ratio of the input image,
  12145. calculated from the other specified dimension. After that it will,
  12146. however, make sure that the calculated dimension is divisible by n and
  12147. adjust the value if necessary.
  12148. If both values are -n with n >= 1, the behavior will be identical to
  12149. both values being set to 0 as previously detailed.
  12150. See below for the list of accepted constants for use in the dimension
  12151. expression.
  12152. @item eval
  12153. Specify when to evaluate @var{width} and @var{height} expression. It accepts the following values:
  12154. @table @samp
  12155. @item init
  12156. Only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or when a command is processed.
  12157. @item frame
  12158. Evaluate expressions for each incoming frame.
  12159. @end table
  12160. Default value is @samp{init}.
  12161. @item interl
  12162. Set the interlacing mode. It accepts the following values:
  12163. @table @samp
  12164. @item 1
  12165. Force interlaced aware scaling.
  12166. @item 0
  12167. Do not apply interlaced scaling.
  12168. @item -1
  12169. Select interlaced aware scaling depending on whether the source frames
  12170. are flagged as interlaced or not.
  12171. @end table
  12172. Default value is @samp{0}.
  12173. @item flags
  12174. Set libswscale scaling flags. See
  12175. @ref{sws_flags,,the ffmpeg-scaler manual,ffmpeg-scaler} for the
  12176. complete list of values. If not explicitly specified the filter applies
  12177. the default flags.
  12178. @item param0, param1
  12179. Set libswscale input parameters for scaling algorithms that need them. See
  12180. @ref{sws_params,,the ffmpeg-scaler manual,ffmpeg-scaler} for the
  12181. complete documentation. If not explicitly specified the filter applies
  12182. empty parameters.
  12183. @item size, s
  12184. Set the video size. For the syntax of this option, check the
  12185. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  12186. @item in_color_matrix
  12187. @item out_color_matrix
  12188. Set in/output YCbCr color space type.
  12189. This allows the autodetected value to be overridden as well as allows forcing
  12190. a specific value used for the output and encoder.
  12191. If not specified, the color space type depends on the pixel format.
  12192. Possible values:
  12193. @table @samp
  12194. @item auto
  12195. Choose automatically.
  12196. @item bt709
  12197. Format conforming to International Telecommunication Union (ITU)
  12198. Recommendation BT.709.
  12199. @item fcc
  12200. Set color space conforming to the United States Federal Communications
  12201. Commission (FCC) Code of Federal Regulations (CFR) Title 47 (2003) 73.682 (a).
  12202. @item bt601
  12203. @item bt470
  12204. @item smpte170m
  12205. Set color space conforming to:
  12206. @itemize
  12207. @item
  12208. ITU Radiocommunication Sector (ITU-R) Recommendation BT.601
  12209. @item
  12210. ITU-R Rec. BT.470-6 (1998) Systems B, B1, and G
  12211. @item
  12212. Society of Motion Picture and Television Engineers (SMPTE) ST 170:2004
  12213. @end itemize
  12214. @item smpte240m
  12215. Set color space conforming to SMPTE ST 240:1999.
  12216. @item bt2020
  12217. Set color space conforming to ITU-R BT.2020 non-constant luminance system.
  12218. @end table
  12219. @item in_range
  12220. @item out_range
  12221. Set in/output YCbCr sample range.
  12222. This allows the autodetected value to be overridden as well as allows forcing
  12223. a specific value used for the output and encoder. If not specified, the
  12224. range depends on the pixel format. Possible values:
  12225. @table @samp
  12226. @item auto/unknown
  12227. Choose automatically.
  12228. @item jpeg/full/pc
  12229. Set full range (0-255 in case of 8-bit luma).
  12230. @item mpeg/limited/tv
  12231. Set "MPEG" range (16-235 in case of 8-bit luma).
  12232. @end table
  12233. @item force_original_aspect_ratio
  12234. Enable decreasing or increasing output video width or height if necessary to
  12235. keep the original aspect ratio. Possible values:
  12236. @table @samp
  12237. @item disable
  12238. Scale the video as specified and disable this feature.
  12239. @item decrease
  12240. The output video dimensions will automatically be decreased if needed.
  12241. @item increase
  12242. The output video dimensions will automatically be increased if needed.
  12243. @end table
  12244. One useful instance of this option is that when you know a specific device's
  12245. maximum allowed resolution, you can use this to limit the output video to
  12246. that, while retaining the aspect ratio. For example, device A allows
  12247. 1280x720 playback, and your video is 1920x800. Using this option (set it to
  12248. decrease) and specifying 1280x720 to the command line makes the output
  12249. 1280x533.
  12250. Please note that this is a different thing than specifying -1 for @option{w}
  12251. or @option{h}, you still need to specify the output resolution for this option
  12252. to work.
  12253. @item force_divisible_by
  12254. Ensures that both the output dimensions, width and height, are divisible by the
  12255. given integer when used together with @option{force_original_aspect_ratio}. This
  12256. works similar to using @code{-n} in the @option{w} and @option{h} options.
  12257. This option respects the value set for @option{force_original_aspect_ratio},
  12258. increasing or decreasing the resolution accordingly. The video's aspect ratio
  12259. may be slightly modified.
  12260. This option can be handy if you need to have a video fit within or exceed
  12261. a defined resolution using @option{force_original_aspect_ratio} but also have
  12262. encoder restrictions on width or height divisibility.
  12263. @end table
  12264. The values of the @option{w} and @option{h} options are expressions
  12265. containing the following constants:
  12266. @table @var
  12267. @item in_w
  12268. @item in_h
  12269. The input width and height
  12270. @item iw
  12271. @item ih
  12272. These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
  12273. @item out_w
  12274. @item out_h
  12275. The output (scaled) width and height
  12276. @item ow
  12277. @item oh
  12278. These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}
  12279. @item a
  12280. The same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
  12281. @item sar
  12282. input sample aspect ratio
  12283. @item dar
  12284. The input display aspect ratio. Calculated from @code{(iw / ih) * sar}.
  12285. @item hsub
  12286. @item vsub
  12287. horizontal and vertical input chroma subsample values. For example for the
  12288. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  12289. @item ohsub
  12290. @item ovsub
  12291. horizontal and vertical output chroma subsample values. For example for the
  12292. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  12293. @end table
  12294. @subsection Examples
  12295. @itemize
  12296. @item
  12297. Scale the input video to a size of 200x100
  12298. @example
  12299. scale=w=200:h=100
  12300. @end example
  12301. This is equivalent to:
  12302. @example
  12303. scale=200:100
  12304. @end example
  12305. or:
  12306. @example
  12307. scale=200x100
  12308. @end example
  12309. @item
  12310. Specify a size abbreviation for the output size:
  12311. @example
  12312. scale=qcif
  12313. @end example
  12314. which can also be written as:
  12315. @example
  12316. scale=size=qcif
  12317. @end example
  12318. @item
  12319. Scale the input to 2x:
  12320. @example
  12321. scale=w=2*iw:h=2*ih
  12322. @end example
  12323. @item
  12324. The above is the same as:
  12325. @example
  12326. scale=2*in_w:2*in_h
  12327. @end example
  12328. @item
  12329. Scale the input to 2x with forced interlaced scaling:
  12330. @example
  12331. scale=2*iw:2*ih:interl=1
  12332. @end example
  12333. @item
  12334. Scale the input to half size:
  12335. @example
  12336. scale=w=iw/2:h=ih/2
  12337. @end example
  12338. @item
  12339. Increase the width, and set the height to the same size:
  12340. @example
  12341. scale=3/2*iw:ow
  12342. @end example
  12343. @item
  12344. Seek Greek harmony:
  12345. @example
  12346. scale=iw:1/PHI*iw
  12347. scale=ih*PHI:ih
  12348. @end example
  12349. @item
  12350. Increase the height, and set the width to 3/2 of the height:
  12351. @example
  12352. scale=w=3/2*oh:h=3/5*ih
  12353. @end example
  12354. @item
  12355. Increase the size, making the size a multiple of the chroma
  12356. subsample values:
  12357. @example
  12358. scale="trunc(3/2*iw/hsub)*hsub:trunc(3/2*ih/vsub)*vsub"
  12359. @end example
  12360. @item
  12361. Increase the width to a maximum of 500 pixels,
  12362. keeping the same aspect ratio as the input:
  12363. @example
  12364. scale=w='min(500\, iw*3/2):h=-1'
  12365. @end example
  12366. @item
  12367. Make pixels square by combining scale and setsar:
  12368. @example
  12369. scale='trunc(ih*dar):ih',setsar=1/1
  12370. @end example
  12371. @item
  12372. Make pixels square by combining scale and setsar,
  12373. making sure the resulting resolution is even (required by some codecs):
  12374. @example
  12375. scale='trunc(ih*dar/2)*2:trunc(ih/2)*2',setsar=1/1
  12376. @end example
  12377. @end itemize
  12378. @subsection Commands
  12379. This filter supports the following commands:
  12380. @table @option
  12381. @item width, w
  12382. @item height, h
  12383. Set the output video dimension expression.
  12384. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  12385. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  12386. value.
  12387. @end table
  12388. @section scale_npp
  12389. Use the NVIDIA Performance Primitives (libnpp) to perform scaling and/or pixel
  12390. format conversion on CUDA video frames. Setting the output width and height
  12391. works in the same way as for the @var{scale} filter.
  12392. The following additional options are accepted:
  12393. @table @option
  12394. @item format
  12395. The pixel format of the output CUDA frames. If set to the string "same" (the
  12396. default), the input format will be kept. Note that automatic format negotiation
  12397. and conversion is not yet supported for hardware frames
  12398. @item interp_algo
  12399. The interpolation algorithm used for resizing. One of the following:
  12400. @table @option
  12401. @item nn
  12402. Nearest neighbour.
  12403. @item linear
  12404. @item cubic
  12405. @item cubic2p_bspline
  12406. 2-parameter cubic (B=1, C=0)
  12407. @item cubic2p_catmullrom
  12408. 2-parameter cubic (B=0, C=1/2)
  12409. @item cubic2p_b05c03
  12410. 2-parameter cubic (B=1/2, C=3/10)
  12411. @item super
  12412. Supersampling
  12413. @item lanczos
  12414. @end table
  12415. @item force_original_aspect_ratio
  12416. Enable decreasing or increasing output video width or height if necessary to
  12417. keep the original aspect ratio. Possible values:
  12418. @table @samp
  12419. @item disable
  12420. Scale the video as specified and disable this feature.
  12421. @item decrease
  12422. The output video dimensions will automatically be decreased if needed.
  12423. @item increase
  12424. The output video dimensions will automatically be increased if needed.
  12425. @end table
  12426. One useful instance of this option is that when you know a specific device's
  12427. maximum allowed resolution, you can use this to limit the output video to
  12428. that, while retaining the aspect ratio. For example, device A allows
  12429. 1280x720 playback, and your video is 1920x800. Using this option (set it to
  12430. decrease) and specifying 1280x720 to the command line makes the output
  12431. 1280x533.
  12432. Please note that this is a different thing than specifying -1 for @option{w}
  12433. or @option{h}, you still need to specify the output resolution for this option
  12434. to work.
  12435. @item force_divisible_by
  12436. Ensures that both the output dimensions, width and height, are divisible by the
  12437. given integer when used together with @option{force_original_aspect_ratio}. This
  12438. works similar to using @code{-n} in the @option{w} and @option{h} options.
  12439. This option respects the value set for @option{force_original_aspect_ratio},
  12440. increasing or decreasing the resolution accordingly. The video's aspect ratio
  12441. may be slightly modified.
  12442. This option can be handy if you need to have a video fit within or exceed
  12443. a defined resolution using @option{force_original_aspect_ratio} but also have
  12444. encoder restrictions on width or height divisibility.
  12445. @end table
  12446. @section scale2ref
  12447. Scale (resize) the input video, based on a reference video.
  12448. See the scale filter for available options, scale2ref supports the same but
  12449. uses the reference video instead of the main input as basis. scale2ref also
  12450. supports the following additional constants for the @option{w} and
  12451. @option{h} options:
  12452. @table @var
  12453. @item main_w
  12454. @item main_h
  12455. The main input video's width and height
  12456. @item main_a
  12457. The same as @var{main_w} / @var{main_h}
  12458. @item main_sar
  12459. The main input video's sample aspect ratio
  12460. @item main_dar, mdar
  12461. The main input video's display aspect ratio. Calculated from
  12462. @code{(main_w / main_h) * main_sar}.
  12463. @item main_hsub
  12464. @item main_vsub
  12465. The main input video's horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values.
  12466. For example for the pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub}
  12467. is 1.
  12468. @end table
  12469. @subsection Examples
  12470. @itemize
  12471. @item
  12472. Scale a subtitle stream (b) to match the main video (a) in size before overlaying
  12473. @example
  12474. 'scale2ref[b][a];[a][b]overlay'
  12475. @end example
  12476. @item
  12477. Scale a logo to 1/10th the height of a video, while preserving its display aspect ratio.
  12478. @example
  12479. [logo-in][video-in]scale2ref=w=oh*mdar:h=ih/10[logo-out][video-out]
  12480. @end example
  12481. @end itemize
  12482. @subsection Commands
  12483. This filter supports the following commands:
  12484. @table @option
  12485. @item width, w
  12486. @item height, h
  12487. Set the output video dimension expression.
  12488. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  12489. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  12490. value.
  12491. @end table
  12492. @section scroll
  12493. Scroll input video horizontally and/or vertically by constant speed.
  12494. The filter accepts the following options:
  12495. @table @option
  12496. @item horizontal, h
  12497. Set the horizontal scrolling speed. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  12498. Negative values changes scrolling direction.
  12499. @item vertical, v
  12500. Set the vertical scrolling speed. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  12501. Negative values changes scrolling direction.
  12502. @item hpos
  12503. Set the initial horizontal scrolling position. Default is 0. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  12504. @item vpos
  12505. Set the initial vertical scrolling position. Default is 0. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  12506. @end table
  12507. @subsection Commands
  12508. This filter supports the following @ref{commands}:
  12509. @table @option
  12510. @item horizontal, h
  12511. Set the horizontal scrolling speed.
  12512. @item vertical, v
  12513. Set the vertical scrolling speed.
  12514. @end table
  12515. @anchor{selectivecolor}
  12516. @section selectivecolor
  12517. Adjust cyan, magenta, yellow and black (CMYK) to certain ranges of colors (such
  12518. as "reds", "yellows", "greens", "cyans", ...). The adjustment range is defined
  12519. by the "purity" of the color (that is, how saturated it already is).
  12520. This filter is similar to the Adobe Photoshop Selective Color tool.
  12521. The filter accepts the following options:
  12522. @table @option
  12523. @item correction_method
  12524. Select color correction method.
  12525. Available values are:
  12526. @table @samp
  12527. @item absolute
  12528. Specified adjustments are applied "as-is" (added/subtracted to original pixel
  12529. component value).
  12530. @item relative
  12531. Specified adjustments are relative to the original component value.
  12532. @end table
  12533. Default is @code{absolute}.
  12534. @item reds
  12535. Adjustments for red pixels (pixels where the red component is the maximum)
  12536. @item yellows
  12537. Adjustments for yellow pixels (pixels where the blue component is the minimum)
  12538. @item greens
  12539. Adjustments for green pixels (pixels where the green component is the maximum)
  12540. @item cyans
  12541. Adjustments for cyan pixels (pixels where the red component is the minimum)
  12542. @item blues
  12543. Adjustments for blue pixels (pixels where the blue component is the maximum)
  12544. @item magentas
  12545. Adjustments for magenta pixels (pixels where the green component is the minimum)
  12546. @item whites
  12547. Adjustments for white pixels (pixels where all components are greater than 128)
  12548. @item neutrals
  12549. Adjustments for all pixels except pure black and pure white
  12550. @item blacks
  12551. Adjustments for black pixels (pixels where all components are lesser than 128)
  12552. @item psfile
  12553. Specify a Photoshop selective color file (@code{.asv}) to import the settings from.
  12554. @end table
  12555. All the adjustment settings (@option{reds}, @option{yellows}, ...) accept up to
  12556. 4 space separated floating point adjustment values in the [-1,1] range,
  12557. respectively to adjust the amount of cyan, magenta, yellow and black for the
  12558. pixels of its range.
  12559. @subsection Examples
  12560. @itemize
  12561. @item
  12562. Increase cyan by 50% and reduce yellow by 33% in every green areas, and
  12563. increase magenta by 27% in blue areas:
  12564. @example
  12565. selectivecolor=greens=.5 0 -.33 0:blues=0 .27
  12566. @end example
  12567. @item
  12568. Use a Photoshop selective color preset:
  12569. @example
  12570. selectivecolor=psfile=MySelectiveColorPresets/Misty.asv
  12571. @end example
  12572. @end itemize
  12573. @anchor{separatefields}
  12574. @section separatefields
  12575. The @code{separatefields} takes a frame-based video input and splits
  12576. each frame into its components fields, producing a new half height clip
  12577. with twice the frame rate and twice the frame count.
  12578. This filter use field-dominance information in frame to decide which
  12579. of each pair of fields to place first in the output.
  12580. If it gets it wrong use @ref{setfield} filter before @code{separatefields} filter.
  12581. @section setdar, setsar
  12582. The @code{setdar} filter sets the Display Aspect Ratio for the filter
  12583. output video.
  12584. This is done by changing the specified Sample (aka Pixel) Aspect
  12585. Ratio, according to the following equation:
  12586. @example
  12587. @var{DAR} = @var{HORIZONTAL_RESOLUTION} / @var{VERTICAL_RESOLUTION} * @var{SAR}
  12588. @end example
  12589. Keep in mind that the @code{setdar} filter does not modify the pixel
  12590. dimensions of the video frame. Also, the display aspect ratio set by
  12591. this filter may be changed by later filters in the filterchain,
  12592. e.g. in case of scaling or if another "setdar" or a "setsar" filter is
  12593. applied.
  12594. The @code{setsar} filter sets the Sample (aka Pixel) Aspect Ratio for
  12595. the filter output video.
  12596. Note that as a consequence of the application of this filter, the
  12597. output display aspect ratio will change according to the equation
  12598. above.
  12599. Keep in mind that the sample aspect ratio set by the @code{setsar}
  12600. filter may be changed by later filters in the filterchain, e.g. if
  12601. another "setsar" or a "setdar" filter is applied.
  12602. It accepts the following parameters:
  12603. @table @option
  12604. @item r, ratio, dar (@code{setdar} only), sar (@code{setsar} only)
  12605. Set the aspect ratio used by the filter.
  12606. The parameter can be a floating point number string, an expression, or
  12607. a string of the form @var{num}:@var{den}, where @var{num} and
  12608. @var{den} are the numerator and denominator of the aspect ratio. If
  12609. the parameter is not specified, it is assumed the value "0".
  12610. In case the form "@var{num}:@var{den}" is used, the @code{:} character
  12611. should be escaped.
  12612. @item max
  12613. Set the maximum integer value to use for expressing numerator and
  12614. denominator when reducing the expressed aspect ratio to a rational.
  12615. Default value is @code{100}.
  12616. @end table
  12617. The parameter @var{sar} is an expression containing
  12618. the following constants:
  12619. @table @option
  12620. @item E, PI, PHI
  12621. These are approximated values for the mathematical constants e
  12622. (Euler's number), pi (Greek pi), and phi (the golden ratio).
  12623. @item w, h
  12624. The input width and height.
  12625. @item a
  12626. These are the same as @var{w} / @var{h}.
  12627. @item sar
  12628. The input sample aspect ratio.
  12629. @item dar
  12630. The input display aspect ratio. It is the same as
  12631. (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}.
  12632. @item hsub, vsub
  12633. Horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example, for the
  12634. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  12635. @end table
  12636. @subsection Examples
  12637. @itemize
  12638. @item
  12639. To change the display aspect ratio to 16:9, specify one of the following:
  12640. @example
  12641. setdar=dar=1.77777
  12642. setdar=dar=16/9
  12643. @end example
  12644. @item
  12645. To change the sample aspect ratio to 10:11, specify:
  12646. @example
  12647. setsar=sar=10/11
  12648. @end example
  12649. @item
  12650. To set a display aspect ratio of 16:9, and specify a maximum integer value of
  12651. 1000 in the aspect ratio reduction, use the command:
  12652. @example
  12653. setdar=ratio=16/9:max=1000
  12654. @end example
  12655. @end itemize
  12656. @anchor{setfield}
  12657. @section setfield
  12658. Force field for the output video frame.
  12659. The @code{setfield} filter marks the interlace type field for the
  12660. output frames. It does not change the input frame, but only sets the
  12661. corresponding property, which affects how the frame is treated by
  12662. following filters (e.g. @code{fieldorder} or @code{yadif}).
  12663. The filter accepts the following options:
  12664. @table @option
  12665. @item mode
  12666. Available values are:
  12667. @table @samp
  12668. @item auto
  12669. Keep the same field property.
  12670. @item bff
  12671. Mark the frame as bottom-field-first.
  12672. @item tff
  12673. Mark the frame as top-field-first.
  12674. @item prog
  12675. Mark the frame as progressive.
  12676. @end table
  12677. @end table
  12678. @anchor{setparams}
  12679. @section setparams
  12680. Force frame parameter for the output video frame.
  12681. The @code{setparams} filter marks interlace and color range for the
  12682. output frames. It does not change the input frame, but only sets the
  12683. corresponding property, which affects how the frame is treated by
  12684. filters/encoders.
  12685. @table @option
  12686. @item field_mode
  12687. Available values are:
  12688. @table @samp
  12689. @item auto
  12690. Keep the same field property (default).
  12691. @item bff
  12692. Mark the frame as bottom-field-first.
  12693. @item tff
  12694. Mark the frame as top-field-first.
  12695. @item prog
  12696. Mark the frame as progressive.
  12697. @end table
  12698. @item range
  12699. Available values are:
  12700. @table @samp
  12701. @item auto
  12702. Keep the same color range property (default).
  12703. @item unspecified, unknown
  12704. Mark the frame as unspecified color range.
  12705. @item limited, tv, mpeg
  12706. Mark the frame as limited range.
  12707. @item full, pc, jpeg
  12708. Mark the frame as full range.
  12709. @end table
  12710. @item color_primaries
  12711. Set the color primaries.
  12712. Available values are:
  12713. @table @samp
  12714. @item auto
  12715. Keep the same color primaries property (default).
  12716. @item bt709
  12717. @item unknown
  12718. @item bt470m
  12719. @item bt470bg
  12720. @item smpte170m
  12721. @item smpte240m
  12722. @item film
  12723. @item bt2020
  12724. @item smpte428
  12725. @item smpte431
  12726. @item smpte432
  12727. @item jedec-p22
  12728. @end table
  12729. @item color_trc
  12730. Set the color transfer.
  12731. Available values are:
  12732. @table @samp
  12733. @item auto
  12734. Keep the same color trc property (default).
  12735. @item bt709
  12736. @item unknown
  12737. @item bt470m
  12738. @item bt470bg
  12739. @item smpte170m
  12740. @item smpte240m
  12741. @item linear
  12742. @item log100
  12743. @item log316
  12744. @item iec61966-2-4
  12745. @item bt1361e
  12746. @item iec61966-2-1
  12747. @item bt2020-10
  12748. @item bt2020-12
  12749. @item smpte2084
  12750. @item smpte428
  12751. @item arib-std-b67
  12752. @end table
  12753. @item colorspace
  12754. Set the colorspace.
  12755. Available values are:
  12756. @table @samp
  12757. @item auto
  12758. Keep the same colorspace property (default).
  12759. @item gbr
  12760. @item bt709
  12761. @item unknown
  12762. @item fcc
  12763. @item bt470bg
  12764. @item smpte170m
  12765. @item smpte240m
  12766. @item ycgco
  12767. @item bt2020nc
  12768. @item bt2020c
  12769. @item smpte2085
  12770. @item chroma-derived-nc
  12771. @item chroma-derived-c
  12772. @item ictcp
  12773. @end table
  12774. @end table
  12775. @section showinfo
  12776. Show a line containing various information for each input video frame.
  12777. The input video is not modified.
  12778. This filter supports the following options:
  12779. @table @option
  12780. @item checksum
  12781. Calculate checksums of each plane. By default enabled.
  12782. @end table
  12783. The shown line contains a sequence of key/value pairs of the form
  12784. @var{key}:@var{value}.
  12785. The following values are shown in the output:
  12786. @table @option
  12787. @item n
  12788. The (sequential) number of the input frame, starting from 0.
  12789. @item pts
  12790. The Presentation TimeStamp of the input frame, expressed as a number of
  12791. time base units. The time base unit depends on the filter input pad.
  12792. @item pts_time
  12793. The Presentation TimeStamp of the input frame, expressed as a number of
  12794. seconds.
  12795. @item pos
  12796. The position of the frame in the input stream, or -1 if this information is
  12797. unavailable and/or meaningless (for example in case of synthetic video).
  12798. @item fmt
  12799. The pixel format name.
  12800. @item sar
  12801. The sample aspect ratio of the input frame, expressed in the form
  12802. @var{num}/@var{den}.
  12803. @item s
  12804. The size of the input frame. For the syntax of this option, check the
  12805. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  12806. @item i
  12807. The type of interlaced mode ("P" for "progressive", "T" for top field first, "B"
  12808. for bottom field first).
  12809. @item iskey
  12810. This is 1 if the frame is a key frame, 0 otherwise.
  12811. @item type
  12812. The picture type of the input frame ("I" for an I-frame, "P" for a
  12813. P-frame, "B" for a B-frame, or "?" for an unknown type).
  12814. Also refer to the documentation of the @code{AVPictureType} enum and of
  12815. the @code{av_get_picture_type_char} function defined in
  12816. @file{libavutil/avutil.h}.
  12817. @item checksum
  12818. The Adler-32 checksum (printed in hexadecimal) of all the planes of the input frame.
  12819. @item plane_checksum
  12820. The Adler-32 checksum (printed in hexadecimal) of each plane of the input frame,
  12821. expressed in the form "[@var{c0} @var{c1} @var{c2} @var{c3}]".
  12822. @item mean
  12823. The mean value of pixels in each plane of the input frame, expressed in the form
  12824. "[@var{mean0} @var{mean1} @var{mean2} @var{mean3}]".
  12825. @item stdev
  12826. The standard deviation of pixel values in each plane of the input frame, expressed
  12827. in the form "[@var{stdev0} @var{stdev1} @var{stdev2} @var{stdev3}]".
  12828. @end table
  12829. @section showpalette
  12830. Displays the 256 colors palette of each frame. This filter is only relevant for
  12831. @var{pal8} pixel format frames.
  12832. It accepts the following option:
  12833. @table @option
  12834. @item s
  12835. Set the size of the box used to represent one palette color entry. Default is
  12836. @code{30} (for a @code{30x30} pixel box).
  12837. @end table
  12838. @section shuffleframes
  12839. Reorder and/or duplicate and/or drop video frames.
  12840. It accepts the following parameters:
  12841. @table @option
  12842. @item mapping
  12843. Set the destination indexes of input frames.
  12844. This is space or '|' separated list of indexes that maps input frames to output
  12845. frames. Number of indexes also sets maximal value that each index may have.
  12846. '-1' index have special meaning and that is to drop frame.
  12847. @end table
  12848. The first frame has the index 0. The default is to keep the input unchanged.
  12849. @subsection Examples
  12850. @itemize
  12851. @item
  12852. Swap second and third frame of every three frames of the input:
  12853. @example
  12854. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf "shuffleframes=0 2 1" OUTPUT
  12855. @end example
  12856. @item
  12857. Swap 10th and 1st frame of every ten frames of the input:
  12858. @example
  12859. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf "shuffleframes=9 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 0" OUTPUT
  12860. @end example
  12861. @end itemize
  12862. @section shuffleplanes
  12863. Reorder and/or duplicate video planes.
  12864. It accepts the following parameters:
  12865. @table @option
  12866. @item map0
  12867. The index of the input plane to be used as the first output plane.
  12868. @item map1
  12869. The index of the input plane to be used as the second output plane.
  12870. @item map2
  12871. The index of the input plane to be used as the third output plane.
  12872. @item map3
  12873. The index of the input plane to be used as the fourth output plane.
  12874. @end table
  12875. The first plane has the index 0. The default is to keep the input unchanged.
  12876. @subsection Examples
  12877. @itemize
  12878. @item
  12879. Swap the second and third planes of the input:
  12880. @example
  12881. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf shuffleplanes=0:2:1:3 OUTPUT
  12882. @end example
  12883. @end itemize
  12884. @anchor{signalstats}
  12885. @section signalstats
  12886. Evaluate various visual metrics that assist in determining issues associated
  12887. with the digitization of analog video media.
  12888. By default the filter will log these metadata values:
  12889. @table @option
  12890. @item YMIN
  12891. Display the minimal Y value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  12892. range of [0-255].
  12893. @item YLOW
  12894. Display the Y value at the 10% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  12895. range of [0-255].
  12896. @item YAVG
  12897. Display the average Y value within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  12898. [0-255].
  12899. @item YHIGH
  12900. Display the Y value at the 90% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  12901. range of [0-255].
  12902. @item YMAX
  12903. Display the maximum Y value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  12904. range of [0-255].
  12905. @item UMIN
  12906. Display the minimal U value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  12907. range of [0-255].
  12908. @item ULOW
  12909. Display the U value at the 10% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  12910. range of [0-255].
  12911. @item UAVG
  12912. Display the average U value within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  12913. [0-255].
  12914. @item UHIGH
  12915. Display the U value at the 90% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  12916. range of [0-255].
  12917. @item UMAX
  12918. Display the maximum U value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  12919. range of [0-255].
  12920. @item VMIN
  12921. Display the minimal V value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  12922. range of [0-255].
  12923. @item VLOW
  12924. Display the V value at the 10% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  12925. range of [0-255].
  12926. @item VAVG
  12927. Display the average V value within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  12928. [0-255].
  12929. @item VHIGH
  12930. Display the V value at the 90% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  12931. range of [0-255].
  12932. @item VMAX
  12933. Display the maximum V value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  12934. range of [0-255].
  12935. @item SATMIN
  12936. Display the minimal saturation value contained within the input frame.
  12937. Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].
  12938. @item SATLOW
  12939. Display the saturation value at the 10% percentile within the input frame.
  12940. Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].
  12941. @item SATAVG
  12942. Display the average saturation value within the input frame. Expressed in range
  12943. of [0-~181.02].
  12944. @item SATHIGH
  12945. Display the saturation value at the 90% percentile within the input frame.
  12946. Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].
  12947. @item SATMAX
  12948. Display the maximum saturation value contained within the input frame.
  12949. Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].
  12950. @item HUEMED
  12951. Display the median value for hue within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  12952. [0-360].
  12953. @item HUEAVG
  12954. Display the average value for hue within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  12955. [0-360].
  12956. @item YDIF
  12957. Display the average of sample value difference between all values of the Y
  12958. plane in the current frame and corresponding values of the previous input frame.
  12959. Expressed in range of [0-255].
  12960. @item UDIF
  12961. Display the average of sample value difference between all values of the U
  12962. plane in the current frame and corresponding values of the previous input frame.
  12963. Expressed in range of [0-255].
  12964. @item VDIF
  12965. Display the average of sample value difference between all values of the V
  12966. plane in the current frame and corresponding values of the previous input frame.
  12967. Expressed in range of [0-255].
  12968. @item YBITDEPTH
  12969. Display bit depth of Y plane in current frame.
  12970. Expressed in range of [0-16].
  12971. @item UBITDEPTH
  12972. Display bit depth of U plane in current frame.
  12973. Expressed in range of [0-16].
  12974. @item VBITDEPTH
  12975. Display bit depth of V plane in current frame.
  12976. Expressed in range of [0-16].
  12977. @end table
  12978. The filter accepts the following options:
  12979. @table @option
  12980. @item stat
  12981. @item out
  12982. @option{stat} specify an additional form of image analysis.
  12983. @option{out} output video with the specified type of pixel highlighted.
  12984. Both options accept the following values:
  12985. @table @samp
  12986. @item tout
  12987. Identify @var{temporal outliers} pixels. A @var{temporal outlier} is a pixel
  12988. unlike the neighboring pixels of the same field. Examples of temporal outliers
  12989. include the results of video dropouts, head clogs, or tape tracking issues.
  12990. @item vrep
  12991. Identify @var{vertical line repetition}. Vertical line repetition includes
  12992. similar rows of pixels within a frame. In born-digital video vertical line
  12993. repetition is common, but this pattern is uncommon in video digitized from an
  12994. analog source. When it occurs in video that results from the digitization of an
  12995. analog source it can indicate concealment from a dropout compensator.
  12996. @item brng
  12997. Identify pixels that fall outside of legal broadcast range.
  12998. @end table
  12999. @item color, c
  13000. Set the highlight color for the @option{out} option. The default color is
  13001. yellow.
  13002. @end table
  13003. @subsection Examples
  13004. @itemize
  13005. @item
  13006. Output data of various video metrics:
  13007. @example
  13008. ffprobe -f lavfi movie=example.mov,signalstats="stat=tout+vrep+brng" -show_frames
  13009. @end example
  13010. @item
  13011. Output specific data about the minimum and maximum values of the Y plane per frame:
  13012. @example
  13013. ffprobe -f lavfi movie=example.mov,signalstats -show_entries frame_tags=lavfi.signalstats.YMAX,lavfi.signalstats.YMIN
  13014. @end example
  13015. @item
  13016. Playback video while highlighting pixels that are outside of broadcast range in red.
  13017. @example
  13018. ffplay example.mov -vf signalstats="out=brng:color=red"
  13019. @end example
  13020. @item
  13021. Playback video with signalstats metadata drawn over the frame.
  13022. @example
  13023. ffplay example.mov -vf signalstats=stat=brng+vrep+tout,drawtext=fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:textfile=signalstat_drawtext.txt
  13024. @end example
  13025. The contents of signalstat_drawtext.txt used in the command are:
  13026. @example
  13027. time %@{pts:hms@}
  13028. Y (%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.YMIN@}-%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.YMAX@})
  13029. U (%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.UMIN@}-%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.UMAX@})
  13030. V (%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.VMIN@}-%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.VMAX@})
  13031. saturation maximum: %@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.SATMAX@}
  13032. @end example
  13033. @end itemize
  13034. @anchor{signature}
  13035. @section signature
  13036. Calculates the MPEG-7 Video Signature. The filter can handle more than one
  13037. input. In this case the matching between the inputs can be calculated additionally.
  13038. The filter always passes through the first input. The signature of each stream can
  13039. be written into a file.
  13040. It accepts the following options:
  13041. @table @option
  13042. @item detectmode
  13043. Enable or disable the matching process.
  13044. Available values are:
  13045. @table @samp
  13046. @item off
  13047. Disable the calculation of a matching (default).
  13048. @item full
  13049. Calculate the matching for the whole video and output whether the whole video
  13050. matches or only parts.
  13051. @item fast
  13052. Calculate only until a matching is found or the video ends. Should be faster in
  13053. some cases.
  13054. @end table
  13055. @item nb_inputs
  13056. Set the number of inputs. The option value must be a non negative integer.
  13057. Default value is 1.
  13058. @item filename
  13059. Set the path to which the output is written. If there is more than one input,
  13060. the path must be a prototype, i.e. must contain %d or %0nd (where n is a positive
  13061. integer), that will be replaced with the input number. If no filename is
  13062. specified, no output will be written. This is the default.
  13063. @item format
  13064. Choose the output format.
  13065. Available values are:
  13066. @table @samp
  13067. @item binary
  13068. Use the specified binary representation (default).
  13069. @item xml
  13070. Use the specified xml representation.
  13071. @end table
  13072. @item th_d
  13073. Set threshold to detect one word as similar. The option value must be an integer
  13074. greater than zero. The default value is 9000.
  13075. @item th_dc
  13076. Set threshold to detect all words as similar. The option value must be an integer
  13077. greater than zero. The default value is 60000.
  13078. @item th_xh
  13079. Set threshold to detect frames as similar. The option value must be an integer
  13080. greater than zero. The default value is 116.
  13081. @item th_di
  13082. Set the minimum length of a sequence in frames to recognize it as matching
  13083. sequence. The option value must be a non negative integer value.
  13084. The default value is 0.
  13085. @item th_it
  13086. Set the minimum relation, that matching frames to all frames must have.
  13087. The option value must be a double value between 0 and 1. The default value is 0.5.
  13088. @end table
  13089. @subsection Examples
  13090. @itemize
  13091. @item
  13092. To calculate the signature of an input video and store it in signature.bin:
  13093. @example
  13094. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -vf signature=filename=signature.bin -map 0:v -f null -
  13095. @end example
  13096. @item
  13097. To detect whether two videos match and store the signatures in XML format in
  13098. signature0.xml and signature1.xml:
  13099. @example
  13100. ffmpeg -i input1.mkv -i input2.mkv -filter_complex "[0:v][1:v] signature=nb_inputs=2:detectmode=full:format=xml:filename=signature%d.xml" -map :v -f null -
  13101. @end example
  13102. @end itemize
  13103. @anchor{smartblur}
  13104. @section smartblur
  13105. Blur the input video without impacting the outlines.
  13106. It accepts the following options:
  13107. @table @option
  13108. @item luma_radius, lr
  13109. Set the luma radius. The option value must be a float number in
  13110. the range [0.1,5.0] that specifies the variance of the gaussian filter
  13111. used to blur the image (slower if larger). Default value is 1.0.
  13112. @item luma_strength, ls
  13113. Set the luma strength. The option value must be a float number
  13114. in the range [-1.0,1.0] that configures the blurring. A value included
  13115. in [0.0,1.0] will blur the image whereas a value included in
  13116. [-1.0,0.0] will sharpen the image. Default value is 1.0.
  13117. @item luma_threshold, lt
  13118. Set the luma threshold used as a coefficient to determine
  13119. whether a pixel should be blurred or not. The option value must be an
  13120. integer in the range [-30,30]. A value of 0 will filter all the image,
  13121. a value included in [0,30] will filter flat areas and a value included
  13122. in [-30,0] will filter edges. Default value is 0.
  13123. @item chroma_radius, cr
  13124. Set the chroma radius. The option value must be a float number in
  13125. the range [0.1,5.0] that specifies the variance of the gaussian filter
  13126. used to blur the image (slower if larger). Default value is @option{luma_radius}.
  13127. @item chroma_strength, cs
  13128. Set the chroma strength. The option value must be a float number
  13129. in the range [-1.0,1.0] that configures the blurring. A value included
  13130. in [0.0,1.0] will blur the image whereas a value included in
  13131. [-1.0,0.0] will sharpen the image. Default value is @option{luma_strength}.
  13132. @item chroma_threshold, ct
  13133. Set the chroma threshold used as a coefficient to determine
  13134. whether a pixel should be blurred or not. The option value must be an
  13135. integer in the range [-30,30]. A value of 0 will filter all the image,
  13136. a value included in [0,30] will filter flat areas and a value included
  13137. in [-30,0] will filter edges. Default value is @option{luma_threshold}.
  13138. @end table
  13139. If a chroma option is not explicitly set, the corresponding luma value
  13140. is set.
  13141. @section sobel
  13142. Apply sobel operator to input video stream.
  13143. The filter accepts the following option:
  13144. @table @option
  13145. @item planes
  13146. Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.
  13147. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  13148. @item scale
  13149. Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.
  13150. @item delta
  13151. Set value which will be added to filtered result.
  13152. @end table
  13153. @anchor{spp}
  13154. @section spp
  13155. Apply a simple postprocessing filter that compresses and decompresses the image
  13156. at several (or - in the case of @option{quality} level @code{6} - all) shifts
  13157. and average the results.
  13158. The filter accepts the following options:
  13159. @table @option
  13160. @item quality
  13161. Set quality. This option defines the number of levels for averaging. It accepts
  13162. an integer in the range 0-6. If set to @code{0}, the filter will have no
  13163. effect. A value of @code{6} means the higher quality. For each increment of
  13164. that value the speed drops by a factor of approximately 2. Default value is
  13165. @code{3}.
  13166. @item qp
  13167. Force a constant quantization parameter. If not set, the filter will use the QP
  13168. from the video stream (if available).
  13169. @item mode
  13170. Set thresholding mode. Available modes are:
  13171. @table @samp
  13172. @item hard
  13173. Set hard thresholding (default).
  13174. @item soft
  13175. Set soft thresholding (better de-ringing effect, but likely blurrier).
  13176. @end table
  13177. @item use_bframe_qp
  13178. Enable the use of the QP from the B-Frames if set to @code{1}. Using this
  13179. option may cause flicker since the B-Frames have often larger QP. Default is
  13180. @code{0} (not enabled).
  13181. @end table
  13182. @subsection Commands
  13183. This filter supports the following commands:
  13184. @table @option
  13185. @item level
  13186. @item quality
  13187. Same as quality option. And the command accepts the @code{max} same as the @code{6}.
  13188. @end table
  13189. @section sr
  13190. Scale the input by applying one of the super-resolution methods based on
  13191. convolutional neural networks. Supported models:
  13192. @itemize
  13193. @item
  13194. Super-Resolution Convolutional Neural Network model (SRCNN).
  13195. See @url{https://arxiv.org/abs/1501.00092}.
  13196. @item
  13197. Efficient Sub-Pixel Convolutional Neural Network model (ESPCN).
  13198. See @url{https://arxiv.org/abs/1609.05158}.
  13199. @end itemize
  13200. Training scripts as well as scripts for model file (.pb) saving can be found at
  13201. @url{https://github.com/XueweiMeng/sr/tree/sr_dnn_native}. Original repository
  13202. is at @url{https://github.com/HighVoltageRocknRoll/sr.git}.
  13203. Native model files (.model) can be generated from TensorFlow model
  13204. files (.pb) by using tools/python/convert.py
  13205. The filter accepts the following options:
  13206. @table @option
  13207. @item dnn_backend
  13208. Specify which DNN backend to use for model loading and execution. This option accepts
  13209. the following values:
  13210. @table @samp
  13211. @item native
  13212. Native implementation of DNN loading and execution.
  13213. @item tensorflow
  13214. TensorFlow backend. To enable this backend you
  13215. need to install the TensorFlow for C library (see
  13216. @url{https://www.tensorflow.org/install/install_c}) and configure FFmpeg with
  13217. @code{--enable-libtensorflow}
  13218. @end table
  13219. Default value is @samp{native}.
  13220. @item model
  13221. Set path to model file specifying network architecture and its parameters.
  13222. Note that different backends use different file formats. TensorFlow backend
  13223. can load files for both formats, while native backend can load files for only
  13224. its format.
  13225. @item scale_factor
  13226. Set scale factor for SRCNN model. Allowed values are @code{2}, @code{3} and @code{4}.
  13227. Default value is @code{2}. Scale factor is necessary for SRCNN model, because it accepts
  13228. input upscaled using bicubic upscaling with proper scale factor.
  13229. @end table
  13230. @section ssim
  13231. Obtain the SSIM (Structural SImilarity Metric) between two input videos.
  13232. This filter takes in input two input videos, the first input is
  13233. considered the "main" source and is passed unchanged to the
  13234. output. The second input is used as a "reference" video for computing
  13235. the SSIM.
  13236. Both video inputs must have the same resolution and pixel format for
  13237. this filter to work correctly. Also it assumes that both inputs
  13238. have the same number of frames, which are compared one by one.
  13239. The filter stores the calculated SSIM of each frame.
  13240. The description of the accepted parameters follows.
  13241. @table @option
  13242. @item stats_file, f
  13243. If specified the filter will use the named file to save the SSIM of
  13244. each individual frame. When filename equals "-" the data is sent to
  13245. standard output.
  13246. @end table
  13247. The file printed if @var{stats_file} is selected, contains a sequence of
  13248. key/value pairs of the form @var{key}:@var{value} for each compared
  13249. couple of frames.
  13250. A description of each shown parameter follows:
  13251. @table @option
  13252. @item n
  13253. sequential number of the input frame, starting from 1
  13254. @item Y, U, V, R, G, B
  13255. SSIM of the compared frames for the component specified by the suffix.
  13256. @item All
  13257. SSIM of the compared frames for the whole frame.
  13258. @item dB
  13259. Same as above but in dB representation.
  13260. @end table
  13261. This filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  13262. @subsection Examples
  13263. @itemize
  13264. @item
  13265. For example:
  13266. @example
  13267. movie=ref_movie.mpg, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
  13268. [main][ref] ssim="stats_file=stats.log" [out]
  13269. @end example
  13270. On this example the input file being processed is compared with the
  13271. reference file @file{ref_movie.mpg}. The SSIM of each individual frame
  13272. is stored in @file{stats.log}.
  13273. @item
  13274. Another example with both psnr and ssim at same time:
  13275. @example
  13276. ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mpg -lavfi "ssim;[0:v][1:v]psnr" -f null -
  13277. @end example
  13278. @item
  13279. Another example with different containers:
  13280. @example
  13281. ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mkv -lavfi "[0:v]settb=AVTB,setpts=PTS-STARTPTS[main];[1:v]settb=AVTB,setpts=PTS-STARTPTS[ref];[main][ref]ssim" -f null -
  13282. @end example
  13283. @end itemize
  13284. @section stereo3d
  13285. Convert between different stereoscopic image formats.
  13286. The filters accept the following options:
  13287. @table @option
  13288. @item in
  13289. Set stereoscopic image format of input.
  13290. Available values for input image formats are:
  13291. @table @samp
  13292. @item sbsl
  13293. side by side parallel (left eye left, right eye right)
  13294. @item sbsr
  13295. side by side crosseye (right eye left, left eye right)
  13296. @item sbs2l
  13297. side by side parallel with half width resolution
  13298. (left eye left, right eye right)
  13299. @item sbs2r
  13300. side by side crosseye with half width resolution
  13301. (right eye left, left eye right)
  13302. @item abl
  13303. @item tbl
  13304. above-below (left eye above, right eye below)
  13305. @item abr
  13306. @item tbr
  13307. above-below (right eye above, left eye below)
  13308. @item ab2l
  13309. @item tb2l
  13310. above-below with half height resolution
  13311. (left eye above, right eye below)
  13312. @item ab2r
  13313. @item tb2r
  13314. above-below with half height resolution
  13315. (right eye above, left eye below)
  13316. @item al
  13317. alternating frames (left eye first, right eye second)
  13318. @item ar
  13319. alternating frames (right eye first, left eye second)
  13320. @item irl
  13321. interleaved rows (left eye has top row, right eye starts on next row)
  13322. @item irr
  13323. interleaved rows (right eye has top row, left eye starts on next row)
  13324. @item icl
  13325. interleaved columns, left eye first
  13326. @item icr
  13327. interleaved columns, right eye first
  13328. Default value is @samp{sbsl}.
  13329. @end table
  13330. @item out
  13331. Set stereoscopic image format of output.
  13332. @table @samp
  13333. @item sbsl
  13334. side by side parallel (left eye left, right eye right)
  13335. @item sbsr
  13336. side by side crosseye (right eye left, left eye right)
  13337. @item sbs2l
  13338. side by side parallel with half width resolution
  13339. (left eye left, right eye right)
  13340. @item sbs2r
  13341. side by side crosseye with half width resolution
  13342. (right eye left, left eye right)
  13343. @item abl
  13344. @item tbl
  13345. above-below (left eye above, right eye below)
  13346. @item abr
  13347. @item tbr
  13348. above-below (right eye above, left eye below)
  13349. @item ab2l
  13350. @item tb2l
  13351. above-below with half height resolution
  13352. (left eye above, right eye below)
  13353. @item ab2r
  13354. @item tb2r
  13355. above-below with half height resolution
  13356. (right eye above, left eye below)
  13357. @item al
  13358. alternating frames (left eye first, right eye second)
  13359. @item ar
  13360. alternating frames (right eye first, left eye second)
  13361. @item irl
  13362. interleaved rows (left eye has top row, right eye starts on next row)
  13363. @item irr
  13364. interleaved rows (right eye has top row, left eye starts on next row)
  13365. @item arbg
  13366. anaglyph red/blue gray
  13367. (red filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  13368. @item argg
  13369. anaglyph red/green gray
  13370. (red filter on left eye, green filter on right eye)
  13371. @item arcg
  13372. anaglyph red/cyan gray
  13373. (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)
  13374. @item arch
  13375. anaglyph red/cyan half colored
  13376. (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)
  13377. @item arcc
  13378. anaglyph red/cyan color
  13379. (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)
  13380. @item arcd
  13381. anaglyph red/cyan color optimized with the least squares projection of dubois
  13382. (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)
  13383. @item agmg
  13384. anaglyph green/magenta gray
  13385. (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)
  13386. @item agmh
  13387. anaglyph green/magenta half colored
  13388. (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)
  13389. @item agmc
  13390. anaglyph green/magenta colored
  13391. (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)
  13392. @item agmd
  13393. anaglyph green/magenta color optimized with the least squares projection of dubois
  13394. (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)
  13395. @item aybg
  13396. anaglyph yellow/blue gray
  13397. (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  13398. @item aybh
  13399. anaglyph yellow/blue half colored
  13400. (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  13401. @item aybc
  13402. anaglyph yellow/blue colored
  13403. (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  13404. @item aybd
  13405. anaglyph yellow/blue color optimized with the least squares projection of dubois
  13406. (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  13407. @item ml
  13408. mono output (left eye only)
  13409. @item mr
  13410. mono output (right eye only)
  13411. @item chl
  13412. checkerboard, left eye first
  13413. @item chr
  13414. checkerboard, right eye first
  13415. @item icl
  13416. interleaved columns, left eye first
  13417. @item icr
  13418. interleaved columns, right eye first
  13419. @item hdmi
  13420. HDMI frame pack
  13421. @end table
  13422. Default value is @samp{arcd}.
  13423. @end table
  13424. @subsection Examples
  13425. @itemize
  13426. @item
  13427. Convert input video from side by side parallel to anaglyph yellow/blue dubois:
  13428. @example
  13429. stereo3d=sbsl:aybd
  13430. @end example
  13431. @item
  13432. Convert input video from above below (left eye above, right eye below) to side by side crosseye.
  13433. @example
  13434. stereo3d=abl:sbsr
  13435. @end example
  13436. @end itemize
  13437. @section streamselect, astreamselect
  13438. Select video or audio streams.
  13439. The filter accepts the following options:
  13440. @table @option
  13441. @item inputs
  13442. Set number of inputs. Default is 2.
  13443. @item map
  13444. Set input indexes to remap to outputs.
  13445. @end table
  13446. @subsection Commands
  13447. The @code{streamselect} and @code{astreamselect} filter supports the following
  13448. commands:
  13449. @table @option
  13450. @item map
  13451. Set input indexes to remap to outputs.
  13452. @end table
  13453. @subsection Examples
  13454. @itemize
  13455. @item
  13456. Select first 5 seconds 1st stream and rest of time 2nd stream:
  13457. @example
  13458. sendcmd='5.0 streamselect map 1',streamselect=inputs=2:map=0
  13459. @end example
  13460. @item
  13461. Same as above, but for audio:
  13462. @example
  13463. asendcmd='5.0 astreamselect map 1',astreamselect=inputs=2:map=0
  13464. @end example
  13465. @end itemize
  13466. @anchor{subtitles}
  13467. @section subtitles
  13468. Draw subtitles on top of input video using the libass library.
  13469. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  13470. @code{--enable-libass}. This filter also requires a build with libavcodec and
  13471. libavformat to convert the passed subtitles file to ASS (Advanced Substation
  13472. Alpha) subtitles format.
  13473. The filter accepts the following options:
  13474. @table @option
  13475. @item filename, f
  13476. Set the filename of the subtitle file to read. It must be specified.
  13477. @item original_size
  13478. Specify the size of the original video, the video for which the ASS file
  13479. was composed. For the syntax of this option, check the
  13480. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  13481. Due to a misdesign in ASS aspect ratio arithmetic, this is necessary to
  13482. correctly scale the fonts if the aspect ratio has been changed.
  13483. @item fontsdir
  13484. Set a directory path containing fonts that can be used by the filter.
  13485. These fonts will be used in addition to whatever the font provider uses.
  13486. @item alpha
  13487. Process alpha channel, by default alpha channel is untouched.
  13488. @item charenc
  13489. Set subtitles input character encoding. @code{subtitles} filter only. Only
  13490. useful if not UTF-8.
  13491. @item stream_index, si
  13492. Set subtitles stream index. @code{subtitles} filter only.
  13493. @item force_style
  13494. Override default style or script info parameters of the subtitles. It accepts a
  13495. string containing ASS style format @code{KEY=VALUE} couples separated by ",".
  13496. @end table
  13497. If the first key is not specified, it is assumed that the first value
  13498. specifies the @option{filename}.
  13499. For example, to render the file @file{sub.srt} on top of the input
  13500. video, use the command:
  13501. @example
  13502. subtitles=sub.srt
  13503. @end example
  13504. which is equivalent to:
  13505. @example
  13506. subtitles=filename=sub.srt
  13507. @end example
  13508. To render the default subtitles stream from file @file{video.mkv}, use:
  13509. @example
  13510. subtitles=video.mkv
  13511. @end example
  13512. To render the second subtitles stream from that file, use:
  13513. @example
  13514. subtitles=video.mkv:si=1
  13515. @end example
  13516. To make the subtitles stream from @file{sub.srt} appear in 80% transparent blue
  13517. @code{DejaVu Serif}, use:
  13518. @example
  13519. subtitles=sub.srt:force_style='FontName=DejaVu Serif,PrimaryColour=&HCCFF0000'
  13520. @end example
  13521. @section super2xsai
  13522. Scale the input by 2x and smooth using the Super2xSaI (Scale and
  13523. Interpolate) pixel art scaling algorithm.
  13524. Useful for enlarging pixel art images without reducing sharpness.
  13525. @section swaprect
  13526. Swap two rectangular objects in video.
  13527. This filter accepts the following options:
  13528. @table @option
  13529. @item w
  13530. Set object width.
  13531. @item h
  13532. Set object height.
  13533. @item x1
  13534. Set 1st rect x coordinate.
  13535. @item y1
  13536. Set 1st rect y coordinate.
  13537. @item x2
  13538. Set 2nd rect x coordinate.
  13539. @item y2
  13540. Set 2nd rect y coordinate.
  13541. All expressions are evaluated once for each frame.
  13542. @end table
  13543. The all options are expressions containing the following constants:
  13544. @table @option
  13545. @item w
  13546. @item h
  13547. The input width and height.
  13548. @item a
  13549. same as @var{w} / @var{h}
  13550. @item sar
  13551. input sample aspect ratio
  13552. @item dar
  13553. input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}
  13554. @item n
  13555. The number of the input frame, starting from 0.
  13556. @item t
  13557. The timestamp expressed in seconds. It's NAN if the input timestamp is unknown.
  13558. @item pos
  13559. the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown
  13560. @end table
  13561. @section swapuv
  13562. Swap U & V plane.
  13563. @section telecine
  13564. Apply telecine process to the video.
  13565. This filter accepts the following options:
  13566. @table @option
  13567. @item first_field
  13568. @table @samp
  13569. @item top, t
  13570. top field first
  13571. @item bottom, b
  13572. bottom field first
  13573. The default value is @code{top}.
  13574. @end table
  13575. @item pattern
  13576. A string of numbers representing the pulldown pattern you wish to apply.
  13577. The default value is @code{23}.
  13578. @end table
  13579. @example
  13580. Some typical patterns:
  13581. NTSC output (30i):
  13582. 27.5p: 32222
  13583. 24p: 23 (classic)
  13584. 24p: 2332 (preferred)
  13585. 20p: 33
  13586. 18p: 334
  13587. 16p: 3444
  13588. PAL output (25i):
  13589. 27.5p: 12222
  13590. 24p: 222222222223 ("Euro pulldown")
  13591. 16.67p: 33
  13592. 16p: 33333334
  13593. @end example
  13594. @section thistogram
  13595. Compute and draw a color distribution histogram for the input video across time.
  13596. Unlike @ref{histogram} video filter which only shows histogram of single input frame
  13597. at certain time, this filter shows also past histograms of number of frames defined
  13598. by @code{width} option.
  13599. The computed histogram is a representation of the color component
  13600. distribution in an image.
  13601. The filter accepts the following options:
  13602. @table @option
  13603. @item width, w
  13604. Set width of single color component output. Default value is @code{0}.
  13605. Value of @code{0} means width will be picked from input video.
  13606. This also set number of passed histograms to keep.
  13607. Allowed range is [0, 8192].
  13608. @item display_mode, d
  13609. Set display mode.
  13610. It accepts the following values:
  13611. @table @samp
  13612. @item stack
  13613. Per color component graphs are placed below each other.
  13614. @item parade
  13615. Per color component graphs are placed side by side.
  13616. @item overlay
  13617. Presents information identical to that in the @code{parade}, except
  13618. that the graphs representing color components are superimposed directly
  13619. over one another.
  13620. @end table
  13621. Default is @code{stack}.
  13622. @item levels_mode, m
  13623. Set mode. Can be either @code{linear}, or @code{logarithmic}.
  13624. Default is @code{linear}.
  13625. @item components, c
  13626. Set what color components to display.
  13627. Default is @code{7}.
  13628. @item bgopacity, b
  13629. Set background opacity. Default is @code{0.9}.
  13630. @item envelope, e
  13631. Show envelope. Default is disabled.
  13632. @item ecolor, ec
  13633. Set envelope color. Default is @code{gold}.
  13634. @end table
  13635. @section threshold
  13636. Apply threshold effect to video stream.
  13637. This filter needs four video streams to perform thresholding.
  13638. First stream is stream we are filtering.
  13639. Second stream is holding threshold values, third stream is holding min values,
  13640. and last, fourth stream is holding max values.
  13641. The filter accepts the following option:
  13642. @table @option
  13643. @item planes
  13644. Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.
  13645. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  13646. @end table
  13647. For example if first stream pixel's component value is less then threshold value
  13648. of pixel component from 2nd threshold stream, third stream value will picked,
  13649. otherwise fourth stream pixel component value will be picked.
  13650. Using color source filter one can perform various types of thresholding:
  13651. @subsection Examples
  13652. @itemize
  13653. @item
  13654. Binary threshold, using gray color as threshold:
  13655. @example
  13656. ffmpeg -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -f lavfi -i color=black -f lavfi -i color=white -lavfi threshold output.avi
  13657. @end example
  13658. @item
  13659. Inverted binary threshold, using gray color as threshold:
  13660. @example
  13661. ffmpeg -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -f lavfi -i color=white -f lavfi -i color=black -lavfi threshold output.avi
  13662. @end example
  13663. @item
  13664. Truncate binary threshold, using gray color as threshold:
  13665. @example
  13666. ffmpeg -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -lavfi threshold output.avi
  13667. @end example
  13668. @item
  13669. Threshold to zero, using gray color as threshold:
  13670. @example
  13671. ffmpeg -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -f lavfi -i color=white -i 320x240.avi -lavfi threshold output.avi
  13672. @end example
  13673. @item
  13674. Inverted threshold to zero, using gray color as threshold:
  13675. @example
  13676. ffmpeg -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=white -lavfi threshold output.avi
  13677. @end example
  13678. @end itemize
  13679. @section thumbnail
  13680. Select the most representative frame in a given sequence of consecutive frames.
  13681. The filter accepts the following options:
  13682. @table @option
  13683. @item n
  13684. Set the frames batch size to analyze; in a set of @var{n} frames, the filter
  13685. will pick one of them, and then handle the next batch of @var{n} frames until
  13686. the end. Default is @code{100}.
  13687. @end table
  13688. Since the filter keeps track of the whole frames sequence, a bigger @var{n}
  13689. value will result in a higher memory usage, so a high value is not recommended.
  13690. @subsection Examples
  13691. @itemize
  13692. @item
  13693. Extract one picture each 50 frames:
  13694. @example
  13695. thumbnail=50
  13696. @end example
  13697. @item
  13698. Complete example of a thumbnail creation with @command{ffmpeg}:
  13699. @example
  13700. ffmpeg -i in.avi -vf thumbnail,scale=300:200 -frames:v 1 out.png
  13701. @end example
  13702. @end itemize
  13703. @section tile
  13704. Tile several successive frames together.
  13705. The filter accepts the following options:
  13706. @table @option
  13707. @item layout
  13708. Set the grid size (i.e. the number of lines and columns). For the syntax of
  13709. this option, check the
  13710. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  13711. @item nb_frames
  13712. Set the maximum number of frames to render in the given area. It must be less
  13713. than or equal to @var{w}x@var{h}. The default value is @code{0}, meaning all
  13714. the area will be used.
  13715. @item margin
  13716. Set the outer border margin in pixels.
  13717. @item padding
  13718. Set the inner border thickness (i.e. the number of pixels between frames). For
  13719. more advanced padding options (such as having different values for the edges),
  13720. refer to the pad video filter.
  13721. @item color
  13722. Specify the color of the unused area. For the syntax of this option, check the
  13723. @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  13724. The default value of @var{color} is "black".
  13725. @item overlap
  13726. Set the number of frames to overlap when tiling several successive frames together.
  13727. The value must be between @code{0} and @var{nb_frames - 1}.
  13728. @item init_padding
  13729. Set the number of frames to initially be empty before displaying first output frame.
  13730. This controls how soon will one get first output frame.
  13731. The value must be between @code{0} and @var{nb_frames - 1}.
  13732. @end table
  13733. @subsection Examples
  13734. @itemize
  13735. @item
  13736. Produce 8x8 PNG tiles of all keyframes (@option{-skip_frame nokey}) in a movie:
  13737. @example
  13738. ffmpeg -skip_frame nokey -i file.avi -vf 'scale=128:72,tile=8x8' -an -vsync 0 keyframes%03d.png
  13739. @end example
  13740. The @option{-vsync 0} is necessary to prevent @command{ffmpeg} from
  13741. duplicating each output frame to accommodate the originally detected frame
  13742. rate.
  13743. @item
  13744. Display @code{5} pictures in an area of @code{3x2} frames,
  13745. with @code{7} pixels between them, and @code{2} pixels of initial margin, using
  13746. mixed flat and named options:
  13747. @example
  13748. tile=3x2:nb_frames=5:padding=7:margin=2
  13749. @end example
  13750. @end itemize
  13751. @section tinterlace
  13752. Perform various types of temporal field interlacing.
  13753. Frames are counted starting from 1, so the first input frame is
  13754. considered odd.
  13755. The filter accepts the following options:
  13756. @table @option
  13757. @item mode
  13758. Specify the mode of the interlacing. This option can also be specified
  13759. as a value alone. See below for a list of values for this option.
  13760. Available values are:
  13761. @table @samp
  13762. @item merge, 0
  13763. Move odd frames into the upper field, even into the lower field,
  13764. generating a double height frame at half frame rate.
  13765. @example
  13766. ------> time
  13767. Input:
  13768. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13769. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13770. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13771. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13772. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13773. Output:
  13774. 11111 33333
  13775. 22222 44444
  13776. 11111 33333
  13777. 22222 44444
  13778. 11111 33333
  13779. 22222 44444
  13780. 11111 33333
  13781. 22222 44444
  13782. @end example
  13783. @item drop_even, 1
  13784. Only output odd frames, even frames are dropped, generating a frame with
  13785. unchanged height at half frame rate.
  13786. @example
  13787. ------> time
  13788. Input:
  13789. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13790. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13791. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13792. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13793. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13794. Output:
  13795. 11111 33333
  13796. 11111 33333
  13797. 11111 33333
  13798. 11111 33333
  13799. @end example
  13800. @item drop_odd, 2
  13801. Only output even frames, odd frames are dropped, generating a frame with
  13802. unchanged height at half frame rate.
  13803. @example
  13804. ------> time
  13805. Input:
  13806. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13807. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13808. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13809. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13810. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13811. Output:
  13812. 22222 44444
  13813. 22222 44444
  13814. 22222 44444
  13815. 22222 44444
  13816. @end example
  13817. @item pad, 3
  13818. Expand each frame to full height, but pad alternate lines with black,
  13819. generating a frame with double height at the same input frame rate.
  13820. @example
  13821. ------> time
  13822. Input:
  13823. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13824. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13825. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13826. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13827. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13828. Output:
  13829. 11111 ..... 33333 .....
  13830. ..... 22222 ..... 44444
  13831. 11111 ..... 33333 .....
  13832. ..... 22222 ..... 44444
  13833. 11111 ..... 33333 .....
  13834. ..... 22222 ..... 44444
  13835. 11111 ..... 33333 .....
  13836. ..... 22222 ..... 44444
  13837. @end example
  13838. @item interleave_top, 4
  13839. Interleave the upper field from odd frames with the lower field from
  13840. even frames, generating a frame with unchanged height at half frame rate.
  13841. @example
  13842. ------> time
  13843. Input:
  13844. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13845. 11111<- 22222 33333<- 44444
  13846. 11111 22222<- 33333 44444<-
  13847. 11111<- 22222 33333<- 44444
  13848. 11111 22222<- 33333 44444<-
  13849. Output:
  13850. 11111 33333
  13851. 22222 44444
  13852. 11111 33333
  13853. 22222 44444
  13854. @end example
  13855. @item interleave_bottom, 5
  13856. Interleave the lower field from odd frames with the upper field from
  13857. even frames, generating a frame with unchanged height at half frame rate.
  13858. @example
  13859. ------> time
  13860. Input:
  13861. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13862. 11111 22222<- 33333 44444<-
  13863. 11111<- 22222 33333<- 44444
  13864. 11111 22222<- 33333 44444<-
  13865. 11111<- 22222 33333<- 44444
  13866. Output:
  13867. 22222 44444
  13868. 11111 33333
  13869. 22222 44444
  13870. 11111 33333
  13871. @end example
  13872. @item interlacex2, 6
  13873. Double frame rate with unchanged height. Frames are inserted each
  13874. containing the second temporal field from the previous input frame and
  13875. the first temporal field from the next input frame. This mode relies on
  13876. the top_field_first flag. Useful for interlaced video displays with no
  13877. field synchronisation.
  13878. @example
  13879. ------> time
  13880. Input:
  13881. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13882. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13883. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13884. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13885. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13886. Output:
  13887. 11111 22222 22222 33333 33333 44444 44444
  13888. 11111 11111 22222 22222 33333 33333 44444
  13889. 11111 22222 22222 33333 33333 44444 44444
  13890. 11111 11111 22222 22222 33333 33333 44444
  13891. @end example
  13892. @item mergex2, 7
  13893. Move odd frames into the upper field, even into the lower field,
  13894. generating a double height frame at same frame rate.
  13895. @example
  13896. ------> time
  13897. Input:
  13898. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13899. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13900. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13901. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13902. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13903. Output:
  13904. 11111 33333 33333 55555
  13905. 22222 22222 44444 44444
  13906. 11111 33333 33333 55555
  13907. 22222 22222 44444 44444
  13908. 11111 33333 33333 55555
  13909. 22222 22222 44444 44444
  13910. 11111 33333 33333 55555
  13911. 22222 22222 44444 44444
  13912. @end example
  13913. @end table
  13914. Numeric values are deprecated but are accepted for backward
  13915. compatibility reasons.
  13916. Default mode is @code{merge}.
  13917. @item flags
  13918. Specify flags influencing the filter process.
  13919. Available value for @var{flags} is:
  13920. @table @option
  13921. @item low_pass_filter, vlpf
  13922. Enable linear vertical low-pass filtering in the filter.
  13923. Vertical low-pass filtering is required when creating an interlaced
  13924. destination from a progressive source which contains high-frequency
  13925. vertical detail. Filtering will reduce interlace 'twitter' and Moire
  13926. patterning.
  13927. @item complex_filter, cvlpf
  13928. Enable complex vertical low-pass filtering.
  13929. This will slightly less reduce interlace 'twitter' and Moire
  13930. patterning but better retain detail and subjective sharpness impression.
  13931. @item bypass_il
  13932. Bypass already interlaced frames, only adjust the frame rate.
  13933. @end table
  13934. Vertical low-pass filtering and bypassing already interlaced frames can only be
  13935. enabled for @option{mode} @var{interleave_top} and @var{interleave_bottom}.
  13936. @end table
  13937. @section tmix
  13938. Mix successive video frames.
  13939. A description of the accepted options follows.
  13940. @table @option
  13941. @item frames
  13942. The number of successive frames to mix. If unspecified, it defaults to 3.
  13943. @item weights
  13944. Specify weight of each input video frame.
  13945. Each weight is separated by space. If number of weights is smaller than
  13946. number of @var{frames} last specified weight will be used for all remaining
  13947. unset weights.
  13948. @item scale
  13949. Specify scale, if it is set it will be multiplied with sum
  13950. of each weight multiplied with pixel values to give final destination
  13951. pixel value. By default @var{scale} is auto scaled to sum of weights.
  13952. @end table
  13953. @subsection Examples
  13954. @itemize
  13955. @item
  13956. Average 7 successive frames:
  13957. @example
  13958. tmix=frames=7:weights="1 1 1 1 1 1 1"
  13959. @end example
  13960. @item
  13961. Apply simple temporal convolution:
  13962. @example
  13963. tmix=frames=3:weights="-1 3 -1"
  13964. @end example
  13965. @item
  13966. Similar as above but only showing temporal differences:
  13967. @example
  13968. tmix=frames=3:weights="-1 2 -1":scale=1
  13969. @end example
  13970. @end itemize
  13971. @anchor{tonemap}
  13972. @section tonemap
  13973. Tone map colors from different dynamic ranges.
  13974. This filter expects data in single precision floating point, as it needs to
  13975. operate on (and can output) out-of-range values. Another filter, such as
  13976. @ref{zscale}, is needed to convert the resulting frame to a usable format.
  13977. The tonemapping algorithms implemented only work on linear light, so input
  13978. data should be linearized beforehand (and possibly correctly tagged).
  13979. @example
  13980. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf zscale=transfer=linear,tonemap=clip,zscale=transfer=bt709,format=yuv420p OUTPUT
  13981. @end example
  13982. @subsection Options
  13983. The filter accepts the following options.
  13984. @table @option
  13985. @item tonemap
  13986. Set the tone map algorithm to use.
  13987. Possible values are:
  13988. @table @var
  13989. @item none
  13990. Do not apply any tone map, only desaturate overbright pixels.
  13991. @item clip
  13992. Hard-clip any out-of-range values. Use it for perfect color accuracy for
  13993. in-range values, while distorting out-of-range values.
  13994. @item linear
  13995. Stretch the entire reference gamut to a linear multiple of the display.
  13996. @item gamma
  13997. Fit a logarithmic transfer between the tone curves.
  13998. @item reinhard
  13999. Preserve overall image brightness with a simple curve, using nonlinear
  14000. contrast, which results in flattening details and degrading color accuracy.
  14001. @item hable
  14002. Preserve both dark and bright details better than @var{reinhard}, at the cost
  14003. of slightly darkening everything. Use it when detail preservation is more
  14004. important than color and brightness accuracy.
  14005. @item mobius
  14006. Smoothly map out-of-range values, while retaining contrast and colors for
  14007. in-range material as much as possible. Use it when color accuracy is more
  14008. important than detail preservation.
  14009. @end table
  14010. Default is none.
  14011. @item param
  14012. Tune the tone mapping algorithm.
  14013. This affects the following algorithms:
  14014. @table @var
  14015. @item none
  14016. Ignored.
  14017. @item linear
  14018. Specifies the scale factor to use while stretching.
  14019. Default to 1.0.
  14020. @item gamma
  14021. Specifies the exponent of the function.
  14022. Default to 1.8.
  14023. @item clip
  14024. Specify an extra linear coefficient to multiply into the signal before clipping.
  14025. Default to 1.0.
  14026. @item reinhard
  14027. Specify the local contrast coefficient at the display peak.
  14028. Default to 0.5, which means that in-gamut values will be about half as bright
  14029. as when clipping.
  14030. @item hable
  14031. Ignored.
  14032. @item mobius
  14033. Specify the transition point from linear to mobius transform. Every value
  14034. below this point is guaranteed to be mapped 1:1. The higher the value, the
  14035. more accurate the result will be, at the cost of losing bright details.
  14036. Default to 0.3, which due to the steep initial slope still preserves in-range
  14037. colors fairly accurately.
  14038. @end table
  14039. @item desat
  14040. Apply desaturation for highlights that exceed this level of brightness. The
  14041. higher the parameter, the more color information will be preserved. This
  14042. setting helps prevent unnaturally blown-out colors for super-highlights, by
  14043. (smoothly) turning into white instead. This makes images feel more natural,
  14044. at the cost of reducing information about out-of-range colors.
  14045. The default of 2.0 is somewhat conservative and will mostly just apply to
  14046. skies or directly sunlit surfaces. A setting of 0.0 disables this option.
  14047. This option works only if the input frame has a supported color tag.
  14048. @item peak
  14049. Override signal/nominal/reference peak with this value. Useful when the
  14050. embedded peak information in display metadata is not reliable or when tone
  14051. mapping from a lower range to a higher range.
  14052. @end table
  14053. @section tpad
  14054. Temporarily pad video frames.
  14055. The filter accepts the following options:
  14056. @table @option
  14057. @item start
  14058. Specify number of delay frames before input video stream.
  14059. @item stop
  14060. Specify number of padding frames after input video stream.
  14061. Set to -1 to pad indefinitely.
  14062. @item start_mode
  14063. Set kind of frames added to beginning of stream.
  14064. Can be either @var{add} or @var{clone}.
  14065. With @var{add} frames of solid-color are added.
  14066. With @var{clone} frames are clones of first frame.
  14067. @item stop_mode
  14068. Set kind of frames added to end of stream.
  14069. Can be either @var{add} or @var{clone}.
  14070. With @var{add} frames of solid-color are added.
  14071. With @var{clone} frames are clones of last frame.
  14072. @item start_duration, stop_duration
  14073. Specify the duration of the start/stop delay. See
  14074. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  14075. for the accepted syntax.
  14076. These options override @var{start} and @var{stop}.
  14077. @item color
  14078. Specify the color of the padded area. For the syntax of this option,
  14079. check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils
  14080. manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  14081. The default value of @var{color} is "black".
  14082. @end table
  14083. @anchor{transpose}
  14084. @section transpose
  14085. Transpose rows with columns in the input video and optionally flip it.
  14086. It accepts the following parameters:
  14087. @table @option
  14088. @item dir
  14089. Specify the transposition direction.
  14090. Can assume the following values:
  14091. @table @samp
  14092. @item 0, 4, cclock_flip
  14093. Rotate by 90 degrees counterclockwise and vertically flip (default), that is:
  14094. @example
  14095. L.R L.l
  14096. . . -> . .
  14097. l.r R.r
  14098. @end example
  14099. @item 1, 5, clock
  14100. Rotate by 90 degrees clockwise, that is:
  14101. @example
  14102. L.R l.L
  14103. . . -> . .
  14104. l.r r.R
  14105. @end example
  14106. @item 2, 6, cclock
  14107. Rotate by 90 degrees counterclockwise, that is:
  14108. @example
  14109. L.R R.r
  14110. . . -> . .
  14111. l.r L.l
  14112. @end example
  14113. @item 3, 7, clock_flip
  14114. Rotate by 90 degrees clockwise and vertically flip, that is:
  14115. @example
  14116. L.R r.R
  14117. . . -> . .
  14118. l.r l.L
  14119. @end example
  14120. @end table
  14121. For values between 4-7, the transposition is only done if the input
  14122. video geometry is portrait and not landscape. These values are
  14123. deprecated, the @code{passthrough} option should be used instead.
  14124. Numerical values are deprecated, and should be dropped in favor of
  14125. symbolic constants.
  14126. @item passthrough
  14127. Do not apply the transposition if the input geometry matches the one
  14128. specified by the specified value. It accepts the following values:
  14129. @table @samp
  14130. @item none
  14131. Always apply transposition.
  14132. @item portrait
  14133. Preserve portrait geometry (when @var{height} >= @var{width}).
  14134. @item landscape
  14135. Preserve landscape geometry (when @var{width} >= @var{height}).
  14136. @end table
  14137. Default value is @code{none}.
  14138. @end table
  14139. For example to rotate by 90 degrees clockwise and preserve portrait
  14140. layout:
  14141. @example
  14142. transpose=dir=1:passthrough=portrait
  14143. @end example
  14144. The command above can also be specified as:
  14145. @example
  14146. transpose=1:portrait
  14147. @end example
  14148. @section transpose_npp
  14149. Transpose rows with columns in the input video and optionally flip it.
  14150. For more in depth examples see the @ref{transpose} video filter, which shares mostly the same options.
  14151. It accepts the following parameters:
  14152. @table @option
  14153. @item dir
  14154. Specify the transposition direction.
  14155. Can assume the following values:
  14156. @table @samp
  14157. @item cclock_flip
  14158. Rotate by 90 degrees counterclockwise and vertically flip. (default)
  14159. @item clock
  14160. Rotate by 90 degrees clockwise.
  14161. @item cclock
  14162. Rotate by 90 degrees counterclockwise.
  14163. @item clock_flip
  14164. Rotate by 90 degrees clockwise and vertically flip.
  14165. @end table
  14166. @item passthrough
  14167. Do not apply the transposition if the input geometry matches the one
  14168. specified by the specified value. It accepts the following values:
  14169. @table @samp
  14170. @item none
  14171. Always apply transposition. (default)
  14172. @item portrait
  14173. Preserve portrait geometry (when @var{height} >= @var{width}).
  14174. @item landscape
  14175. Preserve landscape geometry (when @var{width} >= @var{height}).
  14176. @end table
  14177. @end table
  14178. @section trim
  14179. Trim the input so that the output contains one continuous subpart of the input.
  14180. It accepts the following parameters:
  14181. @table @option
  14182. @item start
  14183. Specify the time of the start of the kept section, i.e. the frame with the
  14184. timestamp @var{start} will be the first frame in the output.
  14185. @item end
  14186. Specify the time of the first frame that will be dropped, i.e. the frame
  14187. immediately preceding the one with the timestamp @var{end} will be the last
  14188. frame in the output.
  14189. @item start_pts
  14190. This is the same as @var{start}, except this option sets the start timestamp
  14191. in timebase units instead of seconds.
  14192. @item end_pts
  14193. This is the same as @var{end}, except this option sets the end timestamp
  14194. in timebase units instead of seconds.
  14195. @item duration
  14196. The maximum duration of the output in seconds.
  14197. @item start_frame
  14198. The number of the first frame that should be passed to the output.
  14199. @item end_frame
  14200. The number of the first frame that should be dropped.
  14201. @end table
  14202. @option{start}, @option{end}, and @option{duration} are expressed as time
  14203. duration specifications; see
  14204. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  14205. for the accepted syntax.
  14206. Note that the first two sets of the start/end options and the @option{duration}
  14207. option look at the frame timestamp, while the _frame variants simply count the
  14208. frames that pass through the filter. Also note that this filter does not modify
  14209. the timestamps. If you wish for the output timestamps to start at zero, insert a
  14210. setpts filter after the trim filter.
  14211. If multiple start or end options are set, this filter tries to be greedy and
  14212. keep all the frames that match at least one of the specified constraints. To keep
  14213. only the part that matches all the constraints at once, chain multiple trim
  14214. filters.
  14215. The defaults are such that all the input is kept. So it is possible to set e.g.
  14216. just the end values to keep everything before the specified time.
  14217. Examples:
  14218. @itemize
  14219. @item
  14220. Drop everything except the second minute of input:
  14221. @example
  14222. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf trim=60:120
  14223. @end example
  14224. @item
  14225. Keep only the first second:
  14226. @example
  14227. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf trim=duration=1
  14228. @end example
  14229. @end itemize
  14230. @section unpremultiply
  14231. Apply alpha unpremultiply effect to input video stream using first plane
  14232. of second stream as alpha.
  14233. Both streams must have same dimensions and same pixel format.
  14234. The filter accepts the following option:
  14235. @table @option
  14236. @item planes
  14237. Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.
  14238. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  14239. If the format has 1 or 2 components, then luma is bit 0.
  14240. If the format has 3 or 4 components:
  14241. for RGB formats bit 0 is green, bit 1 is blue and bit 2 is red;
  14242. for YUV formats bit 0 is luma, bit 1 is chroma-U and bit 2 is chroma-V.
  14243. If present, the alpha channel is always the last bit.
  14244. @item inplace
  14245. Do not require 2nd input for processing, instead use alpha plane from input stream.
  14246. @end table
  14247. @anchor{unsharp}
  14248. @section unsharp
  14249. Sharpen or blur the input video.
  14250. It accepts the following parameters:
  14251. @table @option
  14252. @item luma_msize_x, lx
  14253. Set the luma matrix horizontal size. It must be an odd integer between
  14254. 3 and 23. The default value is 5.
  14255. @item luma_msize_y, ly
  14256. Set the luma matrix vertical size. It must be an odd integer between 3
  14257. and 23. The default value is 5.
  14258. @item luma_amount, la
  14259. Set the luma effect strength. It must be a floating point number, reasonable
  14260. values lay between -1.5 and 1.5.
  14261. Negative values will blur the input video, while positive values will
  14262. sharpen it, a value of zero will disable the effect.
  14263. Default value is 1.0.
  14264. @item chroma_msize_x, cx
  14265. Set the chroma matrix horizontal size. It must be an odd integer
  14266. between 3 and 23. The default value is 5.
  14267. @item chroma_msize_y, cy
  14268. Set the chroma matrix vertical size. It must be an odd integer
  14269. between 3 and 23. The default value is 5.
  14270. @item chroma_amount, ca
  14271. Set the chroma effect strength. It must be a floating point number, reasonable
  14272. values lay between -1.5 and 1.5.
  14273. Negative values will blur the input video, while positive values will
  14274. sharpen it, a value of zero will disable the effect.
  14275. Default value is 0.0.
  14276. @end table
  14277. All parameters are optional and default to the equivalent of the
  14278. string '5:5:1.0:5:5:0.0'.
  14279. @subsection Examples
  14280. @itemize
  14281. @item
  14282. Apply strong luma sharpen effect:
  14283. @example
  14284. unsharp=luma_msize_x=7:luma_msize_y=7:luma_amount=2.5
  14285. @end example
  14286. @item
  14287. Apply a strong blur of both luma and chroma parameters:
  14288. @example
  14289. unsharp=7:7:-2:7:7:-2
  14290. @end example
  14291. @end itemize
  14292. @section uspp
  14293. Apply ultra slow/simple postprocessing filter that compresses and decompresses
  14294. the image at several (or - in the case of @option{quality} level @code{8} - all)
  14295. shifts and average the results.
  14296. The way this differs from the behavior of spp is that uspp actually encodes &
  14297. decodes each case with libavcodec Snow, whereas spp uses a simplified intra only 8x8
  14298. DCT similar to MJPEG.
  14299. The filter accepts the following options:
  14300. @table @option
  14301. @item quality
  14302. Set quality. This option defines the number of levels for averaging. It accepts
  14303. an integer in the range 0-8. If set to @code{0}, the filter will have no
  14304. effect. A value of @code{8} means the higher quality. For each increment of
  14305. that value the speed drops by a factor of approximately 2. Default value is
  14306. @code{3}.
  14307. @item qp
  14308. Force a constant quantization parameter. If not set, the filter will use the QP
  14309. from the video stream (if available).
  14310. @end table
  14311. @section v360
  14312. Convert 360 videos between various formats.
  14313. The filter accepts the following options:
  14314. @table @option
  14315. @item input
  14316. @item output
  14317. Set format of the input/output video.
  14318. Available formats:
  14319. @table @samp
  14320. @item e
  14321. @item equirect
  14322. Equirectangular projection.
  14323. @item c3x2
  14324. @item c6x1
  14325. @item c1x6
  14326. Cubemap with 3x2/6x1/1x6 layout.
  14327. Format specific options:
  14328. @table @option
  14329. @item in_pad
  14330. @item out_pad
  14331. Set padding proportion for the input/output cubemap. Values in decimals.
  14332. Example values:
  14333. @table @samp
  14334. @item 0
  14335. No padding.
  14336. @item 0.01
  14337. 1% of face is padding. For example, with 1920x1280 resolution face size would be 640x640 and padding would be 3 pixels from each side. (640 * 0.01 = 6 pixels)
  14338. @end table
  14339. Default value is @b{@samp{0}}.
  14340. @item fin_pad
  14341. @item fout_pad
  14342. Set fixed padding for the input/output cubemap. Values in pixels.
  14343. Default value is @b{@samp{0}}. If greater than zero it overrides other padding options.
  14344. @item in_forder
  14345. @item out_forder
  14346. Set order of faces for the input/output cubemap. Choose one direction for each position.
  14347. Designation of directions:
  14348. @table @samp
  14349. @item r
  14350. right
  14351. @item l
  14352. left
  14353. @item u
  14354. up
  14355. @item d
  14356. down
  14357. @item f
  14358. forward
  14359. @item b
  14360. back
  14361. @end table
  14362. Default value is @b{@samp{rludfb}}.
  14363. @item in_frot
  14364. @item out_frot
  14365. Set rotation of faces for the input/output cubemap. Choose one angle for each position.
  14366. Designation of angles:
  14367. @table @samp
  14368. @item 0
  14369. 0 degrees clockwise
  14370. @item 1
  14371. 90 degrees clockwise
  14372. @item 2
  14373. 180 degrees clockwise
  14374. @item 3
  14375. 270 degrees clockwise
  14376. @end table
  14377. Default value is @b{@samp{000000}}.
  14378. @end table
  14379. @item eac
  14380. Equi-Angular Cubemap.
  14381. @item flat
  14382. @item gnomonic
  14383. @item rectilinear
  14384. Regular video. @i{(output only)}
  14385. Format specific options:
  14386. @table @option
  14387. @item h_fov
  14388. @item v_fov
  14389. @item d_fov
  14390. Set horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  14391. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  14392. @end table
  14393. @item dfisheye
  14394. Dual fisheye.
  14395. Format specific options:
  14396. @table @option
  14397. @item in_pad
  14398. @item out_pad
  14399. Set padding proportion. Values in decimals.
  14400. Example values:
  14401. @table @samp
  14402. @item 0
  14403. No padding.
  14404. @item 0.01
  14405. 1% padding.
  14406. @end table
  14407. Default value is @b{@samp{0}}.
  14408. @end table
  14409. @item barrel
  14410. @item fb
  14411. Facebook's 360 format.
  14412. @item sg
  14413. Stereographic format.
  14414. Format specific options:
  14415. @table @option
  14416. @item h_fov
  14417. @item v_fov
  14418. @item d_fov
  14419. Set horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  14420. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  14421. @end table
  14422. @item mercator
  14423. Mercator format.
  14424. @item ball
  14425. Ball format, gives significant distortion toward the back.
  14426. @item hammer
  14427. Hammer-Aitoff map projection format.
  14428. @item sinusoidal
  14429. Sinusoidal map projection format.
  14430. @end table
  14431. @item interp
  14432. Set interpolation method.@*
  14433. @i{Note: more complex interpolation methods require much more memory to run.}
  14434. Available methods:
  14435. @table @samp
  14436. @item near
  14437. @item nearest
  14438. Nearest neighbour.
  14439. @item line
  14440. @item linear
  14441. Bilinear interpolation.
  14442. @item cube
  14443. @item cubic
  14444. Bicubic interpolation.
  14445. @item lanc
  14446. @item lanczos
  14447. Lanczos interpolation.
  14448. @end table
  14449. Default value is @b{@samp{line}}.
  14450. @item w
  14451. @item h
  14452. Set the output video resolution.
  14453. Default resolution depends on formats.
  14454. @item in_stereo
  14455. @item out_stereo
  14456. Set the input/output stereo format.
  14457. @table @samp
  14458. @item 2d
  14459. 2D mono
  14460. @item sbs
  14461. Side by side
  14462. @item tb
  14463. Top bottom
  14464. @end table
  14465. Default value is @b{@samp{2d}} for input and output format.
  14466. @item yaw
  14467. @item pitch
  14468. @item roll
  14469. Set rotation for the output video. Values in degrees.
  14470. @item rorder
  14471. Set rotation order for the output video. Choose one item for each position.
  14472. @table @samp
  14473. @item y, Y
  14474. yaw
  14475. @item p, P
  14476. pitch
  14477. @item r, R
  14478. roll
  14479. @end table
  14480. Default value is @b{@samp{ypr}}.
  14481. @item h_flip
  14482. @item v_flip
  14483. @item d_flip
  14484. Flip the output video horizontally(swaps left-right)/vertically(swaps up-down)/in-depth(swaps back-forward). Boolean values.
  14485. @item ih_flip
  14486. @item iv_flip
  14487. Set if input video is flipped horizontally/vertically. Boolean values.
  14488. @item in_trans
  14489. Set if input video is transposed. Boolean value, by default disabled.
  14490. @item out_trans
  14491. Set if output video needs to be transposed. Boolean value, by default disabled.
  14492. @end table
  14493. @subsection Examples
  14494. @itemize
  14495. @item
  14496. Convert equirectangular video to cubemap with 3x2 layout and 1% padding using bicubic interpolation:
  14497. @example
  14498. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -vf v360=e:c3x2:cubic:out_pad=0.01 output.mkv
  14499. @end example
  14500. @item
  14501. Extract back view of Equi-Angular Cubemap:
  14502. @example
  14503. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -vf v360=eac:flat:yaw=180 output.mkv
  14504. @end example
  14505. @item
  14506. Convert transposed and horizontally flipped Equi-Angular Cubemap in side-by-side stereo format to equirectangular top-bottom stereo format:
  14507. @example
  14508. v360=eac:equirect:in_stereo=sbs:in_trans=1:ih_flip=1:out_stereo=tb
  14509. @end example
  14510. @end itemize
  14511. @section vaguedenoiser
  14512. Apply a wavelet based denoiser.
  14513. It transforms each frame from the video input into the wavelet domain,
  14514. using Cohen-Daubechies-Feauveau 9/7. Then it applies some filtering to
  14515. the obtained coefficients. It does an inverse wavelet transform after.
  14516. Due to wavelet properties, it should give a nice smoothed result, and
  14517. reduced noise, without blurring picture features.
  14518. This filter accepts the following options:
  14519. @table @option
  14520. @item threshold
  14521. The filtering strength. The higher, the more filtered the video will be.
  14522. Hard thresholding can use a higher threshold than soft thresholding
  14523. before the video looks overfiltered. Default value is 2.
  14524. @item method
  14525. The filtering method the filter will use.
  14526. It accepts the following values:
  14527. @table @samp
  14528. @item hard
  14529. All values under the threshold will be zeroed.
  14530. @item soft
  14531. All values under the threshold will be zeroed. All values above will be
  14532. reduced by the threshold.
  14533. @item garrote
  14534. Scales or nullifies coefficients - intermediary between (more) soft and
  14535. (less) hard thresholding.
  14536. @end table
  14537. Default is garrote.
  14538. @item nsteps
  14539. Number of times, the wavelet will decompose the picture. Picture can't
  14540. be decomposed beyond a particular point (typically, 8 for a 640x480
  14541. frame - as 2^9 = 512 > 480). Valid values are integers between 1 and 32. Default value is 6.
  14542. @item percent
  14543. Partial of full denoising (limited coefficients shrinking), from 0 to 100. Default value is 85.
  14544. @item planes
  14545. A list of the planes to process. By default all planes are processed.
  14546. @end table
  14547. @section vectorscope
  14548. Display 2 color component values in the two dimensional graph (which is called
  14549. a vectorscope).
  14550. This filter accepts the following options:
  14551. @table @option
  14552. @item mode, m
  14553. Set vectorscope mode.
  14554. It accepts the following values:
  14555. @table @samp
  14556. @item gray
  14557. @item tint
  14558. Gray values are displayed on graph, higher brightness means more pixels have
  14559. same component color value on location in graph. This is the default mode.
  14560. @item color
  14561. Gray values are displayed on graph. Surrounding pixels values which are not
  14562. present in video frame are drawn in gradient of 2 color components which are
  14563. set by option @code{x} and @code{y}. The 3rd color component is static.
  14564. @item color2
  14565. Actual color components values present in video frame are displayed on graph.
  14566. @item color3
  14567. Similar as color2 but higher frequency of same values @code{x} and @code{y}
  14568. on graph increases value of another color component, which is luminance by
  14569. default values of @code{x} and @code{y}.
  14570. @item color4
  14571. Actual colors present in video frame are displayed on graph. If two different
  14572. colors map to same position on graph then color with higher value of component
  14573. not present in graph is picked.
  14574. @item color5
  14575. Gray values are displayed on graph. Similar to @code{color} but with 3rd color
  14576. component picked from radial gradient.
  14577. @end table
  14578. @item x
  14579. Set which color component will be represented on X-axis. Default is @code{1}.
  14580. @item y
  14581. Set which color component will be represented on Y-axis. Default is @code{2}.
  14582. @item intensity, i
  14583. Set intensity, used by modes: gray, color, color3 and color5 for increasing brightness
  14584. of color component which represents frequency of (X, Y) location in graph.
  14585. @item envelope, e
  14586. @table @samp
  14587. @item none
  14588. No envelope, this is default.
  14589. @item instant
  14590. Instant envelope, even darkest single pixel will be clearly highlighted.
  14591. @item peak
  14592. Hold maximum and minimum values presented in graph over time. This way you
  14593. can still spot out of range values without constantly looking at vectorscope.
  14594. @item peak+instant
  14595. Peak and instant envelope combined together.
  14596. @end table
  14597. @item graticule, g
  14598. Set what kind of graticule to draw.
  14599. @table @samp
  14600. @item none
  14601. @item green
  14602. @item color
  14603. @item invert
  14604. @end table
  14605. @item opacity, o
  14606. Set graticule opacity.
  14607. @item flags, f
  14608. Set graticule flags.
  14609. @table @samp
  14610. @item white
  14611. Draw graticule for white point.
  14612. @item black
  14613. Draw graticule for black point.
  14614. @item name
  14615. Draw color points short names.
  14616. @end table
  14617. @item bgopacity, b
  14618. Set background opacity.
  14619. @item lthreshold, l
  14620. Set low threshold for color component not represented on X or Y axis.
  14621. Values lower than this value will be ignored. Default is 0.
  14622. Note this value is multiplied with actual max possible value one pixel component
  14623. can have. So for 8-bit input and low threshold value of 0.1 actual threshold
  14624. is 0.1 * 255 = 25.
  14625. @item hthreshold, h
  14626. Set high threshold for color component not represented on X or Y axis.
  14627. Values higher than this value will be ignored. Default is 1.
  14628. Note this value is multiplied with actual max possible value one pixel component
  14629. can have. So for 8-bit input and high threshold value of 0.9 actual threshold
  14630. is 0.9 * 255 = 230.
  14631. @item colorspace, c
  14632. Set what kind of colorspace to use when drawing graticule.
  14633. @table @samp
  14634. @item auto
  14635. @item 601
  14636. @item 709
  14637. @end table
  14638. Default is auto.
  14639. @item tint0, t0
  14640. @item tint1, t1
  14641. Set color tint for gray/tint vectorscope mode. By default both options are zero.
  14642. This means no tint, and output will remain gray.
  14643. @end table
  14644. @anchor{vidstabdetect}
  14645. @section vidstabdetect
  14646. Analyze video stabilization/deshaking. Perform pass 1 of 2, see
  14647. @ref{vidstabtransform} for pass 2.
  14648. This filter generates a file with relative translation and rotation
  14649. transform information about subsequent frames, which is then used by
  14650. the @ref{vidstabtransform} filter.
  14651. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  14652. @code{--enable-libvidstab}.
  14653. This filter accepts the following options:
  14654. @table @option
  14655. @item result
  14656. Set the path to the file used to write the transforms information.
  14657. Default value is @file{transforms.trf}.
  14658. @item shakiness
  14659. Set how shaky the video is and how quick the camera is. It accepts an
  14660. integer in the range 1-10, a value of 1 means little shakiness, a
  14661. value of 10 means strong shakiness. Default value is 5.
  14662. @item accuracy
  14663. Set the accuracy of the detection process. It must be a value in the
  14664. range 1-15. A value of 1 means low accuracy, a value of 15 means high
  14665. accuracy. Default value is 15.
  14666. @item stepsize
  14667. Set stepsize of the search process. The region around minimum is
  14668. scanned with 1 pixel resolution. Default value is 6.
  14669. @item mincontrast
  14670. Set minimum contrast. Below this value a local measurement field is
  14671. discarded. Must be a floating point value in the range 0-1. Default
  14672. value is 0.3.
  14673. @item tripod
  14674. Set reference frame number for tripod mode.
  14675. If enabled, the motion of the frames is compared to a reference frame
  14676. in the filtered stream, identified by the specified number. The idea
  14677. is to compensate all movements in a more-or-less static scene and keep
  14678. the camera view absolutely still.
  14679. If set to 0, it is disabled. The frames are counted starting from 1.
  14680. @item show
  14681. Show fields and transforms in the resulting frames. It accepts an
  14682. integer in the range 0-2. Default value is 0, which disables any
  14683. visualization.
  14684. @end table
  14685. @subsection Examples
  14686. @itemize
  14687. @item
  14688. Use default values:
  14689. @example
  14690. vidstabdetect
  14691. @end example
  14692. @item
  14693. Analyze strongly shaky movie and put the results in file
  14694. @file{mytransforms.trf}:
  14695. @example
  14696. vidstabdetect=shakiness=10:accuracy=15:result="mytransforms.trf"
  14697. @end example
  14698. @item
  14699. Visualize the result of internal transformations in the resulting
  14700. video:
  14701. @example
  14702. vidstabdetect=show=1
  14703. @end example
  14704. @item
  14705. Analyze a video with medium shakiness using @command{ffmpeg}:
  14706. @example
  14707. ffmpeg -i input -vf vidstabdetect=shakiness=5:show=1 dummy.avi
  14708. @end example
  14709. @end itemize
  14710. @anchor{vidstabtransform}
  14711. @section vidstabtransform
  14712. Video stabilization/deshaking: pass 2 of 2,
  14713. see @ref{vidstabdetect} for pass 1.
  14714. Read a file with transform information for each frame and
  14715. apply/compensate them. Together with the @ref{vidstabdetect}
  14716. filter this can be used to deshake videos. See also
  14717. @url{http://public.hronopik.de/vid.stab}. It is important to also use
  14718. the @ref{unsharp} filter, see below.
  14719. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  14720. @code{--enable-libvidstab}.
  14721. @subsection Options
  14722. @table @option
  14723. @item input
  14724. Set path to the file used to read the transforms. Default value is
  14725. @file{transforms.trf}.
  14726. @item smoothing
  14727. Set the number of frames (value*2 + 1) used for lowpass filtering the
  14728. camera movements. Default value is 10.
  14729. For example a number of 10 means that 21 frames are used (10 in the
  14730. past and 10 in the future) to smoothen the motion in the video. A
  14731. larger value leads to a smoother video, but limits the acceleration of
  14732. the camera (pan/tilt movements). 0 is a special case where a static
  14733. camera is simulated.
  14734. @item optalgo
  14735. Set the camera path optimization algorithm.
  14736. Accepted values are:
  14737. @table @samp
  14738. @item gauss
  14739. gaussian kernel low-pass filter on camera motion (default)
  14740. @item avg
  14741. averaging on transformations
  14742. @end table
  14743. @item maxshift
  14744. Set maximal number of pixels to translate frames. Default value is -1,
  14745. meaning no limit.
  14746. @item maxangle
  14747. Set maximal angle in radians (degree*PI/180) to rotate frames. Default
  14748. value is -1, meaning no limit.
  14749. @item crop
  14750. Specify how to deal with borders that may be visible due to movement
  14751. compensation.
  14752. Available values are:
  14753. @table @samp
  14754. @item keep
  14755. keep image information from previous frame (default)
  14756. @item black
  14757. fill the border black
  14758. @end table
  14759. @item invert
  14760. Invert transforms if set to 1. Default value is 0.
  14761. @item relative
  14762. Consider transforms as relative to previous frame if set to 1,
  14763. absolute if set to 0. Default value is 0.
  14764. @item zoom
  14765. Set percentage to zoom. A positive value will result in a zoom-in
  14766. effect, a negative value in a zoom-out effect. Default value is 0 (no
  14767. zoom).
  14768. @item optzoom
  14769. Set optimal zooming to avoid borders.
  14770. Accepted values are:
  14771. @table @samp
  14772. @item 0
  14773. disabled
  14774. @item 1
  14775. optimal static zoom value is determined (only very strong movements
  14776. will lead to visible borders) (default)
  14777. @item 2
  14778. optimal adaptive zoom value is determined (no borders will be
  14779. visible), see @option{zoomspeed}
  14780. @end table
  14781. Note that the value given at zoom is added to the one calculated here.
  14782. @item zoomspeed
  14783. Set percent to zoom maximally each frame (enabled when
  14784. @option{optzoom} is set to 2). Range is from 0 to 5, default value is
  14785. 0.25.
  14786. @item interpol
  14787. Specify type of interpolation.
  14788. Available values are:
  14789. @table @samp
  14790. @item no
  14791. no interpolation
  14792. @item linear
  14793. linear only horizontal
  14794. @item bilinear
  14795. linear in both directions (default)
  14796. @item bicubic
  14797. cubic in both directions (slow)
  14798. @end table
  14799. @item tripod
  14800. Enable virtual tripod mode if set to 1, which is equivalent to
  14801. @code{relative=0:smoothing=0}. Default value is 0.
  14802. Use also @code{tripod} option of @ref{vidstabdetect}.
  14803. @item debug
  14804. Increase log verbosity if set to 1. Also the detected global motions
  14805. are written to the temporary file @file{global_motions.trf}. Default
  14806. value is 0.
  14807. @end table
  14808. @subsection Examples
  14809. @itemize
  14810. @item
  14811. Use @command{ffmpeg} for a typical stabilization with default values:
  14812. @example
  14813. ffmpeg -i inp.mpeg -vf vidstabtransform,unsharp=5:5:0.8:3:3:0.4 inp_stabilized.mpeg
  14814. @end example
  14815. Note the use of the @ref{unsharp} filter which is always recommended.
  14816. @item
  14817. Zoom in a bit more and load transform data from a given file:
  14818. @example
  14819. vidstabtransform=zoom=5:input="mytransforms.trf"
  14820. @end example
  14821. @item
  14822. Smoothen the video even more:
  14823. @example
  14824. vidstabtransform=smoothing=30
  14825. @end example
  14826. @end itemize
  14827. @section vflip
  14828. Flip the input video vertically.
  14829. For example, to vertically flip a video with @command{ffmpeg}:
  14830. @example
  14831. ffmpeg -i in.avi -vf "vflip" out.avi
  14832. @end example
  14833. @section vfrdet
  14834. Detect variable frame rate video.
  14835. This filter tries to detect if the input is variable or constant frame rate.
  14836. At end it will output number of frames detected as having variable delta pts,
  14837. and ones with constant delta pts.
  14838. If there was frames with variable delta, than it will also show min, max and
  14839. average delta encountered.
  14840. @section vibrance
  14841. Boost or alter saturation.
  14842. The filter accepts the following options:
  14843. @table @option
  14844. @item intensity
  14845. Set strength of boost if positive value or strength of alter if negative value.
  14846. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -2 to 2.
  14847. @item rbal
  14848. Set the red balance. Default is 1. Allowed range is from -10 to 10.
  14849. @item gbal
  14850. Set the green balance. Default is 1. Allowed range is from -10 to 10.
  14851. @item bbal
  14852. Set the blue balance. Default is 1. Allowed range is from -10 to 10.
  14853. @item rlum
  14854. Set the red luma coefficient.
  14855. @item glum
  14856. Set the green luma coefficient.
  14857. @item blum
  14858. Set the blue luma coefficient.
  14859. @item alternate
  14860. If @code{intensity} is negative and this is set to 1, colors will change,
  14861. otherwise colors will be less saturated, more towards gray.
  14862. @end table
  14863. @subsection Commands
  14864. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  14865. @anchor{vignette}
  14866. @section vignette
  14867. Make or reverse a natural vignetting effect.
  14868. The filter accepts the following options:
  14869. @table @option
  14870. @item angle, a
  14871. Set lens angle expression as a number of radians.
  14872. The value is clipped in the @code{[0,PI/2]} range.
  14873. Default value: @code{"PI/5"}
  14874. @item x0
  14875. @item y0
  14876. Set center coordinates expressions. Respectively @code{"w/2"} and @code{"h/2"}
  14877. by default.
  14878. @item mode
  14879. Set forward/backward mode.
  14880. Available modes are:
  14881. @table @samp
  14882. @item forward
  14883. The larger the distance from the central point, the darker the image becomes.
  14884. @item backward
  14885. The larger the distance from the central point, the brighter the image becomes.
  14886. This can be used to reverse a vignette effect, though there is no automatic
  14887. detection to extract the lens @option{angle} and other settings (yet). It can
  14888. also be used to create a burning effect.
  14889. @end table
  14890. Default value is @samp{forward}.
  14891. @item eval
  14892. Set evaluation mode for the expressions (@option{angle}, @option{x0}, @option{y0}).
  14893. It accepts the following values:
  14894. @table @samp
  14895. @item init
  14896. Evaluate expressions only once during the filter initialization.
  14897. @item frame
  14898. Evaluate expressions for each incoming frame. This is way slower than the
  14899. @samp{init} mode since it requires all the scalers to be re-computed, but it
  14900. allows advanced dynamic expressions.
  14901. @end table
  14902. Default value is @samp{init}.
  14903. @item dither
  14904. Set dithering to reduce the circular banding effects. Default is @code{1}
  14905. (enabled).
  14906. @item aspect
  14907. Set vignette aspect. This setting allows one to adjust the shape of the vignette.
  14908. Setting this value to the SAR of the input will make a rectangular vignetting
  14909. following the dimensions of the video.
  14910. Default is @code{1/1}.
  14911. @end table
  14912. @subsection Expressions
  14913. The @option{alpha}, @option{x0} and @option{y0} expressions can contain the
  14914. following parameters.
  14915. @table @option
  14916. @item w
  14917. @item h
  14918. input width and height
  14919. @item n
  14920. the number of input frame, starting from 0
  14921. @item pts
  14922. the PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) time of the filtered video frame, expressed in
  14923. @var{TB} units, NAN if undefined
  14924. @item r
  14925. frame rate of the input video, NAN if the input frame rate is unknown
  14926. @item t
  14927. the PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) of the filtered video frame,
  14928. expressed in seconds, NAN if undefined
  14929. @item tb
  14930. time base of the input video
  14931. @end table
  14932. @subsection Examples
  14933. @itemize
  14934. @item
  14935. Apply simple strong vignetting effect:
  14936. @example
  14937. vignette=PI/4
  14938. @end example
  14939. @item
  14940. Make a flickering vignetting:
  14941. @example
  14942. vignette='PI/4+random(1)*PI/50':eval=frame
  14943. @end example
  14944. @end itemize
  14945. @section vmafmotion
  14946. Obtain the average VMAF motion score of a video.
  14947. It is one of the component metrics of VMAF.
  14948. The obtained average motion score is printed through the logging system.
  14949. The filter accepts the following options:
  14950. @table @option
  14951. @item stats_file
  14952. If specified, the filter will use the named file to save the motion score of
  14953. each frame with respect to the previous frame.
  14954. When filename equals "-" the data is sent to standard output.
  14955. @end table
  14956. Example:
  14957. @example
  14958. ffmpeg -i ref.mpg -vf vmafmotion -f null -
  14959. @end example
  14960. @section vstack
  14961. Stack input videos vertically.
  14962. All streams must be of same pixel format and of same width.
  14963. Note that this filter is faster than using @ref{overlay} and @ref{pad} filter
  14964. to create same output.
  14965. The filter accepts the following options:
  14966. @table @option
  14967. @item inputs
  14968. Set number of input streams. Default is 2.
  14969. @item shortest
  14970. If set to 1, force the output to terminate when the shortest input
  14971. terminates. Default value is 0.
  14972. @end table
  14973. @section w3fdif
  14974. Deinterlace the input video ("w3fdif" stands for "Weston 3 Field
  14975. Deinterlacing Filter").
  14976. Based on the process described by Martin Weston for BBC R&D, and
  14977. implemented based on the de-interlace algorithm written by Jim
  14978. Easterbrook for BBC R&D, the Weston 3 field deinterlacing filter
  14979. uses filter coefficients calculated by BBC R&D.
  14980. This filter uses field-dominance information in frame to decide which
  14981. of each pair of fields to place first in the output.
  14982. If it gets it wrong use @ref{setfield} filter before @code{w3fdif} filter.
  14983. There are two sets of filter coefficients, so called "simple"
  14984. and "complex". Which set of filter coefficients is used can
  14985. be set by passing an optional parameter:
  14986. @table @option
  14987. @item filter
  14988. Set the interlacing filter coefficients. Accepts one of the following values:
  14989. @table @samp
  14990. @item simple
  14991. Simple filter coefficient set.
  14992. @item complex
  14993. More-complex filter coefficient set.
  14994. @end table
  14995. Default value is @samp{complex}.
  14996. @item deint
  14997. Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accepts one of the following values:
  14998. @table @samp
  14999. @item all
  15000. Deinterlace all frames,
  15001. @item interlaced
  15002. Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.
  15003. @end table
  15004. Default value is @samp{all}.
  15005. @end table
  15006. @section waveform
  15007. Video waveform monitor.
  15008. The waveform monitor plots color component intensity. By default luminance
  15009. only. Each column of the waveform corresponds to a column of pixels in the
  15010. source video.
  15011. It accepts the following options:
  15012. @table @option
  15013. @item mode, m
  15014. Can be either @code{row}, or @code{column}. Default is @code{column}.
  15015. In row mode, the graph on the left side represents color component value 0 and
  15016. the right side represents value = 255. In column mode, the top side represents
  15017. color component value = 0 and bottom side represents value = 255.
  15018. @item intensity, i
  15019. Set intensity. Smaller values are useful to find out how many values of the same
  15020. luminance are distributed across input rows/columns.
  15021. Default value is @code{0.04}. Allowed range is [0, 1].
  15022. @item mirror, r
  15023. Set mirroring mode. @code{0} means unmirrored, @code{1} means mirrored.
  15024. In mirrored mode, higher values will be represented on the left
  15025. side for @code{row} mode and at the top for @code{column} mode. Default is
  15026. @code{1} (mirrored).
  15027. @item display, d
  15028. Set display mode.
  15029. It accepts the following values:
  15030. @table @samp
  15031. @item overlay
  15032. Presents information identical to that in the @code{parade}, except
  15033. that the graphs representing color components are superimposed directly
  15034. over one another.
  15035. This display mode makes it easier to spot relative differences or similarities
  15036. in overlapping areas of the color components that are supposed to be identical,
  15037. such as neutral whites, grays, or blacks.
  15038. @item stack
  15039. Display separate graph for the color components side by side in
  15040. @code{row} mode or one below the other in @code{column} mode.
  15041. @item parade
  15042. Display separate graph for the color components side by side in
  15043. @code{column} mode or one below the other in @code{row} mode.
  15044. Using this display mode makes it easy to spot color casts in the highlights
  15045. and shadows of an image, by comparing the contours of the top and the bottom
  15046. graphs of each waveform. Since whites, grays, and blacks are characterized
  15047. by exactly equal amounts of red, green, and blue, neutral areas of the picture
  15048. should display three waveforms of roughly equal width/height. If not, the
  15049. correction is easy to perform by making level adjustments the three waveforms.
  15050. @end table
  15051. Default is @code{stack}.
  15052. @item components, c
  15053. Set which color components to display. Default is 1, which means only luminance
  15054. or red color component if input is in RGB colorspace. If is set for example to
  15055. 7 it will display all 3 (if) available color components.
  15056. @item envelope, e
  15057. @table @samp
  15058. @item none
  15059. No envelope, this is default.
  15060. @item instant
  15061. Instant envelope, minimum and maximum values presented in graph will be easily
  15062. visible even with small @code{step} value.
  15063. @item peak
  15064. Hold minimum and maximum values presented in graph across time. This way you
  15065. can still spot out of range values without constantly looking at waveforms.
  15066. @item peak+instant
  15067. Peak and instant envelope combined together.
  15068. @end table
  15069. @item filter, f
  15070. @table @samp
  15071. @item lowpass
  15072. No filtering, this is default.
  15073. @item flat
  15074. Luma and chroma combined together.
  15075. @item aflat
  15076. Similar as above, but shows difference between blue and red chroma.
  15077. @item xflat
  15078. Similar as above, but use different colors.
  15079. @item yflat
  15080. Similar as above, but again with different colors.
  15081. @item chroma
  15082. Displays only chroma.
  15083. @item color
  15084. Displays actual color value on waveform.
  15085. @item acolor
  15086. Similar as above, but with luma showing frequency of chroma values.
  15087. @end table
  15088. @item graticule, g
  15089. Set which graticule to display.
  15090. @table @samp
  15091. @item none
  15092. Do not display graticule.
  15093. @item green
  15094. Display green graticule showing legal broadcast ranges.
  15095. @item orange
  15096. Display orange graticule showing legal broadcast ranges.
  15097. @item invert
  15098. Display invert graticule showing legal broadcast ranges.
  15099. @end table
  15100. @item opacity, o
  15101. Set graticule opacity.
  15102. @item flags, fl
  15103. Set graticule flags.
  15104. @table @samp
  15105. @item numbers
  15106. Draw numbers above lines. By default enabled.
  15107. @item dots
  15108. Draw dots instead of lines.
  15109. @end table
  15110. @item scale, s
  15111. Set scale used for displaying graticule.
  15112. @table @samp
  15113. @item digital
  15114. @item millivolts
  15115. @item ire
  15116. @end table
  15117. Default is digital.
  15118. @item bgopacity, b
  15119. Set background opacity.
  15120. @item tint0, t0
  15121. @item tint1, t1
  15122. Set tint for output.
  15123. Only used with lowpass filter and when display is not overlay and input
  15124. pixel formats are not RGB.
  15125. @end table
  15126. @section weave, doubleweave
  15127. The @code{weave} takes a field-based video input and join
  15128. each two sequential fields into single frame, producing a new double
  15129. height clip with half the frame rate and half the frame count.
  15130. The @code{doubleweave} works same as @code{weave} but without
  15131. halving frame rate and frame count.
  15132. It accepts the following option:
  15133. @table @option
  15134. @item first_field
  15135. Set first field. Available values are:
  15136. @table @samp
  15137. @item top, t
  15138. Set the frame as top-field-first.
  15139. @item bottom, b
  15140. Set the frame as bottom-field-first.
  15141. @end table
  15142. @end table
  15143. @subsection Examples
  15144. @itemize
  15145. @item
  15146. Interlace video using @ref{select} and @ref{separatefields} filter:
  15147. @example
  15148. separatefields,select=eq(mod(n,4),0)+eq(mod(n,4),3),weave
  15149. @end example
  15150. @end itemize
  15151. @section xbr
  15152. Apply the xBR high-quality magnification filter which is designed for pixel
  15153. art. It follows a set of edge-detection rules, see
  15154. @url{https://forums.libretro.com/t/xbr-algorithm-tutorial/123}.
  15155. It accepts the following option:
  15156. @table @option
  15157. @item n
  15158. Set the scaling dimension: @code{2} for @code{2xBR}, @code{3} for
  15159. @code{3xBR} and @code{4} for @code{4xBR}.
  15160. Default is @code{3}.
  15161. @end table
  15162. @section xmedian
  15163. Pick median pixels from several input videos.
  15164. The filter accepts the following options:
  15165. @table @option
  15166. @item inputs
  15167. Set number of inputs.
  15168. Default is 3. Allowed range is from 3 to 255.
  15169. If number of inputs is even number, than result will be mean value between two median values.
  15170. @item planes
  15171. Set which planes to filter. Default value is @code{15}, by which all planes are processed.
  15172. @end table
  15173. @section xstack
  15174. Stack video inputs into custom layout.
  15175. All streams must be of same pixel format.
  15176. The filter accepts the following options:
  15177. @table @option
  15178. @item inputs
  15179. Set number of input streams. Default is 2.
  15180. @item layout
  15181. Specify layout of inputs.
  15182. This option requires the desired layout configuration to be explicitly set by the user.
  15183. This sets position of each video input in output. Each input
  15184. is separated by '|'.
  15185. The first number represents the column, and the second number represents the row.
  15186. Numbers start at 0 and are separated by '_'. Optionally one can use wX and hX,
  15187. where X is video input from which to take width or height.
  15188. Multiple values can be used when separated by '+'. In such
  15189. case values are summed together.
  15190. Note that if inputs are of different sizes gaps may appear, as not all of
  15191. the output video frame will be filled. Similarly, videos can overlap each
  15192. other if their position doesn't leave enough space for the full frame of
  15193. adjoining videos.
  15194. For 2 inputs, a default layout of @code{0_0|w0_0} is set. In all other cases,
  15195. a layout must be set by the user.
  15196. @item shortest
  15197. If set to 1, force the output to terminate when the shortest input
  15198. terminates. Default value is 0.
  15199. @end table
  15200. @subsection Examples
  15201. @itemize
  15202. @item
  15203. Display 4 inputs into 2x2 grid.
  15204. Layout:
  15205. @example
  15206. input1(0, 0) | input3(w0, 0)
  15207. input2(0, h0) | input4(w0, h0)
  15208. @end example
  15209. @example
  15210. xstack=inputs=4:layout=0_0|0_h0|w0_0|w0_h0
  15211. @end example
  15212. Note that if inputs are of different sizes, gaps or overlaps may occur.
  15213. @item
  15214. Display 4 inputs into 1x4 grid.
  15215. Layout:
  15216. @example
  15217. input1(0, 0)
  15218. input2(0, h0)
  15219. input3(0, h0+h1)
  15220. input4(0, h0+h1+h2)
  15221. @end example
  15222. @example
  15223. xstack=inputs=4:layout=0_0|0_h0|0_h0+h1|0_h0+h1+h2
  15224. @end example
  15225. Note that if inputs are of different widths, unused space will appear.
  15226. @item
  15227. Display 9 inputs into 3x3 grid.
  15228. Layout:
  15229. @example
  15230. input1(0, 0) | input4(w0, 0) | input7(w0+w3, 0)
  15231. input2(0, h0) | input5(w0, h0) | input8(w0+w3, h0)
  15232. input3(0, h0+h1) | input6(w0, h0+h1) | input9(w0+w3, h0+h1)
  15233. @end example
  15234. @example
  15235. xstack=inputs=9:layout=0_0|0_h0|0_h0+h1|w0_0|w0_h0|w0_h0+h1|w0+w3_0|w0+w3_h0|w0+w3_h0+h1
  15236. @end example
  15237. Note that if inputs are of different sizes, gaps or overlaps may occur.
  15238. @item
  15239. Display 16 inputs into 4x4 grid.
  15240. Layout:
  15241. @example
  15242. input1(0, 0) | input5(w0, 0) | input9 (w0+w4, 0) | input13(w0+w4+w8, 0)
  15243. input2(0, h0) | input6(w0, h0) | input10(w0+w4, h0) | input14(w0+w4+w8, h0)
  15244. input3(0, h0+h1) | input7(w0, h0+h1) | input11(w0+w4, h0+h1) | input15(w0+w4+w8, h0+h1)
  15245. input4(0, h0+h1+h2)| input8(w0, h0+h1+h2)| input12(w0+w4, h0+h1+h2)| input16(w0+w4+w8, h0+h1+h2)
  15246. @end example
  15247. @example
  15248. xstack=inputs=16:layout=0_0|0_h0|0_h0+h1|0_h0+h1+h2|w0_0|w0_h0|w0_h0+h1|w0_h0+h1+h2|w0+w4_0|
  15249. w0+w4_h0|w0+w4_h0+h1|w0+w4_h0+h1+h2|w0+w4+w8_0|w0+w4+w8_h0|w0+w4+w8_h0+h1|w0+w4+w8_h0+h1+h2
  15250. @end example
  15251. Note that if inputs are of different sizes, gaps or overlaps may occur.
  15252. @end itemize
  15253. @anchor{yadif}
  15254. @section yadif
  15255. Deinterlace the input video ("yadif" means "yet another deinterlacing
  15256. filter").
  15257. It accepts the following parameters:
  15258. @table @option
  15259. @item mode
  15260. The interlacing mode to adopt. It accepts one of the following values:
  15261. @table @option
  15262. @item 0, send_frame
  15263. Output one frame for each frame.
  15264. @item 1, send_field
  15265. Output one frame for each field.
  15266. @item 2, send_frame_nospatial
  15267. Like @code{send_frame}, but it skips the spatial interlacing check.
  15268. @item 3, send_field_nospatial
  15269. Like @code{send_field}, but it skips the spatial interlacing check.
  15270. @end table
  15271. The default value is @code{send_frame}.
  15272. @item parity
  15273. The picture field parity assumed for the input interlaced video. It accepts one
  15274. of the following values:
  15275. @table @option
  15276. @item 0, tff
  15277. Assume the top field is first.
  15278. @item 1, bff
  15279. Assume the bottom field is first.
  15280. @item -1, auto
  15281. Enable automatic detection of field parity.
  15282. @end table
  15283. The default value is @code{auto}.
  15284. If the interlacing is unknown or the decoder does not export this information,
  15285. top field first will be assumed.
  15286. @item deint
  15287. Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accepts one of the following
  15288. values:
  15289. @table @option
  15290. @item 0, all
  15291. Deinterlace all frames.
  15292. @item 1, interlaced
  15293. Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.
  15294. @end table
  15295. The default value is @code{all}.
  15296. @end table
  15297. @section yadif_cuda
  15298. Deinterlace the input video using the @ref{yadif} algorithm, but implemented
  15299. in CUDA so that it can work as part of a GPU accelerated pipeline with nvdec
  15300. and/or nvenc.
  15301. It accepts the following parameters:
  15302. @table @option
  15303. @item mode
  15304. The interlacing mode to adopt. It accepts one of the following values:
  15305. @table @option
  15306. @item 0, send_frame
  15307. Output one frame for each frame.
  15308. @item 1, send_field
  15309. Output one frame for each field.
  15310. @item 2, send_frame_nospatial
  15311. Like @code{send_frame}, but it skips the spatial interlacing check.
  15312. @item 3, send_field_nospatial
  15313. Like @code{send_field}, but it skips the spatial interlacing check.
  15314. @end table
  15315. The default value is @code{send_frame}.
  15316. @item parity
  15317. The picture field parity assumed for the input interlaced video. It accepts one
  15318. of the following values:
  15319. @table @option
  15320. @item 0, tff
  15321. Assume the top field is first.
  15322. @item 1, bff
  15323. Assume the bottom field is first.
  15324. @item -1, auto
  15325. Enable automatic detection of field parity.
  15326. @end table
  15327. The default value is @code{auto}.
  15328. If the interlacing is unknown or the decoder does not export this information,
  15329. top field first will be assumed.
  15330. @item deint
  15331. Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accepts one of the following
  15332. values:
  15333. @table @option
  15334. @item 0, all
  15335. Deinterlace all frames.
  15336. @item 1, interlaced
  15337. Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.
  15338. @end table
  15339. The default value is @code{all}.
  15340. @end table
  15341. @section yaepblur
  15342. Apply blur filter while preserving edges ("yaepblur" means "yet another edge preserving blur filter").
  15343. The algorithm is described in
  15344. "J. S. Lee, Digital image enhancement and noise filtering by use of local statistics, IEEE Trans. Pattern Anal. Mach. Intell. PAMI-2, 1980."
  15345. It accepts the following parameters:
  15346. @table @option
  15347. @item radius, r
  15348. Set the window radius. Default value is 3.
  15349. @item planes, p
  15350. Set which planes to filter. Default is only the first plane.
  15351. @item sigma, s
  15352. Set blur strength. Default value is 128.
  15353. @end table
  15354. @subsection Commands
  15355. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  15356. @section zoompan
  15357. Apply Zoom & Pan effect.
  15358. This filter accepts the following options:
  15359. @table @option
  15360. @item zoom, z
  15361. Set the zoom expression. Range is 1-10. Default is 1.
  15362. @item x
  15363. @item y
  15364. Set the x and y expression. Default is 0.
  15365. @item d
  15366. Set the duration expression in number of frames.
  15367. This sets for how many number of frames effect will last for
  15368. single input image.
  15369. @item s
  15370. Set the output image size, default is 'hd720'.
  15371. @item fps
  15372. Set the output frame rate, default is '25'.
  15373. @end table
  15374. Each expression can contain the following constants:
  15375. @table @option
  15376. @item in_w, iw
  15377. Input width.
  15378. @item in_h, ih
  15379. Input height.
  15380. @item out_w, ow
  15381. Output width.
  15382. @item out_h, oh
  15383. Output height.
  15384. @item in
  15385. Input frame count.
  15386. @item on
  15387. Output frame count.
  15388. @item x
  15389. @item y
  15390. Last calculated 'x' and 'y' position from 'x' and 'y' expression
  15391. for current input frame.
  15392. @item px
  15393. @item py
  15394. 'x' and 'y' of last output frame of previous input frame or 0 when there was
  15395. not yet such frame (first input frame).
  15396. @item zoom
  15397. Last calculated zoom from 'z' expression for current input frame.
  15398. @item pzoom
  15399. Last calculated zoom of last output frame of previous input frame.
  15400. @item duration
  15401. Number of output frames for current input frame. Calculated from 'd' expression
  15402. for each input frame.
  15403. @item pduration
  15404. number of output frames created for previous input frame
  15405. @item a
  15406. Rational number: input width / input height
  15407. @item sar
  15408. sample aspect ratio
  15409. @item dar
  15410. display aspect ratio
  15411. @end table
  15412. @subsection Examples
  15413. @itemize
  15414. @item
  15415. Zoom-in up to 1.5 and pan at same time to some spot near center of picture:
  15416. @example
  15417. zoompan=z='min(zoom+0.0015,1.5)':d=700:x='if(gte(zoom,1.5),x,x+1/a)':y='if(gte(zoom,1.5),y,y+1)':s=640x360
  15418. @end example
  15419. @item
  15420. Zoom-in up to 1.5 and pan always at center of picture:
  15421. @example
  15422. zoompan=z='min(zoom+0.0015,1.5)':d=700:x='iw/2-(iw/zoom/2)':y='ih/2-(ih/zoom/2)'
  15423. @end example
  15424. @item
  15425. Same as above but without pausing:
  15426. @example
  15427. zoompan=z='min(max(zoom,pzoom)+0.0015,1.5)':d=1:x='iw/2-(iw/zoom/2)':y='ih/2-(ih/zoom/2)'
  15428. @end example
  15429. @end itemize
  15430. @anchor{zscale}
  15431. @section zscale
  15432. Scale (resize) the input video, using the z.lib library:
  15433. @url{https://github.com/sekrit-twc/zimg}. To enable compilation of this
  15434. filter, you need to configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-libzimg}.
  15435. The zscale filter forces the output display aspect ratio to be the same
  15436. as the input, by changing the output sample aspect ratio.
  15437. If the input image format is different from the format requested by
  15438. the next filter, the zscale filter will convert the input to the
  15439. requested format.
  15440. @subsection Options
  15441. The filter accepts the following options.
  15442. @table @option
  15443. @item width, w
  15444. @item height, h
  15445. Set the output video dimension expression. Default value is the input
  15446. dimension.
  15447. If the @var{width} or @var{w} value is 0, the input width is used for
  15448. the output. If the @var{height} or @var{h} value is 0, the input height
  15449. is used for the output.
  15450. If one and only one of the values is -n with n >= 1, the zscale filter
  15451. will use a value that maintains the aspect ratio of the input image,
  15452. calculated from the other specified dimension. After that it will,
  15453. however, make sure that the calculated dimension is divisible by n and
  15454. adjust the value if necessary.
  15455. If both values are -n with n >= 1, the behavior will be identical to
  15456. both values being set to 0 as previously detailed.
  15457. See below for the list of accepted constants for use in the dimension
  15458. expression.
  15459. @item size, s
  15460. Set the video size. For the syntax of this option, check the
  15461. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  15462. @item dither, d
  15463. Set the dither type.
  15464. Possible values are:
  15465. @table @var
  15466. @item none
  15467. @item ordered
  15468. @item random
  15469. @item error_diffusion
  15470. @end table
  15471. Default is none.
  15472. @item filter, f
  15473. Set the resize filter type.
  15474. Possible values are:
  15475. @table @var
  15476. @item point
  15477. @item bilinear
  15478. @item bicubic
  15479. @item spline16
  15480. @item spline36
  15481. @item lanczos
  15482. @end table
  15483. Default is bilinear.
  15484. @item range, r
  15485. Set the color range.
  15486. Possible values are:
  15487. @table @var
  15488. @item input
  15489. @item limited
  15490. @item full
  15491. @end table
  15492. Default is same as input.
  15493. @item primaries, p
  15494. Set the color primaries.
  15495. Possible values are:
  15496. @table @var
  15497. @item input
  15498. @item 709
  15499. @item unspecified
  15500. @item 170m
  15501. @item 240m
  15502. @item 2020
  15503. @end table
  15504. Default is same as input.
  15505. @item transfer, t
  15506. Set the transfer characteristics.
  15507. Possible values are:
  15508. @table @var
  15509. @item input
  15510. @item 709
  15511. @item unspecified
  15512. @item 601
  15513. @item linear
  15514. @item 2020_10
  15515. @item 2020_12
  15516. @item smpte2084
  15517. @item iec61966-2-1
  15518. @item arib-std-b67
  15519. @end table
  15520. Default is same as input.
  15521. @item matrix, m
  15522. Set the colorspace matrix.
  15523. Possible value are:
  15524. @table @var
  15525. @item input
  15526. @item 709
  15527. @item unspecified
  15528. @item 470bg
  15529. @item 170m
  15530. @item 2020_ncl
  15531. @item 2020_cl
  15532. @end table
  15533. Default is same as input.
  15534. @item rangein, rin
  15535. Set the input color range.
  15536. Possible values are:
  15537. @table @var
  15538. @item input
  15539. @item limited
  15540. @item full
  15541. @end table
  15542. Default is same as input.
  15543. @item primariesin, pin
  15544. Set the input color primaries.
  15545. Possible values are:
  15546. @table @var
  15547. @item input
  15548. @item 709
  15549. @item unspecified
  15550. @item 170m
  15551. @item 240m
  15552. @item 2020
  15553. @end table
  15554. Default is same as input.
  15555. @item transferin, tin
  15556. Set the input transfer characteristics.
  15557. Possible values are:
  15558. @table @var
  15559. @item input
  15560. @item 709
  15561. @item unspecified
  15562. @item 601
  15563. @item linear
  15564. @item 2020_10
  15565. @item 2020_12
  15566. @end table
  15567. Default is same as input.
  15568. @item matrixin, min
  15569. Set the input colorspace matrix.
  15570. Possible value are:
  15571. @table @var
  15572. @item input
  15573. @item 709
  15574. @item unspecified
  15575. @item 470bg
  15576. @item 170m
  15577. @item 2020_ncl
  15578. @item 2020_cl
  15579. @end table
  15580. @item chromal, c
  15581. Set the output chroma location.
  15582. Possible values are:
  15583. @table @var
  15584. @item input
  15585. @item left
  15586. @item center
  15587. @item topleft
  15588. @item top
  15589. @item bottomleft
  15590. @item bottom
  15591. @end table
  15592. @item chromalin, cin
  15593. Set the input chroma location.
  15594. Possible values are:
  15595. @table @var
  15596. @item input
  15597. @item left
  15598. @item center
  15599. @item topleft
  15600. @item top
  15601. @item bottomleft
  15602. @item bottom
  15603. @end table
  15604. @item npl
  15605. Set the nominal peak luminance.
  15606. @end table
  15607. The values of the @option{w} and @option{h} options are expressions
  15608. containing the following constants:
  15609. @table @var
  15610. @item in_w
  15611. @item in_h
  15612. The input width and height
  15613. @item iw
  15614. @item ih
  15615. These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
  15616. @item out_w
  15617. @item out_h
  15618. The output (scaled) width and height
  15619. @item ow
  15620. @item oh
  15621. These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}
  15622. @item a
  15623. The same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
  15624. @item sar
  15625. input sample aspect ratio
  15626. @item dar
  15627. The input display aspect ratio. Calculated from @code{(iw / ih) * sar}.
  15628. @item hsub
  15629. @item vsub
  15630. horizontal and vertical input chroma subsample values. For example for the
  15631. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  15632. @item ohsub
  15633. @item ovsub
  15634. horizontal and vertical output chroma subsample values. For example for the
  15635. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  15636. @end table
  15637. @subsection Commands
  15638. This filter supports the following commands:
  15639. @table @option
  15640. @item width, w
  15641. @item height, h
  15642. Set the output video dimension expression.
  15643. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  15644. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  15645. value.
  15646. @end table
  15647. @c man end VIDEO FILTERS
  15648. @chapter OpenCL Video Filters
  15649. @c man begin OPENCL VIDEO FILTERS
  15650. Below is a description of the currently available OpenCL video filters.
  15651. To enable compilation of these filters you need to configure FFmpeg with
  15652. @code{--enable-opencl}.
  15653. Running OpenCL filters requires you to initialize a hardware device and to pass that device to all filters in any filter graph.
  15654. @table @option
  15655. @item -init_hw_device opencl[=@var{name}][:@var{device}[,@var{key=value}...]]
  15656. Initialise a new hardware device of type @var{opencl} called @var{name}, using the
  15657. given device parameters.
  15658. @item -filter_hw_device @var{name}
  15659. Pass the hardware device called @var{name} to all filters in any filter graph.
  15660. @end table
  15661. For more detailed information see @url{https://www.ffmpeg.org/ffmpeg.html#Advanced-Video-options}
  15662. @itemize
  15663. @item
  15664. Example of choosing the first device on the second platform and running avgblur_opencl filter with default parameters on it.
  15665. @example
  15666. -init_hw_device opencl=gpu:1.0 -filter_hw_device gpu -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, avgblur_opencl, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15667. @end example
  15668. @end itemize
  15669. Since OpenCL filters are not able to access frame data in normal memory, all frame data needs to be uploaded(@ref{hwupload}) to hardware surfaces connected to the appropriate device before being used and then downloaded(@ref{hwdownload}) back to normal memory. Note that @ref{hwupload} will upload to a surface with the same layout as the software frame, so it may be necessary to add a @ref{format} filter immediately before to get the input into the right format and @ref{hwdownload} does not support all formats on the output - it may be necessary to insert an additional @ref{format} filter immediately following in the graph to get the output in a supported format.
  15670. @section avgblur_opencl
  15671. Apply average blur filter.
  15672. The filter accepts the following options:
  15673. @table @option
  15674. @item sizeX
  15675. Set horizontal radius size.
  15676. Range is @code{[1, 1024]} and default value is @code{1}.
  15677. @item planes
  15678. Set which planes to filter. Default value is @code{0xf}, by which all planes are processed.
  15679. @item sizeY
  15680. Set vertical radius size. Range is @code{[1, 1024]} and default value is @code{0}. If zero, @code{sizeX} value will be used.
  15681. @end table
  15682. @subsection Example
  15683. @itemize
  15684. @item
  15685. Apply average blur filter with horizontal and vertical size of 3, setting each pixel of the output to the average value of the 7x7 region centered on it in the input. For pixels on the edges of the image, the region does not extend beyond the image boundaries, and so out-of-range coordinates are not used in the calculations.
  15686. @example
  15687. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, avgblur_opencl=3, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15688. @end example
  15689. @end itemize
  15690. @section boxblur_opencl
  15691. Apply a boxblur algorithm to the input video.
  15692. It accepts the following parameters:
  15693. @table @option
  15694. @item luma_radius, lr
  15695. @item luma_power, lp
  15696. @item chroma_radius, cr
  15697. @item chroma_power, cp
  15698. @item alpha_radius, ar
  15699. @item alpha_power, ap
  15700. @end table
  15701. A description of the accepted options follows.
  15702. @table @option
  15703. @item luma_radius, lr
  15704. @item chroma_radius, cr
  15705. @item alpha_radius, ar
  15706. Set an expression for the box radius in pixels used for blurring the
  15707. corresponding input plane.
  15708. The radius value must be a non-negative number, and must not be
  15709. greater than the value of the expression @code{min(w,h)/2} for the
  15710. luma and alpha planes, and of @code{min(cw,ch)/2} for the chroma
  15711. planes.
  15712. Default value for @option{luma_radius} is "2". If not specified,
  15713. @option{chroma_radius} and @option{alpha_radius} default to the
  15714. corresponding value set for @option{luma_radius}.
  15715. The expressions can contain the following constants:
  15716. @table @option
  15717. @item w
  15718. @item h
  15719. The input width and height in pixels.
  15720. @item cw
  15721. @item ch
  15722. The input chroma image width and height in pixels.
  15723. @item hsub
  15724. @item vsub
  15725. The horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example, for the
  15726. pixel format "yuv422p", @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  15727. @end table
  15728. @item luma_power, lp
  15729. @item chroma_power, cp
  15730. @item alpha_power, ap
  15731. Specify how many times the boxblur filter is applied to the
  15732. corresponding plane.
  15733. Default value for @option{luma_power} is 2. If not specified,
  15734. @option{chroma_power} and @option{alpha_power} default to the
  15735. corresponding value set for @option{luma_power}.
  15736. A value of 0 will disable the effect.
  15737. @end table
  15738. @subsection Examples
  15739. Apply boxblur filter, setting each pixel of the output to the average value of box-radiuses @var{luma_radius}, @var{chroma_radius}, @var{alpha_radius} for each plane respectively. The filter will apply @var{luma_power}, @var{chroma_power}, @var{alpha_power} times onto the corresponding plane. For pixels on the edges of the image, the radius does not extend beyond the image boundaries, and so out-of-range coordinates are not used in the calculations.
  15740. @itemize
  15741. @item
  15742. Apply a boxblur filter with the luma, chroma, and alpha radius
  15743. set to 2 and luma, chroma, and alpha power set to 3. The filter will run 3 times with box-radius set to 2 for every plane of the image.
  15744. @example
  15745. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, boxblur_opencl=luma_radius=2:luma_power=3, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15746. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, boxblur_opencl=2:3, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15747. @end example
  15748. @item
  15749. Apply a boxblur filter with luma radius set to 2, luma_power to 1, chroma_radius to 4, chroma_power to 5, alpha_radius to 3 and alpha_power to 7.
  15750. For the luma plane, a 2x2 box radius will be run once.
  15751. For the chroma plane, a 4x4 box radius will be run 5 times.
  15752. For the alpha plane, a 3x3 box radius will be run 7 times.
  15753. @example
  15754. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, boxblur_opencl=2:1:4:5:3:7, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15755. @end example
  15756. @end itemize
  15757. @section convolution_opencl
  15758. Apply convolution of 3x3, 5x5, 7x7 matrix.
  15759. The filter accepts the following options:
  15760. @table @option
  15761. @item 0m
  15762. @item 1m
  15763. @item 2m
  15764. @item 3m
  15765. Set matrix for each plane.
  15766. Matrix is sequence of 9, 25 or 49 signed numbers.
  15767. Default value for each plane is @code{0 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 0}.
  15768. @item 0rdiv
  15769. @item 1rdiv
  15770. @item 2rdiv
  15771. @item 3rdiv
  15772. Set multiplier for calculated value for each plane.
  15773. If unset or 0, it will be sum of all matrix elements.
  15774. The option value must be a float number greater or equal to @code{0.0}. Default value is @code{1.0}.
  15775. @item 0bias
  15776. @item 1bias
  15777. @item 2bias
  15778. @item 3bias
  15779. Set bias for each plane. This value is added to the result of the multiplication.
  15780. Useful for making the overall image brighter or darker.
  15781. The option value must be a float number greater or equal to @code{0.0}. Default value is @code{0.0}.
  15782. @end table
  15783. @subsection Examples
  15784. @itemize
  15785. @item
  15786. Apply sharpen:
  15787. @example
  15788. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15789. @end example
  15790. @item
  15791. Apply blur:
  15792. @example
  15793. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1/9:1/9:1/9:1/9, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15794. @end example
  15795. @item
  15796. Apply edge enhance:
  15797. @example
  15798. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:5:1:1:1:0:128:128:128, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15799. @end example
  15800. @item
  15801. Apply edge detect:
  15802. @example
  15803. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:5:5:5:1:0:128:128:128, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15804. @end example
  15805. @item
  15806. Apply laplacian edge detector which includes diagonals:
  15807. @example
  15808. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:5:5:5:1:0:128:128:0, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15809. @end example
  15810. @item
  15811. Apply emboss:
  15812. @example
  15813. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15814. @end example
  15815. @end itemize
  15816. @section dilation_opencl
  15817. Apply dilation effect to the video.
  15818. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) maximum.
  15819. It accepts the following options:
  15820. @table @option
  15821. @item threshold0
  15822. @item threshold1
  15823. @item threshold2
  15824. @item threshold3
  15825. Limit the maximum change for each plane. Range is @code{[0, 65535]} and default value is @code{65535}.
  15826. If @code{0}, plane will remain unchanged.
  15827. @item coordinates
  15828. Flag which specifies the pixel to refer to.
  15829. Range is @code{[0, 255]} and default value is @code{255}, i.e. all eight pixels are used.
  15830. Flags to local 3x3 coordinates region centered on @code{x}:
  15831. 1 2 3
  15832. 4 x 5
  15833. 6 7 8
  15834. @end table
  15835. @subsection Example
  15836. @itemize
  15837. @item
  15838. Apply dilation filter with threshold0 set to 30, threshold1 set 40, threshold2 set to 50 and coordinates set to 231, setting each pixel of the output to the local maximum between pixels: 1, 2, 3, 6, 7, 8 of the 3x3 region centered on it in the input. If the difference between input pixel and local maximum is more then threshold of the corresponding plane, output pixel will be set to input pixel + threshold of corresponding plane.
  15839. @example
  15840. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, dilation_opencl=30:40:50:coordinates=231, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15841. @end example
  15842. @end itemize
  15843. @section erosion_opencl
  15844. Apply erosion effect to the video.
  15845. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) minimum.
  15846. It accepts the following options:
  15847. @table @option
  15848. @item threshold0
  15849. @item threshold1
  15850. @item threshold2
  15851. @item threshold3
  15852. Limit the maximum change for each plane. Range is @code{[0, 65535]} and default value is @code{65535}.
  15853. If @code{0}, plane will remain unchanged.
  15854. @item coordinates
  15855. Flag which specifies the pixel to refer to.
  15856. Range is @code{[0, 255]} and default value is @code{255}, i.e. all eight pixels are used.
  15857. Flags to local 3x3 coordinates region centered on @code{x}:
  15858. 1 2 3
  15859. 4 x 5
  15860. 6 7 8
  15861. @end table
  15862. @subsection Example
  15863. @itemize
  15864. @item
  15865. Apply erosion filter with threshold0 set to 30, threshold1 set 40, threshold2 set to 50 and coordinates set to 231, setting each pixel of the output to the local minimum between pixels: 1, 2, 3, 6, 7, 8 of the 3x3 region centered on it in the input. If the difference between input pixel and local minimum is more then threshold of the corresponding plane, output pixel will be set to input pixel - threshold of corresponding plane.
  15866. @example
  15867. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, erosion_opencl=30:40:50:coordinates=231, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15868. @end example
  15869. @end itemize
  15870. @section colorkey_opencl
  15871. RGB colorspace color keying.
  15872. The filter accepts the following options:
  15873. @table @option
  15874. @item color
  15875. The color which will be replaced with transparency.
  15876. @item similarity
  15877. Similarity percentage with the key color.
  15878. 0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.
  15879. @item blend
  15880. Blend percentage.
  15881. 0.0 makes pixels either fully transparent, or not transparent at all.
  15882. Higher values result in semi-transparent pixels, with a higher transparency
  15883. the more similar the pixels color is to the key color.
  15884. @end table
  15885. @subsection Examples
  15886. @itemize
  15887. @item
  15888. Make every semi-green pixel in the input transparent with some slight blending:
  15889. @example
  15890. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, colorkey_opencl=green:0.3:0.1, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15891. @end example
  15892. @end itemize
  15893. @section deshake_opencl
  15894. Feature-point based video stabilization filter.
  15895. The filter accepts the following options:
  15896. @table @option
  15897. @item tripod
  15898. Simulates a tripod by preventing any camera movement whatsoever from the original frame. Defaults to @code{0}.
  15899. @item debug
  15900. Whether or not additional debug info should be displayed, both in the processed output and in the console.
  15901. Note that in order to see console debug output you will also need to pass @code{-v verbose} to ffmpeg.
  15902. Viewing point matches in the output video is only supported for RGB input.
  15903. Defaults to @code{0}.
  15904. @item adaptive_crop
  15905. Whether or not to do a tiny bit of cropping at the borders to cut down on the amount of mirrored pixels.
  15906. Defaults to @code{1}.
  15907. @item refine_features
  15908. Whether or not feature points should be refined at a sub-pixel level.
  15909. This can be turned off for a slight performance gain at the cost of precision.
  15910. Defaults to @code{1}.
  15911. @item smooth_strength
  15912. The strength of the smoothing applied to the camera path from @code{0.0} to @code{1.0}.
  15913. @code{1.0} is the maximum smoothing strength while values less than that result in less smoothing.
  15914. @code{0.0} causes the filter to adaptively choose a smoothing strength on a per-frame basis.
  15915. Defaults to @code{0.0}.
  15916. @item smooth_window_multiplier
  15917. Controls the size of the smoothing window (the number of frames buffered to determine motion information from).
  15918. The size of the smoothing window is determined by multiplying the framerate of the video by this number.
  15919. Acceptable values range from @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}.
  15920. Larger values increase the amount of motion data available for determining how to smooth the camera path,
  15921. potentially improving smoothness, but also increase latency and memory usage.
  15922. Defaults to @code{2.0}.
  15923. @end table
  15924. @subsection Examples
  15925. @itemize
  15926. @item
  15927. Stabilize a video with a fixed, medium smoothing strength:
  15928. @example
  15929. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, deshake_opencl=smooth_strength=0.5, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15930. @end example
  15931. @item
  15932. Stabilize a video with debugging (both in console and in rendered video):
  15933. @example
  15934. -i INPUT -filter_complex "[0:v]format=rgba, hwupload, deshake_opencl=debug=1, hwdownload, format=rgba, format=yuv420p" -v verbose OUTPUT
  15935. @end example
  15936. @end itemize
  15937. @section nlmeans_opencl
  15938. Non-local Means denoise filter through OpenCL, this filter accepts same options as @ref{nlmeans}.
  15939. @section overlay_opencl
  15940. Overlay one video on top of another.
  15941. It takes two inputs and has one output. The first input is the "main" video on which the second input is overlaid.
  15942. This filter requires same memory layout for all the inputs. So, format conversion may be needed.
  15943. The filter accepts the following options:
  15944. @table @option
  15945. @item x
  15946. Set the x coordinate of the overlaid video on the main video.
  15947. Default value is @code{0}.
  15948. @item y
  15949. Set the y coordinate of the overlaid video on the main video.
  15950. Default value is @code{0}.
  15951. @end table
  15952. @subsection Examples
  15953. @itemize
  15954. @item
  15955. Overlay an image LOGO at the top-left corner of the INPUT video. Both inputs are yuv420p format.
  15956. @example
  15957. -i INPUT -i LOGO -filter_complex "[0:v]hwupload[a], [1:v]format=yuv420p, hwupload[b], [a][b]overlay_opencl, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15958. @end example
  15959. @item
  15960. The inputs have same memory layout for color channels , the overlay has additional alpha plane, like INPUT is yuv420p, and the LOGO is yuva420p.
  15961. @example
  15962. -i INPUT -i LOGO -filter_complex "[0:v]hwupload[a], [1:v]format=yuva420p, hwupload[b], [a][b]overlay_opencl, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15963. @end example
  15964. @end itemize
  15965. @section prewitt_opencl
  15966. Apply the Prewitt operator (@url{https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Prewitt_operator}) to input video stream.
  15967. The filter accepts the following option:
  15968. @table @option
  15969. @item planes
  15970. Set which planes to filter. Default value is @code{0xf}, by which all planes are processed.
  15971. @item scale
  15972. Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.
  15973. Range is @code{[0.0, 65535]} and default value is @code{1.0}.
  15974. @item delta
  15975. Set value which will be added to filtered result.
  15976. Range is @code{[-65535, 65535]} and default value is @code{0.0}.
  15977. @end table
  15978. @subsection Example
  15979. @itemize
  15980. @item
  15981. Apply the Prewitt operator with scale set to 2 and delta set to 10.
  15982. @example
  15983. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, prewitt_opencl=scale=2:delta=10, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15984. @end example
  15985. @end itemize
  15986. @section roberts_opencl
  15987. Apply the Roberts cross operator (@url{https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Roberts_cross}) to input video stream.
  15988. The filter accepts the following option:
  15989. @table @option
  15990. @item planes
  15991. Set which planes to filter. Default value is @code{0xf}, by which all planes are processed.
  15992. @item scale
  15993. Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.
  15994. Range is @code{[0.0, 65535]} and default value is @code{1.0}.
  15995. @item delta
  15996. Set value which will be added to filtered result.
  15997. Range is @code{[-65535, 65535]} and default value is @code{0.0}.
  15998. @end table
  15999. @subsection Example
  16000. @itemize
  16001. @item
  16002. Apply the Roberts cross operator with scale set to 2 and delta set to 10
  16003. @example
  16004. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, roberts_opencl=scale=2:delta=10, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16005. @end example
  16006. @end itemize
  16007. @section sobel_opencl
  16008. Apply the Sobel operator (@url{https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Sobel_operator}) to input video stream.
  16009. The filter accepts the following option:
  16010. @table @option
  16011. @item planes
  16012. Set which planes to filter. Default value is @code{0xf}, by which all planes are processed.
  16013. @item scale
  16014. Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.
  16015. Range is @code{[0.0, 65535]} and default value is @code{1.0}.
  16016. @item delta
  16017. Set value which will be added to filtered result.
  16018. Range is @code{[-65535, 65535]} and default value is @code{0.0}.
  16019. @end table
  16020. @subsection Example
  16021. @itemize
  16022. @item
  16023. Apply sobel operator with scale set to 2 and delta set to 10
  16024. @example
  16025. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, sobel_opencl=scale=2:delta=10, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16026. @end example
  16027. @end itemize
  16028. @section tonemap_opencl
  16029. Perform HDR(PQ/HLG) to SDR conversion with tone-mapping.
  16030. It accepts the following parameters:
  16031. @table @option
  16032. @item tonemap
  16033. Specify the tone-mapping operator to be used. Same as tonemap option in @ref{tonemap}.
  16034. @item param
  16035. Tune the tone mapping algorithm. same as param option in @ref{tonemap}.
  16036. @item desat
  16037. Apply desaturation for highlights that exceed this level of brightness. The
  16038. higher the parameter, the more color information will be preserved. This
  16039. setting helps prevent unnaturally blown-out colors for super-highlights, by
  16040. (smoothly) turning into white instead. This makes images feel more natural,
  16041. at the cost of reducing information about out-of-range colors.
  16042. The default value is 0.5, and the algorithm here is a little different from
  16043. the cpu version tonemap currently. A setting of 0.0 disables this option.
  16044. @item threshold
  16045. The tonemapping algorithm parameters is fine-tuned per each scene. And a threshold
  16046. is used to detect whether the scene has changed or not. If the distance between
  16047. the current frame average brightness and the current running average exceeds
  16048. a threshold value, we would re-calculate scene average and peak brightness.
  16049. The default value is 0.2.
  16050. @item format
  16051. Specify the output pixel format.
  16052. Currently supported formats are:
  16053. @table @var
  16054. @item p010
  16055. @item nv12
  16056. @end table
  16057. @item range, r
  16058. Set the output color range.
  16059. Possible values are:
  16060. @table @var
  16061. @item tv/mpeg
  16062. @item pc/jpeg
  16063. @end table
  16064. Default is same as input.
  16065. @item primaries, p
  16066. Set the output color primaries.
  16067. Possible values are:
  16068. @table @var
  16069. @item bt709
  16070. @item bt2020
  16071. @end table
  16072. Default is same as input.
  16073. @item transfer, t
  16074. Set the output transfer characteristics.
  16075. Possible values are:
  16076. @table @var
  16077. @item bt709
  16078. @item bt2020
  16079. @end table
  16080. Default is bt709.
  16081. @item matrix, m
  16082. Set the output colorspace matrix.
  16083. Possible value are:
  16084. @table @var
  16085. @item bt709
  16086. @item bt2020
  16087. @end table
  16088. Default is same as input.
  16089. @end table
  16090. @subsection Example
  16091. @itemize
  16092. @item
  16093. Convert HDR(PQ/HLG) video to bt2020-transfer-characteristic p010 format using linear operator.
  16094. @example
  16095. -i INPUT -vf "format=p010,hwupload,tonemap_opencl=t=bt2020:tonemap=linear:format=p010,hwdownload,format=p010" OUTPUT
  16096. @end example
  16097. @end itemize
  16098. @section unsharp_opencl
  16099. Sharpen or blur the input video.
  16100. It accepts the following parameters:
  16101. @table @option
  16102. @item luma_msize_x, lx
  16103. Set the luma matrix horizontal size.
  16104. Range is @code{[1, 23]} and default value is @code{5}.
  16105. @item luma_msize_y, ly
  16106. Set the luma matrix vertical size.
  16107. Range is @code{[1, 23]} and default value is @code{5}.
  16108. @item luma_amount, la
  16109. Set the luma effect strength.
  16110. Range is @code{[-10, 10]} and default value is @code{1.0}.
  16111. Negative values will blur the input video, while positive values will
  16112. sharpen it, a value of zero will disable the effect.
  16113. @item chroma_msize_x, cx
  16114. Set the chroma matrix horizontal size.
  16115. Range is @code{[1, 23]} and default value is @code{5}.
  16116. @item chroma_msize_y, cy
  16117. Set the chroma matrix vertical size.
  16118. Range is @code{[1, 23]} and default value is @code{5}.
  16119. @item chroma_amount, ca
  16120. Set the chroma effect strength.
  16121. Range is @code{[-10, 10]} and default value is @code{0.0}.
  16122. Negative values will blur the input video, while positive values will
  16123. sharpen it, a value of zero will disable the effect.
  16124. @end table
  16125. All parameters are optional and default to the equivalent of the
  16126. string '5:5:1.0:5:5:0.0'.
  16127. @subsection Examples
  16128. @itemize
  16129. @item
  16130. Apply strong luma sharpen effect:
  16131. @example
  16132. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, unsharp_opencl=luma_msize_x=7:luma_msize_y=7:luma_amount=2.5, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16133. @end example
  16134. @item
  16135. Apply a strong blur of both luma and chroma parameters:
  16136. @example
  16137. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, unsharp_opencl=7:7:-2:7:7:-2, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16138. @end example
  16139. @end itemize
  16140. @c man end OPENCL VIDEO FILTERS
  16141. @chapter VAAPI Video Filters
  16142. @c man begin VAAPI VIDEO FILTERS
  16143. VAAPI Video filters are usually used with VAAPI decoder and VAAPI encoder. Below is a description of VAAPI video filters.
  16144. To enable compilation of these filters you need to configure FFmpeg with
  16145. @code{--enable-vaapi}.
  16146. To use vaapi filters, you need to setup the vaapi device correctly. For more information, please read @url{https://trac.ffmpeg.org/wiki/Hardware/VAAPI}
  16147. @section tonemap_vappi
  16148. Perform HDR(High Dynamic Range) to SDR(Standard Dynamic Range) conversion with tone-mapping.
  16149. It maps the dynamic range of HDR10 content to the SDR content.
  16150. It currently only accepts HDR10 as input.
  16151. It accepts the following parameters:
  16152. @table @option
  16153. @item format
  16154. Specify the output pixel format.
  16155. Currently supported formats are:
  16156. @table @var
  16157. @item p010
  16158. @item nv12
  16159. @end table
  16160. Default is nv12.
  16161. @item primaries, p
  16162. Set the output color primaries.
  16163. Default is same as input.
  16164. @item transfer, t
  16165. Set the output transfer characteristics.
  16166. Default is bt709.
  16167. @item matrix, m
  16168. Set the output colorspace matrix.
  16169. Default is same as input.
  16170. @end table
  16171. @subsection Example
  16172. @itemize
  16173. @item
  16174. Convert HDR(HDR10) video to bt2020-transfer-characteristic p010 format
  16175. @example
  16176. tonemap_vaapi=format=p010:t=bt2020-10
  16177. @end example
  16178. @end itemize
  16179. @c man end VAAPI VIDEO FILTERS
  16180. @chapter Video Sources
  16181. @c man begin VIDEO SOURCES
  16182. Below is a description of the currently available video sources.
  16183. @section buffer
  16184. Buffer video frames, and make them available to the filter chain.
  16185. This source is mainly intended for a programmatic use, in particular
  16186. through the interface defined in @file{libavfilter/vsrc_buffer.h}.
  16187. It accepts the following parameters:
  16188. @table @option
  16189. @item video_size
  16190. Specify the size (width and height) of the buffered video frames. For the
  16191. syntax of this option, check the
  16192. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16193. @item width
  16194. The input video width.
  16195. @item height
  16196. The input video height.
  16197. @item pix_fmt
  16198. A string representing the pixel format of the buffered video frames.
  16199. It may be a number corresponding to a pixel format, or a pixel format
  16200. name.
  16201. @item time_base
  16202. Specify the timebase assumed by the timestamps of the buffered frames.
  16203. @item frame_rate
  16204. Specify the frame rate expected for the video stream.
  16205. @item pixel_aspect, sar
  16206. The sample (pixel) aspect ratio of the input video.
  16207. @item sws_param
  16208. This option is deprecated and ignored. Prepend @code{sws_flags=@var{flags};}
  16209. to the filtergraph description to specify swscale flags for automatically
  16210. inserted scalers. See @ref{Filtergraph syntax}.
  16211. @item hw_frames_ctx
  16212. When using a hardware pixel format, this should be a reference to an
  16213. AVHWFramesContext describing input frames.
  16214. @end table
  16215. For example:
  16216. @example
  16217. buffer=width=320:height=240:pix_fmt=yuv410p:time_base=1/24:sar=1
  16218. @end example
  16219. will instruct the source to accept video frames with size 320x240 and
  16220. with format "yuv410p", assuming 1/24 as the timestamps timebase and
  16221. square pixels (1:1 sample aspect ratio).
  16222. Since the pixel format with name "yuv410p" corresponds to the number 6
  16223. (check the enum AVPixelFormat definition in @file{libavutil/pixfmt.h}),
  16224. this example corresponds to:
  16225. @example
  16226. buffer=size=320x240:pixfmt=6:time_base=1/24:pixel_aspect=1/1
  16227. @end example
  16228. Alternatively, the options can be specified as a flat string, but this
  16229. syntax is deprecated:
  16230. @var{width}:@var{height}:@var{pix_fmt}:@var{time_base.num}:@var{time_base.den}:@var{pixel_aspect.num}:@var{pixel_aspect.den}
  16231. @section cellauto
  16232. Create a pattern generated by an elementary cellular automaton.
  16233. The initial state of the cellular automaton can be defined through the
  16234. @option{filename} and @option{pattern} options. If such options are
  16235. not specified an initial state is created randomly.
  16236. At each new frame a new row in the video is filled with the result of
  16237. the cellular automaton next generation. The behavior when the whole
  16238. frame is filled is defined by the @option{scroll} option.
  16239. This source accepts the following options:
  16240. @table @option
  16241. @item filename, f
  16242. Read the initial cellular automaton state, i.e. the starting row, from
  16243. the specified file.
  16244. In the file, each non-whitespace character is considered an alive
  16245. cell, a newline will terminate the row, and further characters in the
  16246. file will be ignored.
  16247. @item pattern, p
  16248. Read the initial cellular automaton state, i.e. the starting row, from
  16249. the specified string.
  16250. Each non-whitespace character in the string is considered an alive
  16251. cell, a newline will terminate the row, and further characters in the
  16252. string will be ignored.
  16253. @item rate, r
  16254. Set the video rate, that is the number of frames generated per second.
  16255. Default is 25.
  16256. @item random_fill_ratio, ratio
  16257. Set the random fill ratio for the initial cellular automaton row. It
  16258. is a floating point number value ranging from 0 to 1, defaults to
  16259. 1/PHI.
  16260. This option is ignored when a file or a pattern is specified.
  16261. @item random_seed, seed
  16262. Set the seed for filling randomly the initial row, must be an integer
  16263. included between 0 and UINT32_MAX. If not specified, or if explicitly
  16264. set to -1, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a best
  16265. effort basis.
  16266. @item rule
  16267. Set the cellular automaton rule, it is a number ranging from 0 to 255.
  16268. Default value is 110.
  16269. @item size, s
  16270. Set the size of the output video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  16271. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16272. If @option{filename} or @option{pattern} is specified, the size is set
  16273. by default to the width of the specified initial state row, and the
  16274. height is set to @var{width} * PHI.
  16275. If @option{size} is set, it must contain the width of the specified
  16276. pattern string, and the specified pattern will be centered in the
  16277. larger row.
  16278. If a filename or a pattern string is not specified, the size value
  16279. defaults to "320x518" (used for a randomly generated initial state).
  16280. @item scroll
  16281. If set to 1, scroll the output upward when all the rows in the output
  16282. have been already filled. If set to 0, the new generated row will be
  16283. written over the top row just after the bottom row is filled.
  16284. Defaults to 1.
  16285. @item start_full, full
  16286. If set to 1, completely fill the output with generated rows before
  16287. outputting the first frame.
  16288. This is the default behavior, for disabling set the value to 0.
  16289. @item stitch
  16290. If set to 1, stitch the left and right row edges together.
  16291. This is the default behavior, for disabling set the value to 0.
  16292. @end table
  16293. @subsection Examples
  16294. @itemize
  16295. @item
  16296. Read the initial state from @file{pattern}, and specify an output of
  16297. size 200x400.
  16298. @example
  16299. cellauto=f=pattern:s=200x400
  16300. @end example
  16301. @item
  16302. Generate a random initial row with a width of 200 cells, with a fill
  16303. ratio of 2/3:
  16304. @example
  16305. cellauto=ratio=2/3:s=200x200
  16306. @end example
  16307. @item
  16308. Create a pattern generated by rule 18 starting by a single alive cell
  16309. centered on an initial row with width 100:
  16310. @example
  16311. cellauto=p=@@:s=100x400:full=0:rule=18
  16312. @end example
  16313. @item
  16314. Specify a more elaborated initial pattern:
  16315. @example
  16316. cellauto=p='@@@@ @@ @@@@':s=100x400:full=0:rule=18
  16317. @end example
  16318. @end itemize
  16319. @anchor{coreimagesrc}
  16320. @section coreimagesrc
  16321. Video source generated on GPU using Apple's CoreImage API on OSX.
  16322. This video source is a specialized version of the @ref{coreimage} video filter.
  16323. Use a core image generator at the beginning of the applied filterchain to
  16324. generate the content.
  16325. The coreimagesrc video source accepts the following options:
  16326. @table @option
  16327. @item list_generators
  16328. List all available generators along with all their respective options as well as
  16329. possible minimum and maximum values along with the default values.
  16330. @example
  16331. list_generators=true
  16332. @end example
  16333. @item size, s
  16334. Specify the size of the sourced video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  16335. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16336. The default value is @code{320x240}.
  16337. @item rate, r
  16338. Specify the frame rate of the sourced video, as the number of frames
  16339. generated per second. It has to be a string in the format
  16340. @var{frame_rate_num}/@var{frame_rate_den}, an integer number, a floating point
  16341. number or a valid video frame rate abbreviation. The default value is
  16342. "25".
  16343. @item sar
  16344. Set the sample aspect ratio of the sourced video.
  16345. @item duration, d
  16346. Set the duration of the sourced video. See
  16347. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  16348. for the accepted syntax.
  16349. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the video is
  16350. supposed to be generated forever.
  16351. @end table
  16352. Additionally, all options of the @ref{coreimage} video filter are accepted.
  16353. A complete filterchain can be used for further processing of the
  16354. generated input without CPU-HOST transfer. See @ref{coreimage} documentation
  16355. and examples for details.
  16356. @subsection Examples
  16357. @itemize
  16358. @item
  16359. Use CIQRCodeGenerator to create a QR code for the FFmpeg homepage,
  16360. given as complete and escaped command-line for Apple's standard bash shell:
  16361. @example
  16362. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i coreimagesrc=s=100x100:filter=CIQRCodeGenerator@@inputMessage=https\\\\\://FFmpeg.org/@@inputCorrectionLevel=H -frames:v 1 QRCode.png
  16363. @end example
  16364. This example is equivalent to the QRCode example of @ref{coreimage} without the
  16365. need for a nullsrc video source.
  16366. @end itemize
  16367. @section mandelbrot
  16368. Generate a Mandelbrot set fractal, and progressively zoom towards the
  16369. point specified with @var{start_x} and @var{start_y}.
  16370. This source accepts the following options:
  16371. @table @option
  16372. @item end_pts
  16373. Set the terminal pts value. Default value is 400.
  16374. @item end_scale
  16375. Set the terminal scale value.
  16376. Must be a floating point value. Default value is 0.3.
  16377. @item inner
  16378. Set the inner coloring mode, that is the algorithm used to draw the
  16379. Mandelbrot fractal internal region.
  16380. It shall assume one of the following values:
  16381. @table @option
  16382. @item black
  16383. Set black mode.
  16384. @item convergence
  16385. Show time until convergence.
  16386. @item mincol
  16387. Set color based on point closest to the origin of the iterations.
  16388. @item period
  16389. Set period mode.
  16390. @end table
  16391. Default value is @var{mincol}.
  16392. @item bailout
  16393. Set the bailout value. Default value is 10.0.
  16394. @item maxiter
  16395. Set the maximum of iterations performed by the rendering
  16396. algorithm. Default value is 7189.
  16397. @item outer
  16398. Set outer coloring mode.
  16399. It shall assume one of following values:
  16400. @table @option
  16401. @item iteration_count
  16402. Set iteration count mode.
  16403. @item normalized_iteration_count
  16404. set normalized iteration count mode.
  16405. @end table
  16406. Default value is @var{normalized_iteration_count}.
  16407. @item rate, r
  16408. Set frame rate, expressed as number of frames per second. Default
  16409. value is "25".
  16410. @item size, s
  16411. Set frame size. For the syntax of this option, check the @ref{video size syntax,,"Video
  16412. size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}. Default value is "640x480".
  16413. @item start_scale
  16414. Set the initial scale value. Default value is 3.0.
  16415. @item start_x
  16416. Set the initial x position. Must be a floating point value between
  16417. -100 and 100. Default value is -0.743643887037158704752191506114774.
  16418. @item start_y
  16419. Set the initial y position. Must be a floating point value between
  16420. -100 and 100. Default value is -0.131825904205311970493132056385139.
  16421. @end table
  16422. @section mptestsrc
  16423. Generate various test patterns, as generated by the MPlayer test filter.
  16424. The size of the generated video is fixed, and is 256x256.
  16425. This source is useful in particular for testing encoding features.
  16426. This source accepts the following options:
  16427. @table @option
  16428. @item rate, r
  16429. Specify the frame rate of the sourced video, as the number of frames
  16430. generated per second. It has to be a string in the format
  16431. @var{frame_rate_num}/@var{frame_rate_den}, an integer number, a floating point
  16432. number or a valid video frame rate abbreviation. The default value is
  16433. "25".
  16434. @item duration, d
  16435. Set the duration of the sourced video. See
  16436. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  16437. for the accepted syntax.
  16438. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the video is
  16439. supposed to be generated forever.
  16440. @item test, t
  16441. Set the number or the name of the test to perform. Supported tests are:
  16442. @table @option
  16443. @item dc_luma
  16444. @item dc_chroma
  16445. @item freq_luma
  16446. @item freq_chroma
  16447. @item amp_luma
  16448. @item amp_chroma
  16449. @item cbp
  16450. @item mv
  16451. @item ring1
  16452. @item ring2
  16453. @item all
  16454. @item max_frames, m
  16455. Set the maximum number of frames generated for each test, default value is 30.
  16456. @end table
  16457. Default value is "all", which will cycle through the list of all tests.
  16458. @end table
  16459. Some examples:
  16460. @example
  16461. mptestsrc=t=dc_luma
  16462. @end example
  16463. will generate a "dc_luma" test pattern.
  16464. @section frei0r_src
  16465. Provide a frei0r source.
  16466. To enable compilation of this filter you need to install the frei0r
  16467. header and configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-frei0r}.
  16468. This source accepts the following parameters:
  16469. @table @option
  16470. @item size
  16471. The size of the video to generate. For the syntax of this option, check the
  16472. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16473. @item framerate
  16474. The framerate of the generated video. It may be a string of the form
  16475. @var{num}/@var{den} or a frame rate abbreviation.
  16476. @item filter_name
  16477. The name to the frei0r source to load. For more information regarding frei0r and
  16478. how to set the parameters, read the @ref{frei0r} section in the video filters
  16479. documentation.
  16480. @item filter_params
  16481. A '|'-separated list of parameters to pass to the frei0r source.
  16482. @end table
  16483. For example, to generate a frei0r partik0l source with size 200x200
  16484. and frame rate 10 which is overlaid on the overlay filter main input:
  16485. @example
  16486. frei0r_src=size=200x200:framerate=10:filter_name=partik0l:filter_params=1234 [overlay]; [in][overlay] overlay
  16487. @end example
  16488. @section life
  16489. Generate a life pattern.
  16490. This source is based on a generalization of John Conway's life game.
  16491. The sourced input represents a life grid, each pixel represents a cell
  16492. which can be in one of two possible states, alive or dead. Every cell
  16493. interacts with its eight neighbours, which are the cells that are
  16494. horizontally, vertically, or diagonally adjacent.
  16495. At each interaction the grid evolves according to the adopted rule,
  16496. which specifies the number of neighbor alive cells which will make a
  16497. cell stay alive or born. The @option{rule} option allows one to specify
  16498. the rule to adopt.
  16499. This source accepts the following options:
  16500. @table @option
  16501. @item filename, f
  16502. Set the file from which to read the initial grid state. In the file,
  16503. each non-whitespace character is considered an alive cell, and newline
  16504. is used to delimit the end of each row.
  16505. If this option is not specified, the initial grid is generated
  16506. randomly.
  16507. @item rate, r
  16508. Set the video rate, that is the number of frames generated per second.
  16509. Default is 25.
  16510. @item random_fill_ratio, ratio
  16511. Set the random fill ratio for the initial random grid. It is a
  16512. floating point number value ranging from 0 to 1, defaults to 1/PHI.
  16513. It is ignored when a file is specified.
  16514. @item random_seed, seed
  16515. Set the seed for filling the initial random grid, must be an integer
  16516. included between 0 and UINT32_MAX. If not specified, or if explicitly
  16517. set to -1, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a best
  16518. effort basis.
  16519. @item rule
  16520. Set the life rule.
  16521. A rule can be specified with a code of the kind "S@var{NS}/B@var{NB}",
  16522. where @var{NS} and @var{NB} are sequences of numbers in the range 0-8,
  16523. @var{NS} specifies the number of alive neighbor cells which make a
  16524. live cell stay alive, and @var{NB} the number of alive neighbor cells
  16525. which make a dead cell to become alive (i.e. to "born").
  16526. "s" and "b" can be used in place of "S" and "B", respectively.
  16527. Alternatively a rule can be specified by an 18-bits integer. The 9
  16528. high order bits are used to encode the next cell state if it is alive
  16529. for each number of neighbor alive cells, the low order bits specify
  16530. the rule for "borning" new cells. Higher order bits encode for an
  16531. higher number of neighbor cells.
  16532. For example the number 6153 = @code{(12<<9)+9} specifies a stay alive
  16533. rule of 12 and a born rule of 9, which corresponds to "S23/B03".
  16534. Default value is "S23/B3", which is the original Conway's game of life
  16535. rule, and will keep a cell alive if it has 2 or 3 neighbor alive
  16536. cells, and will born a new cell if there are three alive cells around
  16537. a dead cell.
  16538. @item size, s
  16539. Set the size of the output video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  16540. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16541. If @option{filename} is specified, the size is set by default to the
  16542. same size of the input file. If @option{size} is set, it must contain
  16543. the size specified in the input file, and the initial grid defined in
  16544. that file is centered in the larger resulting area.
  16545. If a filename is not specified, the size value defaults to "320x240"
  16546. (used for a randomly generated initial grid).
  16547. @item stitch
  16548. If set to 1, stitch the left and right grid edges together, and the
  16549. top and bottom edges also. Defaults to 1.
  16550. @item mold
  16551. Set cell mold speed. If set, a dead cell will go from @option{death_color} to
  16552. @option{mold_color} with a step of @option{mold}. @option{mold} can have a
  16553. value from 0 to 255.
  16554. @item life_color
  16555. Set the color of living (or new born) cells.
  16556. @item death_color
  16557. Set the color of dead cells. If @option{mold} is set, this is the first color
  16558. used to represent a dead cell.
  16559. @item mold_color
  16560. Set mold color, for definitely dead and moldy cells.
  16561. For the syntax of these 3 color options, check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the
  16562. ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16563. @end table
  16564. @subsection Examples
  16565. @itemize
  16566. @item
  16567. Read a grid from @file{pattern}, and center it on a grid of size
  16568. 300x300 pixels:
  16569. @example
  16570. life=f=pattern:s=300x300
  16571. @end example
  16572. @item
  16573. Generate a random grid of size 200x200, with a fill ratio of 2/3:
  16574. @example
  16575. life=ratio=2/3:s=200x200
  16576. @end example
  16577. @item
  16578. Specify a custom rule for evolving a randomly generated grid:
  16579. @example
  16580. life=rule=S14/B34
  16581. @end example
  16582. @item
  16583. Full example with slow death effect (mold) using @command{ffplay}:
  16584. @example
  16585. ffplay -f lavfi life=s=300x200:mold=10:r=60:ratio=0.1:death_color=#C83232:life_color=#00ff00,scale=1200:800:flags=16
  16586. @end example
  16587. @end itemize
  16588. @anchor{allrgb}
  16589. @anchor{allyuv}
  16590. @anchor{color}
  16591. @anchor{haldclutsrc}
  16592. @anchor{nullsrc}
  16593. @anchor{pal75bars}
  16594. @anchor{pal100bars}
  16595. @anchor{rgbtestsrc}
  16596. @anchor{smptebars}
  16597. @anchor{smptehdbars}
  16598. @anchor{testsrc}
  16599. @anchor{testsrc2}
  16600. @anchor{yuvtestsrc}
  16601. @section allrgb, allyuv, color, haldclutsrc, nullsrc, pal75bars, pal100bars, rgbtestsrc, smptebars, smptehdbars, testsrc, testsrc2, yuvtestsrc
  16602. The @code{allrgb} source returns frames of size 4096x4096 of all rgb colors.
  16603. The @code{allyuv} source returns frames of size 4096x4096 of all yuv colors.
  16604. The @code{color} source provides an uniformly colored input.
  16605. The @code{haldclutsrc} source provides an identity Hald CLUT. See also
  16606. @ref{haldclut} filter.
  16607. The @code{nullsrc} source returns unprocessed video frames. It is
  16608. mainly useful to be employed in analysis / debugging tools, or as the
  16609. source for filters which ignore the input data.
  16610. The @code{pal75bars} source generates a color bars pattern, based on
  16611. EBU PAL recommendations with 75% color levels.
  16612. The @code{pal100bars} source generates a color bars pattern, based on
  16613. EBU PAL recommendations with 100% color levels.
  16614. The @code{rgbtestsrc} source generates an RGB test pattern useful for
  16615. detecting RGB vs BGR issues. You should see a red, green and blue
  16616. stripe from top to bottom.
  16617. The @code{smptebars} source generates a color bars pattern, based on
  16618. the SMPTE Engineering Guideline EG 1-1990.
  16619. The @code{smptehdbars} source generates a color bars pattern, based on
  16620. the SMPTE RP 219-2002.
  16621. The @code{testsrc} source generates a test video pattern, showing a
  16622. color pattern, a scrolling gradient and a timestamp. This is mainly
  16623. intended for testing purposes.
  16624. The @code{testsrc2} source is similar to testsrc, but supports more
  16625. pixel formats instead of just @code{rgb24}. This allows using it as an
  16626. input for other tests without requiring a format conversion.
  16627. The @code{yuvtestsrc} source generates an YUV test pattern. You should
  16628. see a y, cb and cr stripe from top to bottom.
  16629. The sources accept the following parameters:
  16630. @table @option
  16631. @item level
  16632. Specify the level of the Hald CLUT, only available in the @code{haldclutsrc}
  16633. source. A level of @code{N} generates a picture of @code{N*N*N} by @code{N*N*N}
  16634. pixels to be used as identity matrix for 3D lookup tables. Each component is
  16635. coded on a @code{1/(N*N)} scale.
  16636. @item color, c
  16637. Specify the color of the source, only available in the @code{color}
  16638. source. For the syntax of this option, check the
  16639. @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16640. @item size, s
  16641. Specify the size of the sourced video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  16642. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16643. The default value is @code{320x240}.
  16644. This option is not available with the @code{allrgb}, @code{allyuv}, and
  16645. @code{haldclutsrc} filters.
  16646. @item rate, r
  16647. Specify the frame rate of the sourced video, as the number of frames
  16648. generated per second. It has to be a string in the format
  16649. @var{frame_rate_num}/@var{frame_rate_den}, an integer number, a floating point
  16650. number or a valid video frame rate abbreviation. The default value is
  16651. "25".
  16652. @item duration, d
  16653. Set the duration of the sourced video. See
  16654. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  16655. for the accepted syntax.
  16656. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the video is
  16657. supposed to be generated forever.
  16658. @item sar
  16659. Set the sample aspect ratio of the sourced video.
  16660. @item alpha
  16661. Specify the alpha (opacity) of the background, only available in the
  16662. @code{testsrc2} source. The value must be between 0 (fully transparent) and
  16663. 255 (fully opaque, the default).
  16664. @item decimals, n
  16665. Set the number of decimals to show in the timestamp, only available in the
  16666. @code{testsrc} source.
  16667. The displayed timestamp value will correspond to the original
  16668. timestamp value multiplied by the power of 10 of the specified
  16669. value. Default value is 0.
  16670. @end table
  16671. @subsection Examples
  16672. @itemize
  16673. @item
  16674. Generate a video with a duration of 5.3 seconds, with size
  16675. 176x144 and a frame rate of 10 frames per second:
  16676. @example
  16677. testsrc=duration=5.3:size=qcif:rate=10
  16678. @end example
  16679. @item
  16680. The following graph description will generate a red source
  16681. with an opacity of 0.2, with size "qcif" and a frame rate of 10
  16682. frames per second:
  16683. @example
  16684. color=c=red@@0.2:s=qcif:r=10
  16685. @end example
  16686. @item
  16687. If the input content is to be ignored, @code{nullsrc} can be used. The
  16688. following command generates noise in the luminance plane by employing
  16689. the @code{geq} filter:
  16690. @example
  16691. nullsrc=s=256x256, geq=random(1)*255:128:128
  16692. @end example
  16693. @end itemize
  16694. @subsection Commands
  16695. The @code{color} source supports the following commands:
  16696. @table @option
  16697. @item c, color
  16698. Set the color of the created image. Accepts the same syntax of the
  16699. corresponding @option{color} option.
  16700. @end table
  16701. @section openclsrc
  16702. Generate video using an OpenCL program.
  16703. @table @option
  16704. @item source
  16705. OpenCL program source file.
  16706. @item kernel
  16707. Kernel name in program.
  16708. @item size, s
  16709. Size of frames to generate. This must be set.
  16710. @item format
  16711. Pixel format to use for the generated frames. This must be set.
  16712. @item rate, r
  16713. Number of frames generated every second. Default value is '25'.
  16714. @end table
  16715. For details of how the program loading works, see the @ref{program_opencl}
  16716. filter.
  16717. Example programs:
  16718. @itemize
  16719. @item
  16720. Generate a colour ramp by setting pixel values from the position of the pixel
  16721. in the output image. (Note that this will work with all pixel formats, but
  16722. the generated output will not be the same.)
  16723. @verbatim
  16724. __kernel void ramp(__write_only image2d_t dst,
  16725. unsigned int index)
  16726. {
  16727. int2 loc = (int2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
  16728. float4 val;
  16729. val.xy = val.zw = convert_float2(loc) / convert_float2(get_image_dim(dst));
  16730. write_imagef(dst, loc, val);
  16731. }
  16732. @end verbatim
  16733. @item
  16734. Generate a Sierpinski carpet pattern, panning by a single pixel each frame.
  16735. @verbatim
  16736. __kernel void sierpinski_carpet(__write_only image2d_t dst,
  16737. unsigned int index)
  16738. {
  16739. int2 loc = (int2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
  16740. float4 value = 0.0f;
  16741. int x = loc.x + index;
  16742. int y = loc.y + index;
  16743. while (x > 0 || y > 0) {
  16744. if (x % 3 == 1 && y % 3 == 1) {
  16745. value = 1.0f;
  16746. break;
  16747. }
  16748. x /= 3;
  16749. y /= 3;
  16750. }
  16751. write_imagef(dst, loc, value);
  16752. }
  16753. @end verbatim
  16754. @end itemize
  16755. @section sierpinski
  16756. Generate a Sierpinski carpet/triangle fractal, and randomly pan around.
  16757. This source accepts the following options:
  16758. @table @option
  16759. @item size, s
  16760. Set frame size. For the syntax of this option, check the @ref{video size syntax,,"Video
  16761. size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}. Default value is "640x480".
  16762. @item rate, r
  16763. Set frame rate, expressed as number of frames per second. Default
  16764. value is "25".
  16765. @item seed
  16766. Set seed which is used for random panning.
  16767. @item jump
  16768. Set max jump for single pan destination. Allowed range is from 1 to 10000.
  16769. @item type
  16770. Set fractal type, can be default @code{carpet} or @code{triangle}.
  16771. @end table
  16772. @c man end VIDEO SOURCES
  16773. @chapter Video Sinks
  16774. @c man begin VIDEO SINKS
  16775. Below is a description of the currently available video sinks.
  16776. @section buffersink
  16777. Buffer video frames, and make them available to the end of the filter
  16778. graph.
  16779. This sink is mainly intended for programmatic use, in particular
  16780. through the interface defined in @file{libavfilter/buffersink.h}
  16781. or the options system.
  16782. It accepts a pointer to an AVBufferSinkContext structure, which
  16783. defines the incoming buffers' formats, to be passed as the opaque
  16784. parameter to @code{avfilter_init_filter} for initialization.
  16785. @section nullsink
  16786. Null video sink: do absolutely nothing with the input video. It is
  16787. mainly useful as a template and for use in analysis / debugging
  16788. tools.
  16789. @c man end VIDEO SINKS
  16790. @chapter Multimedia Filters
  16791. @c man begin MULTIMEDIA FILTERS
  16792. Below is a description of the currently available multimedia filters.
  16793. @section abitscope
  16794. Convert input audio to a video output, displaying the audio bit scope.
  16795. The filter accepts the following options:
  16796. @table @option
  16797. @item rate, r
  16798. Set frame rate, expressed as number of frames per second. Default
  16799. value is "25".
  16800. @item size, s
  16801. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  16802. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16803. Default value is @code{1024x256}.
  16804. @item colors
  16805. Specify list of colors separated by space or by '|' which will be used to
  16806. draw channels. Unrecognized or missing colors will be replaced
  16807. by white color.
  16808. @end table
  16809. @section adrawgraph
  16810. Draw a graph using input audio metadata.
  16811. See @ref{drawgraph}
  16812. @section agraphmonitor
  16813. See @ref{graphmonitor}.
  16814. @section ahistogram
  16815. Convert input audio to a video output, displaying the volume histogram.
  16816. The filter accepts the following options:
  16817. @table @option
  16818. @item dmode
  16819. Specify how histogram is calculated.
  16820. It accepts the following values:
  16821. @table @samp
  16822. @item single
  16823. Use single histogram for all channels.
  16824. @item separate
  16825. Use separate histogram for each channel.
  16826. @end table
  16827. Default is @code{single}.
  16828. @item rate, r
  16829. Set frame rate, expressed as number of frames per second. Default
  16830. value is "25".
  16831. @item size, s
  16832. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  16833. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16834. Default value is @code{hd720}.
  16835. @item scale
  16836. Set display scale.
  16837. It accepts the following values:
  16838. @table @samp
  16839. @item log
  16840. logarithmic
  16841. @item sqrt
  16842. square root
  16843. @item cbrt
  16844. cubic root
  16845. @item lin
  16846. linear
  16847. @item rlog
  16848. reverse logarithmic
  16849. @end table
  16850. Default is @code{log}.
  16851. @item ascale
  16852. Set amplitude scale.
  16853. It accepts the following values:
  16854. @table @samp
  16855. @item log
  16856. logarithmic
  16857. @item lin
  16858. linear
  16859. @end table
  16860. Default is @code{log}.
  16861. @item acount
  16862. Set how much frames to accumulate in histogram.
  16863. Default is 1. Setting this to -1 accumulates all frames.
  16864. @item rheight
  16865. Set histogram ratio of window height.
  16866. @item slide
  16867. Set sonogram sliding.
  16868. It accepts the following values:
  16869. @table @samp
  16870. @item replace
  16871. replace old rows with new ones.
  16872. @item scroll
  16873. scroll from top to bottom.
  16874. @end table
  16875. Default is @code{replace}.
  16876. @end table
  16877. @section aphasemeter
  16878. Measures phase of input audio, which is exported as metadata @code{lavfi.aphasemeter.phase},
  16879. representing mean phase of current audio frame. A video output can also be produced and is
  16880. enabled by default. The audio is passed through as first output.
  16881. Audio will be rematrixed to stereo if it has a different channel layout. Phase value is in
  16882. range @code{[-1, 1]} where @code{-1} means left and right channels are completely out of phase
  16883. and @code{1} means channels are in phase.
  16884. The filter accepts the following options, all related to its video output:
  16885. @table @option
  16886. @item rate, r
  16887. Set the output frame rate. Default value is @code{25}.
  16888. @item size, s
  16889. Set the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  16890. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16891. Default value is @code{800x400}.
  16892. @item rc
  16893. @item gc
  16894. @item bc
  16895. Specify the red, green, blue contrast. Default values are @code{2},
  16896. @code{7} and @code{1}.
  16897. Allowed range is @code{[0, 255]}.
  16898. @item mpc
  16899. Set color which will be used for drawing median phase. If color is
  16900. @code{none} which is default, no median phase value will be drawn.
  16901. @item video
  16902. Enable video output. Default is enabled.
  16903. @end table
  16904. @section avectorscope
  16905. Convert input audio to a video output, representing the audio vector
  16906. scope.
  16907. The filter is used to measure the difference between channels of stereo
  16908. audio stream. A monaural signal, consisting of identical left and right
  16909. signal, results in straight vertical line. Any stereo separation is visible
  16910. as a deviation from this line, creating a Lissajous figure.
  16911. If the straight (or deviation from it) but horizontal line appears this
  16912. indicates that the left and right channels are out of phase.
  16913. The filter accepts the following options:
  16914. @table @option
  16915. @item mode, m
  16916. Set the vectorscope mode.
  16917. Available values are:
  16918. @table @samp
  16919. @item lissajous
  16920. Lissajous rotated by 45 degrees.
  16921. @item lissajous_xy
  16922. Same as above but not rotated.
  16923. @item polar
  16924. Shape resembling half of circle.
  16925. @end table
  16926. Default value is @samp{lissajous}.
  16927. @item size, s
  16928. Set the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  16929. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16930. Default value is @code{400x400}.
  16931. @item rate, r
  16932. Set the output frame rate. Default value is @code{25}.
  16933. @item rc
  16934. @item gc
  16935. @item bc
  16936. @item ac
  16937. Specify the red, green, blue and alpha contrast. Default values are @code{40},
  16938. @code{160}, @code{80} and @code{255}.
  16939. Allowed range is @code{[0, 255]}.
  16940. @item rf
  16941. @item gf
  16942. @item bf
  16943. @item af
  16944. Specify the red, green, blue and alpha fade. Default values are @code{15},
  16945. @code{10}, @code{5} and @code{5}.
  16946. Allowed range is @code{[0, 255]}.
  16947. @item zoom
  16948. Set the zoom factor. Default value is @code{1}. Allowed range is @code{[0, 10]}.
  16949. Values lower than @var{1} will auto adjust zoom factor to maximal possible value.
  16950. @item draw
  16951. Set the vectorscope drawing mode.
  16952. Available values are:
  16953. @table @samp
  16954. @item dot
  16955. Draw dot for each sample.
  16956. @item line
  16957. Draw line between previous and current sample.
  16958. @end table
  16959. Default value is @samp{dot}.
  16960. @item scale
  16961. Specify amplitude scale of audio samples.
  16962. Available values are:
  16963. @table @samp
  16964. @item lin
  16965. Linear.
  16966. @item sqrt
  16967. Square root.
  16968. @item cbrt
  16969. Cubic root.
  16970. @item log
  16971. Logarithmic.
  16972. @end table
  16973. @item swap
  16974. Swap left channel axis with right channel axis.
  16975. @item mirror
  16976. Mirror axis.
  16977. @table @samp
  16978. @item none
  16979. No mirror.
  16980. @item x
  16981. Mirror only x axis.
  16982. @item y
  16983. Mirror only y axis.
  16984. @item xy
  16985. Mirror both axis.
  16986. @end table
  16987. @end table
  16988. @subsection Examples
  16989. @itemize
  16990. @item
  16991. Complete example using @command{ffplay}:
  16992. @example
  16993. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=input.mp3, asplit [a][out1];
  16994. [a] avectorscope=zoom=1.3:rc=2:gc=200:bc=10:rf=1:gf=8:bf=7 [out0]'
  16995. @end example
  16996. @end itemize
  16997. @section bench, abench
  16998. Benchmark part of a filtergraph.
  16999. The filter accepts the following options:
  17000. @table @option
  17001. @item action
  17002. Start or stop a timer.
  17003. Available values are:
  17004. @table @samp
  17005. @item start
  17006. Get the current time, set it as frame metadata (using the key
  17007. @code{lavfi.bench.start_time}), and forward the frame to the next filter.
  17008. @item stop
  17009. Get the current time and fetch the @code{lavfi.bench.start_time} metadata from
  17010. the input frame metadata to get the time difference. Time difference, average,
  17011. maximum and minimum time (respectively @code{t}, @code{avg}, @code{max} and
  17012. @code{min}) are then printed. The timestamps are expressed in seconds.
  17013. @end table
  17014. @end table
  17015. @subsection Examples
  17016. @itemize
  17017. @item
  17018. Benchmark @ref{selectivecolor} filter:
  17019. @example
  17020. bench=start,selectivecolor=reds=-.2 .12 -.49,bench=stop
  17021. @end example
  17022. @end itemize
  17023. @section concat
  17024. Concatenate audio and video streams, joining them together one after the
  17025. other.
  17026. The filter works on segments of synchronized video and audio streams. All
  17027. segments must have the same number of streams of each type, and that will
  17028. also be the number of streams at output.
  17029. The filter accepts the following options:
  17030. @table @option
  17031. @item n
  17032. Set the number of segments. Default is 2.
  17033. @item v
  17034. Set the number of output video streams, that is also the number of video
  17035. streams in each segment. Default is 1.
  17036. @item a
  17037. Set the number of output audio streams, that is also the number of audio
  17038. streams in each segment. Default is 0.
  17039. @item unsafe
  17040. Activate unsafe mode: do not fail if segments have a different format.
  17041. @end table
  17042. The filter has @var{v}+@var{a} outputs: first @var{v} video outputs, then
  17043. @var{a} audio outputs.
  17044. There are @var{n}x(@var{v}+@var{a}) inputs: first the inputs for the first
  17045. segment, in the same order as the outputs, then the inputs for the second
  17046. segment, etc.
  17047. Related streams do not always have exactly the same duration, for various
  17048. reasons including codec frame size or sloppy authoring. For that reason,
  17049. related synchronized streams (e.g. a video and its audio track) should be
  17050. concatenated at once. The concat filter will use the duration of the longest
  17051. stream in each segment (except the last one), and if necessary pad shorter
  17052. audio streams with silence.
  17053. For this filter to work correctly, all segments must start at timestamp 0.
  17054. All corresponding streams must have the same parameters in all segments; the
  17055. filtering system will automatically select a common pixel format for video
  17056. streams, and a common sample format, sample rate and channel layout for
  17057. audio streams, but other settings, such as resolution, must be converted
  17058. explicitly by the user.
  17059. Different frame rates are acceptable but will result in variable frame rate
  17060. at output; be sure to configure the output file to handle it.
  17061. @subsection Examples
  17062. @itemize
  17063. @item
  17064. Concatenate an opening, an episode and an ending, all in bilingual version
  17065. (video in stream 0, audio in streams 1 and 2):
  17066. @example
  17067. ffmpeg -i opening.mkv -i episode.mkv -i ending.mkv -filter_complex \
  17068. '[0:0] [0:1] [0:2] [1:0] [1:1] [1:2] [2:0] [2:1] [2:2]
  17069. concat=n=3:v=1:a=2 [v] [a1] [a2]' \
  17070. -map '[v]' -map '[a1]' -map '[a2]' output.mkv
  17071. @end example
  17072. @item
  17073. Concatenate two parts, handling audio and video separately, using the
  17074. (a)movie sources, and adjusting the resolution:
  17075. @example
  17076. movie=part1.mp4, scale=512:288 [v1] ; amovie=part1.mp4 [a1] ;
  17077. movie=part2.mp4, scale=512:288 [v2] ; amovie=part2.mp4 [a2] ;
  17078. [v1] [v2] concat [outv] ; [a1] [a2] concat=v=0:a=1 [outa]
  17079. @end example
  17080. Note that a desync will happen at the stitch if the audio and video streams
  17081. do not have exactly the same duration in the first file.
  17082. @end itemize
  17083. @subsection Commands
  17084. This filter supports the following commands:
  17085. @table @option
  17086. @item next
  17087. Close the current segment and step to the next one
  17088. @end table
  17089. @anchor{ebur128}
  17090. @section ebur128
  17091. EBU R128 scanner filter. This filter takes an audio stream and analyzes its loudness
  17092. level. By default, it logs a message at a frequency of 10Hz with the
  17093. Momentary loudness (identified by @code{M}), Short-term loudness (@code{S}),
  17094. Integrated loudness (@code{I}) and Loudness Range (@code{LRA}).
  17095. The filter can only analyze streams which have a sampling rate of 48000 Hz and whose
  17096. sample format is double-precision floating point. The input stream will be converted to
  17097. this specification, if needed. Users may need to insert aformat and/or aresample filters
  17098. after this filter to obtain the original parameters.
  17099. The filter also has a video output (see the @var{video} option) with a real
  17100. time graph to observe the loudness evolution. The graphic contains the logged
  17101. message mentioned above, so it is not printed anymore when this option is set,
  17102. unless the verbose logging is set. The main graphing area contains the
  17103. short-term loudness (3 seconds of analysis), and the gauge on the right is for
  17104. the momentary loudness (400 milliseconds), but can optionally be configured
  17105. to instead display short-term loudness (see @var{gauge}).
  17106. The green area marks a +/- 1LU target range around the target loudness
  17107. (-23LUFS by default, unless modified through @var{target}).
  17108. More information about the Loudness Recommendation EBU R128 on
  17109. @url{http://tech.ebu.ch/loudness}.
  17110. The filter accepts the following options:
  17111. @table @option
  17112. @item video
  17113. Activate the video output. The audio stream is passed unchanged whether this
  17114. option is set or no. The video stream will be the first output stream if
  17115. activated. Default is @code{0}.
  17116. @item size
  17117. Set the video size. This option is for video only. For the syntax of this
  17118. option, check the
  17119. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17120. Default and minimum resolution is @code{640x480}.
  17121. @item meter
  17122. Set the EBU scale meter. Default is @code{9}. Common values are @code{9} and
  17123. @code{18}, respectively for EBU scale meter +9 and EBU scale meter +18. Any
  17124. other integer value between this range is allowed.
  17125. @item metadata
  17126. Set metadata injection. If set to @code{1}, the audio input will be segmented
  17127. into 100ms output frames, each of them containing various loudness information
  17128. in metadata. All the metadata keys are prefixed with @code{lavfi.r128.}.
  17129. Default is @code{0}.
  17130. @item framelog
  17131. Force the frame logging level.
  17132. Available values are:
  17133. @table @samp
  17134. @item info
  17135. information logging level
  17136. @item verbose
  17137. verbose logging level
  17138. @end table
  17139. By default, the logging level is set to @var{info}. If the @option{video} or
  17140. the @option{metadata} options are set, it switches to @var{verbose}.
  17141. @item peak
  17142. Set peak mode(s).
  17143. Available modes can be cumulated (the option is a @code{flag} type). Possible
  17144. values are:
  17145. @table @samp
  17146. @item none
  17147. Disable any peak mode (default).
  17148. @item sample
  17149. Enable sample-peak mode.
  17150. Simple peak mode looking for the higher sample value. It logs a message
  17151. for sample-peak (identified by @code{SPK}).
  17152. @item true
  17153. Enable true-peak mode.
  17154. If enabled, the peak lookup is done on an over-sampled version of the input
  17155. stream for better peak accuracy. It logs a message for true-peak.
  17156. (identified by @code{TPK}) and true-peak per frame (identified by @code{FTPK}).
  17157. This mode requires a build with @code{libswresample}.
  17158. @end table
  17159. @item dualmono
  17160. Treat mono input files as "dual mono". If a mono file is intended for playback
  17161. on a stereo system, its EBU R128 measurement will be perceptually incorrect.
  17162. If set to @code{true}, this option will compensate for this effect.
  17163. Multi-channel input files are not affected by this option.
  17164. @item panlaw
  17165. Set a specific pan law to be used for the measurement of dual mono files.
  17166. This parameter is optional, and has a default value of -3.01dB.
  17167. @item target
  17168. Set a specific target level (in LUFS) used as relative zero in the visualization.
  17169. This parameter is optional and has a default value of -23LUFS as specified
  17170. by EBU R128. However, material published online may prefer a level of -16LUFS
  17171. (e.g. for use with podcasts or video platforms).
  17172. @item gauge
  17173. Set the value displayed by the gauge. Valid values are @code{momentary} and s
  17174. @code{shortterm}. By default the momentary value will be used, but in certain
  17175. scenarios it may be more useful to observe the short term value instead (e.g.
  17176. live mixing).
  17177. @item scale
  17178. Sets the display scale for the loudness. Valid parameters are @code{absolute}
  17179. (in LUFS) or @code{relative} (LU) relative to the target. This only affects the
  17180. video output, not the summary or continuous log output.
  17181. @end table
  17182. @subsection Examples
  17183. @itemize
  17184. @item
  17185. Real-time graph using @command{ffplay}, with a EBU scale meter +18:
  17186. @example
  17187. ffplay -f lavfi -i "amovie=input.mp3,ebur128=video=1:meter=18 [out0][out1]"
  17188. @end example
  17189. @item
  17190. Run an analysis with @command{ffmpeg}:
  17191. @example
  17192. ffmpeg -nostats -i input.mp3 -filter_complex ebur128 -f null -
  17193. @end example
  17194. @end itemize
  17195. @section interleave, ainterleave
  17196. Temporally interleave frames from several inputs.
  17197. @code{interleave} works with video inputs, @code{ainterleave} with audio.
  17198. These filters read frames from several inputs and send the oldest
  17199. queued frame to the output.
  17200. Input streams must have well defined, monotonically increasing frame
  17201. timestamp values.
  17202. In order to submit one frame to output, these filters need to enqueue
  17203. at least one frame for each input, so they cannot work in case one
  17204. input is not yet terminated and will not receive incoming frames.
  17205. For example consider the case when one input is a @code{select} filter
  17206. which always drops input frames. The @code{interleave} filter will keep
  17207. reading from that input, but it will never be able to send new frames
  17208. to output until the input sends an end-of-stream signal.
  17209. Also, depending on inputs synchronization, the filters will drop
  17210. frames in case one input receives more frames than the other ones, and
  17211. the queue is already filled.
  17212. These filters accept the following options:
  17213. @table @option
  17214. @item nb_inputs, n
  17215. Set the number of different inputs, it is 2 by default.
  17216. @end table
  17217. @subsection Examples
  17218. @itemize
  17219. @item
  17220. Interleave frames belonging to different streams using @command{ffmpeg}:
  17221. @example
  17222. ffmpeg -i bambi.avi -i pr0n.mkv -filter_complex "[0:v][1:v] interleave" out.avi
  17223. @end example
  17224. @item
  17225. Add flickering blur effect:
  17226. @example
  17227. select='if(gt(random(0), 0.2), 1, 2)':n=2 [tmp], boxblur=2:2, [tmp] interleave
  17228. @end example
  17229. @end itemize
  17230. @section metadata, ametadata
  17231. Manipulate frame metadata.
  17232. This filter accepts the following options:
  17233. @table @option
  17234. @item mode
  17235. Set mode of operation of the filter.
  17236. Can be one of the following:
  17237. @table @samp
  17238. @item select
  17239. If both @code{value} and @code{key} is set, select frames
  17240. which have such metadata. If only @code{key} is set, select
  17241. every frame that has such key in metadata.
  17242. @item add
  17243. Add new metadata @code{key} and @code{value}. If key is already available
  17244. do nothing.
  17245. @item modify
  17246. Modify value of already present key.
  17247. @item delete
  17248. If @code{value} is set, delete only keys that have such value.
  17249. Otherwise, delete key. If @code{key} is not set, delete all metadata values in
  17250. the frame.
  17251. @item print
  17252. Print key and its value if metadata was found. If @code{key} is not set print all
  17253. metadata values available in frame.
  17254. @end table
  17255. @item key
  17256. Set key used with all modes. Must be set for all modes except @code{print} and @code{delete}.
  17257. @item value
  17258. Set metadata value which will be used. This option is mandatory for
  17259. @code{modify} and @code{add} mode.
  17260. @item function
  17261. Which function to use when comparing metadata value and @code{value}.
  17262. Can be one of following:
  17263. @table @samp
  17264. @item same_str
  17265. Values are interpreted as strings, returns true if metadata value is same as @code{value}.
  17266. @item starts_with
  17267. Values are interpreted as strings, returns true if metadata value starts with
  17268. the @code{value} option string.
  17269. @item less
  17270. Values are interpreted as floats, returns true if metadata value is less than @code{value}.
  17271. @item equal
  17272. Values are interpreted as floats, returns true if @code{value} is equal with metadata value.
  17273. @item greater
  17274. Values are interpreted as floats, returns true if metadata value is greater than @code{value}.
  17275. @item expr
  17276. Values are interpreted as floats, returns true if expression from option @code{expr}
  17277. evaluates to true.
  17278. @item ends_with
  17279. Values are interpreted as strings, returns true if metadata value ends with
  17280. the @code{value} option string.
  17281. @end table
  17282. @item expr
  17283. Set expression which is used when @code{function} is set to @code{expr}.
  17284. The expression is evaluated through the eval API and can contain the following
  17285. constants:
  17286. @table @option
  17287. @item VALUE1
  17288. Float representation of @code{value} from metadata key.
  17289. @item VALUE2
  17290. Float representation of @code{value} as supplied by user in @code{value} option.
  17291. @end table
  17292. @item file
  17293. If specified in @code{print} mode, output is written to the named file. Instead of
  17294. plain filename any writable url can be specified. Filename ``-'' is a shorthand
  17295. for standard output. If @code{file} option is not set, output is written to the log
  17296. with AV_LOG_INFO loglevel.
  17297. @item direct
  17298. Reduces buffering in print mode when output is written to a URL set using @var{file}.
  17299. @end table
  17300. @subsection Examples
  17301. @itemize
  17302. @item
  17303. Print all metadata values for frames with key @code{lavfi.signalstats.YDIF} with values
  17304. between 0 and 1.
  17305. @example
  17306. signalstats,metadata=print:key=lavfi.signalstats.YDIF:value=0:function=expr:expr='between(VALUE1,0,1)'
  17307. @end example
  17308. @item
  17309. Print silencedetect output to file @file{metadata.txt}.
  17310. @example
  17311. silencedetect,ametadata=mode=print:file=metadata.txt
  17312. @end example
  17313. @item
  17314. Direct all metadata to a pipe with file descriptor 4.
  17315. @example
  17316. metadata=mode=print:file='pipe\:4'
  17317. @end example
  17318. @end itemize
  17319. @section perms, aperms
  17320. Set read/write permissions for the output frames.
  17321. These filters are mainly aimed at developers to test direct path in the
  17322. following filter in the filtergraph.
  17323. The filters accept the following options:
  17324. @table @option
  17325. @item mode
  17326. Select the permissions mode.
  17327. It accepts the following values:
  17328. @table @samp
  17329. @item none
  17330. Do nothing. This is the default.
  17331. @item ro
  17332. Set all the output frames read-only.
  17333. @item rw
  17334. Set all the output frames directly writable.
  17335. @item toggle
  17336. Make the frame read-only if writable, and writable if read-only.
  17337. @item random
  17338. Set each output frame read-only or writable randomly.
  17339. @end table
  17340. @item seed
  17341. Set the seed for the @var{random} mode, must be an integer included between
  17342. @code{0} and @code{UINT32_MAX}. If not specified, or if explicitly set to
  17343. @code{-1}, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a best effort
  17344. basis.
  17345. @end table
  17346. Note: in case of auto-inserted filter between the permission filter and the
  17347. following one, the permission might not be received as expected in that
  17348. following filter. Inserting a @ref{format} or @ref{aformat} filter before the
  17349. perms/aperms filter can avoid this problem.
  17350. @section realtime, arealtime
  17351. Slow down filtering to match real time approximately.
  17352. These filters will pause the filtering for a variable amount of time to
  17353. match the output rate with the input timestamps.
  17354. They are similar to the @option{re} option to @code{ffmpeg}.
  17355. They accept the following options:
  17356. @table @option
  17357. @item limit
  17358. Time limit for the pauses. Any pause longer than that will be considered
  17359. a timestamp discontinuity and reset the timer. Default is 2 seconds.
  17360. @item speed
  17361. Speed factor for processing. The value must be a float larger than zero.
  17362. Values larger than 1.0 will result in faster than realtime processing,
  17363. smaller will slow processing down. The @var{limit} is automatically adapted
  17364. accordingly. Default is 1.0.
  17365. A processing speed faster than what is possible without these filters cannot
  17366. be achieved.
  17367. @end table
  17368. @anchor{select}
  17369. @section select, aselect
  17370. Select frames to pass in output.
  17371. This filter accepts the following options:
  17372. @table @option
  17373. @item expr, e
  17374. Set expression, which is evaluated for each input frame.
  17375. If the expression is evaluated to zero, the frame is discarded.
  17376. If the evaluation result is negative or NaN, the frame is sent to the
  17377. first output; otherwise it is sent to the output with index
  17378. @code{ceil(val)-1}, assuming that the input index starts from 0.
  17379. For example a value of @code{1.2} corresponds to the output with index
  17380. @code{ceil(1.2)-1 = 2-1 = 1}, that is the second output.
  17381. @item outputs, n
  17382. Set the number of outputs. The output to which to send the selected
  17383. frame is based on the result of the evaluation. Default value is 1.
  17384. @end table
  17385. The expression can contain the following constants:
  17386. @table @option
  17387. @item n
  17388. The (sequential) number of the filtered frame, starting from 0.
  17389. @item selected_n
  17390. The (sequential) number of the selected frame, starting from 0.
  17391. @item prev_selected_n
  17392. The sequential number of the last selected frame. It's NAN if undefined.
  17393. @item TB
  17394. The timebase of the input timestamps.
  17395. @item pts
  17396. The PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) of the filtered video frame,
  17397. expressed in @var{TB} units. It's NAN if undefined.
  17398. @item t
  17399. The PTS of the filtered video frame,
  17400. expressed in seconds. It's NAN if undefined.
  17401. @item prev_pts
  17402. The PTS of the previously filtered video frame. It's NAN if undefined.
  17403. @item prev_selected_pts
  17404. The PTS of the last previously filtered video frame. It's NAN if undefined.
  17405. @item prev_selected_t
  17406. The PTS of the last previously selected video frame, expressed in seconds. It's NAN if undefined.
  17407. @item start_pts
  17408. The PTS of the first video frame in the video. It's NAN if undefined.
  17409. @item start_t
  17410. The time of the first video frame in the video. It's NAN if undefined.
  17411. @item pict_type @emph{(video only)}
  17412. The type of the filtered frame. It can assume one of the following
  17413. values:
  17414. @table @option
  17415. @item I
  17416. @item P
  17417. @item B
  17418. @item S
  17419. @item SI
  17420. @item SP
  17421. @item BI
  17422. @end table
  17423. @item interlace_type @emph{(video only)}
  17424. The frame interlace type. It can assume one of the following values:
  17425. @table @option
  17426. @item PROGRESSIVE
  17427. The frame is progressive (not interlaced).
  17428. @item TOPFIRST
  17429. The frame is top-field-first.
  17430. @item BOTTOMFIRST
  17431. The frame is bottom-field-first.
  17432. @end table
  17433. @item consumed_sample_n @emph{(audio only)}
  17434. the number of selected samples before the current frame
  17435. @item samples_n @emph{(audio only)}
  17436. the number of samples in the current frame
  17437. @item sample_rate @emph{(audio only)}
  17438. the input sample rate
  17439. @item key
  17440. This is 1 if the filtered frame is a key-frame, 0 otherwise.
  17441. @item pos
  17442. the position in the file of the filtered frame, -1 if the information
  17443. is not available (e.g. for synthetic video)
  17444. @item scene @emph{(video only)}
  17445. value between 0 and 1 to indicate a new scene; a low value reflects a low
  17446. probability for the current frame to introduce a new scene, while a higher
  17447. value means the current frame is more likely to be one (see the example below)
  17448. @item concatdec_select
  17449. The concat demuxer can select only part of a concat input file by setting an
  17450. inpoint and an outpoint, but the output packets may not be entirely contained
  17451. in the selected interval. By using this variable, it is possible to skip frames
  17452. generated by the concat demuxer which are not exactly contained in the selected
  17453. interval.
  17454. This works by comparing the frame pts against the @var{lavf.concat.start_time}
  17455. and the @var{lavf.concat.duration} packet metadata values which are also
  17456. present in the decoded frames.
  17457. The @var{concatdec_select} variable is -1 if the frame pts is at least
  17458. start_time and either the duration metadata is missing or the frame pts is less
  17459. than start_time + duration, 0 otherwise, and NaN if the start_time metadata is
  17460. missing.
  17461. That basically means that an input frame is selected if its pts is within the
  17462. interval set by the concat demuxer.
  17463. @end table
  17464. The default value of the select expression is "1".
  17465. @subsection Examples
  17466. @itemize
  17467. @item
  17468. Select all frames in input:
  17469. @example
  17470. select
  17471. @end example
  17472. The example above is the same as:
  17473. @example
  17474. select=1
  17475. @end example
  17476. @item
  17477. Skip all frames:
  17478. @example
  17479. select=0
  17480. @end example
  17481. @item
  17482. Select only I-frames:
  17483. @example
  17484. select='eq(pict_type\,I)'
  17485. @end example
  17486. @item
  17487. Select one frame every 100:
  17488. @example
  17489. select='not(mod(n\,100))'
  17490. @end example
  17491. @item
  17492. Select only frames contained in the 10-20 time interval:
  17493. @example
  17494. select=between(t\,10\,20)
  17495. @end example
  17496. @item
  17497. Select only I-frames contained in the 10-20 time interval:
  17498. @example
  17499. select=between(t\,10\,20)*eq(pict_type\,I)
  17500. @end example
  17501. @item
  17502. Select frames with a minimum distance of 10 seconds:
  17503. @example
  17504. select='isnan(prev_selected_t)+gte(t-prev_selected_t\,10)'
  17505. @end example
  17506. @item
  17507. Use aselect to select only audio frames with samples number > 100:
  17508. @example
  17509. aselect='gt(samples_n\,100)'
  17510. @end example
  17511. @item
  17512. Create a mosaic of the first scenes:
  17513. @example
  17514. ffmpeg -i video.avi -vf select='gt(scene\,0.4)',scale=160:120,tile -frames:v 1 preview.png
  17515. @end example
  17516. Comparing @var{scene} against a value between 0.3 and 0.5 is generally a sane
  17517. choice.
  17518. @item
  17519. Send even and odd frames to separate outputs, and compose them:
  17520. @example
  17521. select=n=2:e='mod(n, 2)+1' [odd][even]; [odd] pad=h=2*ih [tmp]; [tmp][even] overlay=y=h
  17522. @end example
  17523. @item
  17524. Select useful frames from an ffconcat file which is using inpoints and
  17525. outpoints but where the source files are not intra frame only.
  17526. @example
  17527. ffmpeg -copyts -vsync 0 -segment_time_metadata 1 -i input.ffconcat -vf select=concatdec_select -af aselect=concatdec_select output.avi
  17528. @end example
  17529. @end itemize
  17530. @section sendcmd, asendcmd
  17531. Send commands to filters in the filtergraph.
  17532. These filters read commands to be sent to other filters in the
  17533. filtergraph.
  17534. @code{sendcmd} must be inserted between two video filters,
  17535. @code{asendcmd} must be inserted between two audio filters, but apart
  17536. from that they act the same way.
  17537. The specification of commands can be provided in the filter arguments
  17538. with the @var{commands} option, or in a file specified by the
  17539. @var{filename} option.
  17540. These filters accept the following options:
  17541. @table @option
  17542. @item commands, c
  17543. Set the commands to be read and sent to the other filters.
  17544. @item filename, f
  17545. Set the filename of the commands to be read and sent to the other
  17546. filters.
  17547. @end table
  17548. @subsection Commands syntax
  17549. A commands description consists of a sequence of interval
  17550. specifications, comprising a list of commands to be executed when a
  17551. particular event related to that interval occurs. The occurring event
  17552. is typically the current frame time entering or leaving a given time
  17553. interval.
  17554. An interval is specified by the following syntax:
  17555. @example
  17556. @var{START}[-@var{END}] @var{COMMANDS};
  17557. @end example
  17558. The time interval is specified by the @var{START} and @var{END} times.
  17559. @var{END} is optional and defaults to the maximum time.
  17560. The current frame time is considered within the specified interval if
  17561. it is included in the interval [@var{START}, @var{END}), that is when
  17562. the time is greater or equal to @var{START} and is lesser than
  17563. @var{END}.
  17564. @var{COMMANDS} consists of a sequence of one or more command
  17565. specifications, separated by ",", relating to that interval. The
  17566. syntax of a command specification is given by:
  17567. @example
  17568. [@var{FLAGS}] @var{TARGET} @var{COMMAND} @var{ARG}
  17569. @end example
  17570. @var{FLAGS} is optional and specifies the type of events relating to
  17571. the time interval which enable sending the specified command, and must
  17572. be a non-null sequence of identifier flags separated by "+" or "|" and
  17573. enclosed between "[" and "]".
  17574. The following flags are recognized:
  17575. @table @option
  17576. @item enter
  17577. The command is sent when the current frame timestamp enters the
  17578. specified interval. In other words, the command is sent when the
  17579. previous frame timestamp was not in the given interval, and the
  17580. current is.
  17581. @item leave
  17582. The command is sent when the current frame timestamp leaves the
  17583. specified interval. In other words, the command is sent when the
  17584. previous frame timestamp was in the given interval, and the
  17585. current is not.
  17586. @end table
  17587. If @var{FLAGS} is not specified, a default value of @code{[enter]} is
  17588. assumed.
  17589. @var{TARGET} specifies the target of the command, usually the name of
  17590. the filter class or a specific filter instance name.
  17591. @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of the command for the target filter.
  17592. @var{ARG} is optional and specifies the optional list of argument for
  17593. the given @var{COMMAND}.
  17594. Between one interval specification and another, whitespaces, or
  17595. sequences of characters starting with @code{#} until the end of line,
  17596. are ignored and can be used to annotate comments.
  17597. A simplified BNF description of the commands specification syntax
  17598. follows:
  17599. @example
  17600. @var{COMMAND_FLAG} ::= "enter" | "leave"
  17601. @var{COMMAND_FLAGS} ::= @var{COMMAND_FLAG} [(+|"|")@var{COMMAND_FLAG}]
  17602. @var{COMMAND} ::= ["[" @var{COMMAND_FLAGS} "]"] @var{TARGET} @var{COMMAND} [@var{ARG}]
  17603. @var{COMMANDS} ::= @var{COMMAND} [,@var{COMMANDS}]
  17604. @var{INTERVAL} ::= @var{START}[-@var{END}] @var{COMMANDS}
  17605. @var{INTERVALS} ::= @var{INTERVAL}[;@var{INTERVALS}]
  17606. @end example
  17607. @subsection Examples
  17608. @itemize
  17609. @item
  17610. Specify audio tempo change at second 4:
  17611. @example
  17612. asendcmd=c='4.0 atempo tempo 1.5',atempo
  17613. @end example
  17614. @item
  17615. Target a specific filter instance:
  17616. @example
  17617. asendcmd=c='4.0 atempo@@my tempo 1.5',atempo@@my
  17618. @end example
  17619. @item
  17620. Specify a list of drawtext and hue commands in a file.
  17621. @example
  17622. # show text in the interval 5-10
  17623. 5.0-10.0 [enter] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=hello world',
  17624. [leave] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=';
  17625. # desaturate the image in the interval 15-20
  17626. 15.0-20.0 [enter] hue s 0,
  17627. [enter] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=nocolor',
  17628. [leave] hue s 1,
  17629. [leave] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=color';
  17630. # apply an exponential saturation fade-out effect, starting from time 25
  17631. 25 [enter] hue s exp(25-t)
  17632. @end example
  17633. A filtergraph allowing to read and process the above command list
  17634. stored in a file @file{test.cmd}, can be specified with:
  17635. @example
  17636. sendcmd=f=test.cmd,drawtext=fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text='',hue
  17637. @end example
  17638. @end itemize
  17639. @anchor{setpts}
  17640. @section setpts, asetpts
  17641. Change the PTS (presentation timestamp) of the input frames.
  17642. @code{setpts} works on video frames, @code{asetpts} on audio frames.
  17643. This filter accepts the following options:
  17644. @table @option
  17645. @item expr
  17646. The expression which is evaluated for each frame to construct its timestamp.
  17647. @end table
  17648. The expression is evaluated through the eval API and can contain the following
  17649. constants:
  17650. @table @option
  17651. @item FRAME_RATE, FR
  17652. frame rate, only defined for constant frame-rate video
  17653. @item PTS
  17654. The presentation timestamp in input
  17655. @item N
  17656. The count of the input frame for video or the number of consumed samples,
  17657. not including the current frame for audio, starting from 0.
  17658. @item NB_CONSUMED_SAMPLES
  17659. The number of consumed samples, not including the current frame (only
  17660. audio)
  17661. @item NB_SAMPLES, S
  17662. The number of samples in the current frame (only audio)
  17663. @item SAMPLE_RATE, SR
  17664. The audio sample rate.
  17665. @item STARTPTS
  17666. The PTS of the first frame.
  17667. @item STARTT
  17668. the time in seconds of the first frame
  17669. @item INTERLACED
  17670. State whether the current frame is interlaced.
  17671. @item T
  17672. the time in seconds of the current frame
  17673. @item POS
  17674. original position in the file of the frame, or undefined if undefined
  17675. for the current frame
  17676. @item PREV_INPTS
  17677. The previous input PTS.
  17678. @item PREV_INT
  17679. previous input time in seconds
  17680. @item PREV_OUTPTS
  17681. The previous output PTS.
  17682. @item PREV_OUTT
  17683. previous output time in seconds
  17684. @item RTCTIME
  17685. The wallclock (RTC) time in microseconds. This is deprecated, use time(0)
  17686. instead.
  17687. @item RTCSTART
  17688. The wallclock (RTC) time at the start of the movie in microseconds.
  17689. @item TB
  17690. The timebase of the input timestamps.
  17691. @end table
  17692. @subsection Examples
  17693. @itemize
  17694. @item
  17695. Start counting PTS from zero
  17696. @example
  17697. setpts=PTS-STARTPTS
  17698. @end example
  17699. @item
  17700. Apply fast motion effect:
  17701. @example
  17702. setpts=0.5*PTS
  17703. @end example
  17704. @item
  17705. Apply slow motion effect:
  17706. @example
  17707. setpts=2.0*PTS
  17708. @end example
  17709. @item
  17710. Set fixed rate of 25 frames per second:
  17711. @example
  17712. setpts=N/(25*TB)
  17713. @end example
  17714. @item
  17715. Set fixed rate 25 fps with some jitter:
  17716. @example
  17717. setpts='1/(25*TB) * (N + 0.05 * sin(N*2*PI/25))'
  17718. @end example
  17719. @item
  17720. Apply an offset of 10 seconds to the input PTS:
  17721. @example
  17722. setpts=PTS+10/TB
  17723. @end example
  17724. @item
  17725. Generate timestamps from a "live source" and rebase onto the current timebase:
  17726. @example
  17727. setpts='(RTCTIME - RTCSTART) / (TB * 1000000)'
  17728. @end example
  17729. @item
  17730. Generate timestamps by counting samples:
  17731. @example
  17732. asetpts=N/SR/TB
  17733. @end example
  17734. @end itemize
  17735. @section setrange
  17736. Force color range for the output video frame.
  17737. The @code{setrange} filter marks the color range property for the
  17738. output frames. It does not change the input frame, but only sets the
  17739. corresponding property, which affects how the frame is treated by
  17740. following filters.
  17741. The filter accepts the following options:
  17742. @table @option
  17743. @item range
  17744. Available values are:
  17745. @table @samp
  17746. @item auto
  17747. Keep the same color range property.
  17748. @item unspecified, unknown
  17749. Set the color range as unspecified.
  17750. @item limited, tv, mpeg
  17751. Set the color range as limited.
  17752. @item full, pc, jpeg
  17753. Set the color range as full.
  17754. @end table
  17755. @end table
  17756. @section settb, asettb
  17757. Set the timebase to use for the output frames timestamps.
  17758. It is mainly useful for testing timebase configuration.
  17759. It accepts the following parameters:
  17760. @table @option
  17761. @item expr, tb
  17762. The expression which is evaluated into the output timebase.
  17763. @end table
  17764. The value for @option{tb} is an arithmetic expression representing a
  17765. rational. The expression can contain the constants "AVTB" (the default
  17766. timebase), "intb" (the input timebase) and "sr" (the sample rate,
  17767. audio only). Default value is "intb".
  17768. @subsection Examples
  17769. @itemize
  17770. @item
  17771. Set the timebase to 1/25:
  17772. @example
  17773. settb=expr=1/25
  17774. @end example
  17775. @item
  17776. Set the timebase to 1/10:
  17777. @example
  17778. settb=expr=0.1
  17779. @end example
  17780. @item
  17781. Set the timebase to 1001/1000:
  17782. @example
  17783. settb=1+0.001
  17784. @end example
  17785. @item
  17786. Set the timebase to 2*intb:
  17787. @example
  17788. settb=2*intb
  17789. @end example
  17790. @item
  17791. Set the default timebase value:
  17792. @example
  17793. settb=AVTB
  17794. @end example
  17795. @end itemize
  17796. @section showcqt
  17797. Convert input audio to a video output representing frequency spectrum
  17798. logarithmically using Brown-Puckette constant Q transform algorithm with
  17799. direct frequency domain coefficient calculation (but the transform itself
  17800. is not really constant Q, instead the Q factor is actually variable/clamped),
  17801. with musical tone scale, from E0 to D#10.
  17802. The filter accepts the following options:
  17803. @table @option
  17804. @item size, s
  17805. Specify the video size for the output. It must be even. For the syntax of this option,
  17806. check the @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17807. Default value is @code{1920x1080}.
  17808. @item fps, rate, r
  17809. Set the output frame rate. Default value is @code{25}.
  17810. @item bar_h
  17811. Set the bargraph height. It must be even. Default value is @code{-1} which
  17812. computes the bargraph height automatically.
  17813. @item axis_h
  17814. Set the axis height. It must be even. Default value is @code{-1} which computes
  17815. the axis height automatically.
  17816. @item sono_h
  17817. Set the sonogram height. It must be even. Default value is @code{-1} which
  17818. computes the sonogram height automatically.
  17819. @item fullhd
  17820. Set the fullhd resolution. This option is deprecated, use @var{size}, @var{s}
  17821. instead. Default value is @code{1}.
  17822. @item sono_v, volume
  17823. Specify the sonogram volume expression. It can contain variables:
  17824. @table @option
  17825. @item bar_v
  17826. the @var{bar_v} evaluated expression
  17827. @item frequency, freq, f
  17828. the frequency where it is evaluated
  17829. @item timeclamp, tc
  17830. the value of @var{timeclamp} option
  17831. @end table
  17832. and functions:
  17833. @table @option
  17834. @item a_weighting(f)
  17835. A-weighting of equal loudness
  17836. @item b_weighting(f)
  17837. B-weighting of equal loudness
  17838. @item c_weighting(f)
  17839. C-weighting of equal loudness.
  17840. @end table
  17841. Default value is @code{16}.
  17842. @item bar_v, volume2
  17843. Specify the bargraph volume expression. It can contain variables:
  17844. @table @option
  17845. @item sono_v
  17846. the @var{sono_v} evaluated expression
  17847. @item frequency, freq, f
  17848. the frequency where it is evaluated
  17849. @item timeclamp, tc
  17850. the value of @var{timeclamp} option
  17851. @end table
  17852. and functions:
  17853. @table @option
  17854. @item a_weighting(f)
  17855. A-weighting of equal loudness
  17856. @item b_weighting(f)
  17857. B-weighting of equal loudness
  17858. @item c_weighting(f)
  17859. C-weighting of equal loudness.
  17860. @end table
  17861. Default value is @code{sono_v}.
  17862. @item sono_g, gamma
  17863. Specify the sonogram gamma. Lower gamma makes the spectrum more contrast,
  17864. higher gamma makes the spectrum having more range. Default value is @code{3}.
  17865. Acceptable range is @code{[1, 7]}.
  17866. @item bar_g, gamma2
  17867. Specify the bargraph gamma. Default value is @code{1}. Acceptable range is
  17868. @code{[1, 7]}.
  17869. @item bar_t
  17870. Specify the bargraph transparency level. Lower value makes the bargraph sharper.
  17871. Default value is @code{1}. Acceptable range is @code{[0, 1]}.
  17872. @item timeclamp, tc
  17873. Specify the transform timeclamp. At low frequency, there is trade-off between
  17874. accuracy in time domain and frequency domain. If timeclamp is lower,
  17875. event in time domain is represented more accurately (such as fast bass drum),
  17876. otherwise event in frequency domain is represented more accurately
  17877. (such as bass guitar). Acceptable range is @code{[0.002, 1]}. Default value is @code{0.17}.
  17878. @item attack
  17879. Set attack time in seconds. The default is @code{0} (disabled). Otherwise, it
  17880. limits future samples by applying asymmetric windowing in time domain, useful
  17881. when low latency is required. Accepted range is @code{[0, 1]}.
  17882. @item basefreq
  17883. Specify the transform base frequency. Default value is @code{20.01523126408007475},
  17884. which is frequency 50 cents below E0. Acceptable range is @code{[10, 100000]}.
  17885. @item endfreq
  17886. Specify the transform end frequency. Default value is @code{20495.59681441799654},
  17887. which is frequency 50 cents above D#10. Acceptable range is @code{[10, 100000]}.
  17888. @item coeffclamp
  17889. This option is deprecated and ignored.
  17890. @item tlength
  17891. Specify the transform length in time domain. Use this option to control accuracy
  17892. trade-off between time domain and frequency domain at every frequency sample.
  17893. It can contain variables:
  17894. @table @option
  17895. @item frequency, freq, f
  17896. the frequency where it is evaluated
  17897. @item timeclamp, tc
  17898. the value of @var{timeclamp} option.
  17899. @end table
  17900. Default value is @code{384*tc/(384+tc*f)}.
  17901. @item count
  17902. Specify the transform count for every video frame. Default value is @code{6}.
  17903. Acceptable range is @code{[1, 30]}.
  17904. @item fcount
  17905. Specify the transform count for every single pixel. Default value is @code{0},
  17906. which makes it computed automatically. Acceptable range is @code{[0, 10]}.
  17907. @item fontfile
  17908. Specify font file for use with freetype to draw the axis. If not specified,
  17909. use embedded font. Note that drawing with font file or embedded font is not
  17910. implemented with custom @var{basefreq} and @var{endfreq}, use @var{axisfile}
  17911. option instead.
  17912. @item font
  17913. Specify fontconfig pattern. This has lower priority than @var{fontfile}. The
  17914. @code{:} in the pattern may be replaced by @code{|} to avoid unnecessary
  17915. escaping.
  17916. @item fontcolor
  17917. Specify font color expression. This is arithmetic expression that should return
  17918. integer value 0xRRGGBB. It can contain variables:
  17919. @table @option
  17920. @item frequency, freq, f
  17921. the frequency where it is evaluated
  17922. @item timeclamp, tc
  17923. the value of @var{timeclamp} option
  17924. @end table
  17925. and functions:
  17926. @table @option
  17927. @item midi(f)
  17928. midi number of frequency f, some midi numbers: E0(16), C1(24), C2(36), A4(69)
  17929. @item r(x), g(x), b(x)
  17930. red, green, and blue value of intensity x.
  17931. @end table
  17932. Default value is @code{st(0, (midi(f)-59.5)/12);
  17933. st(1, if(between(ld(0),0,1), 0.5-0.5*cos(2*PI*ld(0)), 0));
  17934. r(1-ld(1)) + b(ld(1))}.
  17935. @item axisfile
  17936. Specify image file to draw the axis. This option override @var{fontfile} and
  17937. @var{fontcolor} option.
  17938. @item axis, text
  17939. Enable/disable drawing text to the axis. If it is set to @code{0}, drawing to
  17940. the axis is disabled, ignoring @var{fontfile} and @var{axisfile} option.
  17941. Default value is @code{1}.
  17942. @item csp
  17943. Set colorspace. The accepted values are:
  17944. @table @samp
  17945. @item unspecified
  17946. Unspecified (default)
  17947. @item bt709
  17948. BT.709
  17949. @item fcc
  17950. FCC
  17951. @item bt470bg
  17952. BT.470BG or BT.601-6 625
  17953. @item smpte170m
  17954. SMPTE-170M or BT.601-6 525
  17955. @item smpte240m
  17956. SMPTE-240M
  17957. @item bt2020ncl
  17958. BT.2020 with non-constant luminance
  17959. @end table
  17960. @item cscheme
  17961. Set spectrogram color scheme. This is list of floating point values with format
  17962. @code{left_r|left_g|left_b|right_r|right_g|right_b}.
  17963. The default is @code{1|0.5|0|0|0.5|1}.
  17964. @end table
  17965. @subsection Examples
  17966. @itemize
  17967. @item
  17968. Playing audio while showing the spectrum:
  17969. @example
  17970. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=a.mp3, asplit [a][out1]; [a] showcqt [out0]'
  17971. @end example
  17972. @item
  17973. Same as above, but with frame rate 30 fps:
  17974. @example
  17975. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=a.mp3, asplit [a][out1]; [a] showcqt=fps=30:count=5 [out0]'
  17976. @end example
  17977. @item
  17978. Playing at 1280x720:
  17979. @example
  17980. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=a.mp3, asplit [a][out1]; [a] showcqt=s=1280x720:count=4 [out0]'
  17981. @end example
  17982. @item
  17983. Disable sonogram display:
  17984. @example
  17985. sono_h=0
  17986. @end example
  17987. @item
  17988. A1 and its harmonics: A1, A2, (near)E3, A3:
  17989. @example
  17990. ffplay -f lavfi 'aevalsrc=0.1*sin(2*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(4*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(6*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(8*PI*55*t),
  17991. asplit[a][out1]; [a] showcqt [out0]'
  17992. @end example
  17993. @item
  17994. Same as above, but with more accuracy in frequency domain:
  17995. @example
  17996. ffplay -f lavfi 'aevalsrc=0.1*sin(2*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(4*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(6*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(8*PI*55*t),
  17997. asplit[a][out1]; [a] showcqt=timeclamp=0.5 [out0]'
  17998. @end example
  17999. @item
  18000. Custom volume:
  18001. @example
  18002. bar_v=10:sono_v=bar_v*a_weighting(f)
  18003. @end example
  18004. @item
  18005. Custom gamma, now spectrum is linear to the amplitude.
  18006. @example
  18007. bar_g=2:sono_g=2
  18008. @end example
  18009. @item
  18010. Custom tlength equation:
  18011. @example
  18012. tc=0.33:tlength='st(0,0.17); 384*tc / (384 / ld(0) + tc*f /(1-ld(0))) + 384*tc / (tc*f / ld(0) + 384 /(1-ld(0)))'
  18013. @end example
  18014. @item
  18015. Custom fontcolor and fontfile, C-note is colored green, others are colored blue:
  18016. @example
  18017. fontcolor='if(mod(floor(midi(f)+0.5),12), 0x0000FF, g(1))':fontfile=myfont.ttf
  18018. @end example
  18019. @item
  18020. Custom font using fontconfig:
  18021. @example
  18022. font='Courier New,Monospace,mono|bold'
  18023. @end example
  18024. @item
  18025. Custom frequency range with custom axis using image file:
  18026. @example
  18027. axisfile=myaxis.png:basefreq=40:endfreq=10000
  18028. @end example
  18029. @end itemize
  18030. @section showfreqs
  18031. Convert input audio to video output representing the audio power spectrum.
  18032. Audio amplitude is on Y-axis while frequency is on X-axis.
  18033. The filter accepts the following options:
  18034. @table @option
  18035. @item size, s
  18036. Specify size of video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  18037. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  18038. Default is @code{1024x512}.
  18039. @item mode
  18040. Set display mode.
  18041. This set how each frequency bin will be represented.
  18042. It accepts the following values:
  18043. @table @samp
  18044. @item line
  18045. @item bar
  18046. @item dot
  18047. @end table
  18048. Default is @code{bar}.
  18049. @item ascale
  18050. Set amplitude scale.
  18051. It accepts the following values:
  18052. @table @samp
  18053. @item lin
  18054. Linear scale.
  18055. @item sqrt
  18056. Square root scale.
  18057. @item cbrt
  18058. Cubic root scale.
  18059. @item log
  18060. Logarithmic scale.
  18061. @end table
  18062. Default is @code{log}.
  18063. @item fscale
  18064. Set frequency scale.
  18065. It accepts the following values:
  18066. @table @samp
  18067. @item lin
  18068. Linear scale.
  18069. @item log
  18070. Logarithmic scale.
  18071. @item rlog
  18072. Reverse logarithmic scale.
  18073. @end table
  18074. Default is @code{lin}.
  18075. @item win_size
  18076. Set window size. Allowed range is from 16 to 65536.
  18077. Default is @code{2048}
  18078. @item win_func
  18079. Set windowing function.
  18080. It accepts the following values:
  18081. @table @samp
  18082. @item rect
  18083. @item bartlett
  18084. @item hanning
  18085. @item hamming
  18086. @item blackman
  18087. @item welch
  18088. @item flattop
  18089. @item bharris
  18090. @item bnuttall
  18091. @item bhann
  18092. @item sine
  18093. @item nuttall
  18094. @item lanczos
  18095. @item gauss
  18096. @item tukey
  18097. @item dolph
  18098. @item cauchy
  18099. @item parzen
  18100. @item poisson
  18101. @item bohman
  18102. @end table
  18103. Default is @code{hanning}.
  18104. @item overlap
  18105. Set window overlap. In range @code{[0, 1]}. Default is @code{1},
  18106. which means optimal overlap for selected window function will be picked.
  18107. @item averaging
  18108. Set time averaging. Setting this to 0 will display current maximal peaks.
  18109. Default is @code{1}, which means time averaging is disabled.
  18110. @item colors
  18111. Specify list of colors separated by space or by '|' which will be used to
  18112. draw channel frequencies. Unrecognized or missing colors will be replaced
  18113. by white color.
  18114. @item cmode
  18115. Set channel display mode.
  18116. It accepts the following values:
  18117. @table @samp
  18118. @item combined
  18119. @item separate
  18120. @end table
  18121. Default is @code{combined}.
  18122. @item minamp
  18123. Set minimum amplitude used in @code{log} amplitude scaler.
  18124. @end table
  18125. @section showspatial
  18126. Convert stereo input audio to a video output, representing the spatial relationship
  18127. between two channels.
  18128. The filter accepts the following options:
  18129. @table @option
  18130. @item size, s
  18131. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  18132. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  18133. Default value is @code{512x512}.
  18134. @item win_size
  18135. Set window size. Allowed range is from @var{1024} to @var{65536}. Default size is @var{4096}.
  18136. @item win_func
  18137. Set window function.
  18138. It accepts the following values:
  18139. @table @samp
  18140. @item rect
  18141. @item bartlett
  18142. @item hann
  18143. @item hanning
  18144. @item hamming
  18145. @item blackman
  18146. @item welch
  18147. @item flattop
  18148. @item bharris
  18149. @item bnuttall
  18150. @item bhann
  18151. @item sine
  18152. @item nuttall
  18153. @item lanczos
  18154. @item gauss
  18155. @item tukey
  18156. @item dolph
  18157. @item cauchy
  18158. @item parzen
  18159. @item poisson
  18160. @item bohman
  18161. @end table
  18162. Default value is @code{hann}.
  18163. @item overlap
  18164. Set ratio of overlap window. Default value is @code{0.5}.
  18165. When value is @code{1} overlap is set to recommended size for specific
  18166. window function currently used.
  18167. @end table
  18168. @anchor{showspectrum}
  18169. @section showspectrum
  18170. Convert input audio to a video output, representing the audio frequency
  18171. spectrum.
  18172. The filter accepts the following options:
  18173. @table @option
  18174. @item size, s
  18175. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  18176. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  18177. Default value is @code{640x512}.
  18178. @item slide
  18179. Specify how the spectrum should slide along the window.
  18180. It accepts the following values:
  18181. @table @samp
  18182. @item replace
  18183. the samples start again on the left when they reach the right
  18184. @item scroll
  18185. the samples scroll from right to left
  18186. @item fullframe
  18187. frames are only produced when the samples reach the right
  18188. @item rscroll
  18189. the samples scroll from left to right
  18190. @end table
  18191. Default value is @code{replace}.
  18192. @item mode
  18193. Specify display mode.
  18194. It accepts the following values:
  18195. @table @samp
  18196. @item combined
  18197. all channels are displayed in the same row
  18198. @item separate
  18199. all channels are displayed in separate rows
  18200. @end table
  18201. Default value is @samp{combined}.
  18202. @item color
  18203. Specify display color mode.
  18204. It accepts the following values:
  18205. @table @samp
  18206. @item channel
  18207. each channel is displayed in a separate color
  18208. @item intensity
  18209. each channel is displayed using the same color scheme
  18210. @item rainbow
  18211. each channel is displayed using the rainbow color scheme
  18212. @item moreland
  18213. each channel is displayed using the moreland color scheme
  18214. @item nebulae
  18215. each channel is displayed using the nebulae color scheme
  18216. @item fire
  18217. each channel is displayed using the fire color scheme
  18218. @item fiery
  18219. each channel is displayed using the fiery color scheme
  18220. @item fruit
  18221. each channel is displayed using the fruit color scheme
  18222. @item cool
  18223. each channel is displayed using the cool color scheme
  18224. @item magma
  18225. each channel is displayed using the magma color scheme
  18226. @item green
  18227. each channel is displayed using the green color scheme
  18228. @item viridis
  18229. each channel is displayed using the viridis color scheme
  18230. @item plasma
  18231. each channel is displayed using the plasma color scheme
  18232. @item cividis
  18233. each channel is displayed using the cividis color scheme
  18234. @item terrain
  18235. each channel is displayed using the terrain color scheme
  18236. @end table
  18237. Default value is @samp{channel}.
  18238. @item scale
  18239. Specify scale used for calculating intensity color values.
  18240. It accepts the following values:
  18241. @table @samp
  18242. @item lin
  18243. linear
  18244. @item sqrt
  18245. square root, default
  18246. @item cbrt
  18247. cubic root
  18248. @item log
  18249. logarithmic
  18250. @item 4thrt
  18251. 4th root
  18252. @item 5thrt
  18253. 5th root
  18254. @end table
  18255. Default value is @samp{sqrt}.
  18256. @item fscale
  18257. Specify frequency scale.
  18258. It accepts the following values:
  18259. @table @samp
  18260. @item lin
  18261. linear
  18262. @item log
  18263. logarithmic
  18264. @end table
  18265. Default value is @samp{lin}.
  18266. @item saturation
  18267. Set saturation modifier for displayed colors. Negative values provide
  18268. alternative color scheme. @code{0} is no saturation at all.
  18269. Saturation must be in [-10.0, 10.0] range.
  18270. Default value is @code{1}.
  18271. @item win_func
  18272. Set window function.
  18273. It accepts the following values:
  18274. @table @samp
  18275. @item rect
  18276. @item bartlett
  18277. @item hann
  18278. @item hanning
  18279. @item hamming
  18280. @item blackman
  18281. @item welch
  18282. @item flattop
  18283. @item bharris
  18284. @item bnuttall
  18285. @item bhann
  18286. @item sine
  18287. @item nuttall
  18288. @item lanczos
  18289. @item gauss
  18290. @item tukey
  18291. @item dolph
  18292. @item cauchy
  18293. @item parzen
  18294. @item poisson
  18295. @item bohman
  18296. @end table
  18297. Default value is @code{hann}.
  18298. @item orientation
  18299. Set orientation of time vs frequency axis. Can be @code{vertical} or
  18300. @code{horizontal}. Default is @code{vertical}.
  18301. @item overlap
  18302. Set ratio of overlap window. Default value is @code{0}.
  18303. When value is @code{1} overlap is set to recommended size for specific
  18304. window function currently used.
  18305. @item gain
  18306. Set scale gain for calculating intensity color values.
  18307. Default value is @code{1}.
  18308. @item data
  18309. Set which data to display. Can be @code{magnitude}, default or @code{phase}.
  18310. @item rotation
  18311. Set color rotation, must be in [-1.0, 1.0] range.
  18312. Default value is @code{0}.
  18313. @item start
  18314. Set start frequency from which to display spectrogram. Default is @code{0}.
  18315. @item stop
  18316. Set stop frequency to which to display spectrogram. Default is @code{0}.
  18317. @item fps
  18318. Set upper frame rate limit. Default is @code{auto}, unlimited.
  18319. @item legend
  18320. Draw time and frequency axes and legends. Default is disabled.
  18321. @end table
  18322. The usage is very similar to the showwaves filter; see the examples in that
  18323. section.
  18324. @subsection Examples
  18325. @itemize
  18326. @item
  18327. Large window with logarithmic color scaling:
  18328. @example
  18329. showspectrum=s=1280x480:scale=log
  18330. @end example
  18331. @item
  18332. Complete example for a colored and sliding spectrum per channel using @command{ffplay}:
  18333. @example
  18334. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=input.mp3, asplit [a][out1];
  18335. [a] showspectrum=mode=separate:color=intensity:slide=1:scale=cbrt [out0]'
  18336. @end example
  18337. @end itemize
  18338. @section showspectrumpic
  18339. Convert input audio to a single video frame, representing the audio frequency
  18340. spectrum.
  18341. The filter accepts the following options:
  18342. @table @option
  18343. @item size, s
  18344. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  18345. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  18346. Default value is @code{4096x2048}.
  18347. @item mode
  18348. Specify display mode.
  18349. It accepts the following values:
  18350. @table @samp
  18351. @item combined
  18352. all channels are displayed in the same row
  18353. @item separate
  18354. all channels are displayed in separate rows
  18355. @end table
  18356. Default value is @samp{combined}.
  18357. @item color
  18358. Specify display color mode.
  18359. It accepts the following values:
  18360. @table @samp
  18361. @item channel
  18362. each channel is displayed in a separate color
  18363. @item intensity
  18364. each channel is displayed using the same color scheme
  18365. @item rainbow
  18366. each channel is displayed using the rainbow color scheme
  18367. @item moreland
  18368. each channel is displayed using the moreland color scheme
  18369. @item nebulae
  18370. each channel is displayed using the nebulae color scheme
  18371. @item fire
  18372. each channel is displayed using the fire color scheme
  18373. @item fiery
  18374. each channel is displayed using the fiery color scheme
  18375. @item fruit
  18376. each channel is displayed using the fruit color scheme
  18377. @item cool
  18378. each channel is displayed using the cool color scheme
  18379. @item magma
  18380. each channel is displayed using the magma color scheme
  18381. @item green
  18382. each channel is displayed using the green color scheme
  18383. @item viridis
  18384. each channel is displayed using the viridis color scheme
  18385. @item plasma
  18386. each channel is displayed using the plasma color scheme
  18387. @item cividis
  18388. each channel is displayed using the cividis color scheme
  18389. @item terrain
  18390. each channel is displayed using the terrain color scheme
  18391. @end table
  18392. Default value is @samp{intensity}.
  18393. @item scale
  18394. Specify scale used for calculating intensity color values.
  18395. It accepts the following values:
  18396. @table @samp
  18397. @item lin
  18398. linear
  18399. @item sqrt
  18400. square root, default
  18401. @item cbrt
  18402. cubic root
  18403. @item log
  18404. logarithmic
  18405. @item 4thrt
  18406. 4th root
  18407. @item 5thrt
  18408. 5th root
  18409. @end table
  18410. Default value is @samp{log}.
  18411. @item fscale
  18412. Specify frequency scale.
  18413. It accepts the following values:
  18414. @table @samp
  18415. @item lin
  18416. linear
  18417. @item log
  18418. logarithmic
  18419. @end table
  18420. Default value is @samp{lin}.
  18421. @item saturation
  18422. Set saturation modifier for displayed colors. Negative values provide
  18423. alternative color scheme. @code{0} is no saturation at all.
  18424. Saturation must be in [-10.0, 10.0] range.
  18425. Default value is @code{1}.
  18426. @item win_func
  18427. Set window function.
  18428. It accepts the following values:
  18429. @table @samp
  18430. @item rect
  18431. @item bartlett
  18432. @item hann
  18433. @item hanning
  18434. @item hamming
  18435. @item blackman
  18436. @item welch
  18437. @item flattop
  18438. @item bharris
  18439. @item bnuttall
  18440. @item bhann
  18441. @item sine
  18442. @item nuttall
  18443. @item lanczos
  18444. @item gauss
  18445. @item tukey
  18446. @item dolph
  18447. @item cauchy
  18448. @item parzen
  18449. @item poisson
  18450. @item bohman
  18451. @end table
  18452. Default value is @code{hann}.
  18453. @item orientation
  18454. Set orientation of time vs frequency axis. Can be @code{vertical} or
  18455. @code{horizontal}. Default is @code{vertical}.
  18456. @item gain
  18457. Set scale gain for calculating intensity color values.
  18458. Default value is @code{1}.
  18459. @item legend
  18460. Draw time and frequency axes and legends. Default is enabled.
  18461. @item rotation
  18462. Set color rotation, must be in [-1.0, 1.0] range.
  18463. Default value is @code{0}.
  18464. @item start
  18465. Set start frequency from which to display spectrogram. Default is @code{0}.
  18466. @item stop
  18467. Set stop frequency to which to display spectrogram. Default is @code{0}.
  18468. @end table
  18469. @subsection Examples
  18470. @itemize
  18471. @item
  18472. Extract an audio spectrogram of a whole audio track
  18473. in a 1024x1024 picture using @command{ffmpeg}:
  18474. @example
  18475. ffmpeg -i audio.flac -lavfi showspectrumpic=s=1024x1024 spectrogram.png
  18476. @end example
  18477. @end itemize
  18478. @section showvolume
  18479. Convert input audio volume to a video output.
  18480. The filter accepts the following options:
  18481. @table @option
  18482. @item rate, r
  18483. Set video rate.
  18484. @item b
  18485. Set border width, allowed range is [0, 5]. Default is 1.
  18486. @item w
  18487. Set channel width, allowed range is [80, 8192]. Default is 400.
  18488. @item h
  18489. Set channel height, allowed range is [1, 900]. Default is 20.
  18490. @item f
  18491. Set fade, allowed range is [0, 1]. Default is 0.95.
  18492. @item c
  18493. Set volume color expression.
  18494. The expression can use the following variables:
  18495. @table @option
  18496. @item VOLUME
  18497. Current max volume of channel in dB.
  18498. @item PEAK
  18499. Current peak.
  18500. @item CHANNEL
  18501. Current channel number, starting from 0.
  18502. @end table
  18503. @item t
  18504. If set, displays channel names. Default is enabled.
  18505. @item v
  18506. If set, displays volume values. Default is enabled.
  18507. @item o
  18508. Set orientation, can be horizontal: @code{h} or vertical: @code{v},
  18509. default is @code{h}.
  18510. @item s
  18511. Set step size, allowed range is [0, 5]. Default is 0, which means
  18512. step is disabled.
  18513. @item p
  18514. Set background opacity, allowed range is [0, 1]. Default is 0.
  18515. @item m
  18516. Set metering mode, can be peak: @code{p} or rms: @code{r},
  18517. default is @code{p}.
  18518. @item ds
  18519. Set display scale, can be linear: @code{lin} or log: @code{log},
  18520. default is @code{lin}.
  18521. @item dm
  18522. In second.
  18523. If set to > 0., display a line for the max level
  18524. in the previous seconds.
  18525. default is disabled: @code{0.}
  18526. @item dmc
  18527. The color of the max line. Use when @code{dm} option is set to > 0.
  18528. default is: @code{orange}
  18529. @end table
  18530. @section showwaves
  18531. Convert input audio to a video output, representing the samples waves.
  18532. The filter accepts the following options:
  18533. @table @option
  18534. @item size, s
  18535. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  18536. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  18537. Default value is @code{600x240}.
  18538. @item mode
  18539. Set display mode.
  18540. Available values are:
  18541. @table @samp
  18542. @item point
  18543. Draw a point for each sample.
  18544. @item line
  18545. Draw a vertical line for each sample.
  18546. @item p2p
  18547. Draw a point for each sample and a line between them.
  18548. @item cline
  18549. Draw a centered vertical line for each sample.
  18550. @end table
  18551. Default value is @code{point}.
  18552. @item n
  18553. Set the number of samples which are printed on the same column. A
  18554. larger value will decrease the frame rate. Must be a positive
  18555. integer. This option can be set only if the value for @var{rate}
  18556. is not explicitly specified.
  18557. @item rate, r
  18558. Set the (approximate) output frame rate. This is done by setting the
  18559. option @var{n}. Default value is "25".
  18560. @item split_channels
  18561. Set if channels should be drawn separately or overlap. Default value is 0.
  18562. @item colors
  18563. Set colors separated by '|' which are going to be used for drawing of each channel.
  18564. @item scale
  18565. Set amplitude scale.
  18566. Available values are:
  18567. @table @samp
  18568. @item lin
  18569. Linear.
  18570. @item log
  18571. Logarithmic.
  18572. @item sqrt
  18573. Square root.
  18574. @item cbrt
  18575. Cubic root.
  18576. @end table
  18577. Default is linear.
  18578. @item draw
  18579. Set the draw mode. This is mostly useful to set for high @var{n}.
  18580. Available values are:
  18581. @table @samp
  18582. @item scale
  18583. Scale pixel values for each drawn sample.
  18584. @item full
  18585. Draw every sample directly.
  18586. @end table
  18587. Default value is @code{scale}.
  18588. @end table
  18589. @subsection Examples
  18590. @itemize
  18591. @item
  18592. Output the input file audio and the corresponding video representation
  18593. at the same time:
  18594. @example
  18595. amovie=a.mp3,asplit[out0],showwaves[out1]
  18596. @end example
  18597. @item
  18598. Create a synthetic signal and show it with showwaves, forcing a
  18599. frame rate of 30 frames per second:
  18600. @example
  18601. aevalsrc=sin(1*2*PI*t)*sin(880*2*PI*t):cos(2*PI*200*t),asplit[out0],showwaves=r=30[out1]
  18602. @end example
  18603. @end itemize
  18604. @section showwavespic
  18605. Convert input audio to a single video frame, representing the samples waves.
  18606. The filter accepts the following options:
  18607. @table @option
  18608. @item size, s
  18609. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  18610. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  18611. Default value is @code{600x240}.
  18612. @item split_channels
  18613. Set if channels should be drawn separately or overlap. Default value is 0.
  18614. @item colors
  18615. Set colors separated by '|' which are going to be used for drawing of each channel.
  18616. @item scale
  18617. Set amplitude scale.
  18618. Available values are:
  18619. @table @samp
  18620. @item lin
  18621. Linear.
  18622. @item log
  18623. Logarithmic.
  18624. @item sqrt
  18625. Square root.
  18626. @item cbrt
  18627. Cubic root.
  18628. @end table
  18629. Default is linear.
  18630. @item draw
  18631. Set the draw mode.
  18632. Available values are:
  18633. @table @samp
  18634. @item scale
  18635. Scale pixel values for each drawn sample.
  18636. @item full
  18637. Draw every sample directly.
  18638. @end table
  18639. Default value is @code{scale}.
  18640. @end table
  18641. @subsection Examples
  18642. @itemize
  18643. @item
  18644. Extract a channel split representation of the wave form of a whole audio track
  18645. in a 1024x800 picture using @command{ffmpeg}:
  18646. @example
  18647. ffmpeg -i audio.flac -lavfi showwavespic=split_channels=1:s=1024x800 waveform.png
  18648. @end example
  18649. @end itemize
  18650. @section sidedata, asidedata
  18651. Delete frame side data, or select frames based on it.
  18652. This filter accepts the following options:
  18653. @table @option
  18654. @item mode
  18655. Set mode of operation of the filter.
  18656. Can be one of the following:
  18657. @table @samp
  18658. @item select
  18659. Select every frame with side data of @code{type}.
  18660. @item delete
  18661. Delete side data of @code{type}. If @code{type} is not set, delete all side
  18662. data in the frame.
  18663. @end table
  18664. @item type
  18665. Set side data type used with all modes. Must be set for @code{select} mode. For
  18666. the list of frame side data types, refer to the @code{AVFrameSideDataType} enum
  18667. in @file{libavutil/frame.h}. For example, to choose
  18668. @code{AV_FRAME_DATA_PANSCAN} side data, you must specify @code{PANSCAN}.
  18669. @end table
  18670. @section spectrumsynth
  18671. Synthesize audio from 2 input video spectrums, first input stream represents
  18672. magnitude across time and second represents phase across time.
  18673. The filter will transform from frequency domain as displayed in videos back
  18674. to time domain as presented in audio output.
  18675. This filter is primarily created for reversing processed @ref{showspectrum}
  18676. filter outputs, but can synthesize sound from other spectrograms too.
  18677. But in such case results are going to be poor if the phase data is not
  18678. available, because in such cases phase data need to be recreated, usually
  18679. it's just recreated from random noise.
  18680. For best results use gray only output (@code{channel} color mode in
  18681. @ref{showspectrum} filter) and @code{log} scale for magnitude video and
  18682. @code{lin} scale for phase video. To produce phase, for 2nd video, use
  18683. @code{data} option. Inputs videos should generally use @code{fullframe}
  18684. slide mode as that saves resources needed for decoding video.
  18685. The filter accepts the following options:
  18686. @table @option
  18687. @item sample_rate
  18688. Specify sample rate of output audio, the sample rate of audio from which
  18689. spectrum was generated may differ.
  18690. @item channels
  18691. Set number of channels represented in input video spectrums.
  18692. @item scale
  18693. Set scale which was used when generating magnitude input spectrum.
  18694. Can be @code{lin} or @code{log}. Default is @code{log}.
  18695. @item slide
  18696. Set slide which was used when generating inputs spectrums.
  18697. Can be @code{replace}, @code{scroll}, @code{fullframe} or @code{rscroll}.
  18698. Default is @code{fullframe}.
  18699. @item win_func
  18700. Set window function used for resynthesis.
  18701. @item overlap
  18702. Set window overlap. In range @code{[0, 1]}. Default is @code{1},
  18703. which means optimal overlap for selected window function will be picked.
  18704. @item orientation
  18705. Set orientation of input videos. Can be @code{vertical} or @code{horizontal}.
  18706. Default is @code{vertical}.
  18707. @end table
  18708. @subsection Examples
  18709. @itemize
  18710. @item
  18711. First create magnitude and phase videos from audio, assuming audio is stereo with 44100 sample rate,
  18712. then resynthesize videos back to audio with spectrumsynth:
  18713. @example
  18714. ffmpeg -i input.flac -lavfi showspectrum=mode=separate:scale=log:overlap=0.875:color=channel:slide=fullframe:data=magnitude -an -c:v rawvideo magnitude.nut
  18715. ffmpeg -i input.flac -lavfi showspectrum=mode=separate:scale=lin:overlap=0.875:color=channel:slide=fullframe:data=phase -an -c:v rawvideo phase.nut
  18716. ffmpeg -i magnitude.nut -i phase.nut -lavfi spectrumsynth=channels=2:sample_rate=44100:win_func=hann:overlap=0.875:slide=fullframe output.flac
  18717. @end example
  18718. @end itemize
  18719. @section split, asplit
  18720. Split input into several identical outputs.
  18721. @code{asplit} works with audio input, @code{split} with video.
  18722. The filter accepts a single parameter which specifies the number of outputs. If
  18723. unspecified, it defaults to 2.
  18724. @subsection Examples
  18725. @itemize
  18726. @item
  18727. Create two separate outputs from the same input:
  18728. @example
  18729. [in] split [out0][out1]
  18730. @end example
  18731. @item
  18732. To create 3 or more outputs, you need to specify the number of
  18733. outputs, like in:
  18734. @example
  18735. [in] asplit=3 [out0][out1][out2]
  18736. @end example
  18737. @item
  18738. Create two separate outputs from the same input, one cropped and
  18739. one padded:
  18740. @example
  18741. [in] split [splitout1][splitout2];
  18742. [splitout1] crop=100:100:0:0 [cropout];
  18743. [splitout2] pad=200:200:100:100 [padout];
  18744. @end example
  18745. @item
  18746. Create 5 copies of the input audio with @command{ffmpeg}:
  18747. @example
  18748. ffmpeg -i INPUT -filter_complex asplit=5 OUTPUT
  18749. @end example
  18750. @end itemize
  18751. @section zmq, azmq
  18752. Receive commands sent through a libzmq client, and forward them to
  18753. filters in the filtergraph.
  18754. @code{zmq} and @code{azmq} work as a pass-through filters. @code{zmq}
  18755. must be inserted between two video filters, @code{azmq} between two
  18756. audio filters. Both are capable to send messages to any filter type.
  18757. To enable these filters you need to install the libzmq library and
  18758. headers and configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-libzmq}.
  18759. For more information about libzmq see:
  18760. @url{http://www.zeromq.org/}
  18761. The @code{zmq} and @code{azmq} filters work as a libzmq server, which
  18762. receives messages sent through a network interface defined by the
  18763. @option{bind_address} (or the abbreviation "@option{b}") option.
  18764. Default value of this option is @file{tcp://localhost:5555}. You may
  18765. want to alter this value to your needs, but do not forget to escape any
  18766. ':' signs (see @ref{filtergraph escaping}).
  18767. The received message must be in the form:
  18768. @example
  18769. @var{TARGET} @var{COMMAND} [@var{ARG}]
  18770. @end example
  18771. @var{TARGET} specifies the target of the command, usually the name of
  18772. the filter class or a specific filter instance name. The default
  18773. filter instance name uses the pattern @samp{Parsed_<filter_name>_<index>},
  18774. but you can override this by using the @samp{filter_name@@id} syntax
  18775. (see @ref{Filtergraph syntax}).
  18776. @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of the command for the target filter.
  18777. @var{ARG} is optional and specifies the optional argument list for the
  18778. given @var{COMMAND}.
  18779. Upon reception, the message is processed and the corresponding command
  18780. is injected into the filtergraph. Depending on the result, the filter
  18781. will send a reply to the client, adopting the format:
  18782. @example
  18783. @var{ERROR_CODE} @var{ERROR_REASON}
  18784. @var{MESSAGE}
  18785. @end example
  18786. @var{MESSAGE} is optional.
  18787. @subsection Examples
  18788. Look at @file{tools/zmqsend} for an example of a zmq client which can
  18789. be used to send commands processed by these filters.
  18790. Consider the following filtergraph generated by @command{ffplay}.
  18791. In this example the last overlay filter has an instance name. All other
  18792. filters will have default instance names.
  18793. @example
  18794. ffplay -dumpgraph 1 -f lavfi "
  18795. color=s=100x100:c=red [l];
  18796. color=s=100x100:c=blue [r];
  18797. nullsrc=s=200x100, zmq [bg];
  18798. [bg][l] overlay [bg+l];
  18799. [bg+l][r] overlay@@my=x=100 "
  18800. @end example
  18801. To change the color of the left side of the video, the following
  18802. command can be used:
  18803. @example
  18804. echo Parsed_color_0 c yellow | tools/zmqsend
  18805. @end example
  18806. To change the right side:
  18807. @example
  18808. echo Parsed_color_1 c pink | tools/zmqsend
  18809. @end example
  18810. To change the position of the right side:
  18811. @example
  18812. echo overlay@@my x 150 | tools/zmqsend
  18813. @end example
  18814. @c man end MULTIMEDIA FILTERS
  18815. @chapter Multimedia Sources
  18816. @c man begin MULTIMEDIA SOURCES
  18817. Below is a description of the currently available multimedia sources.
  18818. @section amovie
  18819. This is the same as @ref{movie} source, except it selects an audio
  18820. stream by default.
  18821. @anchor{movie}
  18822. @section movie
  18823. Read audio and/or video stream(s) from a movie container.
  18824. It accepts the following parameters:
  18825. @table @option
  18826. @item filename
  18827. The name of the resource to read (not necessarily a file; it can also be a
  18828. device or a stream accessed through some protocol).
  18829. @item format_name, f
  18830. Specifies the format assumed for the movie to read, and can be either
  18831. the name of a container or an input device. If not specified, the
  18832. format is guessed from @var{movie_name} or by probing.
  18833. @item seek_point, sp
  18834. Specifies the seek point in seconds. The frames will be output
  18835. starting from this seek point. The parameter is evaluated with
  18836. @code{av_strtod}, so the numerical value may be suffixed by an IS
  18837. postfix. The default value is "0".
  18838. @item streams, s
  18839. Specifies the streams to read. Several streams can be specified,
  18840. separated by "+". The source will then have as many outputs, in the
  18841. same order. The syntax is explained in the @ref{Stream specifiers,,"Stream specifiers"
  18842. section in the ffmpeg manual,ffmpeg}. Two special names, "dv" and "da" specify
  18843. respectively the default (best suited) video and audio stream. Default
  18844. is "dv", or "da" if the filter is called as "amovie".
  18845. @item stream_index, si
  18846. Specifies the index of the video stream to read. If the value is -1,
  18847. the most suitable video stream will be automatically selected. The default
  18848. value is "-1". Deprecated. If the filter is called "amovie", it will select
  18849. audio instead of video.
  18850. @item loop
  18851. Specifies how many times to read the stream in sequence.
  18852. If the value is 0, the stream will be looped infinitely.
  18853. Default value is "1".
  18854. Note that when the movie is looped the source timestamps are not
  18855. changed, so it will generate non monotonically increasing timestamps.
  18856. @item discontinuity
  18857. Specifies the time difference between frames above which the point is
  18858. considered a timestamp discontinuity which is removed by adjusting the later
  18859. timestamps.
  18860. @end table
  18861. It allows overlaying a second video on top of the main input of
  18862. a filtergraph, as shown in this graph:
  18863. @example
  18864. input -----------> deltapts0 --> overlay --> output
  18865. ^
  18866. |
  18867. movie --> scale--> deltapts1 -------+
  18868. @end example
  18869. @subsection Examples
  18870. @itemize
  18871. @item
  18872. Skip 3.2 seconds from the start of the AVI file in.avi, and overlay it
  18873. on top of the input labelled "in":
  18874. @example
  18875. movie=in.avi:seek_point=3.2, scale=180:-1, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [over];
  18876. [in] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
  18877. [main][over] overlay=16:16 [out]
  18878. @end example
  18879. @item
  18880. Read from a video4linux2 device, and overlay it on top of the input
  18881. labelled "in":
  18882. @example
  18883. movie=/dev/video0:f=video4linux2, scale=180:-1, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [over];
  18884. [in] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
  18885. [main][over] overlay=16:16 [out]
  18886. @end example
  18887. @item
  18888. Read the first video stream and the audio stream with id 0x81 from
  18889. dvd.vob; the video is connected to the pad named "video" and the audio is
  18890. connected to the pad named "audio":
  18891. @example
  18892. movie=dvd.vob:s=v:0+#0x81 [video] [audio]
  18893. @end example
  18894. @end itemize
  18895. @subsection Commands
  18896. Both movie and amovie support the following commands:
  18897. @table @option
  18898. @item seek
  18899. Perform seek using "av_seek_frame".
  18900. The syntax is: seek @var{stream_index}|@var{timestamp}|@var{flags}
  18901. @itemize
  18902. @item
  18903. @var{stream_index}: If stream_index is -1, a default
  18904. stream is selected, and @var{timestamp} is automatically converted
  18905. from AV_TIME_BASE units to the stream specific time_base.
  18906. @item
  18907. @var{timestamp}: Timestamp in AVStream.time_base units
  18908. or, if no stream is specified, in AV_TIME_BASE units.
  18909. @item
  18910. @var{flags}: Flags which select direction and seeking mode.
  18911. @end itemize
  18912. @item get_duration
  18913. Get movie duration in AV_TIME_BASE units.
  18914. @end table
  18915. @c man end MULTIMEDIA SOURCES